Getting The Most From Your
NISSAN NAVARA
OWNER’S MANUAL
WELCOME TO YOUR NEW NISSAN NAVARA
CONTENTS
Illustrated table of contents
0
Safety — seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1
Instruments and controls
2
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3
Heater and air conditioner, and audio system
4
Starting and driving
5
In case of emergency
6
Appearance and care
7
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8
Technical information
9
Index
10
Foreword
This manual was prepared to help you understand the operation and maintenance of your
vehicle so that you may enjoy many kilometers
(miles) of driving pleasure. Please read through
this manual before operating your vehicle.
A separate Warranty Information & Maintenance
Booklet explains details about the warranties
covering your vehicle.
Your NISSAN dealer knows your vehicle best.
When you require any service or have any
questions, we will be glad to assist you with the
extensive resources available for you.
IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION
Reminders for safety!
Follow these important driving rules to help
ensure a safe and complete trip for you and
your passengers!
y
NEVER drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs.
y
ALWAYS observe posted speed limits and
never drive too fast for conditions.
y
ALWAYS use your seat belts and appropriate child restraint systems. Preteen
children should be seated in the rear seat
(if equipped).
y
ALWAYS provide information about the
proper use of vehicle safety features to all
occupants of the vehicle.
y
ALWAYS review this Owner's Manual for
important safety information.
When reading the manual
This manual includes information for all options
available on this model. Therefore, you may find
some information that does not apply to your
vehicle.
Throughout this manual, some illustrations
may only show the layout for Right-Hand Drive
(RHD) models. For Left-Hand Drive (LHD) models,
the illustrated shape and location of some components may differ.
All information, specifications and illustrations
in this manual are those in effect at the time of
printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change
specifications or designs without notice and
without obligation.
MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE
This vehicle should not be modified. Modification could affect its performance, safety or
durability, and may even violate governmental
regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from modifications
may not be covered under NISSAN warranties.
Read first — then drive safely
Before driving your vehicle, read this Owner's
Manual carefully. This will ensure familiarity with
controls and maintenance requirements, assisting you in the safe operation of your vehicle.
Throughout this manual we have used the symbol
followed by the word WARNING. This is
used to indicate the presence of a hazard that
could cause death or serious personal injury. To
avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must
be followed precisely.
The symbol
0-Foreword.indd 1
is also used throughout this manual to indicate
the presence of a hazard that could cause
minor or moderate personal injury or damages
to your vehicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, the
procedures must be followed carefully.
sic0697
If you see this symbol, it means “Do not do this”
or “Do not let this happen”.
If you see a symbol similar to these in an illustration, it means the arrow points to the front
of the vehicle.
Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these
indicate movement or action.
Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these
call attention to an item in the illustration.
followed by the word CAUTION
2021/01/06 09:12:00 AM
ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD DRIVING
Air bag warning labels (if equipped):
This vehicle will handle and maneuver differently from an ordinary passenger car, because
it has a higher center of gravity. As with other
vehicles with features of this type, failure to
operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss
of control or an accident.
Be sure to read "On-pavement and off-road
driving precautions" (P.5-6).
JVR0243X
“NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on
a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front
of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can
occur.”
Be sure to read "Air bag warning labels" (P.1-28).
0-Foreword.indd 2
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc. and licensed to Visteon
Corporation and Panasonic
Corporation.
© 2021 NISSAN SOUTH AFRICA PTY LTD
2021/01/06 09:12:00 AM
0 Illustrated table of contents
Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
(SRS) ........................................................................................................................ 0-2
Exterior front .................................................................................................... 0-3
Exterior rear ...................................................................................................... 0-4
Passenger compartment........................................................................ 0-5
Cockpit .................................................................................................................. 0-6
Left-hand drive (LHD) model ....................................................... 0-6
Right-hand drive (RHD) model ................................................... 0-7
Instrument panel .......................................................................................... 0-8
Left-hand drive (LHD) model
0-8
Right-hand drive (RHD) model ................................................... 0-9
Meters and gauges ................................................................................... 0-10
Engine compartment ............................................................................. 0-12
YD25DDTi engine ............................................................................. 0-12
QR25DE engine ................................................................................. 0-13
0-Chapter 0.indd 1
2021/01/22 08:37:40 AM
SEATS, SEAT BELTS AND SUPPLEMENTAL
RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)
WAA0242X
1.
Child restraint anchor point* (for top tether
strap child restraint) (Page 1-19)
7.
Armrest* (P.1-5)
2.
Head restraints (P.1-6)
8.
ISOFIX child restraint system* (P.1-19)
3.
Seat belts (P.1-8)
9.
Supplemental side-impact air bags*
(P.1-25)
4.
Supplemental curtain side-impact air bags*
(P.1-25)
10. Pre-tensioner seat belt system* (P.1-34)
5.
Supplemental front-impact air bags
(P. 1-25)
6.
Rear seats* (P.1-5)
12. Supplemental driver's knee air bag*
(P.1-25)
0-2
11. Front seats (P.1-2)
*:
if equipped
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 2
2021/01/22 08:37:40 AM
EXTERIOR FRONT
10. Tyres
— Tyres and wheels (P.8-30)
— Flat Tyre (P.6-2)
— Specifications (P.9-7)
— Four-Wheel Drive (4WD)*1 (P.5-16)
11. Side turn signal lights (fender or outside
rear view mirror)
— Bulb replacement (P.8-24)
12. Outside rear view mirrors (P.3-24)
13. Side view camera*1 (P.4-8)
14. Doors
— Keys (P.3-2)
— Door locks (P.3-4)
— Remote key less entry system*1 (P.3-5)
— Intelligent Key system*1 (P.3-6)
— Security system*1 (P.3-15)
15. Child safety rear door locks*1 (P.3-5)
*1: if equipped
WAA0231X
1.
Hood (P.3-16)
7.
Towing hook*2 (P.6-13)
2.
Antenna*1 (P.4-58)
8.
Front fog lights*1
3.
Windshield wipers and washers
— Switch operation (P.2-36)
— Switch operation (P.2-36)
— Wiper blade replacement (P.8-17)
*2: The layout illustrated is for the Right-Hand
Drive (RHD) model. On the Left-Hand Drive
(LHD) model, the towing hook is located on
the opposite side.
— Bulb replacement (P.8-24)
9.
Headlights and turn signal lights
— Window washer fluid (P.8-17)
— Switch operation (P.2-32)
4.
Windows (P.2-39)
— Bulb replacement (P.8-24)
5.
Roof rack*1 (P.2-44)
6.
Front view camera*1 (P.4-8)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 3
0-3
2021/01/22 08:37:41 AM
EXTERIOR REAR
WAA0232X
1.
Fuel-filler lid* or Fuel-filler cap* (P.3-17)
6.
Truck box (P.3-19)
— Fuel information (P.9-4)
7.
Power outlet* (P.2-41)
2.
Rear window defogger* (P.2-38)/Auto slide
back windows system* (P.2-40)
8.
Rear combination lights (bulb replacement)
(P.8-28)
3.
Antenna* (P.4-58)
9.
4.
High-mounted stop light* (P.8-23)
License plate lights (bulb replacement)
(P.8-29)
5.
Rear view camera*
— Rear view monitor* (P.4-3)
10. Parking sensor (sonar) system* (P.5-61)
*:
if equipped
— Intelligent Around View Monitor* (P.4-8)
0-4
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 4
2021/01/22 08:37:43 AM
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
— Outside rear view mirror remote control
switch (driver's door)* (P.3-24)
*1: if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner's
Manual (if equipped).
WAA0243X
1.
Room light* (P.2-47)
6.
Inside rear view mirror (P.3-23)
2.
Sun visors (P.2-45)
7.
Rear cup holders* (P.2-44)
3.
Map lights (P.2-46)
8.
Console box* (P.2-43)
4.
Microphone*
— Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System*
(P.4-59, P.4-65 or **)
5.
Sunglasses holder* (P.2-43)
— Power outlet (P.2-41)
— USB charging connector* (P.2-42)
9.
Cup holders* (P.2-43)
10. Door armrest
— Power window controls* (P.2-39)
— Power door lock switch (driver's door)*
(P.3-4)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 5
0-5
2021/01/22 08:37:44 AM
COCKPIT
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL
— Vehicle information display control
switch* (P.2-18)
7.
Wiper and washer switch (P.2-36)
8.
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (right
side)
— Cruise control system* (P.5-41)
— Hands-Free Phone System switch*
(P.4-59, P.4-65 or **)
— Voice recognition system switch**1
9.
Shift lever
— Automatic Transmission (AT) (P.5-13)
— Manual Transmission (MT) (P.5-16)
10. Parking sensor (sonar) system off switch*
(P.5-62)
11. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch*
(P.5-24)
12. Auto slide back windows system* (P.2-40)
13. Tilting steering wheel lever* (P.3-23)
*:
if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner's
Manual (if equipped).
WAA0233X
1.
Instrument brightness control switch (models with color display) (P.2-11)
2.
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(models with color display) (P.2-9)
5.
3.
Instrument brightness control switch
(P.2-11)/Trip computer mode switch (models without color display) (P.2-30)
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(P.2-9)/Trip computer mode switch (models without color display) (P.2-30)
6.
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (left
side)
4.
Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
— Headlight (P.2-32)
0-6
— Turn signal (P.2-35)
— Fog light* (P.2-36)
— Audio control steering switch* (P.4-56 or
**)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 6
2021/01/22 08:37:46 AM
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL
6.
Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
— Headlight (P.2-32)
— Turn signal (P.2-35)
— Fog light* (P.2-36)
7.
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(P.2-9)/Trip computer mode switch (models without color display) (P.2-30)
8.
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(models with color display) (P.2-9)
9.
Instrument brightness control switch (models with color display) (P.2-11)
10. Cup holders (for bench seat models)
(P.2-43)
11. Tilting steering wheel lever* (P.3-23)
12. Auto slide back windows system* (P.2-40)
13. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch*
(P.5-24)
14. Parking sensor (sonar) system off switch*
(P.5-62)
*:
WAA0234X
1.
Shift lever
3.
Wiper and washer switch (P.2-36)
— Automatic Transmission (AT) (P.5-13)
4.
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (right
side)
— Manual Transmission (MT) (P.5-16)
2.
Steering-wheel-mounted
side)
controls*
— Cruise control system* (P.5-41)
(left
— Hands-Free Phone System switch*
(P.4-59, P.4-65 or **)
— Audio control steering switch* (P.4-56)
or **)
— Vehicle information display control
switch* (P.2-29)
0-Chapter 0.indd 7
if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner's
Manual (if equipped).
— Voice recognition system switch**
5.
Instrument brightness control switch
(P.2-11)/Trip computer mode switch
(models without color display (P.2-30)
Illustrated table of contents
0-7
2021/01/22 08:37:47 AM
INSTRUMENT PANEL
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL
9.
Ignition switch (models without intelligent
Key system) (P.5-8)
10. Power outlet (P.2-41)
11. Parking brake
— Operation (P.3-25)
— Check (P.8-12)
12. Hill descent control switch* (P.5-24)
13. Differential lock mode switch* (P.5-22)
14. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection port
(P.4-55 or **)/Auxiliary (AUX) input jack
(P.4-55 or **)
15. Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch*
(P.5-16)
16. Heater and air conditioner control (P.4-18)
17. Glove box (P.2-43)
— Fuse box (P.8-21)
18. Side ventilator (P.4-17)
: 4WD models
: 2WD models
*:
WAA0235X
1.
Meters and gauges (P.2-7)
5.
Centre ventilator (P.4-17)
(P.2-18,
6.
Front passenger's supplemental front impact air bag (P.1-25)
Push-button ignition switch (models with
intelligent Key system) (P.5-9)
7.
Hood release handle (P.3-17)
— Vehicle
P.2-29)
2.
3.
information
display
Audio system* (P.4-23 or **)
— Rear view monitor* (P.4-3)
4.
8.
Steering wheel
— Horn (P.2-39)
— Intelligent Around View Monitor* (P.4-8)
— Driver's supplemental front-impact air
bag (P.1-25)
Hazard indicator flasher switch (P.6-2)
— Power steering (P.5-65)
0-8
if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner's
Manual (if equipped)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 8
2021/01/22 08:37:49 AM
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL
11. Hill descent control switch* (P.5-24)
12. Differential lock mode switch* (P.5-22)
13. Parking brake
— Operation (P.3-25)
— Check (P.8-12)
14. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection port*
(P.4-55 or ***)/Auxiliary (AUX) input jack*
(P.4-55 or ***)
15. Four-wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch*
(P.5-16)
16. Steering wheel
— Horn (P.2-39)
— Driver's supplemental front-impact air
bag (P.1-25)
— Power steering (P.5-65)
17. Hood release handle (P.3-17)
18. Ignition switch (models without intelligent
Key system) (P.5-8)
: 4WD models
: 2WD models
: Except for front bench seat models
WAA0236X
1.
Front passenger's supplemental
impact air bag (P.1-25)
front-
2.
Centre ventilator (P.4-17)
3.
Hazard indicator flasher switch (P.6-2)
4.
Audio system* (P.4-23 or ***) or Navigation
system** or ***
— Rear view monitor* (P.4-3)
— Intelligent Around View Monitor* (P.4-8)
5.
Push-button ignition switch (models with
intelligent Key system) (P.5-9)
6.
Meters and gauges (P.2-7)
— Vehicle information display (P.2-18,
P.2-29)
7.
Side ventilator (P.4-17)
8.
Glove box (P.2-43)
: For front bench seat models
*:
if equipped
**: See the separate Navigation System Owner's Manual (if equipped)
***: See the separate NissanConnect Owner's
Manual (if equipped)
— Fuse box (P.8-21)
9.
Heater* and air conditioner control (P.4-18)
10. Power outlet (P.2-41)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 9
0-9
2021/01/22 08:37:50 AM
METERS AND GAUGES
Model with color display
WAA0208X
1.
Tachometer (P.2-9)
— Instrument brightness control (P.2-11)
2.
Warning/Indicator lights (P.2-12)
3.
Vehicle information display (P.2-18)
— Automatic Transmission (AT) position
indicator (AT model) (P.2-25, P.5-13)
— Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode indicator*
(P.5-16)
4.
Speedometer (P.2-9)
5.
Engine coolant temperature gauge (P.2-9)
— Oil control system* (P.2-30)
6.
Fuel gauge (P.2-10)
— Odometer/twin trip odometer (P.2-9)
*:
if equipped
— Trip computer (P.2-30)
0-10
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 10
2021/01/22 08:37:51 AM
Model without color display
WAA0237X
1.
Tachometer (P.2-9)
— Odometer/twin trip odometer (P.2-9)
2.
Warning/Indicator lights (P.2-12)
— Trip computer (P.2-30)
3.
Vehicle information display (P.2-29)
— Engine
(P.2-9)
coolant
temperature
— Instrument brightness control (P.2-11)
gauge
— Automatic Transmission (AT) position
indicator (AT model) (P.2-25, P.5-13)
— Fuel gauge (P.2-10)
4.
Speedometer (P.2-9)
— Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode indicator*
(P.5-16)
*:
if equipped
— Oil control system* (P.2-30)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 11
0-11
2021/01/22 08:37:51 AM
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
YD25DDTI ENGINE
**2: The layout illustrated is for the Right-Hand
Drive (RHD) model. On the Left-Hand Drive
(LHD) model, brake (and clutch) fluid reservoir is located on the opposite side.
WAA0238X
1.
Window washer fluid reservoir (P.8-17)
8.
Air cleaner (P.8-16)
2.
Brake and clutch*1 reservoir*2 (P.8-14)
9.
Power steering fluid reservoir (P.8-15)
3.
Engine oil dipstick (P.8-8)
10. Engine drive belt location (P.8-11)
4.
Fuel filter (P.8-11)
11. Radiator filler cap (P.8-6)
5.
Engine oil filler cap (P.8-8)
6.
Fuse/fusible link holder (P.8-21)
12. Engine coolant reservoir (P.8-6)
7.
Battery (P.8-18)
*1: For manual Transmission (MT) model
— Vehicle overheat (P.6-10)
— Jump starting (P.6-7)
0-12
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 12
2021/01/22 08:37:51 AM
QR25DE ENGINE
JVC0772X
1.
Window washer fluid reservoir (P.8-17)
7.
Air cleaner (P.8-16)
2.
Brake and clutch* fluid reservoir (P.8-14)
8.
Engine coolant reservoir (P.8-6)
3.
Engine oil filler cap (P.8-8)
9.
Engine drive belt location (P.8-11)
4.
Engine oil dipstick (P.8-8)
10. Radiator filler cap (P.8-6)
5.
Fuse/Fusible link holder (P.8-21)
6.
Battery (P.8-18)
11. Power steering fluid reservoir (P.8-15)
— Jump starting (P.6-7)
*1: For manual Transmission (MT) model
— Vehicle overheat (P.6-10)
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 13
0-13
2021/01/22 08:37:51 AM
MEMO
0-14
Illustrated table of contents
0-Chapter 0.indd 14
2021/01/22 08:37:51 AM
1 Safety — seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Seats ....................................................................................................................... 1-2
Front seats ................................................................................................ 1-2
Rear seats (Double Cab models) .............................................. 1-5
Armrest (if equipped for Double Cab model) .................. 1-5
Head restraints (if equipped) ................................................................ 1-6
Adjustable head restraint components ............................. 1-6
Non-adjustable head restraint components.................. 1-6
Remove ....................................................................................................... 1-6
Install............................................................................................................. 1-7
Adjust ............................................................................................................ 1-7
Seat belts............................................................................................................. 1-8
Precautions on seat belt usage ................................................ 1-8
Child safety............................................................................................... 1-9
Pregnant women.............................................................................. 1-10
Injured persons .................................................................................. 1-10
Center mark on seat belts (if equipped).......................... 1-10
Three-point type seat belts ...................................................... 1-10
Two-point type seat belts (if equipped)........................... 1-11
Seat belt maintenance ................................................................. 1-12
Child restraints............................................................................................. 1-12
Precautions on child restraint usage................................. 1-12
Universal child restraints for front seat and rear
seats (Double Cab models) ....................................................... 1-14
ISOFIX child restraint system (if equipped) ................... 1-18
Child restraint anchorage (if equipped)........................... 1-19
Child restraint installation using ISOFIX (if
equipped)................................................................................................ 1-19
Child restraint installation using three-point type
seat belt ................................................................................................... 1-21
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) ......................................... 1-25
1-Chapter 1.indd 1
Precautions on Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) ............................................................................................................ 1-25
Supplemental air bag systems .............................................. 1-30
SRS air bag deployment conditions ................................... 1-31
Pre-tensioner seat belt system (if equipped) .............. 1-34
Repair and replacement procedure ................................... 1-34
2021/01/06 02:21:11 PM
SEATS
Manual seat adjustment (if equipped)
WARNING:
After adjusting a seat, gently shake the seat
to confirm that the seat is locked securely. If
the seat is not locked securely, it may move
suddenly and could cause the loss of control
of the vehicle.
SSS0133A
WARNING:
y
y
Do not drive and/or ride in the vehicle
with the seatback reclined. This can be
dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be
properly against the body. In an accident,
you and your passengers could be thrown
into the shoulder belt and receive neck or
other serious injuries. You and your passengers could also slide under the lap belt
and receive serious injuries.
For the most effective protection while
the vehicle is in motion, the seatback
should be upright. Always sit well back in
the seat and adjust the seat belt properly.
(See “Seat belts” (P.1-8).)
y
Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly
activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious
accidents.
y
To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not
leave children, people who require the
1-2
assistance of others or pets unattended
in your vehicle. Additionally, the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a warm
day can quickly become high enough to
cause a significant risk of injury or death
to people and pets.
CAUTION:
When adjusting the seat positions, be sure
not to contact any moving parts to avoid
possible injuries and/or damages.
FRONT SEATS
WARNING:
Do not adjust the driver's seat while driving
so that full attention may be given to vehicle
operation.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 2
2021/01/06 02:21:11 PM
JVR0392X
Forward and backward:
1.
Pull up the adjusting lever
.
2.
Slide the seat to the desired position.
3.
Release the adjusting lever to lock the seat
in position.
Reclining bench seat (front bench seat
models)
Reclining:
1.
Pull up the adjusting lever
2.
Tilt the seatback to the desired position.
.
3.
Release the adjusting lever to lock the seatback in position.
The reclining feature allows the adjustment of
the seatback for occupants of different sizes to
help obtain the proper seat belt fit. (See "Seat
belts" (P.1-8).)
The seatback may be reclined to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is parked.
JVR0417X
The bench seat can be reclined to make it easier
to remove the jacking tools from the storage
area. To recline the seatback, pull the lever up .
Seat lifter (if equipped):
Pull up or push down the adjusting lever
to
adjust the seat height until the desired position
is achieved.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 3
1-3
2021/01/06 02:21:11 PM
Power seat adjustment (if equipped)
Operating tips:
y
The power seat motor has an auto-reset
overload protection circuit. If the motor
stops during the seat adjustment, wait 30
seconds, then reactivate the switch.
y
To avoid discharge of the battery, do not
operate the power seats for a long period of
time when the engine is not running.
JVR0054X
Forward and backward:
Move forward or backward the adjusting switch
to the desired position.
Reclining:
Move forward or backward the adjusting switch
to the desired position.
The reclining feature allows the adjustment of
the seatback for occupants of different sizes to
help obtain the proper seat belt fit. (See "Seat
belts" (P.1-8).)
The seatback may be reclined to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is parked.
WARNING:
The seatback should not be reclined any more
than needed for comfort. Seat belts are most
effective when the passenger sits well back
and straight up in the seat. If the seatback is
reclined, the risk of sliding under the lap belt
and being injured is increased.
1-4
JVR0055X
Seat lifter:
1.
Pull up or push down the adjusting switch
to adjust the seat height until the desired
position is achieved.
2.
Tilt up or down the adjusting switch to
adjust the front angle of the seat until the
desired position is achieved.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 4
2021/01/06 02:21:11 PM
ARMREST (if equipped for Double Cab
model)
fold the rear seats in the following steps.
1.
Lift up the seat cushion
.
2.
Secure the seat cushion with the strap
.
To remove the jack and tools, see "Preparing
tools (P.6-2).
Do not drive the vehicle with the rear seat
folded.
JVR0056X
Lumbar support (if equipped):
The lumbar support feature provides lower
back support to the driver.
Push each side of the adjusting switch and
to adjust the seat lumbar area until the desired
position is achieved.
When returning the rear seat to the original position, be certain the seat belts and the buckles
are positioned properly. The strap can be stored
under the seat cushion using the hook-andloop fastener.
WARNING:
y
Never allow anyone to ride on the rear
seats when they are in the fold-up position. Use of this area by passengers
without proper restraints could result in
serious injury in an accident or sudden
stop.
y
When folding or returning the rear seat,
be careful not to squeeze your finger between the seat cushion and the body side.
REAR SEATS (Double Cab models)
Folding
SIC4593
Pull the armrest forward until it is horizontal.
JVR0427X
The jack and tools are stored in the tool storage
compartment located under the rear seat cushion. To access the tool storage compartment,
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 5
1-5
2021/01/06 02:21:12 PM
HEAD RESTRAINTS (if equipped)
WARNING:
Head restraints supplement the other vehicle
safety systems. They may provide additional
protection against injury in certain rear end
collisions. Adjustable head restraints must
be adjusted properly, as specified in this
section. Check the adjustment after someone
else uses the seat. Do not attach anything
to the head restraint stalks or remove the
head restraint. Do not use the seat if the
head restraint has been removed. If the
head restraint was removed, reinstall and
properly adjust the head restraint before an
occupant uses the seating position. Failure
to follow these instructions can reduce the
effectiveness of the head restraint. This may
increase the risk of serious injury or death in
a collision.
y
Your vehicle is equipped with a head restraint that may be integrated, adjustable
or non-adjustable.
y
Adjustable head restraints have multiple
notches along the stalk to lock them in a
desired adjustment position.
y
The non-adjustable head restraints have a
single locking notch to secure them to the
seat frame.
y
Proper Adjustment:
y
If the head restraint has been removed, ensure that it is reinstalled and locked in place
before riding in that designated seating
position.
ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINT COMPONENTS
JVR0203X
SSS0992
1.
Removable head restraint
2.
Multiple notches
3.
Lock knob
4.
Stalks
— For the adjustable type, align the head
restraint so the center of your ear is approximately level with the center of the
head restraint.
— If your ear position is still higher than
the recommended alignment, place the
head restraint at the highest position.
1-6
NON-ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINT
COMPONENTS
1.
Removable head restraint
2.
Single notch
3.
Lock knob
4.
Stalks
REMOVE
SSS1037
Use the following procedure to remove the
head restraint.
1.
Pull the head restraint up to the highest
position.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 6
2021/01/06 02:21:12 PM
2.
Push and hold the lock knob.
3.
Remove the head restraint from the seat.
4.
Store the head restraint properly in a secure
place so it is not loose in the vehicle.
5.
Reinstall and properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating
position.
ADJUST
Raise
INSTALL
SSS0997
To raise the head restraint, pull it up.
Adjust the head restraint so the center is level
with the center of your ears. If your ear position
is still higher than the recommended alignment,
place the head restraint at the highest position.
Make sure the head restraint is positioned from
the stored position or any non-latch position so
the lock knob is engaged in the notch before
riding in that designated seating position.
Lower
SSS1038
1.
Align the head restraint stalks with the
holes in the seat. Make sure that the head
restraint is facing the correct direction. The
stalk with the notch
must be installed in
the hole with the lock knob .
2.
Push and hold the lock knob and push the
head restraint down.
3.
Properly adjust the head restraint before an
occupant uses the seating position.
SSS1035
For adjustable head restraint
JVR0259X
For non-adjustable head restraint
Make sure the head restraint is positioned from
the stored position or any non-latch position so
the lock knob is engaged in the notch before
riding in that designated seating position.
SSS1036
To lower, push and hold the lock knob and push
the head restraint down.
Make sure the head restraint is positioned so
the lock knob is engaged in the notch before
riding in that designated seating position.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 7
1-7
2021/01/06 02:21:12 PM
SEAT BELTS
PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT USAGE
If you are wearing the seat belt properly adjusted and sitting upright and well back in the seat,
chances of being injured or killed in an accident
and/or the severity of injury may be greatly
reduced. NISSAN strongly encourages you and
all of your passengers to buckle up every time
you drive, even if your seating position includes
the supplemental air bag systems.
SSS0134A
SSS0136A
SSS0014
1-8
SSS0016
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 8
2021/01/06 02:21:12 PM
under your arm. Always route the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across
your chest. The belt should be away from
your face and neck, but not falling off your
shoulder. Serious injury may occur if a
seat belt is not worn properly.
WARNING:
y
y
y
Seat belts are designed to bear upon the
bony structure of the body, and should
be worn low across the front of the pelvis
or the pelvis, chest and shoulders, as
applicable; wearing the lap section of the
belt across the abdominal area must be
avoided. Serious injury may occur if a seat
belt is not worn properly.
Position the lap belt as low and snug as
possible around the hips, not the waist. A
lap belt worn too high could increase the
risk of internal injuries in an accident.
y
Do not allow more than one person to use
the same seat belt. Each belt assembly
must only be used by one occupant; it is
dangerous to put a belt around a child
being carried on the occupant’s lap.
y
Never carry more people in the vehicle
than there are seat belts.
y
Never wear seat belts inside out. Belts
should not be worn with straps twisted.
Doing so may reduce their effectiveness.
y
Seat belts should be adjusted as firmly
as possible, consistent with comfort, to
provide the protection for which they
have been designed. A slack belt will
greatly reduce the protection afforded to
the wearer.
y
Every person who drives or rides in this
vehicle should use a seat belt at all times.
Children should be properly restrained in
the rear seat (if equipped) and, if appropriate, in a child restraint system.
y
y
Do not put the belt behind your back or
No modifications or additions should be
made by the user which will either prevent the seat belt adjusting devices from
operating to remove slack, or prevent the
seat belt assembly from being adjusted to
remove slack.
Care should be taken to avoid contamination of the webbing with polishes, oils and
chemicals, and particularly battery acid.
Cleaning may safely be carried out using
mild soap and water. The belt should be
replaced if webbing becomes frayed, contaminated or damaged.
y
It is essential to replace the entire assembly after it has been worn in a severe
impact even if damage to the assembly is
not obvious.
y
All seat belt assemblies including retractors and attaching hardware should be
inspected after any collision by a NISSAN
dealer. NISSAN recommends that all seat
belt assemblies in use during a collision
be replaced unless the collision was minor and the belts show no damage and
continue to operate properly. Seat belt
assemblies not in use during a collision
should also be inspected and, when
necessary, replaced if either damage or
improper operation is noted.
y
Once the pre-tensioner seat belt (if
equipped) has activated, it cannot be
reused. It must be replaced together with
the retractor. Contact a NISSAN dealer.
y
Removal and installation of the pre-tensioner seat belt system (if equipped)
components should be done by a NISSAN
dealer.
CHILD SAFETY
WARNING:
y
Infants and children need special protection. The vehicle’s seat belts may not
fit them properly. The shoulder belt may
come too close to the face or neck. The lap
belt may not fit over their small hipbones.
In an accident, an improperly fitted seat
belt could cause serious or fatal injury.
y
Always use an appropriate child restraint
system.
Children need adults to help protect them.
They need to be properly restrained. The proper
restraint depends on the child’s size.
Infants and small children
SSS0099
NISSAN recommends that infants and small
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 9
1-9
2021/01/06 02:21:13 PM
children be seated in a child restraint system.
You should choose a child restraint system that
fits your vehicle and the child, and always follow
the manufacturer’s instructions for installation
and use.
Large children
WARNING:
y
Never allow children to stand or kneel on
any seats.
y
Never allow children in the luggage areas
while the vehicle is moving. A child could
be seriously injured in an accident or
sudden stop.
Children who are too large for a child restraint
system should be seated and restrained by the
seat belts that are provided.
If the child’s seating position has a shoulder belt
that fits close to the face or neck, the use of a
booster seat (commercially available) may help
overcome this. The booster seat should raise
the child so that the shoulder belt is properly
positioned across the top, middle portion of
the shoulder and the lap belt is low on the hips.
The booster seat should also fit the vehicle seat.
Once the child has grown so that the shoulder
belt is no longer on or near the face or neck
of the child, use the shoulder belt without the
booster seat. In addition, there are many types
of child restraint systems available for larger
children that should be used for maximum
protection.
1-10
PREGNANT WOMEN
THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELTS
NISSAN recommends that pregnant women
use seat belts. The seat belt should be worn
snug, and always position the lap belt as low as
possible around the hips, not the waist. Place
the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across
your chest. Never run the lap/shoulder belt over
your abdominal area. Contact your doctor for
specific recommendations.
Fastening seat belts
INJURED PERSONS
NISSAN recommends that injured persons use
seat belts. Contact your doctor for specific
recommendations.
CENTER MARK ON SEAT BELTS (if
equipped)
SSS0292
WARNING:
Selecting correct set of seat belts
SSS0703
The center seat belt buckle (and/or tongue, if
equipped) is identified by the CENTER mark. The
center seat belt tongue can be fastened only
into the center seat belt buckle.
The seatback should not be in a reclined
position any more than needed for comfort.
Seat belts are most effective when the
passenger sits well back and straight up in
the seat.
1.
Adjust the seat. (See "Seats" (P.1-2).)
2.
Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor
and insert the tongue into the buckle until
you hear and feel the latch engage.
y The retractor is designed to lock during
a sudden stop or on impact. A slow
pulling motion permits the seat belt to
move, and allows you some freedom of
movement in the seat.
y If the seat belt cannot be pulled from
its fully retracted position, firmly pull
the belt and release it. Then smoothly
pull the belt out of the retractor.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 10
2021/01/06 02:21:13 PM
WARNING:
y
SSS0467
3.
Position the lap belt portion low and snug
on the hips as shown.
4.
Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the
retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the
shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder
and is snug across your chest.
Shoulder belt height adjustment (for
front seats)
The shoulder belt anchor height should
be adjusted to the position best for you.
Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and
increase the chance or severity of injury in
an accident.
y
The shoulder belt should rest on the
middle of the shoulder. It must not rest
against the neck.
y
Be sure that the seat belt is not twisted in
any way.
y
Be sure that the shoulder belt anchor is secured by trying to move the shoulder belt
anchor up and down after adjustment.
check the operation by grasping the shoulder
belt and pulling forward quickly. The retractor
should lock and restrict further belt movement.
If the retractor does not lock during this check,
contact a NISSAN dealer immediately.
TWO-POINT TYPE SEAT BELTS (if
equipped)
Fastening seat belts
WARNING:
Every person who drives or rides in this
vehicle should use a seat belt at all times.
To adjust, pull in the release button and move
the shoulder belt anchor to the proper position
, so that the belt passes over the center of the
shoulder. The belt should be away from your
face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder.
Release the button to lock the shoulder belt
anchor into position.
Unfastening seat belts
Push the button on the buckle. The seat belt
automatically retracts.
Checking seat belt operation
SSS0448
1.
Insert the tongue into the buckle marked
CENTER until you hear and feel the latch
engage.
Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat
belt movement:
SSS0351A
y
When the seat belt is pulled quickly from the
retractor.
y
When the vehicle slows down rapidly.
To increase your confidence in the seat belts,
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 11
1-11
2021/01/06 02:21:13 PM
CHILD RESTRAINTS
SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE
Periodically check that the seat belt and all the
metal components, such as buckles, tongues,
retractors, flexible wires and anchors, work
properly. If loose parts, deterioration, cuts or
other damage on the seat belt webbing is
found, the entire seat belt assembly should be
replaced.
SSS0541
2.
Adjust the seat belt length. To shorten, hold
the tongue and pull the upper belt as illustrated . To lengthen, hold the tongue and
pull the under belt as illustrated .
PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD RESTRAINT
USAGE
If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt guide of the
seat belt anchors, the seat belts may retract
slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guide with a
clean, dry cloth.
To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a mild
soap solution or any solution recommended
for cleaning upholstery or carpet. Then wipe
with a cloth and allow the seat belts to dry in
the shade. Do not allow the seat belts to retract
until they are completely dry.
SSS0099
WARNING:
y
Infants and small children should never
be carried on your lap. It is not possible for
even the strongest adult to resist the forces of a severe accident. The child could be
crushed between the adult and parts of
the vehicle. Also, do not put the same seat
belt around both your child and yourself.
y
Infants and children need special protection. The vehicle’s seat belts may not
fit them properly. The shoulder belt may
come too close to the face or neck. The lap
belt may not fit over their small hip bones.
In an accident, an improperly fitting seat
belt could cause serious or fatal injury.
y
Infants and small children should always
be placed in an appropriate child restraint
while riding in the vehicle. Failure to use a
child restraint can result in serious injury
or death.
SSS0450
3.
Position the lap belt portion low and snug
on the hips as shown.
Unfastening seat belts
Push the button on the buckle.
1-12
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 12
2021/01/06 02:21:13 PM
y
y
y
y
y
y
Child restraint systems specially designed
for infants and small children are available from several manufacturers. When
selecting any child restraint systems,
place your child in the child restraint system and check the various adjustments
to be sure that the child restraint system
is compatible with your child. Always
follow the manufacturer’s instructions for
installation and use.
NISSAN recommends that the child
restraints be installed in the rear seat
(Double Cab model). According to accident statistics, children are safer when
properly restrained in the rear seat than
in the front seat.
Follow all of the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for installation and
use. When purchasing a child restraint,
be sure to select one which will fit your
child and vehicle. It may not be possible
to properly install some types of child
restraint in your vehicle.
The direction of the child restraint, either
front-facing or rear-facing, depends on
the type of the child restraint and the size
of the child. Refer to the child restraint
manufacturer's instructions for details.
For a front-facing child restraint system,
check to make sure the shoulder belt
does not fit close to child’s face or neck.
If it does, put the shoulder belt behind the
child restraint system. If you must install
a front-facing child restraint system in
the front seat, see "Installation on front
passenger's seat" (P.1-23).
Never install a rear-facing child restraint
on the front passenger's seat when the
front passenger's air bag is available.
Supplemental front-impact air bags
inflate with great force. A rear-facing
child restraint could be struck by the
supplemental front-impact air bags in an
accident and could seriously injure or kill
your child.
y
Adjustable seatbacks should be positioned to ensure full contact between
child restraint and seatback.
y
If the seat belt in the position where
a child restraint is installed requires a
locking device and if it is not used, injuries
could result from a child restraint system
tipping over during normal vehicle braking or cornering.
y
After attaching a child restraint, test it before you place the child in it. Push it from
side to side and tug it forward to make
sure that it is held securely in place. The
child restraint system should not move
more than 25 mm (1 in). If the restraint is
not secure, tighten the belt as necessary,
or install the restraint in another seat and
test it again.
y
Check the child restraint system in your
vehicle to be sure that it is compatible
with the vehicle’s seat belt system.
y
If a child restraint system is not anchored
properly, the risk of a child being injured
in a collision or a sudden stop greatly
increases.
y
Improper use or improper installation of a
child restraint can increase the risk or severity of injury for both the child and other
occupants of the vehicle and can lead to
serious injury or death in an accident.
y
Always use an appropriate child restraint
system. An improperly installed child restraint system could lead to serious injury
or death in an accident.
y
When the child restraint is not in use, keep
it secured with the ISOFIX child restraint
system (if equipped) or a seat belt to prevent it from being thrown around in case
of a sudden stop or accident.
NISSAN recommends that infants and small
children be seated in a child restraint system.
You should choose a child restraint system
that fits your vehicle and always follow the
manufacturer’s instructions for installation and
use. In addition, there are many types of child
restraint systems available for larger children
that should be used for maximum protection.
CAUTION:
Remember that a child restraint system left
in a closed vehicle can become very hot.
Check the seating surface and buckles before
placing your child in a child restraint system.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 13
1-13
2021/01/06 02:21:13 PM
UNIVERSAL CHILD RESTRAINTS FOR
FRONT SEAT AND REAR SEATS (Double
Cab models)
Kind of child seats (example):
NOTE:
Universal child restraints approved to UN
Regulation NO. 44 (UN R44) or UN Regulation
NO. 129 (UN R129) are clearly marked
“Universal”.
When selecting any child restraint, keep the
following points in mind:
y
Choose a child restraint that complies with
UN R44 or UN R129.
y
Place your child in the child restraint and
check the various adjustments to be sure
the child restraint is compatible with your
child. Always follow all of the recommended
procedures.
y
Check the child restraint in your vehicle to
be sure it is compatible with vehicle’s seat
belt system.
y
Refer to the tables later in this section for a
list of the recommended fitment positions.
Child safety seat categories 0 and 0+
Child safety seat categories 0+ and I
JVR0371X
JVR0372X
Mass group of child seat
Mass group
Group 0
Group 0+
1-14
Child's weight
up to 10 kg
up to 13 kg
Group I
9 to 18 kg
Group II
Group III
15 to 25 kg
22 to 36 kg
Child safety seat categories II and III
JVR0373X
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 14
2021/01/06 02:21:13 PM
Approved child restraint positions (without ISOFIX)
The following restriction is applied when using child restraints varying by infants weight and installation position.
Seating position
Mass Group
Front passenger
seat
Second row left
seat
Second row center Second row right
seat
seat
0 (<10 kg)
X
U
U
U
0+ (<13 kg)
X
U
U
U
I (9-18 kg)
X
U
U
U
II (15-25 kg)
X
UF
UF
UF
III (22-36 kg)
X
UF
UF
UF
If you install a child restraint system in the rear seat, remove the rear seat head restraint.
U:
Suitable for universal category child restraint system approved for this weight group.
UF:
Suitable for forward-facing universal category child restraint system approved for this weight
group.
X:
Not suitable for child restraint system.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 15
1-15
2021/01/06 02:21:14 PM
Permissible options for fitting an ISOFIX child restraint
The following restriction is applied when using child restraints varying by infants weight and installation position.
Mass group
Size class
Fixture
Seating position
F
ISO/L1
Front passenger
seat
X
G
ISO/L2
X
X
X
X
0 (<10 kg)
E
ISO/R1
X
IL*
X
IL*
E
ISO/R1
X
IL*
X
IL*
0+ (<13kg)
D
ISO/R2
X
IL*
X
IL*
C
ISO/R3
X
IL*
X
IL*
D
ISO/R2
X
IL*
X
IL*
C
ISO/R3
X
IL*
X
IL*
B
ISO/F2
X
IUF
X
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
X
IUF
X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
X
IUF
X
IUF
II (15 - 25 kg)
-
-
X
IL
X
IL
II (22 - 36 kg)
-
-
X
IL
X
IL
Carry-cot
I (9 - 18 kg)
Second row left
seat
X
Second row center
seat
X
Second row right
seat
X
If you install a child restraint system in the rear seat, remove the rear seat head restraint.
*:
Move the front seat forward, so there is enough space for the child restraint system and the child's legs.
IUF: Suitable for universal category forward facing child restraint system approved for this weight group.
IL:
Suitable for particular ISOFIX category child restraint system (CRS) given in the below list of vehicle list of child seat manufacturer.
X:
Not suitable for child restraint system.
1-16
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 16
2021/01/06 02:21:14 PM
List of recommended ISOFIX child restraints
Weight group
Facing position
Name of CRS
Fixture of CRS
Category
0+ (<13 kg)
Rear facing
Britax Romer Baby
Safe SHR II Plus
ISOFIX Base
ISOFIX and
support leg
R1
I (9 - 18 kg)
Front facing
Britax Romer Duo
Plus
ISOFIX and top
tether
F2X
Permissible options for fitting an i-Size child restraint
Seating position
i-Size Child
Restraint System
Front passenger
seat
Second row left
seat
X
i-U*
Second row center Second row right
seat
seat
X
i-U*
If you install a child restraint system in the rear seat, remove the rear seat head restraint.
*:
Move the front seat forward, so there is enough space for the child restraint system and the
child's legs.
i-U: Suitable for i-Size "universal" Child Restraint Systems forward and rearward facing.
i-UF: Suitable for forward-facing i-Size "universal" Child Restraint Systems only.
X:
Seating position not suitable for i-Size "universal" Child Restraint Systems.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 17
1-17
2021/01/06 02:21:14 PM
Permissible options for i-Size booster fixture
Largest suitable
booster fixture
(B2/B3)
Front passenger
seat
Seating position
Second row left Second row center Second row right
seat
seat
seat
-
B3
-
ISOFIX child restraint anchor
attachments
B3
If you install a child restraint system in the rear seat, remove the rear seat head restraint.
ISOFIX CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM (if
equipped)
Anchor attachment
ISOFIX lower anchor location
ISOFIX label location
WAB0129X
Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor
points that are used with ISOFIX child restraint
systems.
ISOFIX lower anchor location. The ISOFIX anchors are located as shown. A label is attached
to the seatback to help you locate the ISOFIX
anchors.
ISOFIX lower anchor point locations
The ISOFIX anchor points are provided to install
child restraints in the rear outboard seating
positions only. Do not attempt to install a child
restraint in the rear seat center position using
the ISOFIX anchors.
1-18
SSS0637
SSS0644
ISOFIX child restraints include two rigid attachments that can be connected to two anchors
located in the seat. With this system, you do
not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure
the child restraint. Check your child restraint
for a label stating that it is compatible with the
ISOFIX child restraints. This information may
also be in the instructions provided by the child
restraint manufacturer.
ISOFIX child restraints generally require the use
of a top tether strap or other anti-rotation devices such as support legs. When installing ISOFIX child restraints, carefully read and follow the
instructions in this manual and those supplied
with the child restraints. See "Child restraint
installation using ISOFIX" (P.1-19).
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 18
2021/01/06 02:21:14 PM
CHILD RESTRAINT ANCHORAGE (if
equipped)
Your vehicle is designed to accommodate a
child restraint system on the rear seat. When
installing a child restraint system, carefully read
and follow the instructions in this manual and
those supplied with the child restraint system.
strap be attached, attach and tighten the top
tether strap to the top tether anchor (loop).
Refer to the child restraint instructions and the
following steps.
3.
WARNING:
Child restraint anchorages are designed
to withstand only those loads imposed by
correctly fitted child restraints. Under no
circumstances are they to be used for adult
seat belts, harnesses or for attaching other
items or equipment to the vehicle. Doing so
could damage the child restraint anchorages.
The child restraint will not be properly
installed using the damaged anchorage, and
a child could be seriously injured or killed in
a collision.
JVR0422X
On the rear right outboard seating position
1.
On the rear right outboard seating position:
1.
Remove the head restraints of the rear
right outboard seat and rear center seat.
2. Route the top tether strap
through
the right top tether anchor (loop) and
under the center shoulder belt .
3. Attach the top tether strap to the top
tether anchor (loop) at the rear center
seating position.
2.
Remove the head restraint of the rear
left (or right) outboard seat and rear
center seat.
2.
Route the top tether strap
through
the center top tether anchor (loop) .
3.
Attach the top tether strap to the left
top tether anchor (loop)
(or right top
tether anchor (loop)
through under
the center shoulder belt ).
When the top tether strap is properly tightened,
the top tether anchor (loop) may bend. This is
normal and will not damage the vehicle.
CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
ISOFIX (if equipped)
WARNING:
y
Attach ISOFIX child restraints only at the
specified locations. For the ISOFIX lower
anchor locations, see . If a child restraint is
not secured properly, your child could be
seriously injured or killed in an accident.
y
Do not install child restraints that require
the use of a top tether strap to seating
positions that do not have a top tether
anchor.
y
Do not secure a child restraint in the center rear seating position using the ISOFIX
lower anchors. The child restraint will not
be secured properly.
y
Inspect the lower anchors by inserting
your fingers into the lower anchor area
and feeling to make sure there are no
On the rear left outboard seating position:
1.
The anchor points (loops) are located on the
top of the rear seatback. If the child restraint
manufacturer recommends that the top tether
1.
Tighten the top tether according to the child
restraint manufacturer's instructions.
Anchorage location
WAB0134X
On the rear center seating position:
Remove the head restraints of the rear
left outboard seat and rear center seat.
2. Route the top tether strap
through
the left top tether anchor (loop) .
3. Attach the top tether strap to the top
tether anchor (loop) at the rear center
seating position.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 19
1-19
2021/01/06 02:21:14 PM
obstructions over the ISOFIX anchors,
such as seat belt webbing or seat cushion
material.
y
The child restraint will not be secured
properly if the ISOFIX anchors are obstructed. Child restraint anchorages are
designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are they
to be used for adult seat belts, harnesses
or for attaching other items or equipment
to the vehicle. Doing so could damage
the child restraint anchorages. The child
restraint will not be properly installed
using the damaged anchorage, and a
child could be seriously injured or killed in
a collision.
1.
Position the child restraint on the seat
2.
Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the ISOFIX lower anchors .
3.
The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
Remove the head restraint to obtain the
correct child restraint fit. (See "Head restraints" (P.1-6).) Store the removed head
restraint in a secure place. Be sure to install
the head restraint when the child restraint
is removed. If the seating position does not
have an adjustable head restraint and it is
interfering with the proper child restraint fit,
try another seating position or a different
child restraint.
point. (See "Child restraint anchorage"
(P.1-19).)
.
6.
If the child restraint is equipped with other
anti-rotation devices such as support legs,
use them instead of the top tether strap
following the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions.
Installation on rear outboard seats
Front-facing:
Front-facing: Step 7
Front-facing: Step 4
Front-facing: Steps 1 and 2
1-20
4.
Shorten the rigid attachment to have
the child restraint firmly tightened; press
downward
and rearward
firmly in the
center of the child restraint with your knee
to compress the vehicle seat cushion and
seatback.
5.
If the child restraint is equipped with a top
tether strap, route the top tether strap and
secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
SSS0646A
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a front-facing
child restraint on the rear outboard seats using
ISOFIX:
SSS0754A
SSS0755A
7.
Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
8.
Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If
the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 7.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 20
2021/01/06 02:21:15 PM
downward
and rearward
firmly in the
center of the child restraint with your hand
to compress the vehicle seat cushion and
seatback.
Rear-facing:
Rear-facing: Steps 1 and 2
4.
If the child restraint is equipped with a top
tether strap, route the top tether strap and
secure the tether strap to the tether anchor
point. (See "Child restraint anchorage"
(P.1-19).)
5.
If the child restraint is equipped with other
anti-rotation devices such as support legs,
use them instead of the top tether strap
following the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions.
SSS0649A
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
restraint on the rear outboard seats using
ISOFIX:
1.
Position the child restraint on the seat
2.
Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the ISOFIX lower anchors .
CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT
Installation on rear seats (Double Cab models)
Front-facing:
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a front-facing child
restraint on the rear seats using three-point
type seat belt without automatic locking mode:
.
Front-facing: Step 1
1.
Rear-facing: Step 6
Rear-facing: Step 3
3.
SSS0756A
Shorten the rigid attachment to have
the child restraint firmly tightened; press
SSS0758A
Position the child restraint on the seat
SSS0757A
6.
Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
7.
Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If
the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 6.
Front-facing: Step 2
SSS0493A
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 21
.
1-21
2021/01/06 02:21:15 PM
2.
Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the buckle
until you hear and feel the latch engage.
3.
To prevent slack in the seat belt webbing, it
is necessary to secure the seat belt in place
with locking devices attached to the child
restraint.
5.
Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
6.
Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If
the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 5.
Rear-facing:
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
restraint on the rear seats using three-point
type seat belt without automatic locking mode:
Front-facing: Step 4
4.
Rear-facing: Step 2
2.
Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the buckle
until you hear and feel the latch engage.
3.
To prevent slack in the seat belt webbing, it
is necessary to secure the seat belt in place
with locking devices attached to the child
restraint.
SSS0647A
Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward
and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
with your knee to compress the vehicle seat
cushion and seatback while pulling up on
the seat belt.
Rear-facing: Step 1
1.
SSS0759A
Position the child restraint on the seat
.
Rear-facing: Step 4
4.
Front-facing: Step 5
1-22
SSS0638A
SSS0654A
SSS0639A
Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward
and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
with your hand to compress the vehicle
seat cushion and seatback while pulling up
on the seat belt.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 22
2021/01/06 02:21:15 PM
Installation on front passenger’s seat
Rear-facing: Step 5
5.
6.
SSS0658A
Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
SSS0300A
WARNING:
Front-facing:
y
Never install a rear facing child restraint
system on the front seat. Supplemental
front-impact air bags inflate with great
force. A rear-facing child restraint system
could be struck by the supplemental
front-impact air bags in an accident and
could seriously injure or kill your child.
y
NISSAN recommends that a child restraint
be installed on the rear seat (Double
Cab models). However, subject to local
regulations, if you must install a front
facing child restraint system on the front
passenger’s seat, move the passenger’s
seat to the rearmost position.
y
Child restraints for infants must be used
in the rear-facing direction and therefore
must not be used on the front seat.
y
Failure to use the seat belts will result in
the child restraint system not being properly secured. It could tip over or otherwise
be unsecured and cause injury to the child
in a sudden stop or collision.
Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If
the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 5.
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instructions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a front-facing child
restraint on the front passenger’s seat using
three-point type seat belt without automatic
locking mode:
1.
Move the seat to the rearmost position
Front-facing: Steps 1 and 2
1-Chapter 1.indd 23
SSS0627
2.
Adjust or remove the head restraint
3.
Position the child restraint in the seat.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
.
.
1-23
2021/01/06 02:21:15 PM
Front-facing: Step 4
SSS0360C
4.
Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the buckle
until you hear and feel the latch engage.
5.
To prevent slack in the seat belt webbing, it
is necessary to secure the seat belt in place
with locking devices attached to the child
restraint.
Front-facing: Step 6
6.
Front-facing: Step 7
SSS0302G
7.
Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
8.
Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If
the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 5
through 7.
SSS0647B
Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward
and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
with your knee to compress the vehicle seat
cushion and seatback while pulling up on
the seat belt.
1-24
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 24
2021/01/06 02:21:16 PM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM (SRS)
PRECAUTIONS ON SUPPLEMENTAL
RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)
Supplemental curtain side-impact air
bag system (if equipped)
This Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
section
contains
important
information
concerning the driver's and passenger's supplemental front-impact air bags, supplemental
driver's knee air bag (if equipped), supplemental
side-impact air bags (if equipped), supplemental curtain side-impact air bags (if equipped)
and pre-tensioner seat belts (if equipped).
This system can help cushion the impact force
to the head of the driver and passengers in front
seating positions and rear outboard seating
positions (if equipped) in certain side-impact
collisions. The supplemental curtain side-impact air bag is designed to inflate on the side
where the vehicle is impacted.
Supplemental front-impact air bag
system
This system can help cushion the impact force
to the head and chest area of the driver and/or
front passenger in certain frontal collisions. The
supplemental front-impact air bag is designed
to inflate on the front where the vehicle is impacted.
Supplemental driver's knee air bag
system (if equipped)
This system can help cushion the impact force
to the knee area of the driver in certain frontal
collisions. The supplemental driver's knee air
bag is designed to inflate on the front where the
vehicle is impacted.
Supplemental side-impact air bag
system (if equipped)
This system can help cushion the impact force
to the chest and pelvis area of the driver and
front passenger in certain side-impact collisions. The supplemental side-impact air bag
is designed to inflate on the side where the
vehicle is impacted.
The SRS is designed to supplement the accident protection provided by the driver’s and
passenger’s seat belts and is not designed to
substitute for them. The SRS can help save lives
and reduce serious injuries. However, inflating
air bags may cause abrasions or other injuries.
Air bags do not provide protection to the lower
body. Seat belts should always be correctly
worn and the occupants should always be
seated a suitable distance away from the steering wheel, instrument panel and door finishers.
(See "Seat belts" (P.1-8).) The air bags inflate
quickly in order to help protect the occupants.
The force of the air bags inflating can increase
the risk of injury if the occupants are too close
to, or are against, the air bag modules during
inflation. The air bags will deflate quickly after
deployment.
The SRS operates only when the ignition
switch is in the “ON” position.
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the SRS air bag warning light illuminates
for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This
indicates that the SRS is operational. (See
"Warning lights, indicator lights and audible
reminders" (P.2-12).)
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 25
1-25
2021/01/06 02:21:16 PM
WARNING:
y
y
The supplemental front air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a side impact, rear impact, rollover, or lower severity frontal collision. Always wear your seat
belts to help reduce the risk or severity of
injury in various kinds of accidents.
The seat belts and the supplemental
front-impact air bags are most effective
when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat. The front-impact air bags
inflate with great force. If you and your
passengers are unrestrained, leaning forward, sitting sideways, or out of position
1-26
SSS0131A
SSS0006
SSS0132A
SSS0007
in any way, you and your passengers are
at greater risk of injury or death in an accident. You and your passengers may also
receive serious or fatal injuries from the
supplemental front-impact air bag if you
are up against it when it inflates. Always
sit back against the seatback and as far
away as practical from the steering wheel
or instrument panel. Always use the seat
belts.
y
Keep hands on the outside of the steering
wheel. Placing them inside the steering
wheel rim could increase the risk of injury
if the supplemental front air bag inflates.
SSS0008
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 26
2021/01/06 02:21:16 PM
WARNING:
SSS0009
y
Never let children ride unrestrained or
extend their hands or face out of the
window. Do not attempt to hold them in
your lap or arms. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the
illustrations.
y
Children may be severely injured or killed
when the air bags inflate if they are not
properly restrained.
y
Never install a rear-facing child restraint
system in the front seat. An inflating
supplemental front-impact air bag could
seriously injure or kill your child. (See
"Child restraints" (P.1-12).)
SSS0140
SSS0099
SSS0159
SSS0059A
SSS0100
SSS0162
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 27
1-27
2021/01/06 02:21:16 PM
Be especially careful with children, who
should always be properly restrained.
The warning label is located on the surface of
the driver’s and/or passenger’s sun visor.
y
Do not use seat covers on the front seatbacks. They may interfere with the supplemental side-impact air bag inflations.
The warning label
(if equipped) is located
on the side of the passenger’s side instrument
panel.
y
Do not attach the key with heavy objects,
hard objects or objects with sharp edges.
This may cause injury if the supplemental
knee air bag inflates.
The label(s) warn you not to fit a rear-facing
child restraint system on the front passenger
seat as such a restraint system used in this
position could cause serious injury to the infant
in case of air bag deployment during a collision.
WARNING:
y
y
y
y
The supplemental side-impact air bags
(if equipped) and supplemental curtain
side-impact air bags (if equipped) ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a front
impact, rear impact, rollover, or lower severity side collision. Always wear the seat
belts to help reduce the risk or severity of
injury in accidents.
The seat belts and the supplemental
side-impact air bags and supplemental
curtain side-impact air bags are most
effective when you are sitting well back
and upright in the seat. The supplemental
side-impact air bags and supplemental
curtain side-impact air bags inflate with
great force. If you and your passengers
are unrestrained, leaning forward, sitting
sideways, or out of position in any way,
you and your passengers are at greater
risk of injury or death in an accident.
Do not allow anyone to place their hands,
legs or face near the supplemental
side-impact air bags and supplemental
curtain side-impact air bags located on
the sides of the seatback of the front seats
or near the side roof rails. Do not allow
anyone sitting in the front seats or rear
outboard seats to extend their hands out
of the windows or lean against the doors.
Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the illustrations.
When sitting in the rear seats, do not hold
onto the seatback of the front seats. If
the supplemental side-impact air bags
and supplemental curtain side-impact air
bags inflate, you may be seriously injured.
1-28
Pre-tensioner seat belt system (if
equipped)
Type A:
The pre-tensioner seat belt system may activate with the supplemental air bag system
in certain types of collisions. Working with the
front seat belt retractors and anchors, it helps
tighten the seat belt the instant the vehicle
becomes involved in certain types of collisions,
helping to restrain front seat occupants. (See
"Pre-tensioner seat belt system" (P.1-34).)
Air bag warning labels
j Air bag warning label (sample)
The label
model.
JVR0260X
design varies depending on the
The label warns:
“Extreme Hazard! Do not use a rearward facing
child restraint on a seat protected by an airbag
in front of it!”
Label location
SSS0603
Warning labels about the supplemental
front-impact air bag system are placed in the
vehicle as shown in the illustration.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 28
2021/01/06 02:21:17 PM
SRS air bag warning light
Type B:
j Air bag warning label
JVR0243X
The label warns:
“NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on
a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front
of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can
occur.”
In vehicles equipped with a front-impact passenger air bag system, use a rear-facing child
restraint system only on the rear seats (Double
Cab models).
When installing a child restraint system in your
vehicle, always follow the child restraint system
manufacturer’s instructions for installation. For
additional information, see "Child restraints"
(P.1-12).
SPA1097
The supplemental air bag warning light, displaying in the instrument panel, monitors the
circuits for the air bag systems, pre-tensioner
seat belt system (if equipped) and all related
wiring.
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the SRS air bag warning light illuminates
for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This
indicates that the SRS air bag systems are
operational.
If any of the following conditions occur, the
air bag and/or pre-tensioner seat belt system
need servicing:
y
The SRS air bag warning light remains on
after approximately 7 seconds.
y
The SRS air bag warning light flashes intermittently.
y
The SRS air bag warning light does not
illuminate at all.
Under these conditions, the air bag and/or
pre-tensioner seat belt system may not operate
properly. They must be checked and repaired.
Contact a NISSAN dealer immediately.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 29
1-29
2021/01/06 02:21:17 PM
SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG SYSTEMS
WARNING:
y
Do not place any objects on the steering
wheel pad, on the instrument panel,
under the steering column and near the
front door finishers and the front seats.
Do not place any objects between any
occupants and the steering wheel pad, on
the instrument panel, and near the front
door finishers and the front seats. Such
objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury if a supplemental air
bag inflates.
y
Immediately after inflation, several supplemental air bag system components
will be hot. Do not touch them: you may
severely burn yourself.
y
No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the supplemental air bag systems. This
is to prevent accidental inflation of the
supplemental air bags or damage to the
supplemental air bag systems.
y
Do not make unauthorized changes to
your vehicle’s electrical system, suspension system, front end structure, and side
panels. This could affect proper operation
of the supplemental air bag systems.
y
Tampering with the supplemental air bag
systems may result in serious personal
injury. Tampering includes changes to the
steering wheel and the instrument panel
by placing materials over the steering
wheel pad and above, around or on the instrument panel or by installing additional
trim materials around the supplemental
air bag systems.
WAB0133X
1.
Crash zone sensor
6.
Air bag Control Unit (ACU)
2.
Supplemental driver's knee air bag module
(if equipped)
7.
Satellite sensors (if equipped)
8.
Seat belt
equipped)
Supplemental side-impact air bag modules
(if equipped)
pre-tensioner
retractors
(if
3.
Supplemental front air bag modules
4.
Supplemental curtain side-impact air bag
inflators (if equipped)
9.
5.
Supplemental curtain side-impact air bag
modules (if equipped)
10. Door pressure sensors (if equipped for both
driver's and passenger's side doors)
1-30
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 30
2021/01/06 02:21:17 PM
y
y
Work on and around the supplemental air
bag systems should be done by a NISSAN
dealer. The SRS wiring should not be modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices
should not be used on the supplemental
air bag systems.
The SRS wiring harness connectors are
yellow for easy identification.
When the air bags inflate, a fairly loud noise may
be heard, followed by the release of smoke. This
smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a
fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it
may cause irritation and choking. Those with
a history of a breathing condition should get
fresh air promptly.
Supplemental front-impact air bag
system
Supplemental driver's knee air bag
system (if equipped)
supplemental side-impact air bag system operation.
The supplemental driver's knee air bag is located under the steering column.
Supplemental curtain side-impact air
bag system (if equipped)
The supplemental driver's knee air bag system
is designed to inflate in higher severity frontal
collisions, although it may inflate if the forces
in another type of collision are similar to those
of a higher severity impact. It may not inflate in
certain collisions.
Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an
indication of proper supplemental driver's knee
air bag system operation.
Supplemental side-impact air bag
system (if equipped)
The supplemental curtain side-impact air bag
system is designed to inflate in higher severity
side collisions, although it may inflate if the
forces in another type of collision are similar to
those of a higher severity side impact. It may
not inflate in certain side collisions. Vehicle
damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication
of proper supplemental curtain side-impact air
bag system operation.
SRS AIR BAG DEPLOYMENT CONDITIONS
The SRS air bags activate in the event of a front
or side impact in which the vehicle occupants
may be severely injured even if they are wearing
the seat belts properly.
The driver’s supplemental front-impact air bag
is located at the center of the steering wheel.
The passenger’s supplemental front-impact air
bag is located at the instrument panel above
the glove box.
The supplemental front-impact air bag system
is designed to inflate in higher severity frontal
collisions, although it may inflate if the forces in
another type of collision are similar to those of a
higher severity frontal impact. It may not inflate
in certain frontal collisions. Vehicle damage (or
lack of it) is not always an indication of proper
supplemental front-impact air bag system
operation.
The supplemental curtain side-impact air bag is
located at the roof rails.
SSS0978
The supplemental side-impact air bag is located at the outside of the front seats’ seatbacks.
The supplemental side-impact air bag system
is designed to inflate in higher severity side
collisions, although it may inflate if the forces in
another type of collision are similar to those of
a higher severity side impact. It may not inflate
in certain side collisions. Vehicle damage (or
lack of it) is not always an indication of proper
They may not activate when the crash energy
is absorbed and/or distributed by the vehicle
body. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always
an indication of proper SRS air bag system
operation.
When the SRS air bag will deploy
Supplemental front-impact air bags and
driver's knee air bag (if equipped):
The supplemental front-impact air bag and
driver's knee air bag (if equipped) systems are
designed to inflate in higher severity frontal
collisions. Some examples are shown in the
following illustrations.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 31
1-31
2021/01/06 02:21:17 PM
JVR0161X
(supplemental side-impact air bag system)
JVR0423X
The supplemental front-impact air bag and
driver's knee air bag (if equipped) systems will
deploy in the event of an impact which exceeds
a 25 km/h (16 MPH) frontal collision with a solid
wall that does not move or deform.
The supplemental front-impact air bag and
driver's knee air bag (if equipped) systems may
also deploy when the vehicle receives severe
damage to the undercarriage.
JVR0162X
(supplemental curtain side-impact air bag system)
JVR0424X
y
Hitting a curb, pavement edge or hard surface at high speed
y
Falling into a deep hole or ditch
y
Landing hard on the ground after jumping
Supplemental side-impact and curtain sideimpact air bags (if equipped):
The supplemental side-impact and curtain
side-impact air bag systems are designed to
inflate in higher severity side collisions. Some
examples are shown in the following illustrations.
1-32
y
The supplemental side-impact and curtain
side-impact air bags will deploy in the event
of a side impact with a normal passenger
vehicle that exceeds at a speed of 25 km/h
(16 MPH).
When the SRS air bag is unlikely to deploy
The SRS air bags may not deploy in cases where
the impact is not forceful enough to inflate the
SRS air bags.
For example, if the vehicle strikes an object,
such as a parked vehicle or sign pole, which can
move or deform on impact, the SRS air bags are
unlikely to deploy.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 32
2021/01/06 02:21:17 PM
Supplemental front-impact air bags and
driver's knee air bag (if equipped):
Supplemental side-impact and curtain sideimpact air bags (if equipped):
JVR0163X
JVR0154X
y
y
Striking a vehicle of the same class that is
parked
Crashing into a solid utility pole
JVR0156X
y
A collision from the side at an angle
y
A side impact with a two-wheeled vehicle
y
A frontal offset impact to the guard rails
y
A collision with a pole
When the SRS air bag will not deploy
Once the SRS air bag has inflated, the air bag
module will not function again if your vehicle
collides with another vehicle or an object.
Other examples where the SRS air bag will not
deploy are shown in the following illustrations.
Supplemental front-impact air bags and
driver's knee air bag (if equipped):
JVR0157X
JVR0155X
y
Running under the tailgate of a truck
y
A frontal offset impact to the guard rails
y
A collision from the side impacting the vehicle engine room (truck box area)
y
Vehicle rollover
JVR0159X
y
A collision from the side or rear
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 33
1-33
2021/01/06 02:21:17 PM
y
Vehicle rollover
pre-tensioner seat belt system.
Supplemental side-impact and curtain sideimpact air bags (if equipped):
y
y
JVR0160X
y
A frontal collision with a parked or moving
vehicle
y
A rear collision
PRE-TENSIONER SEAT BELT SYSTEM (if
equipped)
WARNING:
y
The pre-tensioner seat belt cannot be reused after activation. It must be replaced
together with the retractor and buckle as
a unit.
y
If the vehicle becomes involved in a collision but the pre-tensioner is not activated,
be sure to have the pre-tensioner system
checked and, if necessary, replaced by a
NISSAN dealer.
y
No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring of
the pre-tensioner seat belt system. This
is to prevent accidental activation of the
pre-tensioner seat belt or damage to the
1-34
Work around or on the pre-tensioner seat
belt system should be done by a NISSAN
dealer. The SRS wiring should not be modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices
should not be used on the pre-tensioner
seat belt system.
If you need to dispose of the pre-tensioner seat belt system, or scrap the
vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Correct
pre-tensioner disposal procedures are set
forth in the appropriate NISSAN Service
Manual. Incorrect disposal procedures
could cause personal injury.
The pre-tensioner is encased with the front seat
belt’s retractor and anchor. These seat belts are
used the same as conventional seat belts.
When the pre-tensioner seat belt activates, a
fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by the
release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and
does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken
not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and
choking. Those with a history of a breathing
condition should get fresh air promptly.
y
The air bag systems should be inspected
by a NISSAN dealer if there is any damage
to the vehicle.
y
If you need to dispose of the SRS or scrap
the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer.
Correct disposal procedures are set forth
in the appropriate NISSAN Service Manual.
Incorrect disposal procedures could cause
personal injury.
The supplemental front-impact air bags and
pre-tensioner seat belts (if equipped) are designed to activate on a one-time-only basis. As
a reminder, unless the SRS air bag warning light
is damaged, the SRS air bag warning light remains illuminated after inflation has occurred.
The repair and replacement of the SRS should
be done only by a NISSAN dealer.
When maintenance work is required on the
vehicle, information about the air bags, pre-tensioner seat belts and related parts should be
pointed out to the person performing the
maintenance. The ignition switch should always
be in the “LOCK” position when working under
the hood or inside the vehicle.
REPAIR AND REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE
WARNING:
y
Once the supplemental front-impact
air bags have been inflated, the air bag
modules will not function and must be
replaced. The air bag modules must be
replaced by a NISSAN dealer. The inflated
air bag modules cannot be repaired.
Safety - seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1-Chapter 1.indd 34
2021/01/06 02:21:18 PM
2 Instruments and controls
Cockpit .................................................................................................................. 2-3
Left-Hand drive (LHD) model ...................................................... 2-3
Right-Hand drive (RHD) model................................................... 2-4
Instrument panel .......................................................................................... 2-5
Left-Hand drive (LHD) model ...................................................... 2-5
Right-Hand drive (RHD) model................................................... 2-6
Meters and gauges ...................................................................................... 2-7
Speedometer and odometer...................................................... 2-9
Tachometer.............................................................................................. 2-9
Engine coolant temperature gauge...................................... 2-9
Fuel gauge ............................................................................................. 2-10
Instrument brightness control ............................................... 2-11
Warning lights, indicator lights and
audible reminders...................................................................................... 2-12
Checking lights................................................................................... 2-13
Warning lights .................................................................................... 2-13
Indicator lights ................................................................................. 2-16
Audible reminders ............................................................................ 2-17
Vehicle information display (models with
color display) ................................................................................................. 2-18
How to use the vehicle information display ................. 2-18
Startup display ................................................................................... 2-19
Settings ................................................................................................... 2-19
Vehicle information display warnings
and indicators ..................................................................................... 2-22
Trip computer...................................................................................... 2-27
Clock and outside air temperature (if equipped) ..... 2-29
Vehicle information display (models without
color display) ................................................................................................. 2-29
2-Chapter 2.indd 1
Outside air temperature (if equipped) .............................. 2-30
Trip computer...................................................................................... 2-30
Oil control system (if equipped) ............................................. 2-30
Headlight and turn signal switch................................................... 2-32
Headlight switch ............................................................................... 2-32
Battery saver system..................................................................... 2-35
Turn signal switch ............................................................................ 2-35
Fog light switch (if equipped)............................................................ 2-36
Front fog lights (if equipped).................................................... 2-36
Wiper and washer switch..................................................................... 2-36
Windshield wiper and washer switch................................ 2-36
Rain-sensing auto wiper system (if equipped)........... 2-37
Defogger switch (if equipped) .......................................................... 2-38
Horn...................................................................................................................... 2-39
Windows............................................................................................................ 2-39
Manual windows (if equipped)................................................ 2-39
Power windows (if equipped) .................................................. 2-39
Auto slide back windows system (if equipped).......... 2-40
Power outlets ................................................................................................ 2-41
USB (Universal Serial Bus) charging connector
(if equipped) .......................................................................................... 2-42
Storage .............................................................................................................. 2-43
Glove box ................................................................................................ 2-43
Console box (if equipped)........................................................... 2-43
Sunglasses holder (if equipped) ............................................ 2-43
Cup holders........................................................................................... 2-43
Roof rack (if equipped).................................................................. 2-44
Card holder (if equipped) ............................................................ 2-45
Sun visors......................................................................................................... 2-45
2021/01/22 11:46:57 AM
Interior lights ................................................................................................. 2-45
Interior light switch (if equipped) ......................................... 2-45
Console light (if equipped) ......................................................... 2-46
Map lights ............................................................................................... 2-46
Map light control switch (if equipped) .............................. 2-46
Room light (if equipped) .............................................................. 2-47
Vanity mirror lights (if equipped) .......................................... 2-47
Battery saver system..................................................................... 2-47
2-Chapter 2.indd 2
2021/01/22 11:46:57 AM
COCKPIT
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL
switch*
7.
Wiper and washer switch
8.
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (right
side)
— Cruise control system*
— Hands-Free Phone System switch*
— Voice recognition system switch*
9.
Shift lever
— Automatic Transmission (AT)
— Manual Transmission (MT)
10. Parking sensor (sonar) system off switch*
11. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch*
12. Auto slide back window system*
13. Tilting steering wheel lever*
*:
if equipped
WAA0233X
1.
Instrument brightness control switch (models with color display)
2.
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(models with color display)
5.
3.
Instrument brightness control switch/Trip
computer mode switch (models without
color display)
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer/
Trip computer mode switch (models without color display)
6.
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (left
side)
4.
Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
— Headlight
— Turn signal
— Fog light*
— Audio control steering switch*
— Vehicle information display control
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 3
2-3
2021/01/22 11:46:59 AM
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL
— Headlight )
— Turn signal
— Fog light*
7.
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer /
Trip computer mode switch (models without color display)
8.
TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(models with color display)
9.
Instrument brightness control switch (models with color display)
10. Cup holders (for bench seat models)
11. Tilting steering wheel lever*
12. Auto slide back window system*
13. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch*
14. Parking sensor (sonar) system off switch*
*:
if equipped
WAA0234X
1.
Shift lever
3.
Wiper and washer switch
— Automatic Transmission (AT)
4.
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (right
side)
— Manual Transmission (MT)
2.
— Cruise control system*
Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (left
side)
— Hands-Free Phone System switch*
— Audio control steering switch*
— Vehicle information display control
switch*
2-4
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 4
— Voice recognition system switch*
5.
Instrument brightness control switch /Trip
computer mode switch (models without
color display
6.
Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
2021/01/22 11:47:00 AM
INSTRUMENT PANEL
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL
Key system)
10. Power outlet
11. Parking brake
— Operation
— Check
12. Hill descent control switch*
13. Differential lock mode switch*
14. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection port /
Auxiliary (AUX) input jack
15. Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch*
16. Heater and air conditioner control
17. Glove box
— Fuse box
18. Side ventilator
: 4WD models
: 2WD models
*:
if equipped
WAA0235X
1.
Meters and gauges
— Vehicle information display
6.
Front passenger's supplemental front impact air bag
7.
Hood release handle
2.
Push-button ignition switch (models with
intelligent Key system)
3.
Audio system*
— Horn
— Rear view monitor*
— Driver's supplemental front-impact air
bag
8.
— Intelligent Around View Monitor*
4.
Hazard indicator flasher switch
5.
Centre ventilator
Steering wheel
— Power steering
9.
Ignition switch (models without intelligent
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 5
2-5
2021/01/22 11:47:02 AM
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL
13. Parking brake
— Operation
— Check
14. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection port*
/Auxiliary (AUX) input jack*
15. Four-wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch* )
16. Steering wheel
— Horn
— Driver's supplemental front-impact air
bag
— Power steering
17. Hood release handle
18. Ignition switch (models without intelligent
Key system)
: 4WD models
: 2WD models
: Except for front bench seat models
: For front bench seat models
*:
if equipped
WAA0236X
1.
Front passenger's supplemental frontimpact air bag
6.
2.
Centre ventilator
3.
Hazard indicator flasher switch
7.
Side ventilator
4.
Audio system* or Navigation system*
8.
Glove box
— Rear view monitor*
— Intelligent Around View Monitor*
5.
Push-button ignition switch (models with
intelligent Key system)
2-6
Meters and gauges
— Vehicle information display
— Fuse box
9.
Heater* and air conditioner control
10. Power outlet
11. Hill descent control switch*
12. Differential lock mode switch*
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 6
2021/01/22 11:47:04 AM
METERS AND GAUGES
Model with color display
WAA0208X
1.
Tachometer
4.
Speedometer
2.
Warning/Indicator lights
5.
Engine coolant temperature gauge
3.
Vehicle information display
6.
Fuel gauge
— Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode indicator*
*:
if equipped
— Odometer/twin trip odometer
The needle indicators may move slightly after
the ignition switch is placed in the "OFF" position. This is not a malfunction.
— Trip computer
— Instrument brightness control
— Automatic Transmission (AT) position
indicator (AT model)
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 7
2-7
2021/01/22 11:47:07 AM
Model without color display
WAA0237X
1.
Tachometer
— Instrument brightness control
2.
Warning/Indicator lights
3.
Vehicle information display
— Automatic Transmission (AT) position
indicator (AT model)
— Engine coolant temperature gauge
— Fuel gauge
— Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode indicator*
— Oil control system*
— Odometer/twin trip odometer
4.
Speedometer
*:
if equipped
The needle indicators may move slightly after
the ignition switch is placed in the "OFF" position. This is not a malfunction.
— Trip computer
2-8
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 8
2021/01/22 11:47:09 AM
SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER
individual trips.
Speedometer
Changing display:
TRIP A g TRIP B g Trip computer mode g TRIP
A
Push the TRIP RESET switch
(located on the
instrument panel) to change the display as
follows:
For trip computer information, see "Trip computer (P.2-30).
Resetting trip odometer:
TRIP A g TRIP B g ODO g TRIP A
Push the trip odometer reset switch
for approximately 1 second to reset the trip odometer
to zero.
Resetting twin trip odometer:
Push the TRIP RESET switch
for more than 1
second to reset the trip odometer to zero.
TACHOMETER
Odometer (models without color
display)
JVI1107X
The speedometer indicates the vehicle speed.
Odometer (models with color display)
JVI0278X
JVI1233X
Odometer/twin trip odometer:
WAC0500X
Odometer/twin trip odometer:
The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayed
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
The odometer displays the total distance the
vehicle has been driven.
The odometer and twin trip odometer
are
displayed below the vehicle information display
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
The twin trip odometer
of individual trips.
The odometer records the total distance the
vehicle has been driven.
Push the trip odometer reset switch
change the display as follows:
The twin trip odometer records the distance of
displays the distance
The tachometer indicates the engine speed in
revolutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev the
engine into the red zone .
The red zone varies with models.
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
GAUGE
CAUTION:
y
If the gauge indicates the engine coolant
temperature is near the hot (H) end of the
normal range, reduce vehicle speed to
decrease the temperature.
y
If the gauge is over the normal range, stop
Changing trip odometer display:
to
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 9
2-9
2021/01/22 11:47:09 AM
the vehicle as soon as safely possible and
let the engine idle.
y
Models without color display
The fuel gauge indicates the approximate fuel
level in the tank when the ignition switch is in
the “ON” position.
If the engine is overheated, continued
operation of the vehicle may seriously
damage the engine. (See "If your vehicle
overheats" (P.6-10) for immediate action
required.)
The gauge may move slightly during braking,
turning, accelerating, or going up and down hills
due to movement of fuel in the tank.
The low fuel warning appears on the vehicle information display when the fuel level in the tank
is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is convenient,
preferably before the gauge reads the empty (0)
position.
Models with color display
JVI1234X
The engine coolant temperature gauge
cates the engine coolant temperature.
indi-
The engine coolant temperature is normal
when the gauge is within the zone
shown in
the illustration.
WAC0645X
The engine coolant temperature gauge indicates the engine coolant temperature.
The engine coolant temperature is normal
when the gauge needle points within the zone
shown in the illustration.
The engine coolant temperature will vary with
the outside air temperature and driving conditions.
The arrow,
, indicates that the fuel-filler lid is
located on the left side of the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Refuel before the gauge reads the empty (0)
position.
There is a small reserve of fuel in the tank when
the fuel gauge reads the empty (0) position.
Models without color display
FUEL GAUGE
Models with color display
The engine coolant temperature will vary with
the outside air temperature and driving conditions.
JVI1235X
JVI0602X
2-10
The fuel gauge
indicates the approximate
fuel level in the tank when the ignition switch is
in the “ON” position.
The gauge may move slightly during braking,
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 10
2021/01/22 11:47:09 AM
Models without color display
turning, accelerating, or going up and down hills
due to movement of fuel in the tank.
The low fuel warning light illuminates when the
fuel level in the tank is getting low. Refuel as
soon as it is convenient, preferably before the
gauge reads 0.
The arrow,
, indicates that the fuel-filler lid is
located on the left side of the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Refuel before the gauge reads 0 (empty).
There is a small reserve of fuel in the tank when
the fuel gauge reads 0 (empty).
INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS CONTROL
Models with color display
WAC0501X
The instrument brightness control switch can
be operated when the ignition switch is in the
“ON” position. When the switch is operated, the
vehicle information display switches to the
brightness adjustment mode.
Push the + side of the switch to brighten the
meter panel lights. The bar moves to the right
side.
Push the - side of the switch to dim the lights.
The bar moves to the left side.
The vehicle information display returns to the
normal display when the instrument brightness
control switch is not operated for more than 5
seconds.
JVI1236X
The instrument brightness control operates
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position
and the headlight switch is in either the
or
position.
Turn the instrument brightness control switch
to adjust the brightness of the meter. The
brightness indicator
will be shown briefly in
the vehicle information display when the control is turned.
When the brightness level reaches the maximum or minimum, a beep will sound.
JVI1042X
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 11
2-11
2021/01/22 11:47:11 AM
WARNING LIGHTS, INDICATOR
LIGHTS AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light*
Automatic Transmission (AT) check
warning light (AT model)
Automatic Transmission (AT) oil temperature warning light (AT model)
Automatic Transmission (AT) park
warning light (AT model)
Brake warning light
High beam indicator light
Master warning light*
Hill descent control system on indicator light*
Seat belt warning light*
Malfunction indicator light (MIL)
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
air bag warning light
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning light*
Security indicator light*
Small light indicator light*
Charge warning light
Water-in-fuel-filter warning light
Turn signals/hazard indicator lights
Door open warning light*
Differential lock indicator light*
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off
indicator light*
Engine oil pressure warning light
Front fog lights indicator light*
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning light
(4WD model)
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light*
2-12
Low fuel warning light*
*: if equipped
Glow plug indicator light
High beam assist indicator light*
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 12
2021/01/22 11:47:11 AM
CHECKING LIGHTS
With all doors closed, apply the parking brake,
fasten the seat belts and place the ignition
switch in the "ON" position without starting the
engine. The following lights (if equipped) will
come on:
,
,
,
,
,
.
The following lights (if equipped) will come on
briefly and then go off:
,
(YD25DDTi engine model),
(YD25DDTi engine model)
,
,
,
,
,
.
If any light does not come on or operates in a
way other than described, it may indicate a
burned-out bulb and/or a system malfunction.
Have the system checked, and if necessary
repaired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
Models with color display:
Some indicators and warnings are also displayed on the vehicle information display between the speedometer and tachometer. (See
"Vehicle information display (models with color
display)" (P.2-18).)
WARNING LIGHTS
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)
warning light (if equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning
light illuminates and then turns off. This indicates the ABS is operational.
If the ABS warning light illuminates while the engine is running, or while driving, it may indicate
the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the
system checked by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock
function is turned off. The brake system then
operates normally, but without anti-lock assistance. (See "Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)"
(P.5-66).)
While the differential lock (if equipped) is engaged, the ABS warning light illuminates. This
indicates that the anti-lock function is not
fully operating. (See "Rear differential locking
system" (P.5-22) for the rear differential lock
function.)
Automatic Transmission (AT)
check warning light (AT model)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Automatic Transmission (AT) check warning
light illuminates and then turns off. This indicates that the AT is operational.
If the AT check warning light illuminates while
the engine is running, or while driving, it may
indicate that the AT is not functioning properly and may need servicing. Have the system
checked, and if necessary repaired, by a NISSAN
dealer promptly.
Automatic Transmission (AT) oil
temperature warning light (AT model)
This light illuminates when the Automatic
Transmission (AT) oil temperature is too high.
If the light illuminates while driving, reduce the
vehicle speed as soon as safely possible until
the light turns off.
Automatic Transmission (AT) park
warning light (if equipped)
If the ATP warning light is on, this indicates that
the automatic transmission P (Park) position will
not function and the transfer case is in neutral.
If the transfer control is not secured in any driving position while the AT shift lever is in the “P”
(Park) position, the transmission will disengage
and the wheels will not lock.
If the ATP warning light illuminates with the
shift lever in the “P” (Park) position, shift the
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch to the
2WD, 4H or 4LO position again with the shift
lever in the N (Neutral) position. (See "FourWheel Drive (4WD)" (P.5-16).)
WARNING:
If the 4WD mode indicator (see "4WD mode
indicator" (P.5-20)) is “OFF” or the ATP
warning light is “ON”, this indicates that the
automatic transmission P (Park) position will
not function and could result in the vehicle
moving unexpectedly, causing serious personal injury or property damage. Always set
the parking brake.
Brake warning light
WARNING:
y
If the brake fluid level is below the
minimum mark on the brake fluid
reservoir, do not drive the vehicle until
the brake system has been checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
y
Even if you judge it to be safe, have your
vehicle towed because driving it could be
dangerous.
CAUTION:
Continued vehicle operation when the AT oil
temperature warning light is on may damage
the AT.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 13
2-13
2021/01/22 11:47:12 AM
y
Depressing the brake pedal without the
engine running and/or with a low brake
fluid level could increase the stopping
distance and require greater pedal travel
distance and effort.
The brake warning light indicates the parking
brake system operation, a low brake fluid level
of the brake system and an Anti-lock Braking
System (ABS) malfunction.
Parking brake warning indicator:
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, the brake warning light illuminates.
When the engine is started and the parking
brake is released, the brake warning light turns
off.
If the parking brake is not fully released, the
brake warning light remains on. Be sure that
the brake warning light has turned off before
driving. (See "Parking brake" (P.3-25).)
Low brake fluid warning indicator:
If the brake warning light illuminates while the
engine is running, or while driving, and the parking brake is released, it may indicate the brake
fluid level is low.
When the brake warning light illuminates while
driving, stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible. Stop the engine and check the brake fluid
level. If the brake fluid level is at the minimum
mark, add brake fluid as necessary. (See "Brake
fluid" (P.8-14).)
If the brake fluid level is sufficient, have the brake
system checked by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning
indicator (if equipped):
When the parking brake is released and the
brake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brake
warning light and the Anti-lock Braking System
(ABS) warning light illuminate, it may indicate the
ABS is not functioning properly. Have the brake
system checked, and if necessary repaired, by a
NISSAN dealer promptly. (See "Anti-lock Braking
System (ABS) warning light" (P.2-13).)
Charge warning light
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the charge warning light illuminates. After
starting the engine, the charge warning light
turns off. This indicates that the charging system is operational.
If the charge warning light illuminates while
the engine is running, or while driving, it may
indicate that the charging system is not functioning properly and may need servicing.
When the charge warning light illuminates
while driving, stop the vehicle safely as soon as
possible. Stop the engine and check the alternator belt. If the alternator belt is loose, broken
or missing, the charging system needs repair.
(See "Drive belt" (P.8-11).)
If the alternator belt appears to be functioning
correctly but the charge warning light remains
illuminated, have the charging system checked
by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
CAUTION:
Do not continue driving if the alternator belt is
loose, broken or missing.
Door open warning light (if
equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the door open warning light illuminates if any of
the doors are open or not closed securely.
Engine oil pressure warning light
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the engine oil pressure warning light illuminates. After starting the engine, the engine oil
pressure warning light turns off. This indicates
that the oil pressure sensors in the engine are
operational.
If the engine oil pressure warning light illuminates or blinks while the engine is running, it
may indicate that the engine oil pressure is low.
Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.
Stop the engine immediately and call a NISSAN
dealer.
CAUTION:
y
Running the engine with the engine oil
pressure warning light illuminated could
cause serious damage to the engine.
y
The engine oil pressure warning light is
not designed to indicate a low oil level.
The oil level should be checked using the
dipstick. (See "Engine oil" (P.8-8).)
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning
light (4WD model)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning light
illuminates. After starting the engine, the 4WD
warning light turns off.
If the 4WD system malfunctions or the revolu-
2-14
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 14
2021/01/22 11:47:12 AM
tion or radius of the front and the rear wheel
differs, the warning light will either remain illuminated or blink. (See "Four-Wheel Drive (4WD)"
(P.5-16).)
CAUTION:
y
y
If the 4WD warning light illuminates or
blinks while driving, reduce the vehicle
speed and have your vehicle checked by a
NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.
Do not drive on dry and hard surface
roads in the 4H or 4LO position. If the
4WD warning light turns on when you are
driving on dry and hard surface roads:
— in the 4H position, shift the 4WD mode
switch to 2WD.
— in the 4LO position, stop the vehicle
and shift the transmission lever to the
“N” (Neutral) position with the brake
pedal depressed and shift the 4WD
mode switch to 2WD.
ligent Emergency Braking" (P.5-43).
See "Vehicle information display (models with
color display)" (P.2-18).
Low fuel warning light (if
equipped)
The low fuel warning light illuminates when the
fuel level in the tank is getting low. Refuel as
soon as it is convenient, preferably before the
fuel gauge reaches the empty (0) position.
There will be a small reserve of fuel remaining
in the tank when the fuel gauge reaches the
empty (0) position.
Master warning light (if equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the master warning light illuminates if any of
the following are displayed on the vehicle information display.
y
No Key Detected warning (if equipped)
y
Key ID Incorrect warning (if equipped)
y
Release Parking Brake warning
If the warning light is still on after the above operations, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN
dealer as soon as possible.
y
Door open warning
y
Key System Error warning (if equipped)
y
Low Oil Pressure warning (if equipped)
Intelligent Emergency Braking
system warning light (if equipped)
y
4WD Error (if equipped)
y
Shipping Mode On Push Storage Fuse warning (if equipped)
y
Headlight
equipped)
y
Automatic Transmission (AT) Error warning
(Automatic Transmission (AT) models)
y
Parking Sensor Error (if equipped)
y
ITS malfunction (if equipped)
y
Driver Attention Alert warning (if equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light illuminates. After starting the
engine, the warning light turns off.
This light illuminates when the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system is set to OFF on the
vehicle information display.
If the light illuminates when the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system is ON, it may indicate that the system is unavailable. See "Intel-
System
Error
warning
Seat belt warning light (if
equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the seat belt warning light illuminates. The light
will continue to illuminate until the driver’s and/
or the front passenger’s (if equipped) seat belts
are fastened.
When the vehicle speed exceeds 15 km/h (10
MPH), the light will blink and the chime will
sound unless the driver’s and/or the front
passenger's (if equipped) seat belts are securely
fastened. The chime will continue to sound for
about 95 seconds until the seat belt is fastened.
For precautions on seat belt usage, see "Seat
belts" (P.1-8).
Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) air bag warning light (if equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) air
bag warning light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This indicates the SRS
air bag system is operational.
(if
If any of the following conditions occur, the SRS
air bag system and/or pre-tensioner seat belt
(if equipped) need servicing. Have the system
checked, and if necessary repaired, by a NISSAN
dealer promptly.
y
The SRS air bag warning light remains illuminated after about 7 seconds.
y
The SRS air bag warning light flashes intermittently.
y
The SRS air bag warning light does not
come on at all.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 15
2-15
2021/01/22 11:47:13 AM
Unless checked and repaired, the SRS air bag
system and/or pre-tensioner seat belt may not
function properly. (See "Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS)" (P.1-25).)
INDICATOR LIGHTS
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)
warning light (if equipped)
When the differential lock mode switch is in the
“ON” position, the differential lock indicator light
will blink and then stay on after the differential
gear is completely locked.
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning
light illuminates and then turns off.
Differential lock indicator light (if
equipped)
See "Rear differential locking system" (P.5-22).
The warning light blinks when the VDC system
is operating.
Front fog light indicator light (if
equipped)
When the warning light blinks while driving, the
driving condition is slippery and the vehicle’s
traction limit is about to be exceeded.
The front fog light indicator light illuminates
when the front fog lights are on. (See "Fog light
switch" (P.2-36).)
If the VDC warning light illuminates while the
engine is running or while driving, it may indicate that the VDC system is not functioning
properly and may need servicing. Have the
system checked, and if necessary repaired, by a
NISSAN dealer promptly. If a malfunction occurs,
the VDC function is turned off, but the vehicle
is still drivable. (See "Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) system" (P.5-24).)
Water-in-fuel-filter warning light
YD25DDTi engine model:
If the water-in-fuel-filter warning light illuminates while the engine is running, drain the
water from the fuel filter promptly. (See "Fuel
filter (YD25DDTi engine model)" (P.8-11).)
CAUTION:
Continuing vehicle operation without properly draining could cause serious damage to the
engine.
2-16
Glow plug indicator light
YD25DDTi engine model:
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the glow plug indicator light illuminates and
turns off after the glow plugs have warmed up.
If the glow plugs have already warmed up, the
glow plug indicator flashes briefly and then
turns off.
High beam assist indicator light (if
equipped)
This indicator light illuminates when the headlights come on while the headlight switch is
in the “AUTO” position with the high beam selected. This indicates that the high beam assist
system is operational. (See "Headlight and turn
signal switch (P.2-32).)
High beam indicator light
The high beam indicator light illuminates when
the headlight high beam is on. The indicator
turns off when the low beam is selected. (See
"Headlight and turn signal switch" (P.2-32).)
Hill descent control system ON
indicator light (if equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position
the hill descent control system on indicator
light illuminates briefly and then turns off. This
indicates that the hill descent control system is
operational.
The light illuminates when the hill descent control system is activated.
If the hill descent control switch is on and the
indicator light blinks, the system is not engaged.
If the indicator light does not illuminate or blink
when the hill descent control switch is on, the
system may not be functioning properly. Have
the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
For additional information, see "Hill descent
control system" (P.5-24).
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
CAUTION:
y
Continuing vehicle operation without
proper servicing of the engine control
system could lead to poor driveability,
reduced fuel economy, and damage to the
engine control system, which may affect
the vehicle’s warranty coverage.
y
Incorrect setting of the engine control
system may lead to non-compliance of
local and national emission laws and
regulations.
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) illuminates.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 16
2021/01/22 11:47:13 AM
After starting the engine, the MIL turns off. This
indicates that the engine control system is
operational.
If the Malfunction Indicator Light illuminates
or blinks while the engine is running, it may
indicate that the engine control system is not
functioning properly and may need servicing.
Have the system checked, and if necessary
repaired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
Precautions:
Turn signal/hazard indicator lights
The turn signal/hazard indicator lights blink
when the turn signal switch lever or hazard
indicator flasher switch is on. (See "Headlight
and turn signal switch" (P.2-32) or "Hazard
indicator flasher switch" (P.6-2).)
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off
indicator light (if equipped)
ing sound is heard.
Have the system checked, and if necessary
repaired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly. (See
"Brakes" (P.8-12).)
Door lock warning chime
The chime will sound if any of the following
operations are detected:
Models with Intelligent Key system:
To reduce or avoid possible damage to the
engine control system when the MIL blinks:
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator
light illuminates and then turns off.
The chime sounds if the driver's side door is
opened while the ignition switch is placed in the
“ACC” position.
y
Avoid driving at speeds above 70 km/h (43
MPH).
The VDC off indicator light illuminates when the
VDC OFF switch is pushed to the “OFF” position.
y
Avoid sudden acceleration or deceleration.
y
Avoid going up steep uphill grades.
When the VDC OFF switch is pushed to the “OFF”
position, the VDC system is turned off.
When the chime sounds, be sure to check both
the vehicle and the Intelligent Key. (See "Troubleshooting guide" (P.3-11).)
y
Avoid carrying or towing unnecessary loads.
Security indicator light (if
equipped)
The security indicator light blinks when the ignition switch is in the “ACC”, “OFF” or “LOCK” position. This function indicates that the security
system equipped on the vehicle is operational.
If the security system is malfunctioning, this
light will remain on while the ignition switch
is in the “ON” position. (See "Security system"
(P.3-15) for additional information.)
Small light indicator light (if
equipped)
The light illuminates when the headlight switch
is turned to the
position.
When the rear differential lock is engaged with
the differential lock mode switch or the 4LO
position is selected with the Four-Wheel Drive
(4WD) mode switch, the VDC system is disabled
and the VDC off indicator light illuminates.
(See "Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system"
(P.5-24) and "Rear differential locking system"
(P.5-22).)
AUDIBLE REMINDERS
Brake pad wear warning
The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings. When a brake pad requires replacement, it
will make a high pitched scraping sound when
the vehicle is in motion. This scraping sound
will first occur only when the brake pedal is
depressed. After more wear of the brake pad,
the sound will always be heard even if the
brake pedal is not depressed. Have the brakes
checked as soon as possible if the wear warn-
Models without Intelligent Key system:
The chime sounds if the driver's side door
is opened while the key is left in the ignition
switch and the ignition switch is in the “ACC”,
“OFF” or “LOCK” position. Remove the key and
take it with you when leaving the vehicle.
Light reminder chime
The light reminder chime will sound if the
driver’s side door is opened and the headlight
switch is in either the
or
position, and
the ignition switch is in the “ACC”, “OFF” or
“LOCK” position.
Be sure to turn the headlight switch to the “OFF”
(if equipped) or “AUTO” (if equipped) position
when you leave the vehicle.
Parking brake reminder chime
The parking brake reminder chime will sound
if the vehicle is driven at more than 7 km/h (4
MPH) with the parking brake applied. Stop the
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 17
2-17
2021/01/22 11:47:15 AM
VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY
(models with color display)
vehicle and release the parking brake.
y
Seat belt warning chime (if equipped)
The displayed icons/messages in the vehicle
information display may differ depending on
the model.
When the vehicle speed exceeds 15 km/h (10
MPH), the chime will sound unless the driver’s
and/or the front passenger’s (if equipped) seat
belts are securely fastened. The chime will continue to sound for about 95 seconds until the
seat belt is fastened.
Other information
For language settings, see "Unit/Language"
(P.2-21).
HOW TO USE THE VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY
WAC0397X
The vehicle information display
is located
between the tachometer and the speedometer,
and it displays the warnings and information.
The following items are also displayed if the
vehicle is equipped with them:
y
Automatic Transmission (AT)
— "Driving with Automatic Transmission
(AT)" (P.5-13)
y
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD)
— "Four-wheel Drive (4WD)" (P.5-16)
y
Clock and outside air temperature
— "Clock and outside air temperature"
(P.2-29)
y
Trip computer
— "Trip computer" (P.2-18)
y
Cruise control
— "Cruise control" (P.5-41)
y
Intelligent Key system
— "Intelligent Key system" (P.3-6)
y
JVI1566X
The vehicle information display can be changed
using the buttons OK ,
,
, and
located on the left side of the steering
wheel.
OK - change or select an item in the vehicle
information display
- navigate through the items in vehicle
information display
- go back to the previous menu
- change from one display screen to
the next (i.e. trip, Fuel economy)
Oil control system
— "Oil control system" (P.2-30)
2-18
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 18
2021/01/22 11:47:15 AM
STARTUP DISPLAY
Warning (LDW)" (P.5-26)
Cross Traffic Alert (if equipped):
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, the screens that appear in the vehicle
information display include:
Blind Spot (if equipped):
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Blind Spot menu.
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) system.
y
Trip computer
y
Warnings
Warnings will only display if there are any
present. For more information on warnings
and indicators, see "Vehicle information display
warnings and indicators" (P.2-22).
SETTINGS
Settings cannot be made while driving.
The
,
, and OK buttons are used in the
setting mode.
Use the
Driver Assistance
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Driver Assistance menu.
Emergency Brake (if equipped):
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
Intelligent Emergency Braking system.
For additional information, see "Intelligent
Emergency Braking" (P.5-43).
Lane (if equipped):
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Lane menu.
Warning (LDW)
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
Lane Departure Warning system.
For additional information, see "Lane Departure
Warning (BSW)
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) system.
For additional information, see "Blind Spot
Warning (BSW)" (P.5-30).
Parking Aids (if equipped):
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Parking Aids menu.
y
button to select a menu.
Push OK to decide a menu.
y
y
y
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
Intelligent Driver Alertness system.
For additional information, see "Intelligent Driver Alertness" (P.5-56).
Timer Alert:
Select this sub-menu to set an alert to notify
the driver that the set time has been reached.
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
Moving Object Detection (MOD).
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Timer Alert menu.
Sensor
y
---min / ---min
y
Reset
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
parking sensor (sonar) system.
To change the timer amount, use the
button
and push the OK button
to save the selected time amount.
Volume
Low Temp. Alert:
Select this sub-menu to change the parking
sensor (sonar) buzzer volume.
y
Driver Attention Alert (if equipped):
Moving Object (if equipped)
For additional information, see "Moving Object
Detection (MOD)" (P.4-14).
y
For additional information, see "Rear Cross
Traffic Alert (RCTA)" (P.5-36).
Distance
Select this sub-menu to change the parking
sensor (sonar) detection range.
For additional information, see "Parking sensor
(sonar) system" (P.5-61).
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the Low
Temperature Alert.
For additional information, see "Outside air
temperature (˚C or ˚F)" (P.2-19).
ECO Mode Setting
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the ECO Mode Setting menu.
ECO Drive Report:
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the ECO
Drive Report in the vehicle information display.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 19
2-19
2021/01/22 11:47:15 AM
The light sensitivity can be set to illuminate
earlier or later based on the brightness
outside the vehicle.
View History:
Select this sub-menu to reset the past history
of the fuel economy and the best fuel economy.
See "ECO drive report" (P.5-58).
Clock
Clock Mode (if equipped):
The adjustment settings can be selected from
“Manual”.
y
Manual
Turn indicator:
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the “3
Flash Pass” lane change signal feature.
Daylight Saving (if equipped):
Turns the Daylight Saving Time on or off.
Vehicle Settings
y
Ext. Door Switch
Select this sub-menu to activate/deactivate
the request switch on the door.
Wipers (if equipped):
The following sub-menu is displayed.
y
Speed Dependent
Select this sub-menu to activate/deactivate
the speed dependent wiper speed feature.
y
Rain Sensor (if equipped)
Select this sub-menu to activate/deactivate the rain sensor feature.
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Vehicle Settings menu.
Mirrors (if equipped):
Lighting:
y
The following sub-menus are displayed.
Auto Room Lamp
Select this sub-menu to enable/disable the
auto room lamp feature.
The interior lights will be ON if any door is
unlocked when the Auto Room Lamp is
enabled.
y
Auto Headlight (if equipped)
2-20
Auto Fold Off
When this item is turned on, the auto fold
feature for the outside rear view mirrors is
disabled. Use the OK button to select this
function.
The following sub-menus are displayed.
y
The following sub-menus are displayed under
the Maintenance menu.
The following sub-menu is displayed.
Set Clock Manually:
The clock setting can be changed using the
and the OK buttons.
Maintenance
Locking (if equipped):
Clock Format:
The time setting can be selected from 12 hour
and 24 hour formats.
function.
y
WAC0563X
1. Oil and Filter:
Select this sub-menu to set or reset the distance for replacing the engine oil and oil filter.
Unfold at Ignition
When this item is turned on, the outside
rear view mirrors automatically fold when
the doors are locked, and unfold when the
ignition switch is placed in the “ACC” or “ON”
position. Use the OK button to select this
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 20
2021/01/22 11:47:16 AM
NOTE:
Main Menu Selection:
Language (if equipped):
Be sure to reset the distance for replacing the
engine oil and oil filter after replacing. Otherwise, the oil and filter replacement indicator
will continue to be displayed.
Displays available screens that can be shown in
the vehicle information display.
The language of the vehicle information display
can be changed.
Route Guidance (if equipped):
Use the
and the OK
buttons to select
and change the language of the vehicle information display.
2. Tyre:
Select this sub-menu to set or reset the distance for replacing tyres.
WARNING:
y
Alerts
The “Alerts” allows you to turn the route guidance alerts on or off.
Welcome Effect:
The tyre replacement indicator is not a substitute for regular tyre checks, including tyre
pressure checks. See "Changing tyres and
wheels" (P.8-32). Many factors including tyre
inflation, alignment, driving habits and road
conditions affect tyre wear and when tyres
should be replaced. Setting the tyre replacement indicator for a certain driving distance
does not mean your tyres will last that long.
Use the tyre replacement indicator as a guide
only and always perform regular tyre checks.
Failure to perform regular tyre checks, including tyre pressure checks could result in tyre
failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur
and may lead to a collision, which could result
in serious personal injury or death.
The “Welcome Effect” displays the available
welcome effect settings.
3. Other
Mileage/Fuel:
Select this sub-menu to set or reset the distance for replacing items other than the engine
oil, oil filter and tyres.
The unit for the mileage that is shown in the
vehicle information display can be changed.
y
km, km/l
Customize Display
y
km, l/100km
The display settings allows you to choose from
the various meter selections.
y
miles, MPG(UK) (if equipped)
y
miles, MPG(US) (if equipped)
The display settings can be changed using
the
button and the OK buttons.
Use the
and the OK
and change the unit.
y
Gauges
y
Animation
Unit/Language
Factory Reset
The settings in the vehicle information display
can be reset back to the factory default. To reset
the vehicle information display:
1.
Select “Factory Reset” using the
and press the OK button .
2.
Select “YES” to return all settings back to
default by pressing the OK button .
The units that are shown in the vehicle information display can be changed:
y
Mileage/Fuel
y
Temperature
y
Language (if equipped)
Use the
and the OK
buttons to select
and change the units of the vehicle information
display.
buttons to select
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 21
button
2-21
2021/01/22 11:47:17 AM
VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY WARNINGS AND INDICATORS
WAC0541X
2-22
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 22
2021/01/22 11:47:20 AM
1. Engine start operation indicator (if
equipped for Automatic Transmission
(AT) models)
This indicator appears when the shift lever is in
the “P” (Park) position.
This indicator means that the engine will start
by pushing the ignition switch with the brake
pedal depressed. You can start the engine directly in any position of the ignition switch.
2. Engine start operation indicator (if
equipped for Manual Transmission (MT)
models)
This indicator means that the engine will start
by pushing the ignition switch with the clutch
pedal depressed. You can start the engine directly in any position of the ignition switch.
You can also start the engine by pushing the
ignition switch with the brake pedal depressed
when the shift lever is in the “N” (Neutral) position.
3. Steering lock release malfunction
indicator (if equipped)
This indicator appears when the steering wheel
cannot be released from the “LOCK” position.
If this indicator appears, push the ignition
switch while lightly turning the steering wheel
right and left.
See "Steering lock" (P.5-10).
WAC0542X
4. No Key Detected warning (if equipped)
This warning appears when the door is closed
with the Intelligent Key left outside the vehicle
and the ignition switch in the “ON” position.
Make sure that the Intelligent Key is inside the
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 23
2-23
2021/01/22 11:47:21 AM
vehicle.
See "Intelligent Key system" (P.3-6) for more
details.
5. Key reminder warning (if equipped)
This warning appears if the driver's side door
is opened while the key is left in the ignition
switch and ignition switch is in the “ACC”, “OFF”
or “LOCK” position. Remove the key and take it
with you when leaving the vehicle.
6. Shift to Park warning (if equipped for
AT models)
This warning appears when the ignition switch
is pushed to stop the engine with the shift lever
in any position except the “P” (Park) position.
If this warning appears, move the shift lever
to the “P” (Park) position or push the ignition
switch to the “ON” position.
An inside warning chime will also sound. (See
"Intelligent Key system" (P.3-6).)
7. “PUSH” warning (if equipped for AT
models)
This warning appears when the shift lever is
moved to the “P” (Park) position with the ignition switch in the “ACC” position after the Shift
to Park warning appears.
To push the ignition switch to the “OFF” position,
perform the following procedure:
Shift to Park warning g (Move the shift lever
to “P”) g PUSH warning g (Push the ignition
switch g ignition switch position is turned to
“ON”) g PUSH warning g (Push the ignition
switch g ignition switch position is turned to
“OFF”)
2-24
8. Key Battery Low warning (if equipped)
This warning appears when the Intelligent Key
battery is running out of power.
If this warning appears, replace the battery
with a new one. (See "Intelligent Key battery"
(P.8-20).)
9. Engine start operation for Intelligent
Key system indicator (if equipped)
This indicator appears when the Intelligent
Key battery is running out of power and when
the Intelligent Key system and vehicle are not
normally communicated.
If this indicator appears, touch the ignition
switch with the Intelligent Key while depressing
the brake pedal. (See "Intelligent Key battery
discharge" (P.5-11).)
10. Key ID Incorrect warning (if equipped)
This warning appears when the ignition switch
is placed from the “LOCK” position and the Intelligent Key cannot be recognized by the system.
You cannot start the engine with an unregistered key. Use the registered Intelligent Key.
See "Intelligent Key system" (P.3-6).
11. Release Parking Brake warning
This warning appears when the vehicle speed
is above 7 km/h (4 MPH) and the parking brake
is applied. Stop the vehicle and release the
parking brake.
There will be a small reserve of fuel remaining
in the tank when the fuel gauge reaches the
empty (0) position.
13. Door open warning
This warning appears if any of the doors are
open or not closed securely. The vehicle icon
indicates which door is open on the display.
Make sure that all of the doors are closed.
14. 4WD mode indicator (if equipped)
This indicator shows the drive mode of the
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) system.
See "Four-Wheel Drive (4wD)" (P.5-16) for details.
15. 4WD Error warning (if equipped)
This warning appears when the Four-Wheel
Drive (4WD) system is not functioning properly
while the engine is running. Reduce vehicle
speed and have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer. See "4WD warning" (P.5-20).
16. Key System Error warning (if
equipped)
This warning appears if there is a malfunction in
the Intelligent Key system.
If this warning appears while the engine is
stopped, the engine cannot be started. If this
warning appears while the engine is running,
the vehicle can be driven. However, contact a
NISSAN dealer for repair as soon as possible.
12. Low fuel warning
This warning appears when the fuel level in the
tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is convenient, preferably before the fuel gauge reaches
the empty (0) position.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 24
2021/01/22 11:47:21 AM
17. Oil Level Low indicator (if equipped)
If the low level indicator is displayed, the engine oil level is low. If the low level indicator is
displayed, check the level using the engine oil
dipstick. (See "Engine oil" (P.8-8).)
CAUTION:
The oil level should be checked regularly
using the engine oil dipstick. Operating with
an insufficient amount of oil can damage the
engine and such damage is not covered by
the warranty.
18. Oil level sensor warning (if equipped)
If the oil level sensor warning is displayed, the
engine oil level sensor may be malfunctioning.
Contact a NISSAN dealer immediately.
19. Low Oil Pressure Stop vehicle warning (if equipped)
This warning appears if low engine oil pressure
is detected. If the warning appears during
normal driving, pull off the road in a safe area,
stop the engine immediately and call a NISSAN
dealer.
The low oil pressure warning is not designed to
indicate a low oil level. Use the dipstick to check
the oil level. (See Engine oil" (P.8-8).)
CAUTION:
Running the engine with the engine oil pressure warning displayed could cause serious
damage to the engine.
20. Shipping Mode On Push Storage
Fuse warning (if equipped)
This warning may appear if the extended stor-
age fuse switch is not pushed in (switched on).
When this warning appears, push in (switch on)
the extended storage fuse switch to turn off the
warning. For more information, see "Extended
storage fuse switch" (P.8-23).
21. Headlight System Error warning (if
equipped)
This warning appears if the LED headlights are
malfunctioning. Have the system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
26. Automatic Transmission (AT) position indicator (AT models)
This indicator shows the automatic shift position.
In the manual shift mode, when the transmission does not shift to the selected gear due to a
transmission protection mode, the AT position
indicator will blink and a chime will sound.
For further details, see "Driving with Automatic
Transmission (AT)" (P.5-13).
22. Reminder Turn OFF Headlights
warning
27. Automatic Transmission (AT) Error
warning (AT models)
This warning appears when the driver side
door is opened with the headlight switch is
left ON and the ignition switch is placed in the
“OFF”, “ACC” or “LOCK” position. Place the headlight switch in “OFF” (if equipped) or “AUTO” (if
equipped) position. For additional information,
see "Headlight and turn signal switch" (P.2-32).
If the Automatic Transmission (AT) Error warning appears while the engine is running, or while
driving, it may indicate that the AT is not functioning properly and may need servicing. Have
the system checked, and if necessary repaired,
by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
23. Time for a driver break? indicator
This indicator appears when the set “Timer
Alert” alarm activates. You can set the time for
up to 6 hours. (See "Settings" (P.2-19).)
24. Take a break? indicator (if equipped)
This indicator appears when the system has detected that the driver may by displaying fatigue
or a lack of attention. (See "Intelligent Driver
Alertness" (P.5-56).)
25. Cruise control indicator (if equipped)
This indicator shows the cruise control system
status. The status is shown by the color.
See "Cruise control" (P.5-41) for details.
28. Automatic Transmission (AT) park
warning (if equipped)
If the Automatic Transmission park warning
appears, it indicates that the automatic transmission P (Park) position will not function and
the transfer case is in neutral.
If the transfer control is not secured in any driving position while the AT shift lever is in the “P”
(Park) position, the transmission will disengage
and the wheels will not lock.
If the ATP warning appears with the shift lever
in the “P” (Park) position, shift the Four-Wheel
Drive (4WD) mode switch to the 2WD, 4H or
4LO position again with the shift lever in the
N (Neutral) position. (See "Four-Wheel Drive
(4WD)" (P.5-16).)
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 25
2-25
2021/01/22 11:47:22 AM
WARNING:
If the 4WD mode indicator (see "4WD MODE
INDICATOR" (P.5-20)) is “OFF” or the ATP
warning light is “ON”, this indicates that the
automatic transmission P (Park) position will
not function and could result in the vehicle
moving unexpectedly, causing serious personal injury or property damage. Always set
the parking brake.
29. Parking Sensor Error warning (if
equipped)
This warning appears when the parking sensor
(sonar) system is not functioning properly. If the
warning appears, have the system checked by
a NISSAN dealer.
30. Unavailable High Cabin Temperature warning (if equipped)
This warning appears if the interior temperature of the vehicle has reached such a high
temperature that the sensor for the following
system(s) can no longer function reliably. Once
the interior temperature has reached normal
levels, the warning should disappear.
y
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system
If the warning continues to appear, have the
system checked by a NISSAN dealer. For more
details, see "Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
(P.5-26).
31–32. Unavailable Side Radar Obstruction warning (if equipped)
This message appears when the Blind Spot
Warning (BSW)/Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA)
system becomes unavailable because a radar
blockage is detected. For more details, see
2-26
"Blind Spot Warning (BSW)" (P.5-30) or "Rear
Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA)" (P.5-36).
33. Not Available Front Radar Blocked
warning (if equipped)
This message appears when the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system or the Intelligent
Forward Collision Warning system becomes unavailable because the front radar is obstructed.
For more details, see "Intelligent Emergency
Braking" (P.5-43) or "Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system" (P.5-49).
38. System Fault warning (if equipped)
If the Intelligent Driver Alertness system malfunctions, the warning message will appear in
the vehicle information display and the function
will be stopped automatically. For more details,
see "Intelligent Driver Alertness" (P.5-56).
34–37. Not Available System Malfunction warning (if equipped)
This warning appears when there is a malfunction with the following system(s) if the vehicle is
equipped with them.
y
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system
y
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) system
y
Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) system
y
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
y
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
If this warning appears, stop the vehicle in a
safe location, turn off and restart the engine.
If the warning continues to appear, have the
system(s) checked by a NISSAN dealer.
For more details, see "Lane Departure Warning
(LDW)" (P.5-26), "Blind Spot Warning (BSW)"
(P.5-30), "Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA)"
(P.5-36), "Intelligent Emergency Braking"
(P.5-43) or Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system" (P.5-49)
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 26
2021/01/22 11:47:22 AM
TRIP COMPUTER
WAC0506X
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 27
2-27
2021/01/22 11:47:24 AM
Average vehicle speed:
The average vehicle speed display is updated
every 30 seconds. The first 30 seconds after a
reset, the display shows “——”.
To reset the average speed, push the OK button
for longer than 1 second.
To reset the fuel economy and average speed,
push the OK button
for longer than 3 seconds or more.
JVI1566X
The vehicle information display can be changed
using the buttons OK
,
,
, and
located on the left side of the steering
wheel.
2. Fuel economy (l (liter)/100 km, km/l
(liter) or MPG)
The average fuel consumption mode shows the
average fuel consumption since the last reset.
OK - change or select an item in the vehicle
information display
The display is updated every 30 seconds. For
about the first 500 m (1/3 mile) after a reset, the
display shows “———”.
- navigate through the items in vehicle
information display
To reset the fuel economy, push the OK button
for longer than 1 second.
- go back to the previous menu
- change from one display screen to
the next (i.e. trip, Fuel economy
1. Vehicle speed (km/h or MPH)
The vehicle speed mode shows the current
vehicle speed and the average vehicle speed
since the last reset.
button for longer than 1 second. (The elapsed
time is also reset at the same time.)
4. Navigation (if equipped)
When the route guidance is set in the navigation system, this item shows the navigation
route information.
For more details, see the separate NissanConnect Owner’s Manual.
5. Audio (if equipped)
The audio mode shows the status of audio
information.
6. Driving Aids (if equipped)
The Driving Aids mode shows the operating
condition for the following systems.
y
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) (if equipped)
y
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) (if equipped)
To reset the fuel economy and average speed,
push the OK button
for longer than 3 seconds or more.
y
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
y
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
3. Elapsed time and trip odometer (km
or mile)
For more details, see "Lane Departure Warning
(LDW)" (P.5-26), "Blind Spot Warning (BSW)"
(P.5-30), "Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA)"
(P.5-36), "Intelligent Emergency Braking"
(P.5-43) or Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system" (P.5-49)
Elapsed time:
The elapsed time mode shows the time since
the last reset. The displayed time can be reset
by pushing the OK button
for longer than 1
second. (The trip odometer is also reset at the
same time.)
Trip odometer:
The trip odometer mode shows the total
distance the vehicle has been driven since the
last reset. Resetting is done by pushing the OK
2-28
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 28
2021/01/22 11:47:24 AM
VEHICLE INFORMATION DISPLAY
(models without color display)
CLOCK AND OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (IF EQUIPPED)
differ from the actual outside temperature or
the temperature displayed on various signs or
billboards.
JVI1031X
JVI0932X
The clock
and outside air temperature
(if
equipped) are displayed on the upper side of
the vehicle information display.
Clock
For clock adjustment, see "Settings" (P.2-19),
the separate Navigation System Owner's Manual (if equipped) or the NissanConnect Owner's
Manual (if equipped).
Outside air temperature (°C or °F) (if
equipped)
The outside air temperature is displayed in °C
or °F in the range of −40 to 60°C (−40 to 140°F).
The outside air temperature mode includes a
low temperature warning feature. If the outside
air temperature is below 3°C (37°F), the warning
is displayed on the screen.
The outside temperature sensor is located in
front of the radiator. The sensor may be affected by road or engine heat, wind directions
and other driving conditions. The display may
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, the vehicle information display
shows the following information:
y
Engine coolant temperature gauge
— "Engine coolant temperature gauge"
(P.2-9)
y
Fuel gauge
— "Fuel gauge" (P.2-10)
y
Odometer
— "Odometer (models without color display)" (P.2-9)
y
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) (if equipped)
— "4WD mode indicator" (P.5-20)
y
Outside air temperature (if equipped)
— "Outside air temperature" (P.2-30)
y
Trip computer
— "Trip computer" (P.2-30)
y
Oil control system (if equipped)
— "Oil control system" (P.2-30)
y
Automatic Transmission (AT) position indicator (AT model)
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 29
2-29
2021/01/22 11:47:25 AM
— "Driving with Automatic Transmission
(AT)" (P.5-13)
y
Cruise control (if equipped)
— "Cruise control" (P.5-41)
y
Other information
OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (if
equipped)
The outside air temperature is displayed in °C.
Current fuel consumption
y
If the amount of fuel added is small, the
display just before the ignition switch is
turned off may continue to be displayed.
Push the trip computer mode switch
to toggle the fuel consumption display between l/ 100
km and km/l (if equipped).
y
When driving uphill or rounding curves,
the fuel in the tank shifts, which may
momentarily change the display.
Average fuel consumption (l/100 km,
km/l or mpg)
OIL CONTROL SYSTEM (if equipped)
The current fuel consumption mode shows the
current fuel consumption.
The average fuel consumption mode shows the
average fuel consumption since the last reset.
Resetting is done by pushing the trip computer
mode switch for longer than 1 second.
TRIP COMPUTER
The display is updated every 30 seconds. At
about the first 500 m (1/3 miles) after a reset,
the display shows “----”.
Push the trip computer mode switch
to toggle the fuel consumption display between l/ 100
km and km/l (if equipped).
JVI1238X
Distance to empty (dte - km or miles)
JVI1237X
The switch for the trip computer is located on
the meter panel.
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, modes of the trip computer can be
selected by pushing the trip computer mode
switch .
Each time the trip computer mode switch
pushed, the display will change as follows:
is
(TRIP A g TRIP B) g Current fuel consumption
g Average fuel consumption g Distance to
empty (dte) g (TRIP A)
2-30
The distance to empty (dte) mode provides you
with an estimation of the distance that can be
driven before refueling. The dte is constantly
being calculated, based on the amount of fuel in
the fuel tank and the actual fuel consumption.
The display is updated every 30 seconds.
The dte mode includes a low range warning
feature: when the fuel level is low, the dte mode
is automatically selected and the digits and the
low fuel warning light
blink in order to draw
the driver’s attention. Push the trip computer
mode switch to return to the mode that was
selected before the warning occurred.
When the fuel level drops even lower, the dte
display will change to “----”
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 30
2021/01/22 11:47:25 AM
1. Distance to oil change
2.
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, the distance to oil change is displayed.
2. Oil replacement indicator
If adjusting the distance from zero (0): Push
the trip computer mode switch . The default distance to oil change will be restored.
CAUTION:
If the oil replacement indicator is displayed,
change the engine oil as soon as possible.
Operating your vehicle with oil that has deteriorated can damage the engine.
3.
If no further action is taken, the display will
switch to the oil level indication and the new
interval will be set.
Setting distance to oil change:
1.
Refer to the separate maintenance booklet for
the appropriate distance to oil change interval.
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
engine oil information is displayed.
Engine oil information informs you of the distance to oil change, oil level indication and oil
level sensor malfunctions.
To reset the oil control system, push and hold
the trip computer mode switch for more than
3 seconds when the engine oil information is
displayed.
Turn the trip computer mode switch
clockwise or counterclockwise to increase
or decrease the interval. Each turn increases or decreases the interval by 1,000
km (500 miles).
When the distance to oil change information
showing zero (0) or less is displayed: When the
ignition switch is placed in the “ON” position, a
wrench symbol blinks and the distance to oil
change information showing zero (0) is displayed for approximately 5 seconds.
To cancel oil change reminder:
The distance to oil change interval can be
adjusted or disabled using the trip computer
mode switch .
JVI0438X
While the display is flashing, push and hold
the trip computer mode switch
for more
than 3 seconds to enter the adjustment
mode.
To adjust oil change interval:
1.
Push and hold the trip computer mode
switch
for more than 3 seconds while
the wrench symbol
and distance to oil
change information are displayed.
If adjusting the distance from zero (0): Push
and hold the trip computer mode switch
for more than 3 seconds within 5 seconds
of placing the ignition switch in the “ON”
position.
The wrench symbol
start flashing.
and the distance will
Push and hold the trip computer mode
switch
for more than 3 seconds while
the wrench symbol
and distance to oil
change information are displayed.
The wrench symbol
start flashing.
and the distance will
2.
While the display is flashing, push the trip
computer mode switch
again to enter
the adjustment mode.
3.
Turn the trip computer mode switch
counterclockwise until the interval reads 0.
If no further action is taken, the display will
switch to the oil level indication and the oil
change reminder is canceled.
No wrench symbol or distance will be displayed
when the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position. To reactivate the reminder, set the
distance to oil change interval to a value above
zero (0).
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 31
2-31
2021/01/22 11:47:25 AM
HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL
SWITCH
3. Oil level display
HEADLIGHT SWITCH
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, the engine oil level status is displayed.
4. Low level reminder
If the low level indicator is displayed, the engine oil level is low. If the low level reminder is
displayed, check the level using the engine oil
dipstick. (See “Engine oil” (P.8-8).)
CAUTION:
The oil level should be checked regularly
using the engine oil dipstick. Operating the
vehicle with an insufficient amount of oil can
damage the engine and such damage is not
covered by the warranty.
Example C
Example A
WAC0558X
JVI0370X
(See “Engine oil” (P.8-8).)
5. Oil level sensor warning
If the oil sensor warning is displayed, the engine
oil level sensor may be malfunctioning. Contact
a NISSAN dealer immediately.
CAUTION:
y
y
Even if “Oil Good” appears on the engine
oil maintenance display, be sure to replace the engine oil when the engine
oil level gauge shows that the oil level
exceeds the Hi level by approximately 10
mm (0.4 in) because the oil performance
has decreased.
Always reset the oil control system after
replacing the engine oil.
2-32
Example D
Example B
SIC3782
SIC3783
The headlight switch varies depending on the
model.
NISSAN recommends that you consult the local
regulations concerning the use of lights.
AUTO position (if equipped)
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position
and the headlight switch is in the “AUTO”
position, the headlights, front clearance lights,
instrument panel lights, rear combination
lights and other lights turn on automatically
depending on the brightness of the
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 32
2021/01/22 11:47:26 AM
surroundings.
The headlights will turn on automatically at twilight or in rainy weather (when the windshield
wiper is operated continuously).
Headlight beam
The lever can be pulled 4 times for up to 2
minutes.
High beam assist (if equipped)
The high beam assist system will operate when
the vehicle is driven at speeds of approximately
40 km/h (25 MPH) and above. If an oncoming
vehicle or leading vehicle appears in front of
your vehicle when the headlight high beam is
on, the headlight will be switched to the low
beam automatically.
When the ignition switch is placed in the “OFF”
position, the lights will turn off automatically.
Precautions on high beam assist:
WARNING:
CAUTION:
Example
y
The high beam assist system is a
convenience but it is not a substitute for
safe driving operation. The driver should
re- main alert at all times, ensure safe
driving practices and switch the high
beam and low beam manually when
necessary.
y
The high beam or low beam may not
switch automatically under the following
conditions. Switch the high beam and low
beam manually.
JVI1104X
Do not place any objects on top of the sensor
. The sensor senses the brightness level
and controls the Intelligent Auto Headlight
function. If the sensor is covered, it reacts as
if it is dark, and the headlights will illuminate.
position
The
position turns on the front clearance,
instrument panel, tail and license plate lights.
position
The
position turns on the headlights in addition to the other lights.
SIC3785
To turn on the high beam, push the lever towards the front position .
—
During bad weather (rain, fog, snow,
wind, etc.).
To turn off the high beam, return the lever to the
neutral position .
—
When a light source similar to a headlight or tail light is in the vicinity of the
vehicle.
—
When the headlights of the oncoming
vehicle or the leading vehicle are
turned off, when the color of the light
is affected due to foreign materials on
the lights, or when the light beam is
out of position.
—
When there is a sudden, continuous
To flash the headlights, pull the lever towards
the rearmost position . The headlights can be
flashed even when the headlights are not on.
If equipped, when the lever is pulled towards the
rearmost position
after the ignition switch is
placed in the “OFF” or “LOCK” position, the headlight will turn on and stay on for 30 seconds.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 33
2-33
2021/01/22 11:47:28 AM
change in brightness.
y
—
When driving on a road that passes
over rolling hills, or a road that has
level differences.
—
When driving on a road with many
curves.
—
When a sign or mirror-like surface is
reflecting intense light towards the
front of the vehicle.
—
When the container, etc. being towed
by a leading vehicle is reflecting intense light.
—
When a headlight on your vehicle is
damaged or dirty.
—
When the vehicle is leaning at an angle
due to a punctured tire, being towed,
etc.
—
The number of passengers and the
amount of luggage.
cate that the system is not functioning properly.
Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
When the vehicle speed lowers to less than
approximately 30 km/h (19 MPH), the headlight
remains the low beam.
High beam assist operations:
To turn off the high beam assist system, turn
the headlight switch to the
position or select the low beam position by placing the lever
in the neutral position.
Camera unit maintenance:
Example A
WAC0149X
The timing of switching the low beam
and high beam may change under the
following situations.
—
The brightness of the headlights
of the oncoming vehicle or leading
vehicle.
—
The movement and direction of the
oncoming vehicle and the leading
vehicle.
—
—
—
2-34
When only one light on the oncoming
vehicle or the leading vehicle is
illuminated.
When the oncoming vehicle or the
leading vehicle is a two-wheeled
vehicle.
Road conditions (incline, curve, the
road surface, etc.).
WAF0635X
Example B
WAC0502X
To activate the high beam assist system, turn
the headlight switch to the “AUTO” position
and push the lever forward
(high beam
position). The high beam assist indicator light
in the meter will illuminate while the headlights
are turned on.
If the high beam assist indicator light does not
illuminate in the above condition, it may indi-
The camera unit
for the high beam assist
system is located in front of the inside rear view
mirror. To keep the proper operation of the
high beam assist system and prevent a system
malfunction, be sure to observe the following:
y
Always keep the windshield clean.
y
Do not attach a sticker (including transparent material) or install an accessory near
the camera unit.
y
Do not strike or damage the areas around
the camera unit. Do not touch the camera
lens.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 34
2021/01/22 11:47:28 AM
If the camera unit is damaged due to an accident, contact a NISSAN dealer.
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
cancels automatically.
Lane change signal
Daytime running light system (if
equipped)
To turn on the lane change signals, move the
lever up
or down
to the point where the
light begins to flash.
Even if the headlight switch is in the OFF position (if equipped), the daytime running lights will
come on after starting the engine.
If the lever is moved back to its original position
right after moving up or down, the light will
flash 3 times.
When the light switch is turned to the
or
position, the daytime running light will turn
off.
To cancel the flashing, move the lever to the
opposite direction.
BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM
The light reminder chime will sound if the headlight switch is in either the
or
position
and when the driver’s door is opened with the
ignition switch in the “ACC”, “OFF” or “LOCK”
position.
If the ignition switch is in the “OFF” or “LOCK”
position and the doors are closed and locked
while the headlight switch is in either the
or
position, the battery saver function will
turn off the lights to prevent the battery from
being discharged. The lights will turn on when
the doors are being opened.
CAUTION:
Do not leave the lights on when the engine is
not running for extended periods of time to
prevent the battery from being discharged.
SIC3786
CAUTION:
The turn signal switch will not be canceled
automatically if the steering wheel turning
angle does not exceed the preset amount.
After the turn or lane change, make sure
that the turn signal switch is returned to its
original position.
Turn signal
To turn on the turn signals, move the lever up
or down to the point where the lever latches.
When the turn is completed, the turn signal
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 35
2-35
2021/01/22 11:47:29 AM
FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if equipped)
WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
WARNING:
In freezing temperatures, the washer fluid
may freeze on the windshield and obscure
your vision. Warm the windshield with the
defogger before you wash the windshield.
CAUTION:
Type A
y
Do not operate the washer continuously
for longer than 30 seconds.
y
Do not operate the washer if the window
washer fluid reservoir is empty.
y
If the wiper operation is interrupted by
snow or ice, the wiper may stop moving
to protect its motor. If this occurs, turn
the wiper switch to the “OFF” position and
remove the snow or ice on and around the
wiper arms. In approximately 1 minute,
turn the switch on again to operate the
wiper.
SIC3811
Type B
JVI1222X
WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
SWITCH
Type B
SIC3813
Type C
WAC0530X
FRONT FOG LIGHTS (if equipped)
To turn on the front fog lights, turn the fog light
switch to the
position with the headlight
switch in the
or
or AUTO (if equipped)
position.
To turn off the fog lights, turn the fog light
switch to the “OFF” position.
Type A
JVI1105X
Type D
2-36
WAC0531X
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 36
2021/01/22 11:47:29 AM
The windshield wiper and washer operate
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
RAIN-SENSING AUTO WIPER SYSTEM (if
equipped)
by turning the knob toward
(Low).
(High) or toward
Wiper operation
y
High — High sensitive operation
The lever position “AUTO” (Type C/Type D)
operates the rain-sensing auto wiper system
(if equipped). (See “Rain-sensing auto wiper
system” (P.2-37).)
y
Low — Low sensitive operation
To turn the rain-sensing auto wiper system off,
push up the lever to the “OFF” position, or pull
down the lever to the “LO” or “HI” position.
The lever position “INT” (Type A/Type B/Type E)
operates the wiper intermittently.
y
The intermittent operation can be adjusted
by turning the adjustment control knob,
(longer) or (shorter) . (Type A or Type B)
y
The speed of the intermittent operation
varies depending on the vehicle speed.
This function can be turned on or off (if
equipped). See “Settings” (P.2-19). (Type A
or Type B)
The lever position “LO”
low speed.
operates the wiper at
The lever position “HI”
high speed.
operates the wiper at
CAUTION:
Type A
Washer operation
To operate the washer, pull the lever toward the
back of the vehicle
until the desired amount
of washer fluid is spread on the windshield. The
wiper will automatically operate several times.
Type B
Do not touch the rain sensor and around
it when the wiper switch is in the “AUTO”
position and the ignition switch is in the
“ON” position. The wipers may operate
unexpectedly and cause an injury or may
damage a wiper.
y
The rain-sensing auto wipers are intended for use during rain. If the switch
is left in the “AUTO” position, the wipers
may operate unexpectedly when dirt,
fingerprints, oil film or insects are stuck
on or around the sensor. The wipers
may also operate when exhaust gas or
moisture affect the rain sensor.
y
When the windshield glass is coated with
water repellent, the speed of the rainsensing auto wipers may be higher even
though the amount of the rainfall is small.
y
Be sure to turn off the rain-sensing auto
wiper system when you use a car wash.
y
The rain-sensing auto wipers may not
operate if rain does not hit the rain sensor
even if it is raining.
WAC0511X
To stop the wiper operation, move the lever up
to the “OFF” position.
The lever position “MIST”
operates the wiper
one sweep. The lever automatically returns to
its original position.
y
WAC0512X
The rain-sensing auto wiper system can
automatically turn on the wipers and adjust the
wiper speed depending on the rainfall and the
vehicle speed by using the rain sensor located
on the upper part of the windshield.
To set the rain-sensing auto wiper system, push
the lever down to the “AUTO” position . The
wiper will sweep once while the ignition switch
is in the “ON” position.
The rain sensor sensitivity level can be adjusted
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 37
2-37
2021/01/22 11:47:29 AM
DEFOGGER SWITCH (if equipped)
y
To turn off manually, push the defogger switch
again
Using
genuine
wiper
blades
is
recommended for proper operation of
the rain-sensing auto wiper system. (See
“Wiper blades” (P.8-17) for wiper blade
replacement.)
CAUTION:
Type A
Type B
SIC3537
y
When operating the defogger continuously, be sure to start the engine. Otherwise,
it may cause the battery to discharge.
y
When cleaning the inner side of the
window, be careful not to scratch or
damage the electrical conductors on the
surface of the window.
JVI1022X
The rear window defogger switch operates
when the ignition switch is in the "ON" position.
The defogger is used to reduce the moisture,
fog or frost on the rear window and outside rear
view mirror (if equipped) surfaces to improve
the rear view.
When the defogger switch is pushed, the indicator light illuminates and the rear window defogger operates for approximately 15 minutes.
After the preset time has passed, the defogger
will turn off automatically.
2-38
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 38
2021/01/22 11:47:29 AM
HORN
WINDOWS
MANUAL WINDOWS (if equipped)
To open a window, push down the power window switch.
To close a window, pull up the power window
switch
Driver’s window switch
JVI1569X
The horn switch operates regardless of the ignition switch position except when the battery
is discharged.
When the horn switch is pushed and held, the
horn will sound. Releasing the horn switch will
cease the horn sound.
SIC4435
The side windows can be opened
or closed
by turning the hand crank on each door.
POWER WINDOWS (if equipped)
WARNING:
y
y
Make sure that all passengers have their
hands, etc. inside the vehicle before
operating the power windows.
To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and or its systems, including
entrapment in windows or inadvertent
door lock activation, do not leave children,
people who require the assistance of
others or pets unattended in your vehicle.
Additionally, the temperature inside
a closed vehicle on a warm day can
quickly become high enough to cause
a significant risk of injury or death to
people and pets.
JVI1223X
The driver’s switch, the main switch, can control
all windows.
Locking passenger’s windows:
When the lock button
is pushed in, the passenger’s windows cannot be operated.
To cancel the passenger’s windows lock, push
the lock button again.
The power windows operate when the ignition
switch is in the “ON” position.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 39
2-39
2021/01/22 11:47:30 AM
Passenger’s window switch
down or up.
To fully open the window, push the power
window switch down to the second detent and
release the switch. To fully close the window,
pull the power window switch up to the second
detent and release the switch. The switch does
not have to be held during window operation.
To stop the window open/close operation
during the automatic function, push down or
pull up the switch in opposite directions.
Window timer (if equipped):
SIC4523
The passenger's switch can control its corresponding window.
When the passenger’s windows lock button on
the driver’s switch is pushed in, the passenger’s
switch cannot be operated.
Automatic function
The window timer allows the window switch
to be operated for a period of time even if the
ignition switch is placed in the “OFF” position.
The window timer will be canceled when the
driver’s or front passenger’s door is opened or
the preset time has expired.
Auto-reverse function:
WARNING:
There is a small distance just before the
closed position which cannot be detected.
Make sure that all passengers have their
hands, etc. inside the vehicle before closing
the windows.
JVI1224X
The automatic function is available for the
switch that has an
mark on its surface.
The automatic function enables a window to
fully open or close without holding the switch
2-40
If the window does not close automatically
If the power window automatic function (closing only) does not operate properly, perform
the following procedure to initialize the power
window system.
1.
Start the engine.
2.
Close the door.
3.
Open the window completely by operating
the power window switch.
4.
Pull the power window switch and hold it to
close the window, and then hold the switch
more than 3 seconds after the window is
closed completely.
5.
Release the power window switch. Operate
the window by the automatic function to
confirm the initialization is complete.
If the power window automatic function does
not operate properly after performing the procedure above, have your vehicle checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
AUTO SLIDE BACK WINDOWS SYSTEM (if
equipped)
The auto-reverse function enables a window
to automatically reverse when something is
caught in the window as it is closing by the
automatic function. When the control unit detects an obstacle, the window will be lowered
immediately.
Depending on the environment or driving conditions, the auto-reverse function may activate
if an impact or load similar to something being
caught in the window occurs.
JVI1209X
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 40
2021/01/22 11:47:30 AM
POWER OUTLETS
The power outlet is used for powering electrical
accessories.
Use the cutout
between the lid and the
console box to use a powering cable with the
console box lid closed.
WARNING:
JVI1210X
WARNING:
y
Make sure that all passengers have their
hands, etc. inside the vehicle before
operating the auto slide back window.
y
Never leave children or adults who
would normally require the support of
others alone in the vehicle. They could
unknowingly activate switches or controls
and inadvertently become involved in an
accident.
The auto slide back window operates when the
ignition switch is in the "ON" position.
To open the back windows, push down
auto slide back window switch.
To close the back window, pull up
slide back window switch.
the
Instrument panel (lower) (if equipped)
Console box (if equipped)
JVI1024X
CAUTION:
WAC0503X
the auto
Truck box (if equipped)
Do not place any objects on the instrument
panel. Such objects may become dangerous
projectiles and cause injury if a supplemental
air bag inflates (if equipped).
JVI1211X
y
Do not leave a power cable on the
instrument panel in direct sunlight. The
surface of the instrument panel may
become very hot resulting in damage to
the power cable.
y
Do not put a liquid container near the
power outlet. Spilled contents may get
into the power outlet and can result in a
malfunction.
y
The outlet and plug may be hot during or
immediately after use.
y
This power outlet is not designed for use
with a cigarette lighter unit.
y
Do not use accessories that exceed a
combined power draw of 12 volt, 120W
(10A). Do not use double adapters or more
than one electrical accessory.
y
Use this power outlet with the engine
running to avoid discharging the vehicle
battery.
y
Avoid using when the air conditioner,
headlights or rear window defogger is on
(if equipped).
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 41
2-41
2021/01/22 11:47:31 AM
y
y
y
Push the plug in as far as it will go. If good
contact is not made, the plug may overheat or the internal temperature fuse may
blow.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) CHARGING
CONNECTOR (if equipped)
Before inserting or disconnecting a plug,
be sure that the electrical accessory being
used is turned OFF.
Some mobile devices cannot be charged depending on their specifications.
Use the cutout
between the lid and the console box to use a cable with the console box lid
closed.
CAUTION:
When not in use, be sure to close the cap.
Do not allow water or any liquid to contact
the outlet.
Console box
Behind the console box
WAC0499X
y
Do not force a USB device into the
connector. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down (USB Type-A)
into the connector may damage the
connector. Make sure that the USB device
is connected correctly into the connector.
y
Do not use a reversible USB cable. Using
the reversible USB cable may damage the
connector.
WAC0507X
The USB charging connector can be used only
for charging an external device.
Connect a USB device into the connector.
Charging will start automatically (maximum
output up to 5 volt, 12 W, 2.4 A (USB Type-A), 5
volt, 15 W, 3 A (USB Type-C)).
The external device will be charged continuously while the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON”
position.
2-42
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 42
2021/01/22 11:47:31 AM
STORAGE
WARNING:
y
y
The storages should not be used while
driving so that the full attention may be
given to vehicle operation.
Keep the storage lids closed while driving
to help prevent injury in an accident or a
sudden stop.
To open the console box lid, push up the knob
and pull up the lid.
To close, push the lid down until the lock latches.
SUNGLASSES HOLDER (if equipped)
JVI0619X
To open the sunglasses holder, push and release. Only store one pair of sunglasses in the
holder.
JVI1102X
.
To close, push the lid in until the lock latches.
CONSOLE BOX (if equipped)
WARNING:
The driver must not remove or insert cups
into the cup holder while driving so that full
attention may be given to vehicle operation.
CAUTION:
GLOVE BOX
To open the glove box, pull the handle
CUP HOLDERS
y
Avoid abrupt starting and braking
especially when the cup holder is being
used to prevent spilling the contents. If
the contents are hot, they could scald you
or your passengers.
y
Use only soft cups in the cup holder. Hard
objects can injure you in an accident.
Center console (front separate seat
models)
WARNING:
Keep the sunglasses holder closed while driving to avoid obstructing the driver’s view and
to help prevent an accident.
CAUTION:
y
Do not use for anything other than
sunglasses.
y
Do not leave sunglasses in the sunglasses holder while parking in direct
sunlight. The heat may damage the
sunglasses.
JVI1027X
JVI1026X
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 43
2-43
2021/01/22 11:47:31 AM
Lower instrument panel (front bench
seat models
JVI1212X
Rear seat (Double Cab models)
Soft bottle holder
Example
ROOF RACK (if equipped)
JVI1241X
The front and rear (if equipped) soft bottle holders are located on the doors.
CAUTION:
y
y
Do not use bottle holder for any other
objects that could be thrown about in the
vehicle and possibly injure people during
sudden braking or an accident.
Do not use bottle holder for open liquid
containers.
JVI1103X
Do not apply any load directly to the roof side
rails. Cross bars must be installed before applying load/cargo/luggage to the roof of the vehicle. Genuine NISSAN accessory cross bars may
be available through a NISSAN dealer. Contact a
NISSAN dealer for additional information.
The service load capacity for the roof side rails
is 56 kg (125 lb), however do not exceed the
accessory cross bars load capacity.
WARNING:
y
Always install the cross bars onto the
roof side rails before loading cargo of any
kind. Loading cargo directly onto the roof
side rails or the vehicle’s roof may cause
vehicle damage.
y
Drive extra carefully when the vehicle
is loaded at or near the cargo carrying
capacity, especially if the significant
portion of that load is carried on the roof
rack.
y
Heavy loading of the roof rack has the
potential to affect the vehicle stability
and handling during sudden or unusual
SIC4593
2-44
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 44
2021/01/22 11:47:31 AM
SUN VISORS
INTERIOR LIGHTS
handling maneuvers.
load
should
be
CAUTION:
y
Roof rack
distributed.
evenly
y
y
Do not exceed maximum roof rack load
weight capacity.
Turn off the lights when you leave the
vehicle.
y
y
Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
injury.
Do not use the lights for extended periods
of time with the engine stopped. This
could result in a discharged battery.
INTERIOR LIGHT SWITCH (if equipped)
CARD HOLDER (if equipped)
JVI1037X
JVI1240X
Slide a card in the card holder
.
SIC2872
1.
To block out glare from the front, swing
down the sun visor .
2.
To block glare from the side, remove the sun
visor from the center mount and swing it to
the side .
The interior light can be turned ON regardless of door position. The light will go off
after a period of time unless the ignition
switch is placed in the “ON” position when
any door is opened.
The interior lights can be set to operate
when the doors are opened. To turn off the
interior lights when a door open, push the
switch, the interior lights will not illuminate,
regardless of door position. The lights will
go off when the ignition switch is placed
in the “ON” position, or the driver’s door is
closed and locked. The lights will also go off
after a period of time when the doors are
open.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 45
2-45
2021/01/22 11:47:31 AM
CONSOLE LIGHT (if equipped)
Type B
ON position
When the switch is in the “ON” position
map lights will illuminate.
, the
OFF position
When the switch is in the “OFF” position , the
map lights will not illuminate, regardless of any
other condition.
Center position
JVI1038X
The console light will turn on whenever the
clearance lights or headlights are illuminated.
SIC4572
Operate the map light switch to turn the map
light on or off.
: ON position
: OFF position
MAP LIGHTS
Type A
When the switch is in the center position, the
map lights will illuminate under the following
conditions:
y
the key is removed from the ignition switch
—
y
MAP LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH (if
equipped)
—
y
remain on for a period of time.
doors are unlocked by pushing the “UNLOCK”
button (model with remote keyless entry system) with the ignition switch
in the “LOCK” position
remain on for a period of time.
any door is opened
—
remain on while the door is opened.
When the door is closed, the lights go
off.
JVI1039X
Push the button to turn the map lights on. To
turn them off, push the button again.
2-46
SIC4573
The map lights control switch has three positions: ON , OFF and center.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 46
2021/01/22 11:47:32 AM
ROOM LIGHT (if equipped)
entry system).
y
The last door is closed without the key in
the ignition switch (models without Intelligent Key).
BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM
The lights will turn off after a period of time
when the lights remain illuminated to prevent
the battery from becoming discharged.
The interior light timer will be cancelled when:
y
Any door is locked by pushing the “LOCK”
button on the remote controller (if
equipped) with the ignition switch in the
“OFF” position.
y
Any door is locked by door handle request
switch (if equipped) with the ignition switch
in the “OFF” position.
y
The ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position.
SIC2489
The room light has a three-position switch.
When the switch is in the “ON” position
room light illuminates.
, the
When the switch is in the “O” (Door) position
, the room light illuminates when a door is
opened.
The interior light timer will keep the room light
on for a period of time when:
y
The key is removed from the ignition switch
with all doors closed (models without Intelligent Key).
y
The ignition switch is placed in the “OFF”
position with all doors closed (models with
Intelligent Key).
y
The driver’s door is unlocked without the
key in the ignition switch (models without
Intelligent Key).
y
The driver’s door is unlocked when the ignition switch is in the “LOCK” position (models
with Intelligent Key).
y
The doors are unlocked with the “UNLOCK”
button (model with remote keyless
When the switch is in the “OFF” position
, the
room light does not illuminate, regardless of
any condition.
VANITY MIRROR LIGHTS (if equipped)
SIC3869
To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun visor
down and flip open the mirror cover.
The vanity mirror light illuminates when the
vanity mirror cover is opened. When the cover is
closed, the light will turn off.
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 47
2-47
2021/01/22 11:47:32 AM
MEMO
2-48
Instruments and controls
2-Chapter 2.indd 48
2021/01/22 11:47:32 AM
3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
Keys ......................................................................................................................... 3-2
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*) key
(if equipped) ............................................................................................. 3-2
Intelligent Key (if equipped) ......................................................... 3-2
Doors ...................................................................................................................... 3-4
Locking with key .................................................................................. 3-4
Locking with inside lock knob ................................................... 3-4
Locking with power door lock switch (if equipped) .. 3-4
Vehicle speed sensing door lock mechanism (if
equipped)................................................................................................... 3-5
Impact sensing door lock releasing mechanism (if
equipped)................................................................................................... 3-5
Child safety rear door locks (Double cab models) ...... 3-5
Remote keyless entry system (if equipped) .............................. 3-5
Using remote keyless entry system ...................................... 3-6
Intelligent key system (if equipped) ................................................ 3-6
Intelligent Key operating range ................................................ 3-8
Using Intelligent Key system ....................................................... 3-8
Battery saver system........................................................................ 3-9
Warning and audible reminders ............................................ 3-10
Troubleshooting guide ................................................................. 3-11
Using remote keyless entry system ................................... 3-13
Hazard indicator and horn operation ............................... 3-13
Security system (if equipped) ........................................................... 3-15
Theft warning system (if equipped) ................................... 3-15
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS) ........................................ 3-15
Hood .................................................................................................................... 3-16
Opening hood ..................................................................................... 3-17
Closing hood ........................................................................................ 3-17
3-Chapter 3.indd 1
Fuel-filler lid and cap................................................................................ 3-17
Opening fuel-filler lid (if equipped) ...................................... 3-17
Fuel-filler cap........................................................................................ 3-18
Truck box .......................................................................................................... 3-19
Tailgate ..................................................................................................... 3-19
Tie down hooks (if equipped) .................................................. 3-20
C-Channel system (if equipped) ............................................ 3-20
Sport bar (if equipped).................................................................. 3-23
Steering wheel ............................................................................................. 3-23
Steering wheel adjustment ...................................................... 3-23
Mirrors ................................................................................................................ 3-23
Inside rearview mirror ................................................................... 3-23
Outside rearview mirrors ............................................................ 3-24
Vanity mirror (if equipped) ......................................................... 3-25
Parking brake ................................................................................................ 3-25
Front bumper ................................................................................................ 3-26
2021/01/13 11:55:55 AM
KEYS
Mechanical key
A key number plate is supplied with your key.
Record the key number on the key number
plate/metal tag and keep it in a safe place (such
as your wallet), NOT IN THE VEHICLE. NISSAN
does not record key numbers so it is very
important to keep track of your key number
plate.
A key number is only necessary when you have
lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate
from. If you still have a key, this key can be
duplicated by a NISSAN dealer.
NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (NATS*)
KEY (if equipped)
Type A
1.
NATS key (Molded) (2)
2.
Key number plate (1)
JVP0085X
Type B
1.
NATS key (2)
2.
Key number plate (1)
Your vehicle can only be driven with the NATS
keys, which are registered to your vehicle’s
NATS components. As many as 5 NATS keys
can be registered and used with one vehicle.
The new keys must be registered by a NISSAN
dealer prior to use with the NATS of your vehicle.
Since the registration process requires erasing
all memory in the NATS components when
registering new keys, be sure to take all NATS
keys that you have to the NISSAN dealer.
JVP0298X
To unfold the key from the fob, press the release
button.
When storing the key, press the release button
and push key to fold the key back into fob slot.
INTELLIGENT KEY (if equipped)
CAUTION:
Do not allow the NATS key, which contains an
electrical transponder, to come into contact
with water or salt water. This could affect the
system function.
*: Immobilizer
3-2
JVP0277X
SPA2502
1.
Intelligent Key (2)
2.
Mechanical key (inside Intelligent Key) (2)
3.
Key number plate (1)
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 2
2021/01/13 11:55:56 AM
completely dry.
WARNING:
y
The Intelligent Key transmits radio waves
that can adversely affect medical electric
equipment.
y
If you have a pacemaker, you should
contact the medical equipment manufacturer to ask if it will be affected by the
Intelligent Key signal.
— Do not bend, drop or strike it against
another object.
— If the outside temperature is below
-10°C (14°F), the battery of the Intelligent Key may not function properly.
— Do not place the Intelligent Key for
an extended period in a place where
temperatures exceed 60°C (140°F).
Your vehicle can only be driven with the
Intelligent Keys, which are registered to your
vehicle’s Intelligent Key system components and
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*) components.
As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered
and used with one vehicle. The new keys must
be registered by a NISSAN dealer prior to use
with the Intelligent Key system and NATS of
your vehicle. Since the registration process
requires erasing all memory in the Intelligent
Key system components when registering new
keys, be sure to take all Intelligent Keys that you
have to a NISSAN dealer.
*: Immobilizer
CAUTION:
y
Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with
you. Do not leave the vehicle with the
Intelligent Key inside.
y
Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with
you when driving. The Intelligent Key is a
precision device with a built-in transmitter. To avoid damaging it, please note the
following.
Mechanical key
— Do not change or modify the Intelligent Key.
— Do not use a magnet key holder.
— Do not place the Intelligent Key near
equipment that produces a magnetic
field such as a TV, audio equipment
and personal computers.
— Do not allow the Intelligent Key to
come into contact with water or salt
water, and do not wash it in a washing
machine. This could affect the system
function.
y
SPA2033
To remove the mechanical key, release the lock
knob at the back of the Intelligent Key.
To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it into
the Intelligent Key until the lock knob returns to
the lock position.
Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the
doors and tailgate (if equipped). (See "Doors"
(P.3-4) and "Tailgate" (P.3-19).)
If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen,
NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code
of that Intelligent Key. This will prevent
the Intelligent Key from unauthorized
use to unlock the vehicle. For information
regarding the erasing procedure, please
contact a NISSAN dealer.
— The Intelligent Key is water resistant;
however, wetting may damage the
Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key
gets wet, immediately wipe until it is
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 3
3-3
2021/01/13 11:55:56 AM
DOORS
LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK KNOB
WARNING:
y
Always look before opening any doors, to
avoid an accident with oncoming traffic.
y
To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and or its systems, including
entrapment in windows or inadvertent
door lock activation, do not leave children,
people who require the assistance of
others or pets unattended in your vehicle.
Additionally, the temperature in- side a
closed vehicle on a warm day can quickly
become high enough to cause a significant risk of injury or death to people and
pets.
LOCKING WITH KEY
SPA2817
CAUTION:
When locking the doors using the inside lock
knob, be sure not to leave the key in the vehicle.
To lock the door, insert the mechanical key to
the door key cylinder and turn the key to the
front side of the vehicle .
To unlock the door, turn the key to the rear of
the vehicle .
3-4
SPA2803
Operating the power door lock switch (located
on the driver’s door) will lock or unlock all the
doors.
To lock the front doors, push the inside lock
knob to the lock position , and then close the
door while pulling the outside door handle.
To lock the doors, push the power door lock
switch to the lock position
with the driver’s
door open, then close the door while pulling the
outside door handle. All doors will lock.
To lock the rear doors (if equipped), push the
inside lock knob to the lock position
and
then close the door.
y
When locking the doors using the power
door lock switch, be sure not to leave the
key in the vehicle.
y
When the Intelligent Key (if equipped) is
left in the vehicle, and you try to lock the
door using the power door lock switch
after getting out of the vehicle, all the
doors will unlock automatically after the
door is closed.
To unlock, pull the inside lock knob to the unlock
position .
SPA2588
LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR LOCK
SWITCH (if equipped)
For driver’s door (with power door lock
switch):
When the doors are locked, you do not need to
operate the inside lock knob. Just pull the inside
door handle to open the driver’s door.
CAUTION:
To unlock, push the power door lock switch to
the unlock position .
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 4
2021/01/13 11:55:56 AM
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM
(if equipped)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSING DOOR LOCK
MECHANISM (if equipped)
CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCKS
(Double cab models)
All doors will be locked automatically when the
vehicle speed reaches 10 km/h (6 MPH). Once
the lock has been unlocked, while driving, the
vehicle speed sensing door lock mechanism
will not lock the door again unless one of the
following is performed.
y
Opening any doors.
y
Placing the ignition switch in the “LOCK”
position.
To activate or deactivate vehicle speed
sensing door lock mechanism
To activate or deactivate the door lock
mechanism, perform the following procedures.
To activate or deactivate the vehicle speed
sensing door lock mechanism, perform the
following procedures.
The remote keyless entry system can operate
all door locks using the remote controller. The
remote controller can operate at a distance of
approximately 1 m (3.3 ft) away from the vehicle.
The operating distance depends upon the
conditions around the vehicle.
As many as 5 remote controllers can be
used with one vehicle. For information about
the purchase and use of additional remote
controllers, contact a NISSAN dealer.
The remote controller will not function under
the following conditions:
JVP0279X
The child safety rear door locks help prevent
rear doors from being opened accidentally,
especially when small children are in the vehicle.
When the levers are in the lock position , the
child safety rear door locks engage and the rear
doors can only be opened by the outside door
handles.
y
When the distance between the remote
controller and vehicle is more than approximately 1 m (3.3 ft).
y
When the remote controller battery is discharged.
y
When the key is in the ignition switch.
y
When locking the doors using the remote
controller, be sure not to leave the key in
the vehicle.
y
Do not allow the remote controller, which
contains electrical components, to come
into contact with water or salt water. This
could affect the system function.
CAUTION:
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position.
2.
Within 20 seconds, push and hold the power
door lock switch to the “LOCK” position for 5
seconds.
3.
The hazard indicator light will flash as
follows if the switching operation is
successful:
y
Twice - activated
y
Once - deactivated
Do not drop the remote controller.
y
y
Do not strike the remote controller sharply against another object.
y
Do not place the remote controller for an
extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 60°C (140°F).
IMPACT SENSING DOOR LOCK RELEASING MECHANISM (if equipped)
All doors will be unlocked automatically when
the impact sensors sense an impact while the
ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
To disengage, move the levers to the unlock
position .
If a remote controller is lost or stolen, NISSAN
recommends erasing the ID code of that remote
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 5
3-5
2021/01/13 11:55:56 AM
INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM (if
equipped)
controller from the vehicle. This may prevent
the unauthorized use of the remote controller
to unlock the vehicle. For information regarding
the erasing procedure, contact a NISSAN dealer.
For information regarding the replacement of a
battery, see "Battery" (P.8-18).
USING REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM
CAUTION:
WARNING:
After locking the doors using the remote controller, be sure that the doors have been securely locked by operating the door handles.
y
Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use
a pacemaker should contact the electric
medical equipment manufacturer for the
possible influences before use.
y
The Intelligent Key transmits radio waves
when the buttons are pushed. The radio
waves may affect aircraft navigation and
communication systems. Do not operate
the Intelligent Key while on an airplane.
Make sure the buttons are not operated
unintentionally when the unit is stored
during a flight.
Unlocking doors
1.
Push the “UNLOCK”
remote controller.
2.
All doors will be unlocked.
button
on
the
All doors will be locked automatically unless
one of the following operations is performed
within 30 seconds after pushing the “UNLOCK”
button.
y
Opening any doors.
y
Inserting the key into the ignition switch.
Battery indicator light
UNLOCK button
The battery indicator light illuminates when you
push any button. If the light does not illuminate,
the battery is weak or needs replacement. For
information regarding replacement of a battery,
see "Battery" (P.8-18).
Battery indicator light
Hazard indicator operation
JVP0278X
Jackknife type key release button
LOCK button
Locking doors
1.
Remove the ignition key.
2.
Close all doors.
3.
Push the “LOCK”
controller.
4.
All doors will be locked.
5.
Operate door handles to confirm that the
doors have been securely locked.
3-6
button on the remote
When you lock or unlock the doors, the hazard
indicator will flash as a confirmation.
y
“LOCK”: The hazard indicator flashes once.
y
“UNLOCK”: The hazard indicator flashes
twice.
The Intelligent Key system can operate all doors
using the remote controller function or pushing
the request switch on the vehicle without
taking the key out from a pocket or purse. The
operating environment and/or conditions may
affect the Intelligent Key system operation.
Be sure to read the following before using the
Intelligent Key system.
CAUTION:
y
Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with
you when operating the vehicle.
y
Never leave the Intelligent Key in the vehicle when you leave the vehicle.
The Intelligent Key is always communicating
with the vehicle as it receives radio waves. The
Intelligent Key system transmits weak radio
waves. Environmental conditions may interfere
with the operation of the Intelligent Key system
under the following operating conditions.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 6
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
y
When operating near a location where
strong radio waves are transmitted, such as
a TV tower, power station and broadcasting
station.
y
When in possession of wireless equipment,
such as a cellular telephone, transceiver,
and CB radio.
y
When the Intelligent Key is in contact with
or covered by metallic materials.
y
When any type of radio wave remote control
is used nearby.
y
When the Intelligent Key is placed near an
electric appliance such as a personal computer.
In such cases, correct the operating conditions
before using the Intelligent Key function or use
the mechanical key.
Although the life of the battery varies depending
on the operating conditions, the battery’s
life is approximately 2 years. If the battery is
discharged, replace it with a new one.
When the Intelligent Key battery is almost
discharged, see "Intelligent Key battery
discharge" (P.5-11) to start the engine.
Since the Intelligent Key is continuously
receiving radio waves, if the key is left near
equipment which transmits strong radio
waves, such as signals from a TV and personal
computer, the battery life may become shorter.
For information regarding replacement of a
battery, see "Battery" (P.8-18).
Because the steering wheel is locked electrically,
unlocking the steering wheel with the ignition
switch in the “LOCK” position is impossible when
the vehicle battery is completely discharged.
Pay special attention that the vehicle battery is
not completely discharged.
As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be registered
and used with one vehicle. For information
about the purchase and use of additional
Intelligent Keys, contact a NISSAN dealer.
CAUTION:
y
Do not allow the Intelligent Key, which
contains electrical components, to come
into contact with water or salt water. This
could affect the system function.
y
Do not drop the Intelligent Key.
y
Do not strike the Intelligent Key sharply
against another object.
y
Do not change or modify the Intelligent
Key.
y
Wetting may damage the Intelligent Key.
If the Intelligent Key gets wet, immediately wipe until it is completely dry.
y
If the outside temperature is below −10°C
(14°F), the battery of the Intelligent Key
may not function properly.
y
Do not place the Intelligent Key for an
extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 60°C (140°F).
y
Do not attach the Intelligent Key with a
key holder that contains a magnet.
y
Do not place the Intelligent Key near
equipment that produces a magnetic
field, such as a TV, audio equipment and
personal computers.
prevent the unauthorized use of the Intelligent
Key to operate the vehicle. For information
regarding the erasing procedure, contact a
NISSAN dealer.
The Intelligent Key function can be disabled. For
information about disabling the Intelligent Key
function, contact a NISSAN dealer.
If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSAN
recommends erasing the ID code of that
Intelligent Key from the vehicle. This may
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 7
3-7
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
INTELLIGENT KEY OPERATING RANGE
y
When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged
y
When the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or
“ON” position
The Intelligent Key system (opening/closing
doors with the door handle request switch)
can be set to remain inactive. (See "Settings"
(P.2-19).)
JVP0312X
The Intelligent Key functions can only be used
when the Intelligent Key is within the specified
operating range from the request switch .
USING INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM
When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged
or strong radio waves are present near the
operating location, the Intelligent Key system’s
operating range becomes narrower, and the
Intelligent Key may not function properly.
SPA2407
y
Do not push the door handle request switch
with the Intelligent Key held in your hand as
illustrated. The close distance to the door
handle will cause the Intelligent Key system
to have difficulty recognizing that the Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle.
y
After locking the doors using the door
handle request switch, make sure that the
doors have been securely locked by operating the door handles.
y
When locking the doors using the door
handle request switch, make sure to have
the Intelligent Key in your possession before
operating the door handle request switch
to prevent the Intelligent Key from being
left in the vehicle.
The operating range is within 80 cm (31.50 in)
from each request switch .
If the Intelligent Key is too close to the door
glass or door handle, the request switches may
not function.
When the Intelligent Key is within the operating
range, it is possible for anyone, even someone
who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push
the request switch to lock/unlock the doors.
3-8
SPA2075
The request switch will not function under the
following conditions:
y
When another Intelligent Key is left inside
the vehicle
y
When the Intelligent Key is not within the
operational range
y
When any door is open or not closed securely
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 8
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
y
y
The door handle request switch is operational only when the Intelligent Key has
been detected by the Intelligent Key system.
Do not pull the door handle before pushing
the door handle request switch. The door
will be unlocked but will not open. Release
the door handle once and pull it again to
open the door.
contact a NISSAN dealer.
Locking doors
1.
Push the ignition switch to the “OFF”
position.
2.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
3.
Close all doors.
1.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
4.
Push the door handle request switch
(driver’s or front passenger's door).
2.
Push the door handle request switch
3.
All doors will be unlocked.
5.
All doors will be locked.
6.
Operate door handles to confirm that the
doors have been securely locked.
If a door handle is pulled while unlocking the
doors, that door may not be unlocked. Returning
the door handle to its original position will
unlock the door. If the door does not unlock,
after returning the door handle, push the door
handle request switch to unlock the door.
Lockout protection:
SPA2333
To prevent the Intelligent Key from being
accidentally locked in the vehicle, lockout
protection is equipped with the Intelligent Key
system.
y
When you carry the Intelligent Key with you,
you can lock or unlock all doors by pushing the
door handle request switch
(driver's or front
passenger's door) within the range of operation.
When you lock or unlock the doors, the hazard
indicator will flash as a confirmation. For details,
see"Hazard indicator and horn operation"
(P.3-13).
Welcome light and farewell light function (if equipped)
When you lock or unlock the doors, the
clearance lights, tail lights and the license plate
light will illuminate for a period of time. The
welcome light and farewell light function can
be disabled. For information about disabling
the welcome light and farewell light function,
or near metallic materials.
The lockout protection may function when
the Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle but is
too close to the vehicle.
When the Intelligent Key is left in the vehicle and you try to lock the door using the
power door lock switch after getting out of
the vehicle, all the doors will unlock automatically and a chime will sound after the
door is closed.
CAUTION:
The lockout protection may not function
under the following conditions:
y
When the Intelligent Key is placed on top
of the instrument panel.
y
When the Intelligent Key is placed inside
of the glove box.
y
When the Intelligent Key is placed inside
of the door pockets.
y
When the Intelligent Key is placed inside
Unlocking doors
Automatic relock:
All doors will be locked automatically unless one
of the following operations is performed within
30 seconds after pushing the request switch
while the doors are locked.
y
Opening any doors.
y
Pushing the ignition switch.
If during the preset time period the “UNLOCK”
button on the Intelligent Key is pushed, all
doors will be locked automatically after the
next preset time.
BATTERY SAVER SYSTEM
When all the following conditions are met for
a period of time, the battery saver system will
cut off the power supply to prevent battery
discharge.
y
The ignition switch is in the “ACC” position,
and
y
All doors are closed, and
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 9
.
3-9
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
y
The shift lever is in the “P” (Park) position
(automatic transmission model).
WARNING AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS
The Intelligent Key system is equipped with a
function that is designed to minimize improper
operations of the Intelligent Key and to help
prevent the vehicle from being stolen. A chime
or beep sounds inside and outside the vehicle
and a warning message appears in the vehicle
information display.
See the troubleshooting guide on the next page
and "Vehicle information display (models with
color display)" (P.2-18).
CAUTION:
When the chime or beep sounds or the warning message appears, be sure to check both
the vehicle and the Intelligent Key.
3-10
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 10
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Symptom
The Shift to Park warning appears in
the vehicle information display and
When pushing the ignition switch to
the inside warning chime sounds
stop the engine
continuously or for a few seconds.
(Automatic Transmission models)
The inside warning chime sounds
When shifting the shift lever to the P
continuously. (Automatic Transmis(Park) position
sion models)
When opening the driver’s door to The inside warning chime sounds
get out of the vehicle
continuously.
The No Key Detected warning
appears on the display, the outside
chime sounds 3 times and the
inside warning chime sounds for a
When closing the door after getting few seconds.
out of the vehicle
The Shift to Park warning appears
in the vehicle information display
and the outside chime sounds continuously. (Automatic Transmission
models)
When pushing the request switch or
The outside chime sounds for a few
the “LOCK”
button on the Intelliseconds and all the doors unlock.
gent Key to lock the door
When closing the door with the The outside chime sounds for a few
inside lock knob turned to “LOCK”
seconds and all the doors unlock.
Possible cause
Action to take
The shift lever is not in the “P” (Park) Shift the shift lever to the “P” (Park)
position.
position.
The ignition switch is in the “ACC” or Push the ignition switch to the “OFF”
“ON” position.
position.
The ignition switch is in the “ACC” Push the ignition switch to the “OFF”
position.
position.
The ignition switch is in the “ACC” or Push the ignition switch to the “OFF”
“ON” position.
position.
The ignition switch is in the “ACC” or Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park)
“OFF” position and the shift lever is position and push the ignition
not in the “P” (Park) position.
switch to the “OFF” position.
The Intelligent Key is inside the
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
vehicle.
The Intelligent Key is inside the
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
vehicle.
The Intelligent Key is inside the
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
vehicle.
When pushing the door handle The outside chime sounds for a few A door is not closed securely.
Close the door securely.
request switch to lock the door
seconds.
The door handle request switch is Push the door handle request
pushed before the door is closed.
switch after the door is closed.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 11
3-11
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
Symptom
Possible cause
The Key Battery Low warning
appears in the vehicle information The battery charge is low.
display.
When pushing the ignition switch to
The No Key Detected warning apstart the engine
pears in the display and the inside The Intelligent Key is not in the
warning chime sounds for a few vehicle.
seconds.
It warns of a malfunction with the
The Key System Error warning
electrical steering lock system (if
When pushing the ignition switch
appears in the vehicle information
equipped) or the Intelligent Key
display.
system.
3-12
Action to take
Replace the battery with a new one.
(See “Intelligent Key battery” (P.8-20).)
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
Contact a NISSAN dealer.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 12
2021/01/13 11:55:57 AM
USING REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY
SYSTEM
Locking doors
SPA2349
LOCK button
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position.
2.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
3.
Close all doors.
4.
Push the “LOCK”
Intelligent Key.
5.
All doors will be locked.
6.
Operate the door handles to confirm that
the doors have been securely locked.
y
After locking the doors using the
Intelligent Key, be sure that the doors
have been securely locked by operating
the door handles.
The remote keyless entry system allows you to
lock/unlock all doors. The operating distance
depends upon the conditions around the
vehicle. To securely operate the lock and unlock
buttons, approach the vehicle to about 1 m (3.3
ft) from the door.
y
When locking the doors using the
Intelligent Key, be sure not to leave the
key in the vehicle.
The remote keyless entry system will not
function under the following conditions:
y
When the Intelligent Key is not within the
operational range.
y
When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged.
For information regarding the replacement of a
battery, see Battery" (P.8-18).
on the
HAZARD INDICATOR AND HORN OPERATION
When you lock or unlock the doors, the hazard
indicator will flash and the outside chime will
sound as a confirmation.
The following descriptions show how the
hazard indicator and chime will activate when
locking or unlocking the doors.
CAUTION:
UNLOCK button
Operating range
button
all doors will be locked automatically after the
next preset time.
Unlocking doors
1.
Push the “UNLOCK”
Intelligent Key.
button
2.
All doors will be unlocked.
on the
Automatic relock:
All doors will be locked automatically unless one
of the following operations is performed within
30 seconds after pushing the “UNLOCK”
button on the Intelligent Key while the doors
are locked.
y
Opening any doors.
y
Pushing the ignition switch.
If during the preset time period the “UNLOCK”
button on the Intelligent Key is pushed,
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 13
3-13
2021/01/13 11:55:58 AM
Operation
DOOR LOCK
DOOR UNLOCK
Intelligent Key system
(using request switch)
HAZARD - once
OUTSIDE CHIME - once
HAZARD - twice
OUTSIDE CHIME - twice
Remote keyless entry system
(using
or
request switch)
HAZARD - once
OUTSIDE CHIME - once
HAZARD - twice
OUTSIDE CHIME - twice
3-14
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 14
2021/01/13 11:55:58 AM
SECURITY SYSTEM (if equipped)
Your vehicle has either or both of the following
security systems:
y
Theft warning system
y
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*)
How to activate system (if equipped)
The alarm is activated by:
1.
y
Close all windows.
The system can be armed even if the windows are open.
Unlocking the door without using the remote controller, the Intelligent Key, the door
handle request switch (if equipped) or the
mechanical key. (Even if the door is opened
by releasing the door inside lock knob, the
alarm will activate.)
*: Immobilizer
2.
The security condition will be shown by the
security indicator light.
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position.
3.
Carry the remote controller or the Intelligent
Key with you and get out of the vehicle.
How to stop alarm
4.
Close and lock all doors. The doors can
be locked with the remote controller, the
Intelligent Key or door handle request
switch (if equipped).
y
The alarm will stop only by unlocking a door
by pushing the “UNLOCK” button on the
Intelligent Key.
y
5.
Confirm that the security indicator light
comes on. The security indicator light glows
for about 30 seconds and then blinks. The
system is now activated. If, during this 30
second time period, the door is unlocked or
the ignition switch is placed in the “ACC” or
“ON” position, the system will not activate.
The alarm will not stop if the ignition switch
is placed in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
THEFT WARNING SYSTEM (if equipped)
The theft warning system provides visual and
audio alarm signals if parts of the vehicle are
disturbed.
Security indicator light
SIC2045
The security indicator light, located on the
meter panel, operates whenever the ignition
switch is in the “LOCK”, “OFF” or “ACC” position.
This is normal.
Even when the driver and/or passengers are
in the vehicle, the system will activate with all
doors locked with the ignition switch in the
“LOCK” position. When pushing the ignition
switch to the “ACC” or “ON” position, the system will be released.
Theft warning system operation
The vehicle security system will give the
following alarm:
y
The hazard indicator blinks and the horn
sounds intermittently.
y
The alarm automatically turns off after
approximately 30 seconds. However, the
alarm reactivates if the vehicle is tampered
with again.
NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (NATS)
The NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS) will not
allow the engine to start without the use of the
registered NATS key.
If the engine does not start using the registered
NATS key, it may be due to interference caused
by:
y
Another NATS key.
y
Automated toll road device.
y
Automated payment device.
y
Other devices that transmit similar signals.
Start the engine using the following procedure:
1.
Remove any items that may be causing the
interference away from the NATS key.
2.
Leave the ignition switch in the “ON”
position for approximately 5 seconds.
3.
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF” or
“LOCK” position, and wait approximately 10
seconds.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 15
3-15
2021/01/13 11:55:58 AM
HOOD
4.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 again.
5.
Start the engine.
The security indicator light is located in the
meter panel. It indicates the status of NATS.
6.
Repeat the steps above until all possible
interferences are eliminated.
If this procedure allows the engine to start,
NISSAN recommends placing the registered
NATS key separate from other devices to avoid
interference.
FCC Notice:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
The light operates whenever the ignition switch
is in the “LOCK”, “ACC” or “OFF” position.
The security indicator light indicates that the
security systems on the vehicle are operational.
If NATS is malfunctioning, this light will remain
on while the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position.
WARNING:
y
The hood must be closed and latched
securely before driving. Failure to do so
could cause the hood to fly open and
result in an accident.
y
Never open the hood if steam or smoke is
coming from the engine compartment to
avoid injury.
If the light remains on and/or the engine
does not start, contact a NISSAN dealer for
NATS service as soon as possible. Be sure to
bring all Intelligent Keys that you have when
visiting a NISSAN dealer for service.
Note: Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Security indicator light
SIC2045
3-16
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 16
2021/01/13 11:55:58 AM
FUEL-FILLER LID AND CAP
OPENING HOOD
WARNING:
y
Fuel is extremely flammable and highly
explosive under certain conditions. You
could be burned or seriously injured if it is
misused or mishandled. Always stop the
engine and do not smoke or allow open
flames or sparks near the vehicle when
refueling.
y
Fuel may be under pressure. Turn the cap
a half of a turn, and wait for any “hissing”
sound to stop to prevent fuel from spraying out and possibly causing personal
injury. Then remove the cap.
y
Use only an original equipment type
fuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has a
built-in safety valve needed for proper
operation of the fuel system and emission
control system. An incorrect cap can result in a serious malfunction and possible
injury.
WAD0243X
Pull the hood lock release handle located
below the instrument panel until the hood
springs up.
CLOSING HOOD
1.
2.
Locate the lever in between the hood and
grille and push the lever with your fingertips.
While supporting the hood, return the
support rod to its original position.
2.
3.
Raise the hood.
Slowly lower the hood to about 20 to 30 cm
(8 to 12 in) above the hood lock, then let it
drop.
4.
Remove the support rod and insert it into
the slot .
3.
Make sure it is securely latched.
1.
Hold the coated parts when removing or resetting the support rod. Avoid direct contact
with the metal parts, as they may be hot immediately after the engine has been stopped.
OPENING FUEL-FILLER LID (if equipped)
Type A
JVP0365X
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 17
3-17
2021/01/13 11:55:58 AM
To open the fuel-filler lid, turn the key
clockwise . To lock, close it and turn the key
counterclockwise .
FUEL-FILLER CAP
Type B
Type A
Type B
WAD0235X
WAD0232X
WAD0234X
To open the fuel-filler lid, unlock it using one of
the following operations, then push the right
side of the lid.
y
Push the door handle request switch while
carrying the Intelligent Key (if equipped).
y
Push the “UNLOCK”
button on the Intelligent Key or remote controller.
y
Push the power door lock switch to the
“UNLOCK” position.
y
Use the driver's door key cylinder to unlock
the fuel-filler lid.
The fuel-filler cap is a ratcheting type. Turn the
cap counterclockwise to remove. Tighten the
cap clockwise
until ratchet clicks, more than
twice, after refueling.
Route the fuel-filler cap strap around the hook
while refueling.
CAUTION:
If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, flush it
away with water to avoid paint damage.
The fuel-filler cap is a ratcheting type. Turn the
cap counterclockwise to remove. Tighten the
cap clockwise
until ratchet clicks, more than
twice, after refueling.
Put the fuel-filler cap on the cap holder
refueling.
while
CAUTION:
If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, flush it
away with water to avoid paint damage.
To lock the fuel-filler lid, close the lid until it
securely locks.
3-18
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 18
2021/01/13 11:55:59 AM
TRUCK BOX
Type C
Opening the tailgate
WARNING:
y
While driving, never allow anyone to ride
in the cargo area. Abrupt braking or stopping could lead to personal injury.
y
Do not drive the vehicle with the tailgate
down.
y
Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
injury.
Type A:
TAILGATE
Locking or unlocking tailgate (if
equipped)
JVP0370X
WAD0242X
To open the fuel-filler cap, turn the key
counterclockwise .
To lock the tailgate, insert the key to the tailgate
key cylinder and turn the key clockwise .
Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise
the cap is unlocked.
To unlock the tailgate, turn the key counterclockwise .
after
The fuel-filler cap is a screw-on ratcheting type.
After refueling, tighten the cap clockwise until
more than 2 ratcheting clicks are heard. The
fuel-filler cap locks automatically when it is
tightened.
SPA1871
To open the tailgate, pull the tailgate handle
and lower the tailgate. The support wires will
hold the gate open.
For Intelligent Key equipped models, see"Mechanical key" (P.3-3) for removing the
mechanical key.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 19
3-19
2021/01/13 11:55:59 AM
Type B:
ropes or straps to prevent it from shifting or
sliding within the vehicle.
WARNING:
y
Do not drive the vehicle with the tailgate
down.
C-CHANNEL SYSTEM (if equipped)
y
While driving, never allow anyone to ride
in the cargo area. Abrupt braking or stopping could lead to personal injury.
y
Properly install and tighten the tie-down
cleats into the C-Channel system. Also,
do not attach any rope or straps directly
to the channel. Failure to properly install
the tie-down cleats or attaching ropes or
straps directly to the channel can cause
the cargo to become unsecured. In a
sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo
could cause personal injury.
y
Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
injury.
y
Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.
y
Overloading not only can shorten the
life of your vehicle and the tire, but can
also cause unsafe vehicle handling and
longer braking distances. This may cause
a premature tire failure which could result
in a serious accident and personal injury.
Failures caused by overloading are not
covered by the vehicle’s warranty.
y
Do not install accessories over the gap
between the front and rear side channels.
Doing so could affect the rear structure in
certain rear impacts, which could result in
serious injury.
y
WARNING:
Do not pull down the tailgate without attaching the support wires. Doing so may
cause damage to the torsion bar assist
tailgate (Double Cab model) and the tailgate will hit the rear bumper.
Closing the tailgate
When closing the tailgate, make sure that the
latches or levers are securely locked.
TIE DOWN HOOKS (if equipped)
SPA1872
To open the tailgate, pull the tailgate levers
and lower the tailgate. The support wires will
hold the gate open.
y
The weight of the cargo load must be
evenly distributed over both the front and
the rear axles.
y
All cargo should be securely fastened with
ropes or straps to prevent it from shifting or
sliding within the vehicle.
3-20
JVP0619X
For your convenience, four tie down hooks are
placed on the inside of the truck box. These may
be used to help secure cargo loaded into the
truck box.
y
The weight of the cargo load must be evenly distributed over both the front and rear
axles.
y
All cargo should be securely fastened with
The C-Channel system allows you to move tie-
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 20
2021/01/13 11:55:59 AM
down clamps in the bed to the best location to
secure a load.
The tie-down cleats must be installed so the
clamp is properly seated in the notches in the
rail. If the tie-down cleat is not seated in the
notches, it will not be properly tightened. The
bolt in the center of the cleat must be securely
tightened.
Check the tightness of the tie-down cleat
periodically during a trip to make sure the
center bolt has not become loose.
JVP0357X
Side channels
Install the tie-down cleat as follows:
1.
Loosen the center bolt completely.
JVP0359X
JVP0358X
2.
Insert the cleat into the channel
perpendicular to the channel as shown.
Then rotate the cleat clockwise 90° and
slide it to desired location.
3.
Position the cleat so the nubs on the
bottom fully seat into the channel detents.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 21
3-21
2021/01/13 11:55:59 AM
JVP0360X
JVP0362X
4.
3-22
There should be no gap between the
bottom of the cleat and the top of the
channel. Securely tighten the center bolt.
JVP0361X
CAUTION:
y
Install only one cleat per section of
channel.
y
Applying loads at angles to the cleats that
are greater than 45° or loads greater than
90 kg (200 lbs.) may cause damage to the
channel or the bed.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 22
2021/01/13 11:55:59 AM
MIRRORS
STEERING WHEEL
SPORT BAR (if equipped)
STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENT
WARNING:
WARNING:
Never adjust the steering wheel while driving
so that full attention may be given to vehicle
operation.
Adjust the position of all mirrors before driving. Do not adjust the mirror positions while
driving so that full attention may be given to
vehicle operation.
INSIDE REARVIEW MIRROR
While holding the inside rearview mirror, adjust
the mirror angles until the desired position is
achieved.
JVP0406X
CAUTION:
Do not put a load on the sport bar as the
examples shown in the illustration. The sport
bar is an accessory for ornamental purposes
which is not designed to support and hold the
weight of the objects including tension and
pressure on itself.
SPA2225
Pull the lock lever down
and adjust the
steering wheel up or down
until the desired
position is achieved.
Push the lock lever back
firmly to lock the
steering wheel in place.
SPA2447
Manual anti-glare type
SPA2143
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 23
3-23
2021/01/13 11:55:59 AM
Pull the adjusting lever
when the glare
from the headlights of the vehicle behind you
obstructs your vision at night.
Push the adjusting lever
during the day for
the best rearward visibility.
Automatic anti-glare type
The anti-glare system will be automatically
turned on when you push the ignition switch to
the “ON” position.
Adjusting
Manual type:
When the system is turned on, the indicator
light
will illuminate and excessive glare from
the headlights of the vehicle behind you will be
reduced.
Push the switch
for 3 seconds to make the
inside rearview mirror operate normally and
the indicator light will turn off. Push the switch
again for 3 seconds to turn the system on.
Do not hang any objects on the mirror or
apply glass cleaner. Doing so will reduce the
sensitivity of the sensor , resulting in improper operation.
OUTSIDE REARVIEW MIRRORS
Type A
Type B
JVP0132X
The inside rearview mirror is designed so that
it automatically changes reflection according
to the intensity of the headlights of the vehicle
following you.
3-24
WARNING:
SPA2162
y
Never touch the outside rearview mirrors
while they are in motion. Doing so may
pinch your fingers or damage the mirror.
y
Never drive the vehicle with the outside
rearview mirrors folded. This reduces rear
view visibility and may lead to an accident.
y
Objects viewed in the outside mirror are
closer than they appear (if equipped).
y
The picture dimensions and distance in
the outside mirrors are not real.
JVP0407X
The outside rearview mirror can be moved in
any direction for a better rear view.
Remote control type:
JVP0326X
The outside rearview mirror remote control
operates when the ignition switch is in the
“ACC” or “ON” position.
1.
Turn the switch to select the left (L) or right
(R) mirror .
2.
Adjust each mirror by pushing the switch
until the desired position is achieved .
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 24
2021/01/13 11:56:00 AM
PARKING BRAKE
Defogging (if equipped)
“ACC” or “ON” position.
The outside rearview mirrors will be heated
when the rear window defogger switch or the
mirror heater switch is operated.
Folding
The outside rearview mirrors automatically fold
when the outside rearview mirror folding switch
is pushed in. To unfold, push to the switch again.
CAUTION:
Continuously performing the fold/unfold
operation of the outside rearview mirror may
cause the switch to stop the operation.
Manual type:
Automatic fold (if equipped):
The outside rearview mirrors automatically fold
when the doors are locked, and unfold when
the ignition switch is placed in the “ACC” or “ON”
position. For information about disabling the
automatic fold function, see "Settings" (P.2-19).
VANITY MIRROR (if equipped)
SPA1829
Fold the outside rearview mirror by pushing it
toward the rear of the vehicle.
WARNING:
y
Never drive the vehicle with the parking
brake applied. The brake will overheat and
fail to operate and will lead to an accident.
y
Never release the parking brake from
outside the vehicle. If the vehicle moves, it
will be impossible to push the brake pedal
and will lead to an accident.
y
Never use the shift lever in place of the
parking brake. When parking, be sure the
parking brake is fully applied.
y
To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not leave
children, people who require the assistance of others or pets unattended in
your vehicle. Additionally, the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a warm
day can quickly become high enough to
cause a significant risk of injury or death
to people and pets.
Remote control type:
SIC3869
To use the front vanity mirror, pull down the sun
visor and pull up the cover.
SPA2110
JVP0327X
The outside rearview mirror remote control
operates when the ignition switch is in the
To apply the parking brake, pull the parking
brake lever up .
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 25
3-25
2021/01/13 11:56:00 AM
FRONT BUMPER
To release the parking brake, depress and hold
the foot brake pedal. Pull up the parking brake
lever slightly, push the button
and lower the
lever completely .
Before driving, be sure that the brake warning
light has turned off.
WAD0253X
CAUTION:
Do not place your foot on or step on the front
bumper. Doing so may result in damage to the
front bumper.
3-26
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3-Chapter 3.indd 26
2021/01/13 11:56:00 AM
4 Monitor, air conditioner, audio and
phone system
NissanConnect owner’s manual (if equipped) ........................ 4-3
Safety precautions ....................................................................................... 4-3
Rear view monitor (if equipped)......................................................... 4-3
How to read the displayed lines ............................................... 4-4
Difference between predictive and actual distances...................................................................................................................... 4-4
How to park with predictive course lines (if
equipped)................................................................................................... 4-6
How to adjust the screen (if equipped) ............................... 4-7
How to turn on and off predictive course lines (if
equipped)................................................................................................... 4-7
How to turn on and off guide lines (if equipped) ......... 4-7
Operating tips ........................................................................................ 4-7
Intelligent around view monitor (if equipped) ........................ 4-8
Available views....................................................................................... 4-9
Off-road monitor (if equipped) ............................................... 4-11
Difference between predictive and actual distances................................................................................................................... 4-12
How to switch the display.......................................................... 4-13
Camera aiding parking sensor (sonar) function (if
equipped)................................................................................................ 4-13
Moving Object Detection (MOD) ............................................ 4-14
How to adjust the screen (if equipped) ............................ 4-16
Operating tips ..................................................................................... 4-16
Ventilators ....................................................................................................... 4-17
Center ventilators ............................................................................ 4-17
Side ventilators................................................................................... 4-17
Rear ventilators (if equipped) .................................................. 4-17
Heater and air conditioner.................................................................. 4-18
Operating tips (models with automatic
4-Chapter 4.indd 1
air conditioner) ................................................................................... 4-18
Manual air conditioner and heater ..................................... 4-19
Automatic air conditioner .......................................................... 4-21
Servicing air conditioner ............................................................. 4-23
Audio system (if equipped) ................................................................. 4-23
Audio operation precautions................................................... 4-23
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player
(Type A) ..................................................................................................... 4-31
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player
(Type B) ..................................................................................................... 4-36
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player
(Type C)..................................................................................................... 4-43
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player
(Type D)..................................................................................................... 4-49
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection port .................. 4-55
AUX (auxiliary) input jack............................................................. 4-55
CD/USB memory care and cleaning .................................. 4-56
Audio control steering switch (if equipped) ................. 4-56
Antenna............................................................................................................. 4-58
Roof antenna ....................................................................................... 4-58
Pillar antenna ...................................................................................... 4-58
Car phone and CB radio ....................................................................... 4-58
Bluetooth® hands-free phone system (Type A) .................. 4-59
Regulatory information ............................................................... 4-59
Control buttons and microphone........................................ 4-59
Bluetooth® settings ........................................................................ 4-60
Using the system .............................................................................. 4-61
General settings ................................................................................ 4-64
Bluetooth® hands-free phone system (Type B) .................. 4-65
2021/01/13 01:16:47 PM
Regulatory information ............................................................... 4-66
Using the system ............................................................................. 4-66
Bluetooth® settings ........................................................................ 4-68
4-Chapter 4.indd 2
2021/01/13 01:16:47 PM
NISSANCONNECT OWNER’S
MANUAL (if equipped)
For models with NissanConnect System, refer
to the NissanConnect Owner’s Manual that
includes the following information.
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
WARNING:
y
Do not adjust the heater and air conditioner controls or audio controls while
driving so that full attention may be given
to vehicle operation.
y
If you noticed any foreign objects entering the system hardware, spilled liquid on
the system, or noticed smoke or fumes
coming out from the system, or any other
unusual operation is observed, stop using
the system immediately and contact the
nearest NISSAN dealer. Ignoring such
conditions may lead to an accident, fire or
electric shock.
Available functions may vary depending on the
models, specifications and software version.
y
Audio
y
Hands-free phone
y
Apple CarPlay
y
Android Auto
y
Navigation
y
Voice recognition
y
Information and settings viewable on NissanConnect
REAR VIEW MONITOR (if equipped)
y
Do not disassemble or modify this system. If you do, it may lead to an accident,
fire, or electric shock.
CAUTION:
Do not use the system when the engine is
not running for extended periods of time to
prevent battery discharge.
WAE0084X
When the shift lever is shifted into the “R” (Reverse) position, the monitor display shows the
view to the rear of the vehicle.
The system is designed as an aid to the driver
in detecting large stationary objects to help
avoid damaging the vehicle. The system will
not detect small objects below the bumper and
may not detect objects close to the bumper or
on the ground.
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the rear view monitor
could result in serious injury or death.
y
The rear view monitor is a convenience
but it is not a substitute for proper
backing. Always turn and look out the
windows, and check mirrors to be sure
that it is safe to move before operating
the vehicle. Always back up slowly.
y
The system is designed as an aid to the
driver in showing large stationary objects
directly behind the vehicle, to help avoid
damaging the vehicle.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 3
4-3
2021/01/13 01:16:47 PM
y
The system cannot completely eliminate
blind spots and may not show every object.
y
Underneath the bumper and the corner
areas of the bumper cannot be viewed
on the rear view monitor because of its
monitoring range limitation. The system
will not show small objects below the
bumper, and may not show objects close
to the bumper or on the ground.
HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED LINES
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN PREDICTIVE AND
ACTUAL DISTANCES
The distance guide line and the vehicle width
guide line should be used as a reference only
when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface.
The distance viewed on the monitor is for reference only and may be different than the actual
distance between the vehicle and displayed
objects.
y
Objects viewed in the rear view monitor
differ from actual distance because a
wide-angle lens is used.
y
Objects in the rear view monitor will
appear visually opposite compared to
when viewed in the rear view and outside
mirrors.
Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle width
and distances to objects with reference to the
bumper line are displayed on the monitor.
y
Make sure that the tailgate is securely
closed when backing up.
Indicate distances from the vehicle body.
y
Do not put anything on the rear view camera. The rear view camera is installed on
top of the tailgate.
y
y
When washing the vehicle with high pressure water, be sure not to spray it around
the camera. Otherwise, water may enter
the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an
electric shock.
Do not strike the camera. It is a precision
instrument. Otherwise, it may malfunction or cause damage resulting in a fire or
an electric shock.
CAUTION:
Do not scratch the camera lens when cleaning
dirt or snow from the lens.
4-4
the predictive course lines are wider than the
actual width and course.
SAA1896
Distance guide lines:
y
Red line
y
Yellow line
: approx. 0.5 m (1.5 ft)
: approx. 1 m (3 ft)
y
Green line
: approx. 2 m (7 ft)
y
Green line
: approx. 3 m (10 ft)
Vehicle width guide lines
:
Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.
Predictive course lines
(if equipped):
Indicate the predictive course when backing up.
The predictive course lines will be displayed on
the monitor when the shift lever is in the “R” (Reverse) position and the steering wheel is turned.
The predictive course lines will move depending
on how much the steering wheel is turned and
will not be displayed while the steering wheel is
in the neutral position.
The vehicle width guide lines and the width of
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 4
2021/01/13 01:16:47 PM
Backing up on a steep uphill
Backing up on a steep downhill
JVH0893X
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown closer than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 1 m (3 ft) to the
place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft) distance on
the hill is the place . Note that any object on
the hill is viewed in the monitor further than it
appears.
Backing up near a projecting object
JVH0894X
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown further than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 1 m (3 ft)
to the place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft) distance
on the hill is the place . Note that any object
on the hill is viewed in the monitor closer than
it appears.
WAE0134X
The predictive course lines
(if equipped) do
not touch the object in the display. However, the
vehicle may hit the object if it projects over the
actual backing up course.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 5
4-5
2021/01/13 01:16:47 PM
Backing up behind a projecting object
HOW TO PARK WITH PREDICTIVE
COURSE LINES (if equipped)
WARNING:
y
If the tyres are replaced with different
sized tyres, the predictive course lines
may not be displayed correctly.
y
On a snow-covered or slippery road, there
may be a difference between the predictive course lines and the actual course
line.
y
If the battery is disconnected or becomes
discharged, the predictive course lines
may not be displayed correctly. If this
occurs, perform the following procedures.
— Turn the steering wheel from lock to
lock while the engine is running.
— Drive the vehicle on a straight road for
more than 5 minutes.
SSA1897
JVH0895X
The position
is shown further than the position
in the display. However, the position
is actually at the same distance as the position
. The vehicle may hit the object when backing
up to the position
if the object projects over
the actual backing up course.
4-6
1.
Visually check that the parking space is safe
before parking your vehicle.
2.
The rear view of the vehicle is displayed on
the screen
as illustrated when the shift
lever is moved to the “R” (Reverse) position.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 6
2021/01/13 01:16:48 PM
position (MT model) and apply the parking
brake.
pushing the MENU button , touching the “Settings” key and then touching the “Camera” key.
HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN (if
equipped)
HOW TO TURN ON AND OFF PREDICTIVE
COURSE LINES (if equipped)
NOTE:
1.
Push the CAMERA button.
Do not adjust the screen while the vehicle is
moving.
2.
Touch the “Predictive Course Lines” key to
turn on and off the predictive course lines.
Adjusting screen
The “Predictive Course Lines” key can also be
shown by pushing the MENU button, touching
the “Settings” key and then touching the “Camera” key.
HOW TO TURN ON AND OFF GUIDE
LINES (if equipped)
When the rear view monitor is displayed, you
can switch the vehicle width guide lines and
distance guide lines on/off by pushing the
CAMERA button.
WAE0138X
WAE0465X
3.
4.
5.
Slowly back up the vehicle adjusting the
steering wheel so that the predictive course
lines enter the parking space .
Maneuver the steering wheel to make the
vehicle width guide lines
parallel to the
parking space
while referring to the predictive course lines .
When the vehicle is parked in the space
completely, move the shift lever to the “P”
(Park) position (AT model) or the “N” (Neutral)
1.
Push the CAMERA button
.
2.
Touch the “Display Settings” key.
3.
Select the setting items you wish to adjust
by touching or by turning and pushing the
TUNE SCROLL dial .
OPERATING TIPS
y
When the shift lever is shifted to the “R”
(Reverse) position, the monitor screen automatically changes to the rear view monitor
mode. However, the radio can be heard.
y
It may take some time until the rear view
monitor or the normal screen is displayed
after the shift lever has been shifted to
“R” (Reverse) from another position or to
another position from “R” (Reverse). Objects
may be distorted momentarily until the rear
view monitor screen is displayed completely.
y
When the temperature is extremely high
or low, the screen may not clearly display
objects. This is not a malfunction.
Available setting items:
y
Brightness
y
Contrast
y
Tint
y
Colour/Color
y
Black Level
The “Display Settings” key can also be shown by
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 7
4-7
2021/01/13 01:16:48 PM
INTELLIGENT AROUND VIEW
MONITOR (if equipped)
y
When strong light directly enters the camera, objects may not be displayed clearly.
This is not a malfunction.
y
Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the
screen. This is due to strong reflected light
from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.
y
The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light. This is not a malfunction.
y
The colors of objects on the rear view monitor may differ somewhat from those of the
actual object.
y
Objects on the monitor may not be clear in
a dark place or at night. This is not a malfunction.
y
If dirt, rain or snow attaches to the camera,
the rear view monitor may not clearly display objects. Clean the camera.
y
Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth
dampened with diluted mild cleaning agent
and then wipe with a dry cloth.
y
Do not damage the camera as the monitor
screen may be adversely affected.
y
Do not use wax on the camera window. Wipe
off any wax with a clean cloth dampened
with mild detergent diluted with water.
passenger’s side wheel.
y
Front View
The view to the front of the vehicle.
y
Rear View
The view to the rear of the vehicle.
The system is designed as an aid to the driver
in situations such as slot parking or parallel
parking.
WARNING:
Type A
Type B
JVH0648X
y
The front camera view may be obscured
when fitting equipment to the front of
the vehicle such as bullbar, nudge bar or
additional lamps.
y
The driver is always responsible for safety
during parking and other manoeuvres.
WAE0085X
With the ignition switch in the “ON” position,
push the DISP button (if equipped) / CAMERA
button (if equipped) or move the shift lever to
the “R” (Reverse) position to operate the Intelligent Around View Monitor. The monitor displays
various views of the position of the vehicle.
Available views:
4-8
y
Bird’s-eye View
The surrounding view of the vehicle.
y
Front-side View
The view around and ahead of the front
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 8
2021/01/13 01:16:48 PM
WARNING:
y
WAE0556X
There are some areas where the system will not
display objects. When in the front or the rear
view display, an object below the bumper or on
the ground may not be displayed .
When in the bird’s-eye view, a tall object near
the seam of the camera detecting areas will not
appear in the monitor .
CAUTION:
The Intelligent Around View Monitor is a
convenient feature but it is not a substitute for proper vehicle operation because
it has areas where objects cannot be
viewed. Always look out the windows and
check mirrors to be sure that it is safe to
move.
y
The driver is always responsible for safety
during parking and other maneuvers.
y
Do not use the Intelligent Around View
Monitor with the outside mirror in the
stored position, and make sure that the
tailgate is securely closed when operating
the vehicle using the Intelligent Around
View Monitor.
Clean the camera lens with soft cloth to keep
it free from dirt, snow, etc. Do not scratch the
lens when cleaning.
AVAILABLE VIEWS
WARNING:
y
The distance guide line and the vehicle
width line should be used as a reference
only when the vehicle is on a paved, level
surface. The distance viewed on the monitor is for reference only and may be different than the actual distance between
the vehicle and displayed objects.
y
Use the displayed lines and the bird's-eye
view as a reference. The lines and the
bird's-eye view are greatly affected by the
number of occupants, fuel level, vehicle
position, road condition and road grade.
y
The distance between objects viewed
on the Intelligent Around View Monitor
differs from the actual distance.
y
The cameras are installed above the front
grille, the outside mirrors and on top of
the tailgate. Do not put anything on the
cameras.
y
If the tyres are replaced with different
sized tyres, the predictive course line and
the bird's-eye view may be displayed
incorrectly.
y
When washing the vehicle with high-pressure water, be sure not to spray it around
the cameras. Otherwise, water may enter
the camera unit causing water condensation on the lens, a malfunction, fire or an
electric shock.
y
When driving the vehicle up a hill, objects
viewed in the monitor are further than
they appear. When driving the vehicle
down a hill, objects viewed in the monitor
are closer than they appear.
Do not strike the cameras. They are precision instruments. Doing so could cause a
malfunction or cause damage resulting in
a fire or an electric shock.
y
y
Use the mirrors or actually look to properly judge distances to other objects.
y
The vehicle width and predictive course
lines are wider than the actual width and
course.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 9
4-9
2021/01/13 01:16:49 PM
Front and rear view
Indicate the approximate vehicle width.
played. When the steering wheel turns about
90 degrees or more, a predictive course line
is displayed only on the opposite side of the
turn.
Predictive course lines
Bird’s-eye view
y
Green line
: approx. 3 m (10 ft)
Vehicle width guide lines
Front view
SAA1840
:
:
Indicate the predictive course when operating
the vehicle. The predictive course lines will be
displayed on the monitor when the steering
wheel is turned. The predictive course lines will
move depending on how much the steering
wheel is turned. When the rear view is displayed,
predictive course lines will not be displayed
while the steering wheel is in the neutral position.
The front view will not be displayed when the
vehicle speed is above 10 km/h (6 MPH).
WARNING:
y
Rear view
SAA1896
Guiding lines, which indicate the vehicle width
and distances to objects with reference to the
vehicle body line , are displayed on the monitor.
Distance guide lines:
Indicate distances from the vehicle body.
y
Red line
y
Yellow line
: approx. 1 m (3 ft)
y
Green line
: approx. 2 m (7 ft)
4-10
: approx. 0.5 m (1.5 ft)
y
y
The distance between objects viewed in
the rear view may differ from the actual
distance. Objects in the rear view will
appear visually opposite in the same way
for those viewed in the inside and outside
mirrors.
On a snow-covered or slippery road, there
may be a difference between the predictive course line and the actual course line.
The displayed lines on the rear view will
appear slightly off to the right because
the rear view camera is not installed in the
rear center of the vehicle.
NOTE:
When the monitor displays the front view and
the steering wheel turns about 90 degrees or
less from the neutral position, both the right
and left predictive course lines
are dis-
JVH1795X
The bird’s-eye view shows the overhead view
of the vehicle which helps confirm the vehicle
position and the predicted course to a parking
space.
The vehicle icon
shows the position of the
vehicle. Note that the distance between objects
viewed in the bird’s-eye view differs from the
actual distance.
The areas that the cameras cannot cover
indicated in black.
are
After the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position, the non-viewable area is highlighted
in yellow for 3 seconds after the bird’s-eye view
is displayed.
When the vehicle moves closer to an object, the
parking sensor (sonar) indicators (if equipped)
appear. See "Camera aiding parking sensor
(sonar) function" (P.4-13) for more information.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 10
2021/01/13 01:16:49 PM
y
A line on the ground may be misaligned
and is not seen as being straight at the
seam of the views. The misalignment will
increase as the line proceeds away from
the vehicle.
Front-side view
WAE0572X
In addition, the non-viewable corners are displayed in red to remind the driver to be cautious
when parking sensor (sonar) is turned off. (See
"Settings" (P.2-19).)
After the ignition switch is placed in the “ON” position, the non-viewable corners will blink for
3 seconds after the bird’s-eye view is displayed.
WARNING:
y
y
y
y
Objects in the bird’s-eye view will appear
further than the actual distance because
the bird’s-eye view is a pseudo view that
is processed by combining the views from
the cameras on the outside mirrors, the
front and the rear of the vehicle.
Tall objects, such as a curb or vehicle, may
be misaligned or not displayed at the
seam of the views.
Objects that are above the camera cannot
be displayed.
The view for the bird’s-eye view may be
misaligned when the camera position
alters.
Example
JVH1778X
Guiding lines:
Guiding lines that indicate the width and the
front end of the vehicle are displayed on the
monitor.
The front-of-vehicle line
of the vehicle.
shows the front part
The side-of-vehicle line
shows the vehicle
width including the outside mirrors.
The extensions
of both the front
and side
lines are shown with a green dotted line.
CAUTION:
y
Do not scratch the camera lens when
cleaning dirt or snow.
y
The turn signal light may overlap with the
side-of-vehicle line. This is not a malfunction.
OFF-ROAD MONITOR (if equipped)
When the shift lever is out of the "R"(Reverse)
position and the vehicle speed is 10 km/h (6
MPH) or below, selecting the 4LO position using
the 4WD mode switch affects the Intelligent
Around View Monitor display as follows:
y
Selecting the 4LO position will activate the
Intelligent Around View Monitor. The front
view/front-side view split screen will be
displayed.
y
When the ignition switch is placed in the
“ON” position with the 4LO position selected,
the front view/front-side view split screen
will be displayed.
y
When the vehicle is shifted to the 4LO position with the bird’s-eye view displayed, the
passenger side of the display will change to
the front-side view.
For details about the 4WD mode switch, see
"Four-Wheel Drive (4WD)" (P.5-16)
When the off-road monitor is active, the screen
displayed on the Intelligent Around View Monitor will return to the previous screen only when
3 minutes have passed after the vehicle was
shifted out of the 4LO position or vehicle speed
is above 10 km/h (6 MPH).
After automatically returning to the previous
screen due to the vehicle speed exceeding 10
km/h (6 MPH) with the 4WD mode switch in
the 4LO position, decreasing the vehicle speed
to 8 km/h (5 MPH) or below will again display
the Intelligent Around View Monitor (front view/
front-side view screen).
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 11
4-11
2021/01/13 01:16:49 PM
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN PREDICTIVE
AND ACTUAL DISTANCES
Backing up on a steep uphill
JVH0893X
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown closer than the actual distance.
For example, the display shows 1 m (3 ft) to the
place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft) distance on
the hill is the place . Note that any object on
the hill is viewed in the monitor further than it
appears.
4-12
Backing up on a steep downhill
Backing up near a projecting object
JVH0894X
JVH1779X
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide
lines are shown further than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 1 m (3 ft)
to the place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft) distance
on the hill is the place . Note that any object
on the hill is viewed in the monitor closer than
it appears.
The predictive course lines
do not touch
the object on the display. However, the vehicle
may hit the object if it projects over the actual
moving course.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 12
2021/01/13 01:16:50 PM
Backing up behind a projecting object
HOW TO SWITCH THE DISPLAY
y
A different screen is selected (when the shift
lever is not in the “R” (Reverse) position).
CAMERA AIDING PARKING SENSOR
(sonar) FUNCTION (if equipped)
When the vehicle moves closer to the object
while the Intelligent Around View Monitor is
displayed, an indicator is displayed and a tone is
sounded by the parking sensor (sonar) function
to warn the driver.
JVH1781X
With the ignition switch in the “ON” position,
push the CAMERA/DISP button or move the
shift lever to the “R” (Reverse) position to operate the Intelligent Around View Monitor.
The Intelligent Around View Monitor can display
two split views.
If the shift lever is not in the “R” (Reverse) position, the available views are:
y
y
Front view/bird’s-eye view split screen
Front view/front-side view split screen
If the shift lever is in the “R” (Reverse) position,
the available views are:
JVH0895X
The position
is shown further than the position in the display. However, the position is
actually at the same distance as the position .
The vehicle may hit the object when backing up
to the position if the object projects over the
actual moving course.
y
y
y
Rear view/bird’s-eye view split screen
Rear view/front-side view split screen
Rear view
The display will switch back to the previously
displayed screen from the Intelligent Around
View Monitor screen when:
y The shift lever is in the “D” (Drive) position
(AT model) or the shift lever is out of the “R”
(Reverse) position (MT model), and the vehicle speed increases above approximately 10
km/h (6 MPH).
The color of the parking sensor (sonar) indicator and the pattern of the tone vary according
to the distance to the object.
Keep the parking sensor (sonar) (located on the
rear bumper fascia) free from snow, ice and large
accumulations of dirt. Do not clean the sensors
(sonar) with sharp objects. If the sensors (sonar)
are covered, the accuracy of the parking sensor
(sonar) function will be diminished.
The tone sound and the sensor (sonar) indicator
display can be turned on/off, and the volume
of the tone sound and the sensor (sonar) detection range can be adjusted. (See "Settings"
(P.2-19).)
WARNING:
y
The parking sensor (sonar) function is not
designed to prevent the object.
y
The colors of the parking sensor (sonar)
indicator and the distance guide lines
in the front/rear view indicate different
distances to the object.
y
Inclement weather may affect the function of the parking sensor (sonar) system;
this may include reduced performance or
a false activation.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 13
4-13
2021/01/13 01:16:50 PM
y
y
This function is designed as an aid to the
driver in detecting large stationary objects to help avoid damaging the vehicle.
The system will not detect small objects
below the bumper, and may not detect
objects that are too close to the bumper
or on the ground.
If your vehicle sustains damage to the
bumper fascia, leaving it misaligned or
bent, the sensing zone may be altered
causing inaccurate measurement of obstacles or false alarms.
CAUTION:
Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible to hear the tone clearly.
MOVING OBJECT DETECTION (MOD)
The Moving Object Detection (MOD) system
can inform the driver of the moving objects
surrounding the vehicle when driving out of
garages, maneuvering into parking lots and in
other such instances.
The MOD system detects moving objects by using image processing technology on the image
shown on the display.
MOD system operation
The MOD system will turn on automatically
under the following conditions:
y
When the shift lever is in the “R” (Reverse)
position.
y
When vehicle speed decreases below approximately 8 km/h (5 MPH) and the camera
screen is displayed.
Rear and bird's-eye views
WAE0534X
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the Moving Object Detection (MOD) system could result in serious
injury or death.
y
The MOD system is not a substitute
for proper vehicle operation and is not
designed to prevent contact with the
objects surrounding the vehicle. When
maneuvering, always use the outside
mirror and rearview mirror and turn and
check the surrounding to ensure it is safe
to maneuver.
y
The system is deactivated at speeds
above 8 km/h (5 MPH). It is reactivated at
lower speeds.
y
The MOD system is not designed to detect
the surrounding stationary objects.
4-14
Rear and front-side views
JVH1257X
The MOD system operates in the following
conditions when the camera view is displayed:
Front and bird's-eye views
WAE0533X
y
When the shift lever is in the “P” (Park) or
“N” (Neutral) position (AT model) or the shift
lever is out of the “R” (Reverse) position (MT
model) and the vehicle is stopped, the MOD
system detects moving objects in the bird’seye view. The MOD system will not operate if
the outside mirrors are moving in or out, in
the stowed position, or if either front door
is opened.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 14
2021/01/13 01:16:50 PM
y
y
When the shift lever is in the “D” (Drive)
position (AT model) or the shift lever is out
of the "R"(Reverse) position (MT model) and
the vehicle speed is below approximately
8 km/h (5 MPH), the MOD system detects
moving objects in the front view.
When the shift lever is in the “R” (Reverse)
position and the vehicle speed is below
approximately 8 km/h (5 MPH), the MOD
system detects moving objects in the rear
view.
The MOD system will not operate if the tailgate
is open.
MOD system limitations
y
y
y
When the temperature is extremely high
or low, the screen may not display objects
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
Excessive noise (for example, audio
system volume or open vehicle window)
will interfere with the chime sound, and it
may not be heard.
NOTE:
The MOD system performance will be
limited according to environmental conditions and surrounding objects such as:
y
When the system is malfunctioning.
y
When the component temperature reaches a high level (icon will blink).
y
When the rear view camera has detected
a blockage (icon will blink).
— When there is low contrast between
background and the moving objects.
When the MOD system detects moving objects
near the vehicle, a chime will be heard and a yellow frame will be displayed on the view where
the objects are detected. While the MOD system
continues to detect moving objects, the yellow
frame continues to be displayed.
— When there is blinking source of light.
— When strong light such as another vehicle’s headlight or sunlight is present.
— When camera orientation is not in its
usual position, such as when mirror is
folded.
In the bird’s-eye view, the yellow frame
is
displayed on each camera image (front, rear,
right, left) depending on where moving objects
are detected.
— When there is dirt, water drops or snow
on the camera lens.
The blue MOD icon will change to orange if
one of the following has occurred.
If the icon light continues to illuminate in
orange, have the MOD system checked. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service.
System maintenance
— When the position of the moving objects in the display is not changed.
The yellow frame is displayed on each view in
the front view and rear view modes.
y
A blue MOD icon
is displayed in the view
where the MOD system is operative. A white
MOD icon
is displayed in the view where the
MOD system is not operative.
The MOD system might detect flowing
water droplets on the camera lens, white
smoke from the muffler, moving shadows,
etc.
y
The MOD system may not function properly depending on the speed, direction,
distance or shape of the moving objects.
The MOD system can be turned on and off.
If your vehicle sustains damage to the
parts where the camera is installed,
leaving it misaligned or bent, the sensing
zone may be altered and the MOD system
may not detect objects properly.
WARNING:
Listed below are the system limitations for
MOD. Failure to operate the vehicle in accordance with these system limitations could
result in serious injury or death.
The MOD system does not detect moving objects in the front-side view. The MOD icon is not
displayed on the screen when in this view.
Turning MOD system on and off
y
WAE0508X
See "Driver Assistance" (P.2-19) for details.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 15
4-15
2021/01/13 01:16:50 PM
4.
CAUTION:
y
y
Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
clean the camera. This will cause discoloration.
Adjust the level using the TUNE FOLDER
dial
and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button to apply the adjustment.
Adjusting screen (Type B)
OPERATING TIPS
CAUTION:
y
Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with
a cloth dampened with a diluted mild
cleaning agent and then wipe with a dry
cloth.
y
Do not damage the camera as the monitor screen may be adversely affected.
y
The screen displayed on the Intelligent
Around View Monitor will automatically
return to the previous screen when no operation takes place for 3 minutes after the
CAMERA button or DISP button has been
pushed while the shift lever is in a position
other than the “R” (Reverse) position.
y
The display of images on the screen may be
delayed after screens are switched. Objects
in the Intelligent Around View Monitor
may be distorted momentarily until the
Intelligent Around View Monitor screen is
displayed completely.
y
When the temperature is extremely high
or low, the screen may not display objects
clearly. This is not a malfunction.
y
When strong light directly shines on the
camera, objects may not be displayed clearly. This is not a malfunction.
y
The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light. This is not a malfunction.
y
The colors of objects on the Intelligent
Around View Monitor may differ somewhat
from those of the actual object.
Do not damage the camera as the monitor screen may be adversely affected.
If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on any of the
cameras , the MOD system may not operate
properly. Clean the camera by wiping with a
cloth dampened with a diluted mild cleaning
agent and then wiping with a dry cloth.
HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN (if
equipped)
NOTE:
WAE0086X
Do not adjust the screen while the vehicle is
moving.
y
Push the MENU button
Adjusting screen (Type A)
y
Touch the “Settings” key.
y
Touch the “Camera” key.
y
Touch the “Display Settings” key.
y
Select the setting items you wish to adjust
by touching or by turning and pushing the
TUNE SCROLL dial .
Available setting items:
JVH0653X
1.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button
2.
Turn the TUNE FOLDER dial
to highlight
the “Brightness” or the “Contrast” key.
3.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button
4-16
.
y
Brightness
y
Contrast
y
Tint
y
Colour/Color
y
Black Level
.
.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 16
2021/01/13 01:16:51 PM
VENTILATORS
y
Objects on the monitor may not be clear
and the color of the object may differ in a
dark location or at night. This is not a malfunction.
y
There may be differences in clearness between each camera view of the bird's-eye
view.
y
If dirt, rain or snow attaches to the camera,
the Intelligent Around View Monitor may
not display objects clearly. Clean the camera.
y
Do not use wax on the camera window.
Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth that
has been dampened with a mild detergent
diluted with water.
CENTER VENTILATORS
REAR VENTILATORS (if equipped)
JVH0887X
Type A
Adjust the air flow direction of the ventilators by
moving the center knob (up/down, left/right)
until the desired position is achieved.
JVH0940X
SIDE VENTILATORS
Type B
SAA3126
Adjust the air flow direction of the ventilators by
opening, closing or rotating.
The side ventilators can be used for the side
defogger.
JVH1597X
Adjust the air flow direction of the ventilators by
moving the center knob (up/down, left/right)
until the desired position is achieved.
For Type A:
Open/close the vents by moving the control to
either direction.
:
This symbol indicates that the vents are
closed. Moving the control to this direction will close the vents.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 17
4-17
2021/01/13 01:16:51 PM
HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER
:
This symbol indicates that the vents are
open. Moving the control to this direction will open the vents.
WARNING:
y
The heater and air conditioner operate
only when the engine is running.
y
Never leave children or adults who would
normally require the support of others
alone in the vehicle. Pets should not be
left alone either. They could unknowingly
activate switches or controls and inadvertently become involved in a serious
accident and injure themselves. On hot,
sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough
to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries
to people or animals.
y
Do not use the recirculation mode for long
periods as it may cause the interior air to
become stale and the windows to fog up.
y
Do not adjust the heating and air conditioning controls while driving so that full
attention may be given to vehicle operation.
The heater and air conditioner operate when
the engine is running. The air blower will operate even if the engine is turned off and the
ignition switch is placed in the “ON” position.
NOTE:
4-18
y
Odors from inside and outside the vehicle
can build up in the air conditioner unit.
Odor can enter the passenger compartment through the vents.
y
When parking, set the heater and air
conditioner controls to turn off air recirculation to allow fresh air into the passenger
compartment. This should help reduce
odors inside the vehicle.
OPERATING TIPS (models with automatic air conditioner)
SAA2324
WAE0536X
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model (example)
When the engine coolant temperature and outside air temperature are low, the air flow from
the foot outlets may not operate. However, this
is not a malfunction. After the coolant temperature warms up, the air flow from the foot outlets
will operate normally.
The sensors and , located on the instrument
panel, help maintain a constant temperature.
Do not put anything on or around the sensors.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 18
2021/01/13 01:16:51 PM
MANUAL AIR CONDITIONER AND HEATER
Outside air circulation:
Push the air recirculation “
” button. (The
indicator light will turn off.) The air flow is drawn
from outside the vehicle.
Select the outside air circulation mode for normal heating or air conditioning operation.
Air recirculation:
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will illuminate.)
” button. (The
The air flow is recirculated inside the vehicle.
JVH1521X
1.
Air recirculation “
” button
clockwise to decrease the fan speed.
2.
Mirror heater button (if equipped)
When you push the button, the indicator
light illuminates and the outside rearview
mirror heater is turned on.
3.
Temperature control dial
4.
“A/C” (air conditioner) button
5.
Fan speed control “
6.
Air flow control dial
” dial
Temperature control:
Turn the temperature control dial to set the
desired temperature. Turn the dial between
the middle and the right position to select the
hot temperature. Turn the dial between the
middle and the left position to select the cool
temperature.
Air flow control:
This dial allows you to select the air flow outlets.
Controls
A/C (Air Conditioner) operation:
Push the “A/C” button to turn on or off the air
conditioner. When the air conditioner is on, the
“A/C” indicator light on the button illuminates.
Heater operation
Heating:
This mode is used to direct heated air from the
foot outlets.
1.
Push the air recirculation “
” button for
normal heating. (The indicator light will turn
off.)
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
3.
Turn the fan speed control “
desired position.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle and
the hot (right) position.
”
—
Air flows from center and side ventilators.
To turn on the system, turn the fan speed control “
” dial out of the “0” position. Turn the dial
counter clockwise to the “0” position to turn off
the system.
—
Air flows from center and side ventilators and foot outlets.
—
Air flows mainly from the foot outlets.
4.
Fan speed control:
—
Air flows from the defogger and foot
outlets.
Ventilation:
—
Air flows mainly from the defogger
outlets.
This mode directs outside air from the side and
center ventilators.
Turning system on/off:
Turn the fan speed control “
to increase the fan speed.
” dial clockwise
Turn the fan speed control “
” dial counter-
” dial to the
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 19
4-19
2021/01/13 01:16:52 PM
1.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
” button. (The
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
3.
Turn the fan speed control “
desired position.
4.
3.
Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.
”
4.
Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
light will illuminate.)
” dial to the
5.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle and
the cool (left) position.
1.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
” button. (The
”
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
” dial to the
3.
Turn the fan speed control “
desired position.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
4.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
Defrosting or defogging:
Heating and defogging:
This mode directs the air to the defogger outlets to defrost/defog the windows.
This mode heats the interior and defogs the
windows.
1.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
”
1.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
2.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
” button. (The
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
3.
Turn the fan speed control “
desired position.
” dial to the
3.
Turn the fan speed control dial to the desired position.
4.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle and
the hot (right) position.
4.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
maximum hot (right) position.
y
To remove frost from the windshield quickly,
turn the temperature control dial to the
maximum position and the fan speed control “
” dial to the maximum position.
y
If it is difficult to defog the windshield, turn
the “A/C” button on.
Bi-level heating:
This mode directs cool air from the side and
center vents and warm air from the foot outlets.
When the temperature control dial is turned to
the maximum hot or cool position, the air between the ventilators and the foot outlets is the
same temperature.
4-20
A visible mist may be seen coming from the
ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air
is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunction.
y
” button. (The
”
Air conditioner operation
The air conditioner system should be operated
for approximately 10 minutes at least once a
month. This helps prevent damage to the air
conditioner system due to the lack of lubrication.
Cooling:
This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the
air.
1.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
” button. (The
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
”
For quick cooling when the outside temperature is high, push the air recirculation
“
” button. (The indicator light will turn
on.) Be sure to return the air recirculation
“
” button to turn off for normal cooling.
Dehumidified heating:
This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the
air.
1.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
” button. (The
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
3.
Turn the fan speed control “
desired position.
4.
Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
light will illuminate.)
5.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle and
the hot (right) position.
”
” dial to the
Dehumidified defogging:
This mode is used to defog the windows and
dehumidify the air.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 20
2021/01/13 01:16:52 PM
1.
Push the air recirculation “
indicator light will turn off.)
” button. (The
2.
Turn the air flow control dial to the “
position.
3.
Turn the fan speed control “
desired position.
4.
Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
light will illuminate.)
5.
Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
AUTOMATIC AIR CONDITIONER
”
” dial to the
JVH0892X
1.
Temperature control buttons (left side seat)
2.
Outside air circulation “
3.
Air recirculation “
4.
Display screen
5.
Front defogger “
6.
Rear defogger “
” button* (See "Defogger
switch" (P.2-38).) (if equipped) / Mirror heater button (if equipped)
” button*
” button*
Automatic operation (AUTO)
” button*
When you push the button, the indicator
light illuminates and the outside rearview
mirror heater is turned on.
7.
Temperature control buttons (right side
seat)
8.
“DUAL” (zone control ON/OFF) button*
9.
“A/C” (Air Conditioner) button*
10. Fan speed control “
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model. For the LeftHand Drive (LHD) model, the switch layout will
be opposite.
The “AUTO” mode may be used year-round
as the system automatically controls the air
conditioner to a constant temperature, air flow
distribution and fan speed after the desired
temperature is set manually.
To turn the heater and air conditioner on or off,
push the “ON·OFF” button.
Cooling and dehumidified heating:
1.
Push the “AUTO” button (the “AUTO” indicator light will illuminate).
2.
For the Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model:
If the “A/C” indicator light is not illuminated,
push the “A/C” button (the “A/C” indicator
light will illuminate).
” button
11. “MODE” button
12. “AUTO” button*
3.
13. “ON·OFF” button*
*:The switch layout in the illustration is for the
Push the temperature control buttons (“
” and “
”) to set the desired temperature.
y
When the “DUAL” indicator light is not
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 21
4-21
2021/01/13 01:16:52 PM
illuminated, pushing the “DUAL” button
(the “DUAL” indicator light will illuminate)
allows the user to independently change
the driver and passenger side temperatures with the corresponding temperature control buttons (“
” and “
”).
y
4.
A visible mist may be seen coming from the
ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air
is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunction.
Heating (A/C off):
1.
Push the “AUTO” button (the “AUTO” indicator light will illuminate).
2.
If the “A/C” indicator light is illuminated,
push the “A/C” button (the “A/C” indicator
light will turn off).
3.
Push the temperature control buttons (“
” and “
”) to set the desired temperature.
4-22
y
To cancel the separate temperature
setting, push the “DUAL” button (the
“DUAL” indicator light will turn off) and
the driver's side temperature setting
will be applied to both the driver and
passenger sides.
Push either the outside air circulation “
”
button or the air recirculation “
” button
(the button with an indicator light illuminated) for approximately 2 seconds to switch
to the automatic air intake control mode
(the indicator lights will blink twice).
y
temperatures with the corresponding
temperature control buttons (“
” and
“
”).
When the “DUAL” indicator light is not
illuminated, pushing the “DUAL” button
(the “DUAL” indicator light will illuminate) allows the user to independently
change the driver and passenger side
y
y
To cancel the separate temperature
setting, push the “DUAL” button (the
“DUAL” indicator light will turn off) and
the driver's side temperature setting
will be applied to both the driver and
passenger sides.
Do not set the temperature lower than
the outside air temperature. Doing so
may cause the temperature to not be
controlled properly.
If the windows fog up, use dehumidified
heating instead of the “A/C” off heating.
so may fog up the windshield.
Manual operation
The manual mode can be used to control the
heater and air conditioner to your desired
settings.
Fan speed control:
Push the fan speed control “
” button ( + side
or − side) to manually control the fan speed.
Air flow control:
Push the “MODE” button to select the desired
mode:
Dehumidified defrosting/defogging:
1.
Push the front defogger “
” button (the
“
” indicator light will illuminate).
2.
Push the temperature control buttons (“
” and “
”) to set the desired temperature.
y
To quickly remove frost from the outside
surface of the windshield, set the temperature control and the fan speed to the
maximum levels.
y
After the windshield is cleared, push the
“AUTO” button to return to the “AUTO” mode.
y
When the front defogger “
” button is
pushed, the air conditioner will automatically turn on, sensing the outside air temperature to defog the windshield. For the
best defogging performance, do not select
the air recirculation mode.
y
Do not set the temperature too low when
the front defogger mode is on (the “
”
indicator light is illuminated), because doing
—
Air flows from center and side ventilators.
—
Air flows from center and side ventilators and foot outlets.
—
Air flows mainly from the foot outlets.
—
Air flows from the front defogger outlets and foot outlets.
Temperature control:
Push the temperature control buttons (“
and “
”) to set the desired temperature.
”
y
When the “DUAL” indicator light is not
illuminated, pushing the “DUAL” button (the
“DUAL” indicator light will illuminate) allows
the user to independently change the driver
and passenger side temperatures with the
corresponding temperature control buttons (“
” and “
”).
y
To cancel the separate temperature setting,
push the “DUAL” button (the “DUAL” indicator light will turn off) and the driver's side
temperature setting will be applied to both
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 22
2021/01/13 01:16:53 PM
AUDIO SYSTEM (if equipped)
the driver and passenger sides.
Air intake control:
y
Push the
air recirculation button to
recirculate interior air inside the vehicle. The
indicator light on the button will come
on.
y
Push the
outside air circulation button
to draw outside air into the passenger
compartment. The
indicator light on
the button will come on.
y
To control the air intake automatically, push
and hold either the
air recirculation
button or the
outside air circulation
button (whichever indicator light is illuminated). The indicator lights (both air
recirculation and outside air circulation
buttons) will flash twice, and then the air
intake will switch to automatic control.
When the automatic control is set, the system automatically alternates between the
outside air circulation and the
air
recirculation modes (the indicator light of
the active mode will illuminate).
To turn system on/off
To turn off the heater and air conditioner, push
the “ON·OFF” button.
SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER
WARNING:
The air conditioner system contains refrigerant under high pressure. To avoid personal
injury, any air conditioner service should be
done only by an experienced technician with
the proper equipment.
The air conditioner system in your vehicle is
charged with a refrigerant designed with the
environment in mind.
This refrigerant will not harm the earth’s
ozone layer. However, it may contribute in a
small part to global warming.
Special charging equipment and lubricant are
required when servicing your vehicle’s air conditioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubricants
will cause severe damage to the air conditioner
system. (See "Air conditioner system refrigerant
and lubricant" (P.9-5).)
A NISSAN dealer will be able to service your
environmentally friendly air conditioner system.
For models with NissanConnect System:
Refer to NissanConnect Owner’s Manual for the
audio system operations.
AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS
WARNING:
Do not adjust the audio system while driving
so that full attention may be given to vehicle
operation.
Radio
y
Radio reception is affected by station signal
strength, distance from radio transmitter,
buildings, bridges, mountains and other
external influences. Intermittent changes
in reception quality normally are caused by
these external influences.
y
Using a cellular phone in or near the vehicle
may influence radio reception quality.
Air conditioner filter
The air conditioner system is equipped with an
air conditioner filter which collects and neutralizes dirt, pollen, dust, etc. To make sure that
the air conditioner heats, defogs and ventilates
efficiently, replace the filter in accordance with
the specified maintenance intervals listed in the
separate maintenance booklet. To replace the
filter, contact a NISSAN dealer.
The filter should be replaced if the air flow decreases significantly or if windows fog up easily
when operating the heater or air conditioner.
Anti-theft system
Use of a 4-digit radio PIN (Personal Identification
Number) code, known only to the vehicle owner,
effectively reduces the possibility of the audio
unit being stolen. Without the PIN code the
audio unit can not be activated.
If force is used to try and remove the audio unit,
the Anti-theft system activates and the audio
unit is locked. The only way to unlock the audio
unit is to enter the radio code number shown
on an identification card supplied with the vehicle documentation.
NOTE:
y
The 4 digit radio code is shown on a card
that you received with your vehicle documentation.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 23
4-23
2021/01/13 01:16:53 PM
y
Contact a NISSAN dealer, if you do lose the
4 digit radio code of the audio unit.
4.
Unlocking the unit
The second, third, and fourth digits of the
radio code must be entered, in the same
way, only now using preset buttons , ,
and .
For example, press
nine times.
JVH1078A
If the battery supply to the vehicle is interrupted, the audio unit will lock.
When the power is restored and the unit is
switched on, the display will show the [Radio
Code:] and it will be unlocked when the code
has been entered correctly.
Unlocking procedure:
Read this section very carefully. It is important
that the instructions are followed precisely.
To unlock the audio unit, proceed as follows:
1.
Turn the power switch to the ACC or ON
position.
2.
[Radio Code:] is displayed along with four
numerical zero digits.
3.
Press preset button the number of times
corresponding with the first digit of the
radio code.
six times, and
5.
Press and hold the preset button < > to
confirm the code. If you entered the code
correctly the unit will switch on.
6.
If the code is entered incorrectly a notification message [INCORRECT PIN] and
the number of at- tempts left [REMAINING
TRIES: XX] will be shown.
After reading the message, press the button to return to the entry screen
and enter the correct radio code.
– If the wrong code is entered after the
third attempt, the audio unit will lock for
60 minutes. The display will show a count
down timer from 60 to 0 (minutes). After
60 minutes enter the correct radio code.
– If the wrong code is entered after eight
sets of three entries, the audio unit will
lock permanently. Contact a NISSAN
dealer for further details.
For example, if the radio code is 5169: for the
first digit, 5, press the preset button
five
times.
4-24
once,
Compact Disc (CD) player
SAA0480
y
During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to the humidity. If
this occurs, remove the CD from CD player
and dehumidify or ventilate the player
completely.
y
The player may skip while driving on rough
roads.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 24
2021/01/13 01:16:54 PM
y
The CD player sometimes may not function when the passenger compartment
temperature is extremely high. Lower the
temperature before use.
y
Do not expose the CD to direct sunlight.
y
CDs that are of poor quality, or are dirty,
scratched, covered with fingerprints, or that
have pin holes may not work properly.
y
The following CDs may not work properly.
— Copy control compact discs (CCCD)
— Recordable compact discs (CD-R)
— Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)
y
Do not use the following CDs as they may
cause the CD player to malfunction.
— 8 cm (3.1 in) discs
— CDs that are not round
— CDs with a paper label
— CDs that are warped, scratched or have
unusual edges.
y
This audio system can only play prerecorded CDs. It has no capabilities to record or
burn CDs.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection
Port
WARNING:
Do not connect, disconnect or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be a
distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident or
serious injury.
of the device.
CAUTION:
y
y
Do not force the USB device into the USB
connection port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the USB
device is connected correctly into the USB
connection port.
Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device.
USB devices should be purchased separately as
necessary.
This system cannot be used to format USB
devices. To format a USB device, use a personal
computer.
In some states/area, the USB device for the
front seats plays only sound without images
for regulatory reasons, even when the vehicle
is parked.
This system supports various USB memory
devices, USB hard drives and iPod players. Some
USB devices may not be supported by this
system.
y
Partitioned USB devices may not be played
correctly.
y
Some characters used in other languages
(Chinese, Japanese, etc.) may not appear
properly in the display. Using English
language characters with a USB device is
recommended.
Notes for iPod use:
“Made for iPod”, “Made for iPhone”, and “Made
for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory
has been designed to connect specifically to
iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been
certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of
this device or its compliance with safety and
regulatory standards.
Please note that the use of this accessory with
iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance.
iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, iPod
shuffle, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple
Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Lightning is a trademark of Apple Inc.
y
Improperly plugging in the iPod may cause
a checkmark to be displayed on and off
(flickering). Always make sure that the iPod
is connected properly.
y
An iPod nano (1st Generation) may remain
in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this case,
please manually reset the iPod.
y
An iPod nano (2nd Generation) will continue
to fast-forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation.
y
An incorrect song title may appear when
the Play Mode is changed while using an
iPod nano (2nd Generation).
y
Audio books may not play in the same order
as they appear on an iPod.
General notes for USB use:
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 25
4-25
2021/01/13 01:16:54 PM
y
Large video files cause slow responses in
an iPod. The vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but will soon recover.
y
If an iPod automatically selects large video
files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle
center display may momentarily black out,
but will soon recover.
y
While a Bluetooth® audio device is connected through the Bluetooth® wireless
connection, the battery power of the device
may discharge quicker than usual.
Compact Disc (CD)/USB device with
MP3/WMA/AAC (if equipped)
y
This system is compatible with the Bluetooth® AV profile (A2DP and AVRCP).
y
MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving Pictures
Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the
most well known compressed digital audio
file format. This format allows for near “CD
quality” sound, but at a fraction of the size
of normal audio files. MP3 conversion of
an audio track from CD can reduce the file
size by approximately 10:1 ratio (Sampling:
44.1 kHz, Bit rate: 128 kbps) with virtually no
perceptible loss in quality. MP3 compression
removes the redundant and irrelevant
parts of a sound signal that the human ear
doesn’t hear.
y
WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA) is a
compressed audio format created by Microsoft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA
codec offers greater file compression than
the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more
digital audio tracks in the same amount of
space when compared to MP3s at the same
level of quality.
Bluetooth® audio player (if equipped)
y
Some Bluetooth® audio devices may not
be used with this system. For detailed information about Bluetooth® audio devices
that are available for use with this system,
contact a NISSAN dealer.
y
Before using a Bluetooth® audio system,
the initial registration process for the audio
device is necessary.
y
Operation of the Bluetooth® audio system
may vary depending on the audio device
that is connected. Confirm the operation
procedure before use.
y
The playback of Bluetooth® audio will be
paused under the following conditions. The
playback will be resumed after the following
conditions are completed.
Terms:
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc., and licensed to Visteon
Corporation and Panasonic
Corporation.
This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft Corporation and third parties. Use or distribution
of such technology outside of this product
is prohibited without a license from Microsoft or an authorized Microsoft subsidiary
and third parties.
— while using a hands-free phone
— while checking a connection with a cell
phone
y
The in-vehicle antenna for Bluetooth®
communication is built in the system. Do
not place the Bluetooth® audio device in an
area surrounded by metal, far away from
the system or in a narrow space where the
device closely contacts the body or the seat.
Otherwise, sound degradation or connection interference may occur.
4-26
y
AAC (if equipped) — Advanced Audio Coding
(AAC) is a compressed audio format. AAC
offers greater file compression than MP3
and enables music file creation and storage
at the same quality as MP3.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 26
2021/01/13 01:16:54 PM
y
Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number of
bits per second used by a digital music files.
The size and quality of a compressed digital
audio file is determined by the bit rate used
when encoding the file.
y
Sampling frequency — Sampling frequency
is the rate at which the samples of a signal
are converted from analog to digital (A/D
conversion) per second.
y
Multisession — Multisession is one of the
methods for writing data to media. Writing
data once to the media is called a single
session, and writing more than once is
called a multisession.
y
ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is the
part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that
contains information about the digital
music file such as song title, artist, album
title, encoding bit rate, track time duration,
etc. ID3 tag information is displayed on the
Album/Artist/Track title line on the display.
Playback order:
* Windows® and Windows Media® are registered
trademarks and/or trademarks of Microsoft
Corporation in the United States of America
and/or other countries.
SAA2494
Music playback order of the CD with MP3/WMA/
AAC (if equipped) is as illustrated above.
y
The folder names of folders not containing
MP3/WMA files are not shown in the display.
y
If there is a file in the top level of the disc,
“Root Folder” is displayed.
y
The playback order is the order in which the
files were written by the writing software, so
the files might not play in the desired order.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 27
4-27
2021/01/13 01:16:54 PM
Specification chart :
For FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player type A, B or C
Supported media
Supported file systems
MP3
Supported versions*1
WMA*2
AAC
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Tag information (Song title and Artist name)
Folder levels
CD, CD-R, CD-RW
USB
Displayable character codes*3
CD, CD-R, CD-RW, USB2.0
ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet
ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported
Files saved using the Live File System component (on a Windows Vista-based computer) are not supported.
USB memory: FAT16, FAT32
MPEG1
32 kHz - 48 kHz
32 kbps - 320 kbps VBR*4
WMA9 (compatible WMA7 and WMA8)
16 kHz - 48 kHz
48 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR*4
MPEG-4 AAC
8 kHz - 48 kHz
32 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR*4
ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3
AAC tag supported
Folder levels: 8, Folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one
folder)
Folder levels: 8, Folders 255, Files: 2500 (Max. 255 files for one folder)
Memory size: 4GB
01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF16 Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little
Endian), 07:SHIFT-JIS
*1
Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.
*2
Protected WMA files (DRM) cannot be played.
*3
Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.
*4
When VBR files are played, the playback time may not be displayed correctly. WMA7 and WMA8 are not applied to VBR.
4-28
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 28
2021/01/13 01:16:54 PM
Specification chart :
For FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player type D
Supported media
Supported file systems
MP3
Supported versions*1
WMA*2
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Version
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Tag information (Song title and Artist name)
Folder levels
CD, CD-R, CD-RW
USB
Displayable character codes*3
CD, CD-R, CD-RW, USB2.0
CD, CD-R, CD-RW: ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Romeo, Joliet
* ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported
* Files saved using the Live File System component (on a Windows Vista-based computer) are not supported.
USB memory: FAT16, FAT32
MPEG1 Audio Layer 3
32 kHz - 48 kHz
32 kbps - 320 kbps VBR*4
WMA7, WMA8, WMA9
32 kHz - 48 kHz
32kbps - 192 kbps, VBR4, 32 kbps - 320 kbps (WMA9 only)
ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3, VER2.4 (MP3 only)
WMA tag (WMA only)
Folder levels: 8, Folders: 255, Files: 999 (Max. 255 files for one folder)
Folder levels: 8, Folders 255, Files: 2500 (Max. 255 files for one folder)
Memory size: 4GB
01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16
Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8)
*1
Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.
*2
Protected WMA files (DRM) cannot be played.
*3
Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.
*4
When VBR files are played, the playback time may not be displayed correctly.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 29
4-29
2021/01/13 01:16:54 PM
Troubleshooting guide:
Symptom
Cause and Countermeasure
Check if the disc was inserted correctly.
Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.
Check if there is condensation inside the player, and if there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before
using the player.
If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.
If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and MP3/WMA/AAC (if equipped) files on a CD, only the music CD files
Cannot play
(CD-DA data) will be played.
Files with extensions other than “.MP3”, “.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and
number of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.
Check if the disc or the file is generated in an irregular format. This may occur depending on the variation or the setting of
MP3/WMA/AAC (if equipped) writing applications or other text editing applications.
Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.
Check if the disc is protected by copyright.
Poor sound quality
Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.
It takes a relatively long time before the music If there are many folder or file levels on the MP3/WMA/AAC (if equipped) disc, some time may be required before the music
starts playing.
starts playing.
The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc.,
Music cuts off or skips
might not match the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.
Skipping with high bit rate files
Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.
When a non-MP3/WMA/AAC (if equipped) file has been given an extension of “.MP3”, “.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma”, or when play
Move immediately to the next song when playing.
is prohibited by copyright protection, the player will skip to the next song.
The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software, so the files might not play in the
The songs do not play back in the desired order.
desired order
4-30
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 30
2021/01/13 01:16:55 PM
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type A)
Audio main operation
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
Power button/VOL control knob:
Power ON/OFF:
To turn on the audio system, push the power
button.
The system will turn on in the mode that was
used immediately before the system was
turned off.
To turn off the audio system, push the power
button.
Volume control:
To control the volume, turn the VOL control
knob.
Turn the knob clockwise to make the sound
louder.
Turn the knob counterclockwise to make the
sound quieter.
JVH0677X
1.
DISP (Display) button
9.
CD eject button
2.
RADIO button
10. MEDIA button
3.
Day/Night button
11. MUTE button
4.
MIX button
12. Power VOL (volume) dial
5.
Seek/track (rewind) button
13. RPT (repeat) button
6.
Seek/track (fast forward) button
14. Station memory buttons
7.
SETUP button
15. A-Z button
8.
Back button
16. ENTER button/MENU knob
The audio unit is equipped with a speed volume.
This means that the audio system automatically adjusts the volume level in relation to vehicle
speed.
SETUP button:
This item is available only when the audio system is turned on.
To configure Audio, Clock, Radio or Language,
perform the following procedure.
1.
Push the
2.
Turn the MENU knob clockwise or counterclockwise, the display will appear in the
following order.
button.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 31
4-31
2021/01/13 01:16:55 PM
Audio
3.
Clock
Radio
Language
Push the ENTER button to select the item.
Audio setting:
Push the
button and then select “Audio”.
Turn the MENU knob, and the mode will change
as follows.
Sound
Default
AUX In
Speed Volume
Audio
Push the ENTER button to select the setting you
want to change. Turn the MENU knob to adjust
the selected item.
Sound:
Adjust Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade. Turn the
MENU knob and then push the ENTER button to
select the setting item. Turn the MENU knob to
adjust the setting.
y
Bass:
Enhances or attenuates the bass response
sound.
y
Treble:
Enhances or attenuates the treble.
y
Balance:
Adjusts the balance of the volume between
the left and right speakers.
y
Fade:
Adjusts the balance of the volume between
the front and rear (if equipped) speakers.
AUX In:
Adjusts the volume output from the auxiliary
source.
Speed Vol.:
Set the audio system to automatically adjust
4-32
the volume level in relation to vehicle speed.
follows.
Turn the MENU knob counterclockwise or clockwise to adjust the volume, higher (more) bars
mean the volume level relatively changes more
when the vehicle speed increase or decrease.
Push the ENTER button to confirm.
The hour display will start flashing. Turn the
MENU knob to adjust the hour and push the
ENTER button. The minute display will start
flashing. Turn the MENU knob to adjust the
minute and push the ENTER button to finish the
clock adjustment.
This mode controls the volume output from the
speakers automatically in relation to vehicle
speed. When “Speed Volume” is displayed, turn
the MENU knob clockwise or counterclockwise
to adjust the volume level.
Adjusting the setting to 0 (zero) turns off the
speed volume feature. Increasing the speed
volume setting results in the audio volume increasing more rapidly with vehicle speed. Once
chosen, press Enter button to save the setting.
Audio Default menu:
The audio unit has a saved preset settings
as a factory default. Select “Yes” to change all
settings back to the factory preset settings.
Select “No” to exit the menu keeping the current
settings.
After the desired settings have been set, push
either the
button or the
button continuously, and wait for 10 seconds without pushing
any other buttons to exit the menu screen.
Clock setting:
Push the
button to enter the setup menu
screen and then select “Clock”.
Turn the MENU knob, and the mode will change
as follows.
Set Time
ON/OFF
Format
Set Time:
Select “Set Time” and then adjust the clock as
ON/OFF:
Set the clock display between on or off when
the audio unit is turned off. If the clock display
setting is turned on, the clock will be displayed
when the audio unit is turned off either by
pushing the power button or when the ignition
switch is placed in the “OFF” position.
Format:
Switch the clock display between 24-hour
mode and 12-hour clock mode.
Radio setting:
Push the
button to enter the setup menu
screen and then select “Radio”.
This function is used to select the FM frequency
band.
Language setting:
Push the
button to enter the setup menu
screen and then select “Language”.
Select the appropriate language and push the
ENTER button. Upon completion, the screen will
automatically adapt the language setting.
Day/Night button:
Push the Day/Night button to switch the display
brightness between the daytime and nighttime
modes.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 32
2021/01/13 01:16:55 PM
MUTE button:
Push the MUTE button to mute the audio system. Push again to restored the sound.
MEDIA button:
Push the MEDIA button to play a compatible
device when it is connected.
Each time the MEDIA button is pushed, the
audio source will change as follows.
CD g USB/IPod g AUX g CD
A source that is not available will be skipped.
Radio operation
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
RADIO button:
When the
button is pushed while another
audio source is playing, the other audio source
will turn off and the radio will turn on.
To change the radio band (FM1, FM2, or AM),
push the
button.
Seek/track buttons:
When adjusting the broadcasting station frequency manually, push the
or
button
until the desired frequency is achieved. When
adjusting the broadcasting station frequency
automatically, push and hold the
or
button. When the system detects a broadcasting station, it will stop at the station.
(Radio memory) buttons:
During radio reception, pushing the radio memory button will select the stored radio station.
The audio system can store up to 12 FM station
frequencies (6 in each of FM 1, FM 2) and 6 AM
station frequencies.
To store the station frequency manually:
1.
Tune to the desired broadcasting station
frequency by using the
buttons.
2.
Push and hold a radio memory button
until a beep sounds.
3.
The channel indicator will display, indicating
that the memory is stored properly.
4.
Perform steps 1 - 3 for all other memory
buttons.
-
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the audio fuse blows, the radio memory will be erased.
In such a case, reset the desired stations.
CD player operation
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
Loading:
Insert a CD into the slot with the label side facing up. The CD will be guided automatically into
the slot and will start playing. After loading the
CD, the number of tracks and the play time will
appear on the display.
CAUTION:
Do not force the CD into the slot. This could
damage the player.
NOTE:
y
The CD player accepts normal audio CDs
or CDs containing MP3/WMA/AAC files.
y
An error notification message will be
displayed when inserting an incompatible
disc type (e.g., DVD), or if the player cannot read the CD. Eject the disc and insert
another disc.
MEDIA button
To change to the CD mode, push the
button with a CD inserted until the CD mode is
selected.
List view:
While the track is being played, push the ENTER
button to display the available tracks in a listed
view mode. To select a track from the list, turn
the MENU knob and then push the ENTER button.
Quick search:
In the list view mode, a quick search can be performed to find a track from the list. Push the A-Z
button, turn the MENU knob to the first alphabetic letter of the song title, and then push the
ENTER button. When found, a list of the available
songs will be displayed. Select, and push the
ENTER button to play the preferred track.
Seek/track buttons
Push and hold the
or
button to fast
forward or rewind through the track. When the
button is released, the track will play at normal
playing speed.
Track up/down:
By pushing the
or
button once, the
track will skip forward to the next track or backward to the beginning of the current track. Push
the
or
button more than once to skip
through the tracks.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 33
4-33
2021/01/13 01:16:55 PM
Folder browsing:
If the recorded media contains folders with
music files, pushing the
or
button will
play the tracks of each folder in sequence.
When the
button is pushed repeatedly
while a CD with MP3/WMA is playing, further
information about the track can be displayed
along with the track title as follows.
To select a preferred folder:
Track time g Artist g Album g Track time
1.
Track details:
Push the ENTER button or the
button,
and a list of tracks in the current folder is
displayed.
2.
Push the
button.
3.
Turn the MENU knob for the preferred folder.
4.
Push the ENTER button to access the folder.
Push the ENTER button again to start
playing the first track or turn the MENU
knob, and push the ENTER button to select
another track.
If the current selected folder contains sub folders, push the ENTER button, and a new screen
with a list of sub folders will be displayed. Turn
the MENU knob for the sub folder and then push
the ENTER button to select. Select the root folder item when songs are recorded additionally in
the root folder.
To return to the previous folder screen, push the
button.
RPT button:
Push the
button and the current track will
be played continuously.
MIX button:
Push the
button and all the tracks will be
played in a random order.
DISP button:
While a CD with title information is being played,
the title of the played track is displayed.
4-34
Pushing and holding the
button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. Push the
button to return to the display for the main
display mode.
CD eject button:
When the
button is pushed while a CD is
loaded, the CD will be ejected.
When the ignition switch is placed in the “OFF”
or “LOCK” position it is possible to eject the CD
currently being played. However the audio unit
will not be activated.
If a CD is ejected by pushing the
button,
and it is not taken out from the loading slot
within 20 seconds, the CD will automatically be
reloaded to the slot in order to protect the CD.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
Connect a USB memory device into the connection port. The system will switch to the USB
memory device mode automatically.
If the system has been turned off while the USB
memory device was playing, pushing the power
button will start the USB memory device.
The following operations are identical to the
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
operation. For details, see "CD player operation"
(P.4-33).
y List view
y Quick search
y
(Seek/track)
y MIX (Random play)
y RPT (Repeat track)
y Folder browsing
MEDIA button:
To change to the USB mode, push the
button with a USB connected until the USB mode
is selected.
DISP button:
While a track with recorded music information
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
played track is displayed. If the tags are not provided then a notification message is displayed.
When the
button is pushed continuously,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows.
Track time g Artist g Album g Track time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the
button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. Push the
button to return to the display for the main
display mode.
iPod player operation
Connecting iPod:
Connect the iPod to the USB connection port
using the USB cable that came with your iPod.
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 34
2021/01/13 01:16:56 PM
When the iPod is connected to the vehicle, the
iPod music library can only be operated by the
vehicle audio controls.
y
y
* iPod and iPhone are a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
y
WARNING:
Do not connect, disconnect or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be a
distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident or
serious injury.
CAUTION:
y
y
Do not force the USB device into the USB
connection port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the USB
device is connected correctly into the
USB connection port. (Some USB devices
come with a
mark as a guide. Make
sure that the mark is facing the correct
direction before inserting the device.)
Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
of the device.
Compatibility:
The system unit shall be compatible with all
devices (past and future) supporting Apple
Accessory Protocol on USB link.
It includes (and not limited to):
y iPod Generation 5 devices
y iPod Classic I and II (Generation 6 and 7)
iTouch Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next
iPhone Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and nextiPod
Nano (1G, 2G, 3G)
iPad 1, 2 and 3
NOTE:
This audio system does not support iPad
charging.
MEDIA button:
To operate the iPod, push the
button
repeatedly until the USB/iPod mode is selected
and then push the ENTER button.
iPod main operation:
Interface:
The interface for iPod operation shown on
the audio system display is similar to the iPod
interface. Use the ENTER button or MENU knob
to play a track on the iPod.
The following items can be chosen from the
menu list screen.
y Playlists
y Artist
y Albums
y Tracks
y More
For further information about each item, see
the iPod owner’s manual.
The following operations are identical to the
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
operation. For details, see "CD player operation"
(P.4-33).
y List view
y Quick search
y
(Seek/track)
y MIX (Random play)
y
y
RPT (Repeat track)
Folder browsing
DISP button:
While a track with recorded music information
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
played track is displayed.
When the
button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
Track time g Artist g Album g Track time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the
button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. To return to
the main display, push the
button.
Auxiliary input jack
The AUX input jack is located on the lower part
of the instrument panel. See "AUX (auxiliary)
input jack" (P.4-55). The AUX input jack accepts
any standard analog audio input such as from a
portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or
laptop computer.
Push the
button to play a compatible device when it is plugged into the AUX input jack.
NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
mini plug cable when connecting your music
device to the audio system. Music may not play
properly when a monaural cable is used.
WARNING:
Do not allow the cable or an external device
connected to the AUX terminal to affect your
driving.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 35
4-35
2021/01/13 01:16:56 PM
NOTE:
y
Depending on the external device, please
note that the volume may be louder or
quieter than that of the external device.
y
When the AUX contacts the plug of the
connector cable, noise may be heard.
y
The connected external device cannot
be operated with the main audio system.
The volume and sound quality can be
adjusted.
y
The song title in the external device cannot be displayed on the audio display.
y
For the power source of the external device, use the special battery. The external
device cannot be charged with the AUX
terminal. Noise may be heard if the CD,
radio etc. is operated while charging the
battery with the power socket of the
vehicle.
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (TYPE B)
JVH1078X
4-36
1.
DISP (Display) button
9.
CD eject button
2.
RADIO button
10. MEDIA button
3.
Day/Night button
11. Phone button
4.
MIX button
12. Power/VOL (Volume) dial
5.
Seek/track (rewind) button
13. RPT (repeat) button
6.
Seek/track (fast forward) button
14. Station memory buttons
7.
SETUP button
15. A-Z button
8.
Back button
16. MENU/ENTER dial
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 36
2021/01/13 01:16:56 PM
Anti-theft system (if equipped)
enter the correct radio code.
Use of a 4-digit radio PIN (Personal Identification
Number) code, known only to the vehicle owner,
effectively reduces the possibility of the audio
unit being stolen. Without the PIN code the
audio unit cannot be activated.
y
If the wrong code is entered after the
third attempt, the audio unit will lock for
60 minutes. The display will show a count
down timer from 60 to 0 (minutes). After 60
minutes enter the correct radio code.
If force is used to try and remove the audio unit,
the Anti-theft system activates and the audio
unit is locked. The only way to unlock the audio
unit is to enter the radio code number shown
on an identification card supplied with the vehicle documentation.
y
If the wrong code is entered after eight
sets of three entries, the audio unit will lock
permanently. Contact a NISSAN dealer for
further details.
NOTE:
y
The 4 digit radio code is shown on a card
that you received with your vehicle documentation.
y
Contact a NISSAN dealer if you do lose the
4 digit radio code of the audio unit.
JVI0832X
When the power is restored and the unit
switched on, the display will show “Radio Code”
and it will be unlocked when the codes have
been entered correctly.
Unlocking procedure:
Read this section very carefully. It is important
that the instructions are followed precisely.
To unlock the audio unit, proceed as follows:
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
Place the ignition switch in the “ACC” or “ON”
position.
2.
“Radio Code” is displayed along with four
numerical zero digits.
3.
Push preset
the number of times corresponding with the first digit of the radio
code.
Power ON/OFF:
For example, if the radio code is 5169: for the
first digit, “5”, push the preset five times.
The system will turn on in the mode, which
was used immediately before the system was
turned off.
Unlocking the unit:
If the battery supply to the vehicle is interrupted, the audio unit will lock.
Audio main operation
1.
4.
The second, third, and fourth digits of the
radio code must be entered in the same
way, only now using preset , , and .
For example, push
nine times.
once,
six times, and
5.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial to confirm the
code. If you entered the code correctly the
unit will switch on.
6.
If the code is entered incorrectly a notification message “Incorrect Pin”, “Please
re-enter Pin” and the number of attempts
left [Remaining Tries: xx] will be shown.
After reading the message, push the MENU/
ENTER dial to return to the entry screen and
Power/VOL dial:
To turn on the audio system, push the Power/
VOL dial.
To turn off the audio system, push the Power/
VOL dial.
Volume control:
To control the volume, turn the Power/VOL dial.
Turn the Power/VOL dial clockwise to make the
sound louder.
Turn the Power/VOL dial counterclockwise to
make the sound quieter.
SETUP button:
To configure Audio, Clock, Radio, or Language
settings, perform the following procedure:
1.
Push the SETUP button.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 37
4-37
2021/01/13 01:16:56 PM
2.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the display will
appear in the following order:
Audio g Clock g Radio g Language
3.
from the auxiliary source.
y
Push the MENU/ENTER dial.
Adjusting the setting to 0 (zero) turns off
the speed volume feature.
y
Turn on or off the Bass Boost feature which
emphasizes the lower audio frequencies.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Audio is
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
Each time the MENU/ENTER dial is pushed, the
mode will change as follows:
y
y
Sound:
Bass:
Use this control to enhance or attenuate
bass response sound.
Treble:
Use this control to enhance or attenuate
the treble.
Bal. (Balance):
Use this control to adjust the balance of the
volume between the left and right speakers.
Fade:
Use this control to adjust the balance of
the volume between the front and the rear
speakers.
y
AUX In:
Audio Default:
The audio unit has a saved preset settings
as a factory default. Select “Yes” to change
all settings back to the factory preset settings. Select “No” to exit the menu keeping
the current settings.
Sound g AUX In g Speed Vol. g Bass Boost g
Audio Default
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial clockwise or counterclockwise to adjust the following items and
push MENU/ENTER dial to confirm.
Bass Boost:
Clock setting:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Clock is
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the mode will
change as follows:
Set Time g ON/OFF g Format
y
Set Time
Select “Set Time” then adjust the clock as
follows:
The hour display will start flashing. Turn the
MENU/ENTER dial to adjust the hour and
push the MENU/ENTER dial. The minute
display will start flashing. Turn the MENU/
ENTER dial to adjust the minute and push
the MENU/ENTER dial to finish the clock
adjustment.
ON/OFF
The clock display can be turned on and off.
When “ON” is selected, the clock will be displayed. (The clock will keep being displayed
even after the power of the audio unit is
turned off). When “OFF” is selected, the clock
will not be displayed.
This mode controls the volume output from
the speakers automatically in relation to
vehicle speed.
After the desired levels have been set, push
the Back button repeatedly or push the SETUP
button.
Audio adjustments:
y
Speed Vol. (Volume) :
y
Format
Switch the clock display between 24-hour
mode and 12-hour clock mode.
Radio setting:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Radio is
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
The FM station which can be received will be
updated.
Language setting:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Language
is displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
Select the appropriate language and push the
MENU/ENTER dial. Upon completion, the screen
will automatically adapt the language setting.
Day/Night button:
Push the Day/Night button to switch the display
brightness between the daytime and nighttime
modes.
The switches on the audio unit will also illuminate in the nighttime mode.
Phone button:
For operation on how to use phone button, see
"Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System (Type
A)" (P.4-59).
Use this control to adjust the volume output
4-38
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 38
2021/01/13 01:16:56 PM
MEDIA button:
Push the MEDIA button to play a compatible
device when it is connected.
Each time the MEDIA button is pushed, the
audio source will change.
Radio operation
Frequency range and step change:
To change the frequency range and step
specification of the radio, perform the following
operations.
1.
Turn on the audio system.
2.
Push the RADIO button and select AM or FM
mode.
3.
Push and hold the SETUP button for more
than 3 seconds.
4.
After the 3 seconds, keep holding the SETUP button and turn the MENU/ENTER dial
counterclockwise until you hear 3 clicks,
clockwise until you hear 3 clicks, and then
counterclockwise until you hear 3 clicks.
5.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until “Region”
is highlighted, and push the MENU/ENTER
dial.
6.
Select an appropriate region from the following options:
y EUR
y GOM Pacific
y GOM S. America
7.
To apply the setting, turn off the audio system, place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position, and then place the ignition switch
back in the “ON” position.
frequency by using the Seek/track buttons.
RADIO button:
When the RADIO button is pushed while the
audio system is off, the audio system will turn
on and the radio will turn on.
When the RADIO button is pushed while another
audio source is playing, the other audio source
will turn off and the radio will turn on.
To change the radio bands, push the RADIO
button until the desired band appears.
FM 1 g FM 2 g AM g FM 1
When the RADIO button is pushed for more than
1.5 seconds, the six stations with the strongest
signals are stored in the preset (1 to 6) buttons
of the band. During the search, a notification
message appears on the display and the sound
is muted until the operation is complete. Once
completed, the radio selects preset button.
Seek/track buttons:
Push
or
button briefly to manually
change the frequency.
To adjust the broadcasting station frequency
automatically, push and hold the
or
button. When the system detects a broadcasting station, it will stop at the station.
Station memory buttons:
During radio reception, pushing the station
memory button for less than 2 seconds will
select the stored radio station.
The audio system can store up to 12 FM station
frequencies (6 in each of FM 1 and FM 2 ) and 6
AM station frequencies.
2.
Push and hold a station memory button
until a beep sounds.
3.
The channel indicator will display, indicating
that the memory is stored properly.
4.
Perform steps 1 - 3 for all other memory
buttons.
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the
audio fuse blows, the station memory will be
erased. In such a case, reset the desired stations.
Radio Data System (RDS) operation (if
equipped):
The RDS is a system through which encoded
digital information is transmitted by FM radio
stations in addition to the normal FM radio
broadcasting. The RDS provides information
services such as station name, traffic information, or news.
NOTE:
In some countries or regions, some of these
services may not be available.
Alternative Frequency (AF) mode
The AF mode operates in the FM (radio) mode.
The AF function compares signal strengths and
selects the station with the optimum reception
conditions for the currently tuned-in station.
RDS functions
When an RDS station is tuned in with seek or
manual tuning, the RDS data is received and the
Programme Service (PS) name is displayed.
To store the station frequency manually:
1.
Tune to the desired broadcasting station
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 39
4-39
2021/01/13 01:16:57 PM
CD player operation
Loading:
Insert a CD into the slot with the label side facing up. The CD will be guided automatically into
the slot and will start playing. After loading the
CD, the number of tracks and the playtime will
appear on the display.
CAUTION:
Do not force the CD into the slot. This could
damage the player.
NOTE:
y
The CD player accepts normal audio CDs
or CDs containing MP3/WMA/AAC files.
y
An error notification message will be
displayed when inserting an incompatible
disc type (e.g. DVD), or if the player cannot
read the CD. Eject the disc and insert another disc.
MEDIA button:
To change to the CD mode, push the MEDIA
button with a CD inserted until the CD mode is
selected.
List view:
While the track is being played, push the MENU/
ENTER dial to display the available tracks in a
listed view mode. To select a track from the list,
turn the MENU/ENTER dial then push MENU/
ENTER dial.
Quick search:
In the list view mode, a quick search can be
performed to find a track from the list. Push the
A-Z button, turn the MENU/ENTER dial to the
4-40
first alphabetic letter of the song title and then
push the MENU/ENTER dial. When found, a list of
the available songs will be displayed. Select, and
push the MENU/ENTER dial to play the preferred
track.
Seek/track buttons:
Push and hold the
or
button to fast
forward or rewind through the track. When the
button is released, the track will play at normal
playing speed.
Track up/down:
Pushing the
or
button once, the track
will skip forward to the next track or backward
to the beginning of the current track. Push
the
or
button more than once to skip
through the tracks.
Folder browsing:
If the recorded media contains folders with
music files, pushing the Seek/track button will
play in sequence the tracks of each folder.
To select a preferred folder:
1.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial or the Back button and a list of tracks in the current folder
is displayed.
2.
Push the Back button.
3.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial for the preferred
folder.
4.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial to access the
folder. Push the MENU/ENTER dial again
to start playing the first track or turn the
MENU/ENTER dial, and push the MENU/
ENTER dial to select another track.
If the current selected folder contains sub folders, push the MENU/ENTER dial, a new screen
with a list of sub folders will be displayed. Turn
the MENU/ENTER dial for the sub folder then
push the MENU/ENTER dial to select. Select
the root folder item when songs are recorded
additionally in the root folder.
To return to the previous folder screen, push the
Back button.
RPT button:
Push the RPT button and the current track will
be played continuously.
MIX button:
Push the MIX button and all the tracks will be
played in a random order.
DISP button:
While a CD with recorded music information
tags (CD-text/ID3-text tags) is being played,
the title of the played track is displayed when
available.
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
Track time g Artist name g Album title g Track
time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. Push the
Back button to return to the previous screen.
CD eject button:
When the CD eject button is pushed while the
ignition switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC”
position, the CD will be ejected.
If a CD is ejected by pushing the CD eject button,
and it is not taken out from the loading slot
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 40
2021/01/13 01:16:57 PM
within 20 seconds, the CD will automatically be
reloaded to the slot to protect the CD.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port
USB device main operation:
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
Connect a USB memory device into the connection port. The USB memory device will be
activated automatically.
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
of the device.
If the system has been turned off while the USB
memory device was playing, pushing the Power/VOL dial will start the USB memory device.
The following operations are identical to the
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
operation. For details, see "CD player operation"
(P.4-40).
y List view
y Quick search
y
(Seek/track)
y MIX (Random play)
y RPT (Repeat track)
y Folder browsing
MEDIA button:
To operate the USB memory device, push the
MEDIA button repeatedly until the USB mode is
selected.
DISP button:
While a track with recorded music information
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
played track is displayed.
NOTE:
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
This audio system do not support iPad
charging.
Track time g Artist g Album g Track time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. Push the
Back button to return to the display for the
main display mode.
iPod player operation
Connecting iPod:
Connect the iPod to the USB connection port
using the USB cable that came with your iPod.
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
When the iPod is connected to the vehicle, the
iPod music library can only be operated by the
vehicle audio controls.
* iPod and iPhone are a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Compatibility:
The system unit shall be compatible with all
devices (past and future) supporting Apple
Accessory Protocol on USB link.
It includes (and not limited to):
y iPod Generation 5 devices
y iPod Classic I and II (Generation 6 and 7)
y iTouch Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next
y iPhone Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next
y iPod Nano (1G, 2G, 3G)
y iPad 1, 2 and 3
MEDIA button:
To operate the iPod, push the MEDIA button
repeatedly until the USB (iPod) mode is selected
and then push the MENU/ENTER dial.
iPod main operation:
Interface:
The interface for iPod operation shown on the
audio system display is similar to the iPod interface. Use the MENU/ENTER dial to play a track
on the iPod.
The following items can be chosen from the
menu list screen.
y Playlists
y Artists
y Albums
y Tracks
y More
For further information about each item, see
the iPod owner’s manual.
The following operations are identical to the
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
operation. For details, see"CD player operation"
(P.4-40).
y
y
y
y
y
y
List view
Quick search
(Seek/track)
MIX (Random play)
RPT (Repeat track)
Folder browsing
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 41
4-41
2021/01/13 01:16:57 PM
Bluetooth® audio player main operation:
DISP button:
While a track with recorded music information
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
played track is displayed.
DISP button:
If the song contains music information tags
(ID3– tags), the title of the played song will be
displayed. If tags are not provided then the
display will not show any messages.
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly
further information about the song can be
displayed along with the song title.
Track time g Artist g Album g Track time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. To return to
the main display, push the Back button.
Bluetooth® audio player operation
Regulatory information:
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc., and licensed to Visteon
Corporation and Panasonic
Corporation.
CE statement:
Hereby Visteon Corp. declares that this system
is in compliance with the essential requirements
and other relevant provisions of Directive
1999/5/EC.
NOTE:
The audio system only supports Bluetooth®
devices with AVRCP (Audio Video Remote
Control Profile) version 1.3, or 1.0 or earlier.
4-42
through the tracks.
JVH0848X
To play Bluetooth® audio, the Bluetooth® audio
device needs to be paired to the in-vehicle
system. For the pairing operation, see "Pairing
device" (P.4-60).
MEDIA button:
To operate the Bluetooth® audio streaming use
the following method:
Push MEDIA button repeatedly until “BT Audio”
is shown.
The type of display, or , shown on the audio
system can vary depending on the Bluetooth®
version of the device.
Seek/track buttons:
Push and hold the
or
button to fast
forward or rewind through the track. When the
button is released, the track will play at normal
playing speed.
A long push on DISP button will turn the display
into a detailed overview which after a few seconds returns to the main display; or push DISP
button briefly.
AUX device player operation
The AUX jack is located on lower part of the
instrument panel. See "AUX (auxiliary) input
jack" (P.4-55). The AUX input jack accepts any
standard analog audio input such as from a
portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or
laptop computer.
NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
mini plug cable when connecting your music
device to the audio system. Music may not play
properly when a monaural cable is used.
MEDIA button:
To switch to the AUX mode, push the MEDIA button repeatedly until the AUX mode is selected.
Track up/down:
Pushing the
or
button once, the track
will skip forward to the next track or backward
to the beginning of the current track. Push
the
or
button more than once to skip
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 42
2021/01/13 01:16:57 PM
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (TYPE C)
Anti-theft system (if equipped)
Use of a 4-digit radio PIN (Personal Identification
Number) code, known only to the vehicle owner,
effectively reduces the possibility of the audio
unit being stolen. Without the PIN code the
audio unit cannot be activated.
If force is used to try and remove the audio unit,
the Anti-theft system activates and the audio
unit is locked. The only way to unlock the audio
unit is to enter the radio code number shown
on an identification card supplied with the vehicle documentation.
NOTE:
y
The 4 digit radio code is shown on a card
that you received with your vehicle documentation.
y
Contact a NISSAN dealer if you do lose the
4 digit radio code of the audio unit.
Unlocking the unit:
If the battery supply to the vehicle is interrupted, the audio unit will lock.
JVH1079X
1.
AM button
9.
CD eject button
2.
FM button
10. MEDIA button
3.
Day/Night button
11. DISP (Display) button
4.
Seek/track (rewind) button
12. Power/VOL (Volume) dial
5.
Seek/track (fast forward) button
13. Station memory buttons
6.
RPT (repeat) ·MIX button
14. A-Z button
7.
SETUP button
15. MENU/ENTER dial
8.
Back button
When the power is restored and the unit
switched on, the display will show “Radio Code”
and it will be unlocked when the codes have
been entered correctly.
Unlocking procedure:
Read this section very carefully. It is important
that the instructions are followed precisely.
To unlock the audio unit, proceed as follows:
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 43
4-43
2021/01/13 01:16:58 PM
After reading the message, push the MENU/
ENTER dial to return to the entry screen and
enter the correct radio code.
y
y
JVH0832X
If the wrong code is entered after the
third attempt, the audio unit will lock for
60 minutes. The display will show a count
down timer from 60 to 0 (minutes). After 60
minutes enter the correct radio code.
If the wrong code is entered after eight
sets of three entries, the audio unit will lock
permanently. Contact a NISSAN dealer for
further details.
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “ACC” or “ON”
position.
Audio main operation
2.
“Radio Code” is displayed along with four
numerical zero digits.
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
3.
Push preset
the number of times corresponding with the first digit of the radio
code.
Power ON/OFF:
4.
For example, if the radio code is 5169: for the
first digit, “5”, push the preset five times.
To turn on the audio system, push the Power/
VOL dial.
The second, third, and fourth digits of the
radio code must be entered in the same
way, only now using preset , , and .
The system will turn on in the mode, which
was used immediately before the system was
turned off.
For example, push
nine times.
To turn off the audio system, push the Power/
VOL dial.
5.
6.
once,
six times, and
Push the MENU/ENTER dial to confirm the
code. If you entered the code correctly the
unit will switch on.
If the code is entered incorrectly a notification message “Incorrect Pin”, “Please
re-enter Pin” and the number of attempts
left [Remaining Tries: xx] will be shown.
4-44
Power/VOL dial:
Volume control:
To control the volume, turn the Power/VOL dial.
Turn the Power/VOL dial clockwise to make the
sound louder.
Turn the Power/VOL dial counterclockwise to
make the sound quieter.
SETUP button:
To configure Audio, Clock, Radio, or Language
settings, perform the following procedure:
1.
Push the SETUP button.
2.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the display will
appear in the following order:
Audio g Clock g Radio g Language
3.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial.
After the desired levels have been set, push
the Back button repeatedly or push the SETUP
button.
Audio adjustments:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Audio is
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
Each time the MENU/ENTER dial is pushed, the
mode will change as follows:
Sound g AUX In g Speed Vol. g Bass Boost g
Audio Default
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial clockwise or counterclockwise to adjust the following items and
push MENU/ENTER dial to confirm.
y
Sound menu
Bass:
Use this control to enhance or attenuate
bass response sound.
Treble:
Use this control to enhance or attenuate
the treble.
Bal. (Balance):
Use this control to adjust the balance of the
volume between the left and right speakers.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 44
2021/01/13 01:16:58 PM
Fade:
Use this control to adjust the balance of
the volume between the front and the rear
speakers.
y
AUX In menu
display will start flashing. Turn the MENU/
ENTER dial to adjust the minute and push
the MENU/ENTER dial to finish the clock
adjustment.
y
Use this control to adjust the volume output
from the auxiliary source.
y
Speed Vol. (Volume) menu
This mode controls the volume output from
the speakers automatically in relation to
vehicle speed.
Adjusting the setting to 0 (zero) turns off
the speed volume feature.
y
Bass Boost menu
Turn on or off the Bass Boost feature which
emphasizes the lower audio frequencies.
y
Audio Default menu
The audio unit has a saved preset settings
as a factory default. Select “Yes” to change
all settings back to the factory preset settings. Select “No” to exit the menu keeping
the current settings.
Clock setting:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Clock is
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial. Turn
the MENU/ENTER dial, the mode will change as
follows:
Set Time g ON/OFF g Format
y
Set Time
Select “Set Time” then adjust the clock as
follows:
The hour display will start flashing. Turn the
MENU/ENTER dial to adjust the hour and
push the MENU/ENTER dial. The minute
y
ON/OFF
The clock display can be turned on and off.
When “ON” is selected, the clock will be displayed. (The clock will keep being displayed
even after the power of the audio unit is
turned off). When “OFF” is selected, the clock
will not be displayed.
Format
Switch the clock display between 24-hour
mode and 12-hour clock mode.
Radio setting:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Radio is displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial. The FM
station which can be received will be updated.
MEDIA button:
Push the MEDIA button to play a compatible
device when it is connected.
Each time the MEDIA button is pushed, the
audio source will change.
Radio operation
Frequency range and step change:
To change the frequency range and step
specification of the radio, perform the following
operations.
1.
Turn on the audio system.
2.
Push the FM or the AM button and select
AM or FM mode.
3.
Push and hold the SETUP button for more
than 3 seconds.
4.
After the 3 seconds, keep holding the SETUP button and turn the MENU/ENTER dial
counterclockwise until you hear 3 clicks,
clockwise until you hear 3 clicks, and then
counterclockwise until you hear 3 clicks.
5.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until “Region”
is highlighted, and push the MENU/ENTER
dial.
6.
Select an appropriate region from the following options:
Language setting:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Language
is displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
Select the appropriate language and push the
MENU/ENTER dial. Upon completion, the screen
will automatically adapt the language setting.
Day/Night button:
Push the Day/Night button to switch the display
brightness between the daytime and nighttime
modes.
y
EUR
The switches on the audio unit will illuminate in
the nighttime mode.
y
GOM Pacific
y
GOM S. America
7.
To apply the setting, turn off the audio system, place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position, and then place the ignition switch
back in the “ON” position.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 45
4-45
2021/01/13 01:16:58 PM
AM/FM buttons:
To store the station frequency manually:
1.
Tune to the desired broadcasting station
frequency by using the Seek/track buttons.
2.
When the AM or the FM button is pushed while
another audio source is playing, the other audio
source will turn off and the radio will turn on.
Push and hold a station memory button
until a beep sounds. (The radio mutes
when the memory button is pushed.)
3.
To change the radio bands, push the FM button
until the desired band appears.
The channel indicator will display, indicating
that the memory is stored properly.
4.
Perform steps 1 - 3 for all other memory
buttons.
When the AM or the FM button is pushed while
the audio system is off, the audio system will
turn on and the radio will turn on.
FM 1 g FM 2 g FM 1
When the AM or the FM button is pushed for
more than 1.5 seconds, the six stations with
the strongest signals are stored in the preset
(1 to 6) buttons of the band. During the search,
a notification message appears on the display
and the sound is muted until the operation is
complete. Once completed, the radio selects
preset button.
Seek/track buttons:
Push
or
button briefly to manually
change the frequency.
To adjust the broadcasting station frequency
automatically, push and hold the
or
button. When the system detects a broadcasting station, it will stop at the station.
Station memory buttons:
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the
audio fuse blows, the station memory will be
erased. In such a case, reset the desired stations.
Radio Data System (RDS) operation (if
equipped):
The RDS is a system through which encoded
digital information is transmitted by FM radio
stations in addition to the normal FM radio
broadcasting. The RDS provides information
services such as station name, traffic information, or news.
NOTE:
In some countries or regions, some of these
services may not be available.
Alternative Frequency (AF) mode
The AF mode operates in the FM (radio) mode.
During radio reception, pushing the station
memory button for less than 2 seconds will
select the stored radio station.
The AF function compares signal strengths and
selects the station with the optimum reception
conditions for the currently tuned-in station.
The audio system can store up to 12 FM station
frequencies (6 in each of FM 1 and FM 2 ) and 6
AM station frequencies.
RDS functions
4-46
When an RDS station is tuned in with seek or
manual tuning, the RDS data is received and the
Programme Service (PS) name is displayed.
CD player operation
Loading:
Insert a CD into the slot with the label side facing up. The CD will be guided automatically into
the slot and will start playing. After loading the
CD, the number of tracks and the playtime will
appear on the display.
CAUTION:
Do not force the CD into the slot. This could
damage the player.
NOTE:
y
The CD player accepts normal audio CDs
or CDs containing MP3/WMA files.
y
The audio unit will automatically detect if
a CD containing MP3/WMA files is inserted, and “MP3CD” will be indicated.
y
An error notification message will be
displayed when inserting an incompatible
disc type (e.g. DVD), or if the player cannot
read the CD. Eject the disc and insert another disc.
MEDIA button:
To change to the CD mode, push the MEDIA
button with a CD inserted until the CD mode is
selected.
List view:
While the track is being played, push the MENU/
ENTER dial to display the available tracks in a
listed view mode. To select a track from the list,
turn the MENU/ENTER dial then push MENU/
ENTER dial.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 46
2021/01/13 01:16:58 PM
MENU/ENTER dial, and push the MENU/
ENTER dial to select another track.
Quick search:
In the list view mode, a quick search can be
performed to find a track from the list. Push the
A-Z button, turn the MENU/ENTER dial to the
first alphabetic letter of the song title and then
push the MENU/ENTER dial. When found, a list of
the available songs will be displayed. Select, and
push the MENU/ENTER dial to play the preferred
track.
Seek/track buttons:
Push and hold the
or
button to fast
forward or rewind through the track. When the
button is released, the track will play at normal
playing speed.
Track up/down:
Pushing the
or
button once, the track
will skip forward to the next track or backward
to the beginning of the current track. Push
the
or
button more than once to skip
through the tracks.
Folder browsing:
If the recorded media contains folders with
music files, pushing the
or
button will
play in sequence the tracks of each folder.
To select a preferred folder:
If the current selected folder contains sub folders, push the MENU/ENTER dial, a new screen
with a list of sub folders will be displayed. Turn
the MENU/ENTER dial for the sub folder then
push the MENU/ENTER dial to select. Select
the root folder item when songs are recorded
additionally in the root folder.
To return to the previous folder screen, push the
Back button.
RPT·MIX button:
When the RPT·MIX button is pushed while a CD
is playing, the play mode will change as follows:
CD:
DISC REPEAT g TRACK REPEAT g DISC RANDOM
g DISC REPEAT
CD with MP3/WMA:
DISC REPEAT g FOLDER REPEAT g TRACK REPEAT g DISC RANDOM g FOLDER RANDOM g
DISC REPEAT
DISC REPEAT:
All the tracks on the selected CD will play repeatedly in sequential order.
FOLDER REPEAT (CD with MP3 or WMA only):
1.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial or the Back button and a list of tracks in the current folder
is displayed.
2.
Push the Back button.
TRACK REPEAT:
3.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial for the preferred
folder.
The selected track will play repeatedly.
DISC RANDOM:
4.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial to access the
folder. Push the MENU/ENTER dial again
to start playing the first track or turn the
All the tracks on the selected CD will play in
random order.
All the tracks in the selected folder will play
repeatedly in sequential order.
FOLDER RANDOM (CD with MP3 or WMA only):
All the tracks in the selected folder will play
repeatedly in random order.
DISP button
While a CD with recorded music information
tags (CD-text/ID3-text tags) is being played,
the title of the played track is displayed when
available.
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
Track time g Artist name g Album title g Track
time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. Push the
Back button to return to the previous screen.
CD eject button:
When the CD eject button is pushed while the
ignition switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC”
position, the CD will be ejected.
If a CD is ejected by pushing the CD eject button,
and it is not taken out from the loading slot
within 20 seconds, the CD will automatically be
reloaded to the slot to protect the CD.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port
USB device main operation:
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
Connect a USB memory device into the connection port.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 47
4-47
2021/01/13 01:16:59 PM
The USB memory device will be activated automatically.
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
of the device.
If the system has been turned off while the USB
memory device was playing, pushing the Power/VOL dial will start the USB memory device.
The following operations are identical to the
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
operation. For details, see "CD player operation"
(P.4-46).
y
y
y
y
y
y
List view
Quick search
(Seek/track)
MIX (Random play)
RPT (Repeat track)
Folder browsing
MEDIA button:
To operate the USB memory device, push the
MEDIA button repeatedly until the USB mode is
selected.
DISP button:
While a track with recorded music information
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
played track is displayed.
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
Track time g Artist g Album g Track time
Track details:
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. Push the
Back button to return to the display for the
4-48
main display mode.
iPod main operation:
iPod player operation
Interface:
Connecting iPod:
Connect the iPod to the USB connection port
using the USB cable that came with your iPod.
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
When the iPod is connected to the vehicle, the
iPod music library can only be operated by the
vehicle audio controls.
* iPod and iPhone are a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Compatibility:
The system unit shall be compatible with all
devices (past and future) supporting Apple
Accessory Protocol on USB link.
It includes (and not limited to):
y
y
y
y
y
y
iPod Generation 5 devices
iPod Classic I and II (Generation 6 and 7)
iTouch Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next
iPhone Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next
iPod Nano (1G, 2G, 3G)
iPad 1, 2 and 3
NOTE:
This audio system do not support iPad
charging.
MEDIA button:
To operate the iPod, push the MEDIA button
repeatedly until the USB (iPod) mode is selected
and then push the MENU/ENTER dial.
The interface for iPod operation shown on the
audio system display is similar to the iPod interface. Use the MENU/ENTER dial to play a track
on the iPod.
The following items can be chosen from the
menu list screen.
y
y
y
y
y
Playlists
Artists
Albums
Tracks
More
For further information about each item, see
the iPod owner’s manual.
The following operations are identical to the
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
operation. For details, see "CD player operation"
(P.4-46).
y
y
y
y
y
y
List view
Quick search
(Seek/track)
MIX (Random play)
RPT (Repeat track)
Folder browsing
DISP button:
While a track with recorded music information
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
played track is displayed.
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
further information about the track can be
displayed along with the track title as follows:
Track time g Artist g Albumg Track time
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 48
2021/01/13 01:16:59 PM
Track details:
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
the display into a detailed overview. To return to
the main display, push the Back button.
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (TYPE D)
AUX device player operation
The AUX jack is located on lower part of the
instrument panel. See "AUX (auxiliary) input
jack" (P.4-55). The AUX input jack accepts any
standard analog audio input such as from a
portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or
laptop computer.
NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
mini plug cable when connecting your music
device to the audio system. Music may not play
properly when a monaural cable is used.
MEDIA button:
To switch to the AUX mode, push the MEDIA button repeatedly until the AUX mode is selected.
JVH0924X
1.
MEDIA button
9.
SCAN tuning button
2.
FM·AM button
10. SEEK·TRACK (fast forward) button
3.
CD eject button
11. BACK button
4.
CD button
12. Power/VOL (volume) dial
5.
DISP (display) button
13. RPT (repeat) button
6.
Display screen
14. RDM (random) button
7.
iPod MENU button
15. Station memory buttons
8.
SEEK·TRACK (rewind) button
16. TUNE·FOLDER dial
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 49
4-49
2021/01/13 01:16:59 PM
17. ENTER/SETTING button
the TUNE·FOLDER dial to adjust the Bass,
Treble, balance and Fade of the screen to
the preferred level.
Audio main operation
Head unit:
y
The auto loudness circuit enhances the low and
high frequency ranges automatically.
The power of the audio system can be turned
on when the ignition switch is placed in the
“ON” or “ACC” position. Push the power/VOL dial
while the system is off to turn on the last audio
source, which was playing immediately before
the system was turned off. While the system
is on, pushing the power/VOL dial turns the
system off.
Brightness and Contrast
Adjust the brightness and contrast of the
screen.
Select the “Brightness” or “Contrast” using
the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the
ENTER/SETTING button. Turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial to adjust the brightness and
contrast of the screen to the preferred level.
Power/VOL dial:
y
y
Select the “On-Screen Clock” using the
TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the
ENTER/SETTING button. You can toggle between ON and OFF using the TUNE·FOLDER
dial.
y
RDS Display
RDS (radio data system) information can be
shown on the display. Select “RDS Display”
using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push
the ENTER/SETTING button. You can toggle
between ON and OFF using the TUNE·FOLDER dial.
y
Speed Sensitive Vol.
To change the Speed Sensitive Volume
(Speed Sensitive Vol.) level from off (0) to 5,
turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial.
y
AUX Vol.
Controls the volume level of incoming
sound when an auxiliary device is connected to the system. Choose a setting between
1 and 3 or choose 0 to disable the feature
entirely.
y
Language Select
The language settings can be changed.
Clock Adjust
Adjust the clock according to the following
procedure.
Turn the power/VOL dial to adjust the volume.
Audio settings:
The settings screen will appear when pushing
the ENTER/SETTING button.
The following items are available in the settings
screen.
y
y
Bluetooth
It is possible to set the Bluetooth® settings.
For details of the Bluetooth® settings,
see "Bluetooth® audio player operation"
(P.4-54).
Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade
Controls the sound of the audio system.
Balance adjusts the sound between the left
and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound
between the front and rear speakers.
Select the “Bass”, “Treble”, “Balance” or
“Fade” using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and
then push the ENTER/SETTING button. Turn
4-50
JVH0729X
1. Select “Clock Adjust” using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the ENTER/
SETTING button
2. .Adjust the hour with the TUNE·FOLDER
dial and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button .
On-Screen Clock
When this item is turned on, a clock is
always displayed in the upper right corner
of the screen.
Select “Language Select” using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the ENTER/
SETTING button. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial
to select the preferred language.
3. Adjust the minute with the TUNE·FOLDER
dial and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button .
24 hour clock is not available.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 50
2021/01/13 01:16:59 PM
DISP button:
y
Models without Intelligent Around View
Monitor
Display of the screen can be turned off by
pushing the DISP button. You can still listen
to music that is being played back even
while the screen display is turned off. If you
want to display the screen again, push the
DISP button once more. Pushing some of
the audio source buttons will also turn the
screen back on and display the screens of
the corresponding sources.
y
Models with Intelligent Around View Monitor
The Intelligent Around View Monitor can
be displayed by pushing the DISP button.
To display the audio screen again, push the
DISP button repeatedly. Pushing some of
the audio source buttons can also display
the audio screen. For details about the
Intelligent Around View Monitor, see
MEDIA button:
Pushing the MEDIA button will switch the audio
source as follows:
USB/iPod g Bluetooth g AUX g USB/iPod
Radio operation
AM/FM buttons:
Pushing the FM·AM button will change the band
as follows:
AM g FM1 g FM2 g AM
TUNE (Tuning):
Turn the radio TUNE·FOLDER dial for manual
tuning.
2.
Tune to the desired station using the
button or the TUNE·FOLDER dial.
RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is a data
information service transmitted by some radio
stations on the FM band (not AM band) encoded within a regular radio broadcast. Currently,
most RDS stations are in large cities, but many
stations are now considering broadcasting RDS
data.
3.
Push and hold the desired station preset
button
to
until the radio mutes.
4.
The station indicator will then come on and
the sound will resume. Memorizing is now
complete.
5.
RDS can display:
Other buttons can be set in the same manner.
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the
fuse opens, the station memory will be erased.
In that case, reset the desired stations.
Radio Data System (RDS):
y
y
Station name, such as “The Groove”.
Music or programming type such as “Classical”, “Country” or “Rock”.
Seek/track buttons:
Push the
or
button to tune from low to
high or high to low frequencies and to stop at
the next broadcasting station.
SCAN tuning buttons:
Push the SCAN tuning button to tune from
low to high frequencies and stop at each
broadcasting station for 5 seconds. Pushing
the button again during this 5 seconds period
will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain
tuned to that station.
If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within
5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next
station.
to
Station memory buttons:
12 stations can be set for the FM band (6 each
for FM1 and FM2) and 6 stations can be set for
the AM band.
1.
Choose the radio band using the FM·AM
button.
CD player operation
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” or “ACC”
position. Insert the Compact Disc (CD) into the
slot with the label side facing up. The CD will
be guided automatically into the slot and start
playing.
After loading the CD, the number of tracks on
the CD and the play time will appear on the
display.
If the radio is already operating, it will automatically turn off and the CD will play.
If the system has been turned off while the CD
was playing, pushing the power/VOL dial will
start the CD.
CD button:
When the CD button is pushed with the system
off and the CD loaded, the system will turn on
and the CD will start to play.
When the CD button is pushed with the CD
loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the CD will start
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 51
or
4-51
2021/01/13 01:16:59 PM
to play.
y
SEEK/TRACK:
When the
or
button is pushed for
more than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being
played, the CD will play while fast forwarding or
rewinding. When the button is released, the CD
will return to normal play speed.
When the
or
button is pushed for less
than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
the next track or the beginning of the current
track on the CD will be played.
RPT button:
When the RPT button is pushed while the CD
is played, the play pattern can be changed as
follows:
(CD)
(Normal)
1 Track Repeat
When this button is pushed while the CD is
being played, the CD will be ejected.
If the CD comes out and is not removed, it will
be pulled back into the slot to protect it.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port
USB main operation:
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
Connect a USB memory device into the connection port. The USB memory device will be
activated automatically.
If the system has been turned off while the USB
memory device was playing, pushing the power/VOL dial will start the USB memory device.
(CD with compressed audio files)
(Normal) g 1 Folder Repeat g 1 Track Repeat g
(Normal)
RDM button:
When the RDM button is pushed while a CD is
being played, the play pattern can be changed
as follows:
(CD)
WARNING:
Do not connect, disconnect or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be a
distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident or
serious injury.
CAUTION:
y
(Normal)
1 Disc Random
(CD with compressed audio files)
(Normal) g 1 Disc Random g 1 Folder Random
g (Normal)
CD eject button:
When the CD eject button is pushed with the CD
loaded, the CD will be ejected.
4-52
Do not force the USB device into the USB
connection port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the USB
device is connected correctly into the
USB connection port. (Some USB devices
come with a
mark as a guide. Make
sure that the mark is facing the correct
direction before inserting the device.)
Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
of the device.
MEDIA button:
When the MEDIA button is pushed with the
system turned off and the USB device inserted,
the system will turn on.
If another audio source is playing and a USB
device is inserted, push the MEDIA button repeatedly until the display screen changes to the
USB device mode.
SEEK/TRACK buttons:
When the
or
button is pushed for more
than 1.5 seconds while a USB device is being
played, the USB device will play while forwarding or rewinding. When the button is released,
the USB device will return to normal play speed.
When the
or
button is pushed for less
than 1.5 seconds while the USB device is being
played, the next track or the beginning of the
current track on the USB device will be played.
Folder selection:
To change to another folder in the USB device,
turn the TUNE FOLDER dial.
RPT button:
When the RPT button is pushed while the USB
device is played, the play pattern can be change
as follows.
To change the play mode, push the RPT button
repeatedly and the mode will change as follows.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 52
2021/01/13 01:17:00 PM
(Normal) g 1 Folder Repeat g 1 Track Repeat g
(Normal)
WARNING:
When the RDM button is pushed while a USB
device is being played, the play pattern can be
changed as follows.
Do not connect, disconnect or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be a
distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident or
serious injury.
To change the play mode, push the RDM button
repeatedly, and the mode will change as follows.
y
RDM button:
(Normal) g All Random g 1 Folder Random g
(Normal)
CAUTION:
BACK:
When the BACK button is pushed, it returns to
the previous display.
iPod player operation
Connecting iPod:
Connect the iPod to the USB connection port
using the USB cable that came with your iPod.
y
Do not force the USB device into the USB
connection port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the USB
device is connected correctly into the
USB connection port. (Some USB devices
come with a
mark as a guide. Make
sure that the mark is facing the correct
direction before inserting the device.)
Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. See "USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port" (P.4-55).
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
of the device.
Connect the iPod cable to the USB connection
port. The battery of the iPod is charged while
the cable is connected to the vehicle.
Compatibility:
Depending on the version of the iPod, the
display on the iPod shows a NISSAN or Accessory Attached screen when the connection
is completed. When the iPod is connected to
the vehicle, the iPod music library can only be
operated by the vehicle audio controls.
* iPod and iPhone are a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
The following models are compatible:
y iPod nano 1G (Firmware version 1.3.1 -)
y iPod nano 2G (Firmware version 1.1.3 -)
y iPod nano 3G (Firmware version 1.0.0 -)
y iPod nano 4G (Firmware version 1.0.2 -)
y iPod nano 5G (Firmware version 1.0.1 -)
y iPod nano 6G (Firmware version 1.0 -)
y iPod nano 7G (Firmware version 1.0.0 -)
y iPod 5G (Firmware version 1.2.1 -)
y iPod classic (Firmware version 1.0.0 -)
y iPod Touch (iOS 1.1 -)
y iPod Touch 2G (iOS 2.1.1 -)
y
y
y
y
y
y
y
y
iPod Touch 3G (iOS 3.1 -)
iPod Touch 4G (iOS 4.1 -)
iPod Touch 5G (iOS 6.0.0 -)
iPhone (iOS 1.0.0 - 2.2.1)
iPhone 3G (iOS 2.1 -)
iPhone 3GS (iOS 3.0 -)
iPhone 4/4S (iOS 4.0 -)
iPhone 5 (iOS 6.0.0 -)
Operations attributable to firmware update by
Apple are not guaranteed.
iPod main operation:
The system operates when the ignition switch
is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position. Push
the MEDIA button repeatedly or push the iPod
MENU button to switch to the iPod mode.
If the system has been turned off while the iPod
was playing, pushing the power/VOL dial will
start the iPod.
If another audio source is playing and the iPod
is connected, pushing the iPod MENU button or
the MEDIA button repeatedly will change to the
iPod mode.
When the iPod MENU button is pushed while the
iPod is connected, the interface for iPod operation is shown on the audio display. The items
on the menu list can be scrolled by turning the
TUNE·FOLDER dial while the iPod is operating.
To select an item, push ENTER/SETTING button.
Items in the iPod menu appear on the display in
the following order.
y
y
y
y
y
y
Now playing
Playlists
Artists
Albums
Songs
Podcasts
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 53
4-53
2021/01/13 01:17:00 PM
y
y
y
y
Genres
Composers
Audiobooks
Shuffle Songs
For more information about each item, see the
iPod Owner’s Manual.
device can be connected to the vehicle's audio
system so that the audio files on the device play
through the vehicle's speakers.
Regulatory information:
When the
or
button is pushed for less
than 1.5 seconds while the iPod is playing, the
next track or the beginning of the current track
on the iPod will be played.
Bluetooth® audio main operation:
Bluetooth® trademark:
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc., and licensed to Visteon
Corporation and Panasonic
Corporation.
SEEK/TRACK buttons:
When the
or
button is pushed for more
than 1.5 seconds while the iPod is playing, the
iPod will play while fast forwarding or rewinding.
When the button is released, the iPod will return
to the normal play speed.
Connecting Bluetooth® device:
To connect your Bluetooth® device to the vehicle, follow the procedure below:
1.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button.
JVH1012X
To switch to the Bluetooth® audio mode, push
the MEDIA button repeatedly until the Bluetooth® audio mode is displayed on the screen.
RPT button:
When the RPT button is pushed while a track is
being played, the play pattern can be changed
as follows:
The controls for the Bluetooth® audio are displayed on the screen. Use the Preset 3 button to
play and use the Preset 4 button to pause.
(Repeat off) g 1 Track Repeat g All Repeat g
(Repeat off)
Auxiliary input jack
RDM button:
When the RDM button is pushed while a track is
being played, the play pattern can be changed
as follows:
(Shuffle off) g Track Shuffle g (Shuffle off)
JVH0620X
2.
Select the “Bluetooth” key.
3.
Select the “Add Phone” key. This same
screen can be accessed to remove, replace
or select a different Bluetooth® device.
BACK:
The display will return to the previous screen.
Bluetooth® audio player operation
If you have a compatible Bluetooth® audio
device that is capable of playing audio files, the
4-54
according to each cellular phone model.
See the Owner's manual of the Bluetooth®
device for details.
4.
The system acknowledges the command
and asks you to initiate connecting from
the Bluetooth® device. The connecting
procedure of the Bluetooth® device varies
The AUX input jack is located on the lower part
of the instrument panel. See " AUX (auxiliary)
input jack" (P.4-55). The AUX input jack accepts
any standard analog audio input such as from a
portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player or
laptop computer.
Push the MEDIA button to play a compatible device when it is plugged into the AUX input jack.
NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
mini plug cable when connecting your music
device to the audio system. Music may not play
properly when a monaural cable is used.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 54
2021/01/13 01:17:00 PM
USB (UNIVERSAL SERIAL BUS) CONNECTION PORT
AUX (auxiliary) INPUT JACK
WARNING:
Do not connect, disconnect or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be a
distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident or
serious injury.
CAUTION:
y
Do not force the USB device into the USB
connection port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port may
damage the port. Make sure that the USB
device is connected correctly into the USB
connection port.
y
Do not grab the USB connection port
cover (if equipped) when pulling the USB
device out of the port. This could damage
the port and the cover.
y
Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally.
Pulling the cable may damage the port.
Refer to your device manufacturer's owner
information regarding the proper use and care
of the device.
Except for front bench seat models
JVH1258X
Except for front bench seat models
For front bench seat models
JVH1259X
JVH111X
The USB connection port is located on the
lower part of the instrument panel. Insert USB
devices or iPod connectors into this port.
For front bench seat models
JVH1112X
The AUX input jack is located on the lower part
of the instrument panel. Compatible audio
devices, such as some MP3 players, can be
connected to the system through the AUX input
jack.
Before connecting a device to a jack, turn off the
power of the portable device.
With a compatible device connected to the jack,
push the corresponding button (depends on
the audio system) repeatedly until the display
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 55
4-55
2021/01/13 01:17:00 PM
switches to the AUX mode.
NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
mini plug cable when connecting your music
device to the audio system. Music may not play
properly when a monaural cable is used.
CD/USB MEMORY CARE AND CLEANING
CD
USB memory
Volume control button:
y
Do not place heavy objects on the USB
memory.
y
Do not store the USB memory in highly
humid locations.
y
Do not expose the USB memory to direct
sunlight.
y
Do not spill any liquids on the USB memory.
Refer to the USB memory Owner’s Manual for
details.
AUDIO CONTROL STEERING SWITCH (if
equipped)
Steering wheel mounted controls for
audio (Type A)
Push the + or − side of the button to increase or
decrease the volume.
Tuning buttons:
y
RADIO
— Pushing
/
shorter.
Next or previous preset station
—
y
CD, iPod, Bluetooth® audio or USB device
— Pushing
/
shorter.
Next track or the beginning of the
current track (the previous track if the
button is pushed immediately after the
current track starts playing)
—
SAA0451
y
Handle a disc by its edges. Never touch the
surface of the disc. Do not bend the disc.
y
Always place the discs in the storage case
when they are not being used.
y
To clean a disc, wipe the surface from the
center to the outer edge using a clean, soft
cloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circular
motion.
y
Pushing
/
longer
Fast-forward or rewind
Source select button:
Push the SOURCE button to change the mode
to available audio source.
When the display is off, push the SOURCE button to turn on the display.
WAE0509X
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or
alcohol intended for industrial use.
1.
Tuning buttons
A new disc may be rough on the inner and
outer edges. Remove the rough edges by
rubbing the inner and outer edges with the
side of a pen or pencil as illustrated.
2.
Volume control buttons
3.
Source select button
4-56
Pushing
/
longer
Next or previous station
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 56
2021/01/13 01:17:01 PM
Steering wheel mounted controls for
audio (Type B)
RADIO
y
Pushing
/
shorter.
Next or previous preset station
y
Pushing
/
longer
Next or previous station
CD, iPod, USB device or Bluetooth® audio
JVH1545X
1.
Menu control buttons/OK button
2.
Volume control buttons
3.
Tuning buttons
4.
Back button
y
Pushing
/
shorter
Next track or the beginning of the current
track (the previous track if the button is
pushed immediately after the current track
starts playing)
y
Pushing
/
longer
Fast-forward or rewind
Back button:
Push the Back button to return to the previous
screen or cancel the current selection.
Menu control buttons/OK button:
Push the
/
buttons and switch the vehicle information display to audio mode. Push the
OK button until the preferred available audio
source is selected
Volume control buttons:
Push the + or − button to increase or decrease
the volume.
Tuning buttons:
Push the
or track.
/
buttons to select a station
Depending on the status of the vehicle information display, the tuning buttons cannot be used
for audio control.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 57
4-57
2021/01/13 01:17:01 PM
ANTENNA
CAR PHONE AND CB RADIO
ROOF ANTENNA
following conditions.
y
The vehicle enters an automatic car wash.
y
The vehicle enters a garage with a low
ceiling.
y
The vehicle is covered with a car cover.
PILLAR ANTENNA
Adjust the antenna length for the best reception. A fully extended antenna is usually best for
distant reception.
When installing a CB, ham radio or a car phone
in your vehicle, be sure to observe the following
cautions, otherwise the new equipment may
adversely affect the Engine Control System and
other electronic parts.
CAUTION:
y
Keep the antenna as far away as possible
from the Electronic Control Module.
y
Keep the antenna wire at least 20 cm (8 in)
away from the Engine Control harnesses.
Do not route the antenna wire next to any
harnesses.
y
Adjust the antenna standing wave ratio
as recommended by the manufacturer.
y
Connect the ground wire from the radio
chassis to the body.
y
For details, consult a NISSAN dealer.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage, be sure that the antenna
is retracted before the vehicle enters an automatic car wash.
JVH0666X
The antenna can be removed if necessary.
Hold the bottom of the antenna and remove by
turning counterclockwise.
To install the antenna, turn the antenna clockwise and tighten.
CAUTION:
To avoid damaging or deforming the antenna, be sure to remove the antenna under the
4-58
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 58
2021/01/13 01:17:01 PM
Bluetooth® HANDS-FREE PHONE
SYSTEM (Type A)
*This Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System is
for models with type B audio.
WARNING:
y
y
Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in
a safe location. If you have to use a phone
while driving, exercise extreme caution at
all times so full attention may be given to
vehicle operation.
If you find yourself unable to devote full
attention to vehicle operation while using
the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle before doing
so.
CAUTION:
To avoid draining the vehicle battery, use a
phone after starting the engine.
Bluetooth® is a wireless radio communication
standard. This system offers a hands-free facility for your cellular phone to enhance driving
comfort.
To use the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System, your cellular phone must first be setup.
For details, see "Bluetooth® settings" (P.4-60).
Once it has been setup, the hands-free mode
is automatically activated on the registered
cellular phone (via Bluetooth®) when it comes
into range.
If the audio system is in use at the time, the
radio, CD, iPod, USB audio, Bluetooth® audio or
AUX source mode will be muted and will stay
muted until the active call has ended.
REGULATORY INFORMATION
Bluetooth® trademark
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc., and licensed to Visteon
Corporation and Panasonic
Corporation.
The Bluetooth® system may not be able to connect with your cellular phone for the following
reasons:
y
The cellular phone is too far away from the
vehicle.
y
The Bluetooth® mode on your cellular
phone has not been activated.
y
Your cellular phone has not been paired
with the Bluetooth® system of the audio
unit.
y
The cellular phone does not support Bluetooth® technology.
NOTE:
y
For details, see your cellular phone's
Owner's Manual.
y
For assistance with your cellular phone
integration, please visit your local NISSAN
dealer.
CE statement
Hereby Visteon Corp. declares that this system
is in compliance with the essential requirements
and other relevant provisions of Directive
1999/5/EC.
NOTE:
The audio system only supports Bluetooth®
devices with AVRCP (Audio Video Remote
Control Profile) version 1.3, or 1.0 or earlier.
CONTROL BUTTONS AND MICROPHONE
Instrument panel (if equipped):
A notification message appears on the audio
display when the phone is connected, when an
incoming call is being received, as well as when
a call is initiated.
When a call is active, the Instrument panel
mounted control buttons (if equipped), microphone, and steering wheel mounted control
buttons enable hands-free communication.
JVH0856X
1.
Phonebook quick search button
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 59
4-59
2021/01/13 01:17:01 PM
2.
Back
3.
Phone
4.
MENU/ENTER dial
Bluetooth® SETTINGS
button
button
Pairing device
Enter the phone setup menu via the
button on the instrument panel or the
button
on the steering wheel, select the “Bluetooth”
key, and then check if the Bluetooth® is set to
on. (If not push the MENU/ENTER dial to turn it
on.)
Steering wheel mounted control:
Manual for further details.
Setting items
To set up the Bluetooth® system with a device,
the following items are available:
To setup the Bluetooth® system to pair (connect or register) your preferred cellular phone,
follow the following procedure.
1.
To pair a device, select the “Scan device” key
or the “Pair device” key on the display.
2.
A notification message will be displayed
when the phone is successfully paired.
3.
The display will return to the current audio
source status after the connection is complete.
y
While the Bluetooth® connection is active,
the following icons will appear on the display.
WAE0537X
1.
Volume control
-/
+ buttons
Push the buttons to increase or decrease
the volume of the speakers.
2.
Phone send
button
y Accept an incoming call by pushing once.
3.
Scan devices
Shows all available visible Bluetooth® devices and initializes Bluetooth® connection
from the audio unit.
y
Pair device
Initializes Bluetooth® connection from the
mobile device.
y
*: If low battery is indicated, the Bluetooth® device must be recharged soon.
Sel. device
Paired Bluetooth® devices are listed and can
be selected for connection.
y
Up to 5 different Bluetooth® devices can be
connected. However, only one device can be
used at a time. If 5 different Bluetooth® devices are registered, a new device can only
replace one of the 5 existing paired devices.
Del. device
A registered Bluetooth® device can be
deleted.
y
Bluetooth
If this setting is turned off, the connection
between the Bluetooth® devices and the
in-vehicle Bluetooth® module will be cancelled.
y Redial the last outgoing call by pushing
the button for more than 2 seconds.
—
: Signal strength indicator
—
: Battery status indicator*
Phone end
—
: Bluetooth® connection ON indicator
button
y
Reject an incoming call by pushing the
button during an incoming call.
y
End an active call by pushing the button
once.
y
Microphone:
Microphone is located near the map lights.
y
4-60
JVH0847X
y
The pairing procedure and operation may
vary according to device type and compatibility. See the Bluetooth® device Owner’s
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 60
2021/01/13 01:17:02 PM
Scan device:
Pair device:
1.
y
Turn on the Bluetooth® on the audio unit.
See "Bluetooth®" (P.4-60).
y
Use the audio unit to pair:
Push the
button on the instrument
panel or the
button on the steering
wheel. Select “Scan device” key. The audio
unit searches for the Bluetooth® devices
and shows all devices that were found.
Push the
button on the instrument
panel or the
button on the steering
wheel. Select the “Pair Device” key.
Make sure your Bluetooth® device is available at this time.
2.
Select the device to be paired using the
MENU/ENTER dial.
3.
The pairing procedure depends on the
device to be connected:
The pairing procedure depends on the
Bluetooth® device to be connected:
1) Device without PIN code:
The Bluetooth® connection will be automatically connected without any further
input.
a. Device without PIN code:
The Bluetooth® connection will be automatically connected without any further
input.
2) Device with PIN code:
Two different ways of pairing are possible
depending on the device. For the correct
procedure details, see "Scan device"
(P.4-61).
b. Device with PIN code:
y
The paired device list shows which Bluetooth®
audio or cellular phone devices have been
paired or registered to the system. Select the
appropriate device to connect to the system.
The following icons (if equipped) indicate the
capability of the registered device:
y
y
: Cellular phone integration
: Audio streaming (A2DP – Advanced
Audio Distribution Profile)
Del. device:
A registered device can be removed from Bluetooth® system registration. Select a registered
device and push the MENU/ENTER dial to confirm to deletion.
Bluetooth:
The message “To pair” and “Enter Pin” 0000
will be displayed.
1) Switch on the search mode for Bluetooth® devices.
Confirm the PIN code on the device. The
Bluetooth® connection will be made.
If the search mode finds the audio unit it will
be shown on the device display.
If Bluetooth® signal has been turned off, a notification message “ON/OFF” appears when you
select “Bluetooth” from the phone menu. (Push
the
button to display the phone menu.) To
turn the Bluetooth® signal on, push the MENU/
ENTER dial and a follow up screen will appear.
Select “ON” and push the MENU/ENTER dial to
display the Bluetooth® settings menu screen.
Type B:
2) Select the unit device shown as “My Car”.
USING THE SYSTEM
The message “Pairing request” and “Confirm
password” together with a 6 digit code will
be displayed. The unique and identical code
should be displayed on the device. If the
code is identical confirm on the device.
3) Enter the number code shown on the
relevant device with the device’s own
keypad, and push the confirmation key
on the Bluetooth® device.
The hands-free mode can be operated using
the
button on the instrument panel or the
button on the steering wheel.
Two different ways of pairing are possible
depending on the device:
y
Sel. device:
Type A:
The Bluetooth® connection will be made.
y
Use the Bluetooth® audio/cellular phone
device to pair:
Refer to the relevant Bluetooth® device Owner’s
Manual for further details.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 61
4-61
2021/01/13 01:17:02 PM
Receiving a call
y
y
:
Select this item to transfer the call back
to the hands-free phone system from the
cellular phone.
#123:
Select this item to enter numbers during
a call. For example, use this function when
directed by an automated phone system to
dial an extension number.
Putting a call on hold:
JVH0857X
When receiving an incoming call, the display
on the audio unit will show the caller’s phone
number (or a notification message that the
caller’s phone number cannot be shown) and
three operation icons as illustrated. To highlight
different icons, turn the MENU/ENTER dial. Push
the MENU/ENTER dial to select the highlighted
icon.
To put a call on hold, select
. Select
return to the call. To reject the call select
.
to
Rejecting a call:
To reject an incoming call, select
ing
on the steering wheel.
or by push-
y
Making a call from the phonebook
y
Manually dialing a phone number
y
Redialing
y
Using call history (Call List menu)
— Dialed
— Received
— Missed
Making a call from the phonebook:
Once the Bluetooth® connection has been
made between the registered cellular phone
and the hands-free phone system, phonebook
data will be transferred automatically to the
hands-free phone system. The transfer may
take a while before completion.
NOTE:
Making a call
Phone book data will be erased when:
WARNING:
Park the vehicle in a safe location, and apply
the parking brake before making a call.
y
Switching to another registered cellular
phone.
y
Cellular phone is disconnected.
Answer the call by selecting
on the display
or by pushing
on the steering wheel.
y
The registered cellular phone is deleted
from the audio system.
During the call, the following icons are available:
1.
Push the
button on instrument panel
or the
button on the steering wheel.
2.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial to highlight
“Phone Book” and push the MENU/ENTER
dial.
3.
Scroll down through the list, select the appropriate contact name (highlighted), and
push the MENU/ENTER dial.
4.
The screen will show the number to be
dialed. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to dial
the number.
Answering and during a call:
y
:
Select this item to end the call.
y
:
Select this item to put the call on hold.
y
:
Select this item to transfer the call from the
hands-free phone system to your cellular
phone.
JVH0863X
A call can be initiated using one of the following
methods:
4-62
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 62
2021/01/13 01:17:02 PM
If more than one number is registered, select an appropriate icon.
Manually dialing a phone number:
Redial:
To redial or call the last number dialed, push
and hold the
button on the instrument
panel or the
button on the steering wheel
for more than 2 seconds.
: Home
: Cellular phone
: Office
Using call history (Call list menu):
Quick searching the phonebook:
JVH0859X
To dial a phone number manually, perform the
following operation:
1.
JVH0858X
The quick search mode can be used as follows:
1.
Push the A-Z button.
2.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial for the first alphabetic or numerical letter of the contact
name. Once highlighted, push the MENU/
ENTER dial to select the letter.
3.
4.
2.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial to select “Dial
Number”.
3.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial to scroll along
and highlight each number of the phone
number. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to
select the highlighted number.
To delete the last number entered, scroll
to the “ ” (Backspace symbol) and once
highlighted, push the MENU/ENTER dial.
The last number will be deleted. Pushing
the MENU/ENTER dial repeatedly will delete
each subsequent number.
The display will show the corresponding
contact name(s). Where necessary, use the
MENU/ENTER dial to scroll further for the
appropriate contact name to call.
The screen will show the number to be
dialed. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to dial
the number.
Push the
button on the instrument
panel or the
button on the steering
wheel and turn the MENU/ENTER dial to
highlight “Dial Number”.
4.
After entering the last number, highlight the
icon and push the MENU/ENTER dial to
dial the number.
JVH0860X
A number from the dialed, received, or missed
call lists can also be used to make a call.
1.
Push the
button on the instrument
panel or the
button on the steering
wheel and select “Call List” on the display.
2.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial and scroll to an
item, and push the MENU/ENTER dial to
select an item.
Available items:
y
Dialed
Use the dialed call mode to make a call
which is based on the list of outgoing (dialed) calls.
y
Received
Use the received call mode to make a call
which is based on the list of received calls.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 63
4-63
2021/01/13 01:17:02 PM
y
Missed
Use the missed call mode to make a call
which is based on the list of missed calls.
3.
GENERAL SETTINGS
y
Ringtone
— Car
Switch the ringtone to ring from the vehicle or the cellular phone.
Scroll to the preferred phone number and
push the MENU/ENTER dial, the
button
on the instrument panel or the
button
on the steering wheel.
— Phone
Switch the phone ringing volume on or
off.
Second incoming call
y
PB download
Download the phonebook of the mobile
device to the audio unit manually.
JVH0862X
Using the MENU/ENTER dial, highlight “Settings”
from the phone menu and push the MENU/
ENTER dial.
Volume settings and manually downloading
the phonebook can be done using this menu.
JVH0861X
Whenever there is a second incoming call is
shown in the display. By selecting the
icon
the call is accepted and the current call is put
on hold.
Selecting the
icon using the MENU/ENTER
dial rejects the second incoming call. When this
is done during the conversation it ends the call.
Selecting the
icon using the MENU/ENTER
dial switches the call on line between the first
and the second call.
Ending a call
Menu operation:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial to change the highlighted item and to change the volume settings.
Push the MENU/ENTER dial to select the highlighted item and to apply the setting.
Menu items:
y
Volume
— Ring
Set the phone ringing volume.
— Call
Set the volume of the conversation
during a call.
To end an active call, highlight the
icon and
push the ENTER/MENU dial or push the
button on the steering wheel.
4-64
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 64
2021/01/13 01:17:03 PM
Bluetooth® HANDS-FREE PHONE
SYSTEM (Type B)
*This Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System is
for models with type D audio.
WARNING:
y
y
Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in
a safe location. If you have to use a phone
while driving, exercise extreme caution at
all times so full attention may be given to
vehicle operation.
If you find yourself unable to devote
full attention to vehicle operation while
talking on the phone, pull off the road to a
safe location and stop your vehicle before
doing so.
CAUTION:
To avoid draining the vehicle battery, use a
phone after starting the engine.
NOTE:
Wireless LAN (Wi-Fi) and the Bluetooth® functions share the same frequency band (2.4
GHz). Using the Bluetooth® and the wireless
LAN functions at the same time may slow
down or disconnect communication and
cause undesired noise. It is recommended
that you turn off the wireless LAN (Wi-Fi)
when using the Bluetooth® functions.
vehicle phone module, no phone connecting
procedure is required. Your phone is automatically connected with the in-vehicle phone
module when the ignition switch is placed in
the “ON” position with the registered cellular
phone turned on and carried in the vehicle.
You can register up to 5 different Bluetooth®
cellular phones in the in-vehicle phone module.
However, you can talk on only one cellular
phone at a time.
When a call is active, the audio system and
microphone (located near the map lights) are
used for the handsfree communications.
If the audio system is being used at the time, the
audio mode will mute and will stay muted until
the active call is ended.
not to be dialed.
y
When the radio wave condition is not ideal
or ambient sound is too loud, it may be
difficult to hear the other person’s voice
during a call.
y
Immediately after the ignition switch is
placed in the “ON” position, it may be impossible to receive a call for a short period of
time.
y
Do not place the cellular phone in an area
surrounded by metal or far away from the
in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone
quality degradation and wireless connection disruption.
y
While a cellular phone is connected through
the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the
battery power of the cellular phone may
discharge quicker than usual.
y
If the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
seems to be malfunctioning, please contact
a NISSAN dealer.
y
Some cellular phones or other devices
may cause interference or a buzzing noise
to come from the audio system speakers.
Storing the device in a different location
may reduce or eliminate the noise.
y
Refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manual
regarding the telephone pairing procedure
specific to your phone, battery charging,
cellular phone antenna, etc.
y
The antenna display on the monitor will not
coincide with the antenna display of some
cellular phones.
y
Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible to hear the caller’s voice clearly as
Before using the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System, refer to the following notes.
y
Set up the wireless connection between
a cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone
module before using the Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System.
y
Some Bluetooth® enabled cellular phones
may not be recognized by the in-vehicle
phone module.
y
You will not be able to use a hands-free
phone under the following conditions:
Your vehicle is equipped with Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System. If you are an owner
of a Bluetooth® enabled cellular phone, you
can set up the wireless connection between
your cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone
module. With Bluetooth® wireless technology,
you can make or receive a telephone call with
your cellular phone in your pocket.
—
Your vehicle is outside of the telephone
service area.
—
Once your cellular phone is paired to the in-
Your vehicle is in an area where it is
difficult to receive radio waves; such as
in a tunnel, in an underground parking
garage, behind a tall building or in a
mountainous area.
—
Your cellular phone is locked in order
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 65
4-65
2021/01/13 01:17:03 PM
well as to minimize its echoes.
y
If reception between callers is unclear,
adjusting the incoming or outgoing call
volume may improve the clarity.
y
This wireless hands free car kit is based on
Bluetooth® technology.
USING THE SYSTEM
to vehicle operation.
Control buttons:
Setup
Choosing a language:
You can interact with the Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System using several languages
that are available. To change the language, perform the following. See "Audio main operation
(P.4-50).
— Frequency: 2402 MHz - 2480 MHz
— Modulation: FHSS GFSK 8DPSK, π/4DQPSK
Connecting procedure:
— Number of Channel: 79
— This wireless equipment cannot be used
for any services related to safety due to
the possibility of radio interference.
JVH1576X
REGULATORY INFORMATION
1.
Volume control buttons
CE statement
2.
Select buttons:
Hereby “Yangfeng Visteon Automotive Electronics Co., Ltd.” declares that this Bluetooth car
kit is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive
1999/5/EC.
Push the
/
buttons to manually
control the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System.
3.
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.,
and licensed to Visteon Corporation and Panasonic Corporation.
button
Push the
button to initiate a phone
session or answer an incoming call.
4.
Bluetooth® trademark:
Phone send
Phone end
button:
Push the
button to end a phone call or
to stop the system from providing voice
prompts.
Microphone:
Microphone is located near the map lights.
The NISSAN Voice Recognition system (if
equipped) allows hands-free operation of the
Bluetooth® Hands- Free Phone System.
If the vehicle is in motion, some commands may
not be available so full attention may be given
4-66
You can register up to 5 different Bluetooth®
cellular phones in the in-vehicle phone module.
However, you can talk on only one cellular
phone at a time.
To connect a phone to the Bluetooth® handsfree phone system. See "Connecting Bluetooth®
device" (P.4-54).
Selecting a registered phone:
1.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button.
2.
Use the TUNE FOLDER dial to select “Bluetooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button.
3.
Select “Select Phone”, and then push the
ENTER/SETTING button.
4.
Select the phone you wish to use.
Deleting a registered phone:
1.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button.
2.
Use the TUNE FOLDER dial to select “Bluetooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button.
3.
Select “Delete Phone”, and then push the
ENTER/SETTING button.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 66
2021/01/13 01:17:03 PM
4.
Use the TUNE FOLDER dial to select the
phone you wish to delete.
NOTE:
When you delete a phone, the associated
phonebook for the phone will also be deleted.
Bluetooth® on/off:
1.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button.
2.
Use the TUNE FOLDER dial to select “Bluetooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button.
3.
Select “Bluetooth” and select “On” or “Off” to
turn the vehicle's Bluetooth® system on or
off.
When Bluetooth® is off, you will not be able to
make or receive calls by the hands-free mode.
Also, you will not have access to the phonebook.
wheel to move through the list and select
the person you wish to call.
y
Redial
Select this item to call the last number
dialed.
y
Call Back
Select this item to call the number of the
last incoming call to the vehicle.
Phonebook:
Call
Phonebook
y
Record Name (if equipped)
y
Recent Calls
y
Select Phone
Missed Calls
Select this item to list the last five missed
calls to the vehicle. If the call is from an
entry in the phonebook, the name will be
displayed. Otherwise, the phone number
of the missed call will be displayed. Select
“Dial” to call the number. Select “Next Entry”
or “Previous Entry” to move through the list
of missed calls.
y
Outgoing Calls
Select this item to list the last five outgoing
calls from the vehicle. If the call was to an
entry in the phonebook, the name will be
displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of
the outgoing call will be displayed. Select
“Dial” to call the number. Select “Next Entry”
or “Previous Entry” to move through the list
of outgoing calls.
y
Redial
Select this item to call the last number
dialed.
Call Back
Select this item to call the number of the
last incoming call to the vehicle.
Each phone has its own separate phonebook.
You cannot access Phone A's phonebook if
you are currently connected with Phone B.
List Names
Select this item to have the system list the
names in the phonebook one by one in
alphabetical order. Select “Dial” to dial the
number of the currently selected name.
Push the
/
buttons on the steering
wheel to move through the list and select
the person you wish to call.
y
Delete Entry
Select this item to delete an entry in the
phonebook. Choose an entry to delete.
Push the
button to bring up the phone
menu. The available options are:
y
y
NOTE:
y
Incoming Calls
Select this item to list the last five incoming
calls to the vehicle. If the call is from an
entry in the phonebook, the name will be
displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of
the incoming call will be displayed.
Select “Dial” to call the number. Select “Next
Entry” or “Previous Entry” to move through
the list of incoming calls.
The following items are available under “Phonebook”.
Phone menu
y
y
Call:
Record Name (if equipped):
The following items are available under “Call”.
The system allows you to record custom voice
tags for contact names in the phonebook. Up
to 40 voice tags can be recorded to the system.
y
Recent Calls:
Select Phone:
The following items are available under “Recent
Calls”:
Select this item to select a phone to use from a
list of those phones connected to the vehicle.
y
List Names
Select this item to have the system list the
names in the phonebook one by one in
alphabetical order. Select “Dial” to dial the
number of the currently selected name.
Push the
/
buttons on the steering
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 67
4-67
2021/01/13 01:17:03 PM
Making a call
Phonebook:
1.
Push the
button on the steering wheel
and push the
/
buttons on the
steering wheel to select the “Phonebook”
menu.
2.
Push the
/
buttons on the steering
wheel to select the “List Names” menu.
3.
Push the
/
buttons on the steering
wheel to select the person you wish to call.
4.
Push the
button to accept the selection.
The system acknowledges the selection
and starts dialing.
Redial:
1.
Push the phone send
2.
Push the
/
buttons on the steering
wheel or using the TUNE FOLDER dial to select “Recent Calls”, and then push the phone
send
button.
button.
3.
Push the
/
buttons on the steering
wheel to select “Redial”, and then push the
phone send
button.
4.
Push the phone send
button, and then
the system begins the call.
Bluetooth® cellular phone keypad:
You can also make a call by operating the cellular phone that is registered to the in-vehicle
phone module to use the hands-free phone
system.
Receiving a call
System, the call information is displayed on
either the vehicle information display or both
the vehicle information display and the control
panel display.
Push the
button to accept the call. Push the
button to reject the call.
During a call
During a call, push the phone send
button
to access additional options. Select one of the
following items:
y
y
“Mute On” / “Mute Off”
Select the item to mute or unmute the
system.
“Transfer Call”
Select this item to switch the call from the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System to
the cellular phone when privacy is desired.
Once the ignition switch is placed in the
“OFF” position and the “ON” position again,
the system will automatically change to the
hands-free mode as a default setting.
If supported by the phone, the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System allows for call
waiting functionality. If a call is received while
another call is already active, a message will be
displayed on the screen. Push the phone send
button to hold the active call and switch
to the second call. Push the
button to reject
the second call.
While the second call is active, pushing the
phone send
button will allow the same
items that are available during any call as well
as two additional items:
When a call is received by the phone connected
to the vehicle's Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
4-68
y
“Switch Call”
Select this item to hold the second call and
switch back to the original call.
y
“End Other Call”
Select this item to stay with the second call
and end the original call.
Push the phone send
button to accept the
call. Push the
button to reject the call.
Ending a call
Push the phone end
button on the steering
wheel or the off button on the cellular phone.
Bluetooth® SETTINGS
To access and adjust the settings for the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System;
1.
Push the ENTER/SETTING button.
2.
Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial to select “Bluetooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING
button.
Available setting items:
y
Bluetooth
Select “On” or “Off” to turn the vehicle's
Bluetooth® system on or off.
y
Add Phone
For operation to connect a phone to the
system, see "Connecting Bluetooth® device" (P.4-54).
y
Delete Phone
Select to delete a phone from the displayed
list. The system will ask to confirm before
deleting the phone.
NOTE:
When you delete a phone, the associated
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 68
2021/01/13 01:17:03 PM
phonebook for the phone will also be deleted.
y
Replace Phone
Select to replace a phone from the displayed
list. When a selection is made, the system
will ask to confirm before proceeding. The
recorded phonebook for the phone being
deleted will be saved as long as the new
phone’s phonebook is the same as the old
phone’s phonebook.
y
Select Phone
Select to connect to a previously connected
phone from the displayed list.
y
Phonebook Download (if equipped)
Select to turn on or off the automatic download of a connected phone’s phonebook.
y
Show Incoming Calls
Select “Driver Only” to have incoming call
information displayed only in the vehicle
information display. Select “Both” to have
incoming call information displayed in both
the vehicle information display and the
center display screen.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system
4-Chapter 4.indd 69
4-69
2021/01/13 01:17:04 PM
MEMO
4-70
Illustrated table of contents
4-Chapter 4.indd 70
2021/01/13 01:17:04 PM
5 Starting and driving
Break-in schedule ......................................................................................... 5-4
Before starting engine .............................................................................. 5-4
Precautions when starting and driving ....................................... 5-4
Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) .............................................. 5-5
Turbocharger system (if equipped) ................................................. 5-5
On-pavement and off-road driving precautions .................. 5-6
Driving safety precautions............................................................ 5-6
Care when driving ........................................................................................ 5-7
Engine cold start period ................................................................. 5-7
Loading luggage .................................................................................. 5-7
Driving in wet conditions ............................................................... 5-7
Driving in winter conditions ....................................................... 5-8
Ignition switch (models without Intelligent
Key system) ....................................................................................................... 5-8
Manual Transmission (MT) ............................................................ 5-8
Automatic Transmission (AT) ...................................................... 5-8
Key positions........................................................................................... 5-9
Push-button ignition switch (models with Intelligent
Key system) ....................................................................................................... 5-9
Precautions on push-button ignition switch
operation ................................................................................................... 5-9
Intelligent Key system ...................................................................... 5-9
Automatic Transmission (AT) ................................................... 5-10
Steering lock ........................................................................................ 5-10
Ignition switch positions............................................................. 5-10
Intelligent Key battery discharge ......................................... 5-11
Starting engine (models without Intelligent Key
system) .............................................................................................................. 5-12
Starting engine (models with Intelligent Key
system) .............................................................................................................. 5-12
5-Chapter 5.indd 1
Driving vehicle .............................................................................................. 5-13
Driving with Automatic Transmission (AT)..................... 5-13
Driving with Manual Transmission (MT) ........................... 5-16
Four-wheel drive (4WD) (if equipped).......................................... 5-16
Part time 4WD system .................................................................. 5-17
4WD mode switch operation ................................................... 5-19
4WD mode indicator ...................................................................... 5-20
4WD warning ....................................................................................... 5-20
Tyre recommendation for 4WD ............................................. 5-21
Rear differential locking system (if equipped) ...................... 5-22
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system
(if equipped) ................................................................................................... 5-23
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch.................. 5-24
Hill descent control system (if equipped)................................. 5-24
Hill descent control switch ........................................................ 5-24
Hill start assist system (if equipped) ............................................ 5-25
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) (if equipped)........................ 5-26
LDW system operation.................................................................. 5-26
How to enable/disable the LDW system ......................... 5-27
LDW system limitations................................................................ 5-28
System temporarily unavailable............................................ 5-29
System malfunction ....................................................................... 5-29
System maintenance .................................................................... 5-29
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) (if equipped) ..................................... 5-30
BSW system operation.................................................................. 5-31
How to enable/disable the BSW system ......................... 5-32
BSW system limitations................................................................ 5-32
BSW driving situations .................................................................. 5-33
System temporarily unavailable............................................ 5-35
2021/01/13 02:16:34 PM
System malfunction ....................................................................... 5-35
System maintenance .................................................................... 5-35
Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) (if equipped) .......................... 5-36
RCTA system operation ............................................................... 5-37
How to enable/disable the RCTA system....................... 5-38
RCTA system limitations ............................................................. 5-39
System temporarily unavailable............................................ 5-40
System malfunction ....................................................................... 5-41
System maintenance .................................................................... 5-41
Cruise control (if equipped) ................................................................ 5-41
Precautions on cruise control ................................................. 5-42
Cruise control operations .......................................................... 5-42
Intelligent Emergency Braking (if equipped) ......................... 5-43
Intelligent Emergency Braking
system operation ............................................................................. 5-43
Turning the Intelligent Emergency Braking
system ON/OFF ................................................................................. 5-45
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
limitations .............................................................................................. 5-45
System temporarily unavailable............................................ 5-48
System malfunction ....................................................................... 5-49
System maintenance .................................................................... 5-49
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system (if
equipped) ......................................................................................................... 5-49
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
operation ................................................................................................ 5-50
Turning the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
5-Chapter 5.indd 2
system ON/OFF ................................................................................. 5-52
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
limitations .............................................................................................. 5-52
System temporarily unavailable............................................ 5-55
System malfunction ....................................................................... 5-55
System maintenance .................................................................. 5-56
Intelligent Driver Alertness (if equipped) .................................. 5-56
Intelligent Driver Alertness system operation ............ 5-57
How to enable/disable the Intelligent Driver
Alertness system .............................................................................. 5-57
Intelligent Driver Alertness system limitations .......... 5-58
System malfunction ....................................................................... 5-58
ECO drive report (if equipped) .......................................................... 5-58
Fuel Efficiency and Carbon Dioxide Reduction
driving tips....................................................................................................... 5-59
Increasing fuel economy and reducing Carbon
Dioxide emissions ...................................................................................... 5-59
Parking ............................................................................................................... 5-60
Parking sensor (SONAR) system (if equipped)...................... 5-61
Parking sensor (sonar) system OFF switch .................. 5-62
Parking sensor (sonar) system setting ............................ 5-63
Trailer towing ................................................................................................ 5-63
Operating precautions ................................................................. 5-63
Maximum load limits ...................................................................... 5-64
Tyre pressure ....................................................................................... 5-64
Safety chains........................................................................................ 5-64
Trailer brakes........................................................................................ 5-64
2021/01/13 02:16:35 PM
Trailer detection (if equipped) ................................................. 5-65
Power steering ............................................................................................. 5-65
Brake system ................................................................................................. 5-65
Brake precautions ............................................................................ 5-65
Brake assist (if equipped)............................................................ 5-66
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) (if equipped) .............. 5-66
Vehicle security............................................................................................ 5-67
Cold weather driving ............................................................................... 5-67
Battery...................................................................................................... 5-68
Engine coolant.................................................................................... 5-68
Tyre equipment.................................................................................. 5-68
Special winter equipment .......................................................... 5-68
Parking brake....................................................................................... 5-68
Corrosion protection ..................................................................... 5-68
5-Chapter 5.indd 3
2021/01/13 02:16:35 PM
BREAK-IN SCHEDULE
During the first 1,600 km (1,000 miles), follow
these recommendations to obtain maximum
engine performance and ensure the future
reliability and economy of your new vehicle.
Failure to follow these recommendations may
result in shortened engine life and reduced
engine performance.
y
Do not drive at a constant speed, either fast
or slow, for long periods of time.
y
Do not run the engine over 4,000 rpm.
y
Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear.
y
Do not start quickly.
y
Do not brake hard as much as possible.
y
Do not tow a trailer for at least the first 800
km (500 miles).
5-4
BEFORE STARTING ENGINE
PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING
AND DRIVING
WARNING:
The driving characteristics of your vehicle
will change remarkably by any additional
load and its distribution, as well as by adding
optional equipment (trailer coupling, roof
rack, etc.). Your driving style and speed must
be adjusted according to the circumstances.
Especially when carrying heavy loads, your
speed must be reduced adequately.
y
Make sure the area around the vehicle is
clear.
y
Check fluid levels such as engine oil, coolant, brake (and clutch) fluid, window washer
fluid as frequently as possible, at least
whenever you refuel.
y
Visually inspect tyres for their appearance
and condition. Measure and check the tyre
pressure for proper inflation.
y
Check that all windows and lights are clean.
y
Adjust the seat and head restraint positions.
y
Adjust the inside and outside rearview mirror positions.
y
Fasten your seat belt and ask all passengers
to do the same.
y
Check that all doors are closed.
y
Check the operation of the warning lights
when the ignition switch is placed in the
“ON” position.
y
Maintenance items in the “8. Maintenance
and do-it-yourself” section should be
checked periodically.
WARNING:
y
Never leave children or adults who would
normally require the support of others
alone in your vehicle. Pets should not be
left alone either. They could unknowingly
activate switches or controls and
inadvertently become involved in a
serious accident and injure themselves.
On hot, sunny days, temperatures in a
closed vehicle could quickly become high
enough to cause severe or possibly fatal
illness to people or animals.
y
Properly secure all cargo to help prevent
it from sliding or shifting. Do not place
cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a
sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo
could cause personal injury.
NOTE:
During the first few months after purchasing
a new vehicle, if you smell strong odors of
Volatile Organic Compounds (VOCs) inside
the vehicle, ventilate the passenger compartment thoroughly. Open all the windows
before entering or while in the vehicle.
In addition, when the temperature in the
passenger compartment rises, or when the
vehicle is parked in direct sunlight for a period
of time, turn off the air recirculation mode of
the air conditioner and/or open the windows
to allow sufficient fresh air into the passenger
compartment.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 4
2021/01/13 02:16:35 PM
TURBOCHARGER SYSTEM (if
equipped)
EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide)
WARNING:
y
Do not breathe exhaust gas; it contains
colorless and odorless carbon monoxide.
Carbon monoxide is dangerous. It can
cause unconsciousness or death.
y
If you suspect that exhaust fumes
are entering the vehicle, drive with all
windows fully open, and have the vehicle
inspected immediately.
ment.
—
You notice a change in the sound of
the exhaust system.
—
You have had an accident involving
damage to the exhaust system,
underbody, or rear of the vehicle.
The turbocharger system uses engine oil
for lubrication and cooling of its rotating
components. The turbocharger turbine turns
at extremely high speeds and it can reach an
extremely high temperature. It is essential
to maintain a flow of clean oil through the
turbocharger system. A sudden interruption to
the oil supply may cause a malfunction in the
turbocharger.
To ensure prolonged life and performance of
the turbocharger, it is essential to comply with
the following maintenance procedure:
y
Do not run the engine in closed spaces
such as a garage.
y
Do not park the vehicle with the engine
running for an extended period of time.
y
y
If electrical wiring or other cable
connections must pass to a trailer
through the seal of the body, follow the
manufacturer’s recommendations to
prevent carbon monoxide entry into the
vehicle.
Change the engine oil of the turbocharged diesel engine as prescribed. See
the separately provided maintenance
booklet for additional information.
y
Use only the recommended engine oil.
For details, see "Recommended fluids/
lubricants and capacities" (P.9-2).
y
If the engine has been operating at high
rpm for an extended period of time, let it
idle for a few minutes prior to shutdown.
y
Do not accelerate the engine to high rpm
immediately after starting it.
y
When starting the engine at ambient
temperatures below −5°C (23°F), an engine
protection mode may be activated. During
this time, the engine output is reduced.
The engine protection mode is switched
off automatically after a maximum of 3
minutes (provided the accelerator pedal
is released completely).
y
y
If a special body or other equipment
is added for recreational or other
usage,
follow
the
manufacturer’s
recommendation to prevent carbon
monoxide entry into the vehicle. (Some
recreational vehicle appliances such as
stoves, refrigerators, heaters, etc. may
also generate carbon monoxide.)
The exhaust system and body should
be inspected by a qualified mechanic
whenever:
—
Your vehicle is raised while being serviced.
—
You suspect that exhaust fumes are
entering into the passenger compart-
CAUTION:
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 5
5-5
2021/01/13 02:16:35 PM
ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD
DRIVING PRECAUTIONS
Pick-up vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles.
They have higher ground clearance than
passenger cars to make them capable of
performing in a wide variety of on-pavement
and off-road applications. This gives them a
higher center of gravity than ordinary cars.
An advantage of higher ground clearance
is a better view of the road, allowing you to
anticipate problems. However, they are not
designed for cornering at the same speeds as
conventional passenger cars any more than
low-slung sports cars are designed to perform
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. If
at all possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt
maneuvers, particularly at high speeds. As with
other vehicles of this type, failure to operate this
vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or
vehicle rollover.
For information about driving using Four-Wheel
Drive (4WD) (if equipped), see "Four-wheel Drive
(4WD)" (P.5-16).
forward or backward.
y
WARNING:
y
Do not drive across steep slopes. Instead
drive either straight up or straight down
the slopes. Off-road vehicles can tip over
sideways much more easily than they can
5-6
y
Do not grip the inside or spokes of the
steering wheel when driving off-road. The
steering wheel could move suddenly and
injure your hands. Instead drive with your
fingers and thumbs on the outside of the
rim.
Do not shift ranges while driving on
downhill grades as this could cause loss
of control of the vehicle.
y
Stay alert when driving to the top of a hill.
At the top there could be a drop-off or
other hazard that could cause an accident.
y
Before operating the vehicle, ensure that
the driver and all passengers have their
seat belts fastened.
y
If your engine stalls or you cannot make
it to the top of a steep hill, never attempt
to turn around. Your vehicle could tip
or roll over. Always back straight down
in R (Reverse) range. Never back down
in N (Neutral) or with the clutch pedal
depressed (MT model) using only the
brake, as this could cause loss of control.
y
Always drive with the floor mats in place
as the floor may became hot.
y
Lower your speed when encountering
strong crosswinds. With a higher center of
gravity, your NISSAN is more affected by
strong side winds. Slower speeds ensure
better vehicle control.
y
Do not drive beyond the performance
capability of the tyres, even with 4WD
engaged.
y
Do not attempt to raise two wheels off
the ground and shift the transmission
to any drive or reverse position with the
engine running. Doing so may result in
drivetrain damage or unexpected vehicle
movement which could result in serious
vehicle damage or personal injury.
y
Do not attempt to test a 4WD equipped
vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer or
similar equipment even if the other two
wheels are raised off the ground. Make
sure you inform test facility personnel
that your vehicle is equipped with 4WD
before it is placed on a dynamometer.
y
Please observe the following precautions:
Drive carefully when off the road and
avoid dangerous areas. Every person
who drives or rides in this vehicle should
be seated with their seat belt fastened.
This will keep you and your passengers in
position when driving over rough terrain.
vehicle with tyres larger than specified in
this manual. This could cause your vehicle
to roll over.
y
DRIVING SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
y
Many hills are too steep for any vehicle.
If you drive up them, you may stall. If you
drive down them, you may not be able
to control your speed. If you drive across
them, you may roll over.
Heavy braking going down a hill could
cause your brakes to overheat and
fade, resulting in loss of control and an
accident. Apply brakes lightly and use a
low range to control your speed.
y
Unsecured cargo can be thrown around
when driving over rough terrain. Properly
secure all cargo so it will not be thrown
forward and cause injury to you or your
passengers.
y
To avoid raising the center of gravity
excessively, do not exceed the rated
capacity of the roof rack (if equipped) and
evenly distribute the load. Secure heavy
loads in the cargo area as far forward
and as low as possible. Do not equip the
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 6
2021/01/13 02:16:35 PM
CARE WHEN DRIVING
Using the wrong test equipment may
result in drivetrain damage or unexpected
vehicle movement which could result in
serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
information in a separate maintenance
booklet.
y
Rinse the underside of the vehicle with
fresh water after driving through mud or
sand. Remove any brush or sticks that are
trapped.
Driving your vehicle to fit the circumstances
is essential for your safety and comfort. As a
driver, you should be the one who knows best
how to drive in the given circumstances.
y
When a wheel is off the ground due to
an unlevel surface, do not spin the wheel
excessively.
y
Accelerating quickly, sharp steering
maneuvers or sudden braking may cause
loss of control.
y
If at all possible, avoid sharp turning
maneuvers, particularly at high speeds.
Your vehicle has a higher center of gravity
than a conventional passenger car. The
vehicle is not designed for cornering
at the same speeds as conventional
passenger cars. Failure to operate this
vehicle correctly could result in loss of
control and/or a rollover accident.
LOADING LUGGAGE
y
Always use tyres of the same type, size,
brand, construction (bias, bias-belted
or radial), and tread pattern on all four
wheels. Install tyre chains on the rear
wheels when driving on slippery roads
and drive carefully.
Avoid accelerating or stopping suddenly.
y
Avoid sharp turning or lane changing suddenly.
y
Avoid following too close to the vehicle in
front.
y
y
Be sure to check the brakes immediately
after driving in mud or water. See "Brake
system" (P.5-65) for wet brakes.
y
Avoid parking your vehicle on steep hills.
If you get out of the vehicle and it rolls
forward, backward or sideways, you could
be injured.
y
Whenever you drive off-road through
sand, mud or water as deep as the
wheel hub, more frequent maintenance
may be required. See the maintenance
ENGINE COLD START PERIOD
Due to the higher engine speeds, when the
engine is cold, extra caution must be exercised
when selecting a gear during the engine warmup period after starting the engine.
Loads and their distribution and the attachment
of equipment (roof baggage carriers, etc.) will
considerably change the driving characteristics
of the vehicle. Your driving style and speed must
be adjusted according to the circumstances.
DRIVING IN WET CONDITIONS
When water covers the road surface with water
puddles, small water streams, etc., reduce speed
to prevent hydroplaning which can cause
skidding and loss of control. Worn tyres will
increase this risk.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 7
5-7
2021/01/13 02:16:35 PM
IGNITION SWITCH (models without
Intelligent Key system)
DRIVING IN WINTER CONDITIONS
y
Drive cautiously.
y
Avoid accelerating or stopping suddenly.
y
Avoid sharp turning or lane changing suddenly.
y
Avoid sudden steering.
y
Avoid following too close to the vehicle in
front.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (AT)
WARNING:
Never remove the key or turn the ignition
switch to the “LOCK” position while driving.
The steering wheel will lock. This will cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle and
could result in serious vehicle damage or
personal injury.
MANUAL TRANSMISSION (MT)
SSD0392
SSD0392
The switch includes an anti-theft steering lock
device.
The ignition key can only be removed when the
switch is in the “LOCK” normal parking position
(0).
There is an “OFF” position in between “LOCK”
and “ACC”, although it does not show on the
lock cylinder.
To lock the steering wheel, remove the key.
To unlock the steering wheel, insert the key
and turn it gently while rotating the steering
wheel slightly right and left.
The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition
switch cannot be turned to the “LOCK” position
until the shift lever is moved to the “P” (Park)
position. When moving the ignition switch to
the “LOCK” position, to remove the key from the
ignition switch, make sure the shift lever is in
the “P” (Park) position.
When the ignition switch cannot be turned to
the “LOCK” position:
1.
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
2.
Turn the ignition switch slightly in the “ON”
direction.
3.
Place the ignition switch in the “LOCK”
position.
4.
Remove the key.
If the ignition switch is turned to the “LOCK”
position, the shift lever cannot be moved
from the “P” (Park) position. The shift lever can
be moved if the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position with the foot brake pedal depressed.
The “OFF” position is between the “LOCK” and
“ON” positions, although it is not marked on the
ignition switch.
5-8
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 8
2021/01/13 02:16:36 PM
KEY POSITIONS
LOCK (Normal parking position) (0):
The ignition key can only be removed at this
position.
OFF (1):
The engine can be turned off without locking
the steering wheel.
ACC (Accessories) (2):
This position activates electrical accessories
such as the radio when the engine is not
running.
ON (Normal operating position) (3):
This position turns on the ignition system and
electrical accessories.
START (4):
This position starts the engine. As soon as the
engine has started, release the key immediately.
It will automatically return to the “ON” position.
PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
(models with Intelligent Key
system)
PRECAUTIONS ON PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH OPERATION
Operating range
WARNING:
Do not operate the push-button ignition
switch while driving the vehicle except in an
emergency. (The engine will stop when the
ignition switch is pushed 3 consecutive times
or the ignition switch is pushed and held for
more than 2 seconds.) The steering wheel
may lock and could cause the driver to lose
control of the vehicle. This could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM
The Intelligent Key system can operate the
ignition switch without taking the key out from
your pocket or bag. The operating environment
and/or conditions may affect the Intelligent Key
system operation.
Some indicators and warnings for operation
are displayed in the vehicle information display.
(See "Vehicle information display (models with
color display)" (P.2-18).)
CAUTION:
JVS0442X
The Intelligent Key can only be used for starting
the engine when the Intelligent Key is within the
specified operating range as illustrated.
When the Intelligent Key battery is almost
discharged or strong radio waves are present
near the operating location, the Intelligent Key
system’s operating range becomes narrower
and may not function properly.
If the Intelligent Key is within the operating
range, it is possible for anyone, even someone
who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push
the ignition switch to start the engine.
y
Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with
you when operating the vehicle.
y
The truck box area is not included in the operating range of the engine start function.
y
Never leave the Intelligent Key inside the
vehicle when you leave the vehicle.
y
y
If the vehicle battery is discharged, the
ignition switch cannot be switched from
the “LOCK” position, and if the steering
lock is engaged, the steering wheel
cannot be moved. Charge the battery as
soon as possible. (See "Jump starting"
(P.6-7).)
If the Intelligent Key is placed on the
instrument panel, inside the glove box,
door pocket or the corner of the interior
compartment, the Intelligent Key may not
function.
y
If the Intelligent Key is placed near the door
or window outside the vehicle, the Intelligent Key may function.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 9
5-9
2021/01/13 02:16:36 PM
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (AT)
STEERING LOCK
The ignition lock is designed so that the ignition
switch cannot be switched to the “LOCK”
position until the shift lever is moved to the
“P” (Park) position. When pushing the ignition
switch to the “OFF” position, make sure the shift
lever is in the “P” (Park) position.
The ignition switch is equipped with an antitheft steering lock device.
When the ignition switch cannot be switched to
the “LOCK” position:
1.
“Shift to Park” warning appears on the
vehicle information display and a chime
sounds.
2.
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
3.
If the ignition switch is in the “ACC” position,
PUSH warning appears on the vehicle
information display.
4.
Push the ignition switch. The ignition switch
is switched to the “OFF” position.
5.
If the ignition switch is switched to the “LOCK”
position, the shift lever cannot be moved
from the “P” (Park) position. The shift lever can
be moved if the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position with the foot brake pedal depressed.
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position where the ignition switch position
indicator will not illuminate.
2.
Open or close the door. The ignition switch
turns to the “LOCK” position.
3.
Turn the steering wheel 1/6 of a turn to the
right or left from the straight up position.
y
Use electrical accessories with the engine
running to avoid discharging the vehicle
battery. If you must use accessories while
the engine is not running, do not use
them for extended periods of time and do
not use multiple electrical accessories at
the same time.
To unlock steering wheel
Push the ignition switch, and the steering wheel
will be automatically unlocked.
CAUTION:
y
If the battery of the vehicle is discharged,
the push-button ignition switch cannot
be switched from the “LOCK” position.
y
If the steering lock release malfunction
indicator (if equipped) appears in the
vehicle information display, push the
ignition switch again while rotating the
steering wheel slightly to the right and
left. (See "Vehicle information display
(models with color display)" (P.2-18).)
IGNITION SWITCH POSITIONS
WARNING:
Never place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position while driving. The steering wheel
may lock and cause the driver to lose control
of the vehicle, resulting in serious vehicle
damage or personal injury.
5-10
Do not leave the vehicle for extended
periods of time when the ignition switch is
in the “ON” position and the engine is not
running. This can discharge the battery.
To lock steering wheel
Open the door. The ignition switch turns to
the “LOCK” position.
For warnings and indicators on the vehicle
information display, see "Vehicle information
display (models with color display)" (P.2-18).
CAUTION:
y
JVS0241X
When the ignition switch is pushed without
depressing the brake pedal (automatic
transmission model) or the clutch pedal
(manual transmission model), the ignition
switch position will change as follows:
y
Push once to change to “ACC”.
y
Push two times to change to “ON”.
y
Push three times to change to “OFF”.
y
Push four times to return to “ACC”.
y
Open or close any door to return to “LOCK”
from the “OFF” position.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 10
2021/01/13 02:16:36 PM
LOCK position
INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY DISCHARGE
The ignition switch and steering lock can only
be locked at this position.
NOTE:
y
When the ignition switch is pushed to
the “ACC” or “ON” position or the engine
is started by the above procedures, the
Key Battery Low warning appears on
the vehicle information display even if
the Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle.
This is not a malfunction. To turn off the
warning, touch the ignition switch with
the Intelligent Key again.
y
If the Key Battery Low warning appears
on the vehicle information display,
replace the battery as soon as possible.
(See "Battery" (P.8-18).)
The ignition switch will be unlocked when it is
pushed to the “ACC” position while carrying the
Intelligent Key.
ACC position
The electrical accessory power activates at this
position without the engine turned on.
ON position
The ignition system and the electrical accessory
power activate at this position without the
engine turned on.
The “ON” position has a battery saver feature
that will place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position, if the vehicle is not running, after some
time under the following conditions:
y
all doors are closed.
y
shift lever is in “P” (Park) position (AT model)
or “N” (Neutral) position (MT model).
The battery saver feature will be cancelled if any
of the following occur:
y
any door is opened.
y
shift lever is moved out of the “P” (Park)
position (AT model).
y
ignition switch changes position.
OFF position
The engine is turned off with the steering wheel
unlocked.
SSD0944
If the battery of the Intelligent Key is discharged,
or environmental conditions interfere with
the Intelligent Key operation, start the engine
according to the following procedure:
1.
Automatic Transmission (AT) model:
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
Manual Transmission (MT) model:
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
2.
Firmly depress the brake pedal.
3.
Touch the ignition switch with the Intelligent
Key as illustrated. (A chime will sound.)
4.
Push the ignition switch while depressing
the brake pedal (AT model) or the clutch
pedal (MT model) within 10 seconds after
the chime sounds. The engine will start.
After step 3 is performed, when the ignition
switch is pushed without depressing the brake
pedal (AT model) or the clutch pedal (MT model),
the ignition switch position will change to “ACC”.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 11
5-11
2021/01/13 02:16:36 PM
STARTING ENGINE (models
without Intelligent Key system)
1.
Apply the parking brake.
2.
Depress the foot brake pedal.
3.
Automatic Transmission (AT) model:
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) or the
“N” (Neutral) position.
The starter is designed to operate only
when the shift lever is in the proper position.
Manual Transmission (MT) model:
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral) position and depress the clutch pedal to the
floor while starting the engine.
4.
Crank the engine with your foot off the
accelerator pedal by turning the ignition
switch to the “START” position.
STARTING ENGINE (models with
Intelligent Key system)
y
6.
If it becomes necessary to start the engine
with a booster battery and jumper cables,
the instructions and cautions contained
in the “6. In case of emergency” section
should be carefully followed.
1.
Apply the parking brake.
2.
Automatic Transmission (AT) model:
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) or the
“N” (Neutral) position.
The starter is designed to operate only
when the shift lever is in the proper position.
Allow the engine to idle for at least 30
seconds after starting the engine to warmup. Drive at moderate speeds for a short
distance first, especially in cold weather.
Manual Transmission (MT) model:
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
CAUTION:
Do not leave the vehicle unattended while the
engine is warming up.
The Intelligent Key must be carried when
operating the ignition switch.
3.
Turn the ignition switch to the “ON” position
and wait until the glow plug indicator light
turns off.
5.
CAUTION:
y
Wait until the glow plug indicator light
goes out.
Immediately release the ignition switch
when the engine starts. If the engine
starts, but fails to run, repeat the above
procedures.
If the engine is very hard to start in extremely cold or hot weather, depress the
accelerator pedal and hold it to help start
the engine.
Do not operate the starter for more than
15 seconds at a time. If the engine does
not start, turn the ignition switch off and
wait 20 seconds before cranking the
engine again. Otherwise, the starter could
be damaged.
5-12
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position.
Firmly depress the brake pedal (AT model)
or the clutch pedal (MT model) and push the
ignition switch to start the engine.
If the engine is already warmed up, the
glow plug indicator light may not illuminate
when the engine is started.
To start the engine immediately, push and
release the ignition switch while depressing
the brake pedal or clutch pedal with the
ignition switch in any position.
4.
Immediately release the ignition switch
when the engine starts. If the engine
starts, but fails to run, repeat the above
procedures.
If the engine is very hard to start in extremely cold or hot weather, depress the accelerator pedal and hold it. Push the ignition
switch for up to 15 seconds while holding.
Release the accelerator pedal when the
engine starts.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 12
2021/01/13 02:16:36 PM
DRIVING VEHICLE
CAUTION:
y
As soon as the engine has started, release
the ignition switch immediately.
y
Do not operate the starter for more than
15 seconds at a time. If the engine does
not start, push the ignition switch to the
“OFF” position and wait 20 seconds before
cranking the engine again. Otherwise, the
starter could be damaged.
y
5.
If it becomes necessary to start the engine
with a booster battery and jumper cables,
the instructions and cautions contained
in the “6. In case of emergency” section
should be carefully followed.
Allow the engine to idle for at least 30
seconds after starting the engine to warmup. Drive at moderate speeds for a short
distance first, especially in cold weather.
CAUTION:
Do not leave the vehicle unattended while the
engine is warming up.
6.
To stop the engine, move the shift lever to
the “P” (Park) (AT model) or “N” (Neutral) (MT
model) position, apply the parking brake,
and push the ignition switch to the “OFF”
position.
DRIVING WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (AT)
The Automatic Transmission (AT) in your vehicle
is electronically controlled to produce maximum
power and smooth operation.
The recommended operating procedures for
this transmission are shown on the following
pages. Follow these procedures for maximum
vehicle performance and driving enjoyment.
y
Shift into the “P” (Park) position and apply
the parking brake when at a standstill for
longer than a short waiting period.
y
Keep the engine at idling speed while
shifting from the “N” (Neutral) position to
any driving position.
y
When stopping the vehicle on an
uphill grade, do not hold the vehicle by
depressing the accelerator pedal. The
foot brake pedal should be depressed in
this situation.
CAUTION:
y
The cold engine idle speed is high, so
use caution when shifting into a forward
or reverse gear before the engine has
warmed up.
y
Avoid revving up the engine while the
vehicle is stopped. This could cause
unexpected vehicle movement.
y
Do not downshift abruptly on slippery
roads. This may cause a loss of control.
y
Never shift to either the “P” (Park) or “R”
(Reverse) position while the vehicle is
moving forward and “P” (Park) or “D”
(Drive) position while the vehicle is moving
rearward. This could cause an accident or
damage the transmission.
y
Except in an emergency, do not shift to
the “N” (Neutral) position while driving.
Coasting with the transmission in the
“N” (Neutral) position may cause serious
damage to the transmission.
y
Start the engine in either the “P” (Park) or
“N” (Neutral) position. The engine will not
start in any other gear position. If it does,
have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN
dealer.
Starting vehicle
1.
After starting the engine, fully depress the
foot brake pedal before attempting to move
the shift lever out of the “P” (Park) position.
2.
Keep the foot brake pedal depressed and
move the shift lever into a driving position.
3.
Release the parking brake, the foot brake
pedal, and then gradually start the vehicle
in motion.
The AT is designed so the foot brake pedal
MUST be depressed before shifting from the
“P” (Park) position to any driving position
while the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
The shift lever cannot be moved out of the “P”
(Park) position and into any of the other gear
positions if the ignition switch is placed in the
“LOCK”, “OFF” or “ACC” position.
CAUTION:
y
DEPRESS THE FOOT BRAKE PEDAL Shifting the shift lever to “D”, “R” or manual
shift mode without depressing the foot
brake pedal causes the vehicle to move
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 13
5-13
2021/01/13 02:16:36 PM
slowly when the engine is running. Make
sure the foot brake pedal is depressed
fully and the vehicle is stopped before
shifting the shift lever.
y
y
y
MAKE SURE OF THE SHIFT LEVER POSITION
- Make sure the shift lever is in the desired
position. “D” and manual shift mode are
used to move forward and “R” to back
up. Depress the accelerator pedal to start
the vehicle and merge with traffic (avoid
abrupt starting and spinning the wheels).
y
WARM UP THE ENGINE - Due to the higher
idle speeds when the engine is cold, extra
caution must be exercised when shifting
the shift lever into the driving position
immediately after starting the engine.
y
PARKING THE VEHICLE - Depress the foot
brake pedal and, once the vehicle stops,
move the shift lever into the “P” (Park)
position, pull the parking brake lever and
release the foot brake pedal.
Shifting
:
Push the button
brake pedal
while depressing the
:
Push the button
:
Just move the shift lever
WARNING:
Apply the parking brake if the shift lever
is in any position while the engine is not
running. Failure to do so could cause the
vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away
and result in serious personal injury or
property damage.
If the shift lever cannot be moved from
the “P” (Park) position while the engine
is running and the foot brake pedal is
depressed, the stop lights may not work.
Malfunctioning stop lights could cause an
accident injuring yourself and others.
After starting the engine, fully depress the foot
brake pedal, push the shift lever button and
move the shift lever out of the “P” (Park) position.
If the ignition switch is placed in the “OFF” or
“ACC” position for any reason while the shift
lever is in any positions other than the “P” (Park)
position, the ignition switch cannot be placed in
the “LOCK” position.
If the ignition switch cannot be placed in the
“LOCK” position, perform the following steps:
JVS00443X
5-14
1.
Apply the parking brake.
2.
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position
while depressing the foot brake pedal.
3.
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
4.
Place the ignition switch in the “LOCK”
position.
P (Park):
Use this position when the vehicle is parked or
when starting the engine. Make sure that the
vehicle is completely stopped and move the
shift lever into the “P” (Park) position. Apply
the parking brake. When parking on a hill, first
depress the foot brake pedal, apply the parking
brake, and then move the shift lever into the “P”
(Park) position.
R (Reverse):
Use this position to back up. Make sure that the
vehicle is completely stopped before selecting
the “R” (Reverse) position.
N (Neutral):
Neither the forward nor reverse gear is engaged.
The engine can be started in this position. You
may shift to the “N” (Neutral) position and restart
a stalled engine while the vehicle is moving.
D (Drive):
Use this position for all normal forward driving.
Manual shift mode
When the shift lever is shifted to the manual
shift gate and moved up or down while driving,
the transmission enters the manual shift mode.
Shift range can be selected manually.
When shifting up, move the shift lever to the +
(up) side. The transmission shifts to the higher
range.
When shifting down, move the shift lever to
the − (down) side. The transmission shifts to the
lower range.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 14
2021/01/13 02:16:37 PM
When canceling the manual shift mode, return
the shift lever to the “D” (Drive) position. The
transmission returns to the normal driving
mode.
In the manual shift mode, the shift range is
displayed in the vehicle information display
between the speedometer and tachometer.
helps maintain driving performance and
reduces the chance of vehicle damage or
loss of control.
y
Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows:
1
2
M
M
3
M
M
4
5
M
6
M
M
7
7 (7th):
M
Use this position for all normal forward driving
at highway speeds.
6 (6th) and M5 (5th):
M
Use these positions when driving up long
slopes, or for engine braking when driving down
long slopes.
4 (4th), M3 (3rd) and M2 (2nd):
M
Use these positions for hill climbing or engine
braking on downhill grades.
1 (1st):
M
y
When the transmission does not shift
to the selected gear, the Automatic
Transmission (AT) position indicator light
(in the vehicle information display) will
blink and the buzzer will sound.
In the manual shift mode, the transmission
automatically shifts down to 1st gear
before the vehicle comes to a stop. When
accelerating again, it is necessary to shift
up to the desired range.
Accelerator downshift - in D (Drive)
position
For passing or climbing hills, depress the
accelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts the
transmission down into a lower gear, depending
on the vehicle speed.
Remember not to drive at high speeds for
extended periods of time in lower than 7th
gear. This reduces fuel economy.
y
Moving the shift lever to the same side twice
will shift the ranges in succession. However,
if this motion is rapidly done, the second
shifting may not be completed properly.
y
In the manual shift mode, the transmission
may not shift to the selected gear or may
automatically shift to the other gear. This
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF” or
“LOCK” position.
2.
Apply the parking brake.
3.
Push down the shift lock release button
4.
Push and hold the shift lever button and
move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position while holding down the shift lock
release button .
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position to
release the steering wheel lock.
The vehicle may be moved, by pushing, to the
desired location.
If the shift lever cannot be moved out of the “P”
(Park) position, have a NISSAN dealer check the
AT system as soon as possible.
Fail-safe
JVS0444X
If the battery is discharged, the shift lever may
not be moved from the “P” (Park) position even
with the brake pedal depressed.
If the vehicle is driven under extreme conditions, such as excessive wheel spinning and
subsequent hard braking, the fail-safe system may be activated. This will occur even if
all electrical circuits are functioning properly.
In this case, place the ignition switch in the
“OFF” position and wait for 3 seconds. Then
place the ignition switch back in the “ON” position. The vehicle should return to its normal
operating condition. If it does not return to its
normal operating condition, have a NISSAN
dealer check the transmission and repair it if
necessary.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 15
.
When the fail-safe operation occurs, the AT will
be locked in any of the forward gears depending
on conditions.
Shift lock release
Use this position when climbing steep hills
slowly or driving slowly through deep snow, or
for maximum engine braking on steep downhill
grades.
y
To release the shift lock, perform the following
procedure:
5-15
2021/01/13 02:16:37 PM
FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE (4WD) (if
equipped)
DRIVING WITH MANUAL TRANSMISSION
(MT)
WARNING:
y
Do not downshift abruptly on slippery
roads. This may cause a loss of control.
y
Do not over-rev the engine when shifting
to a lower gear. This may cause a loss of
vehicle control or engine damage.
CAUTION:
y
Do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal
while driving. This may damage the clutch
system.
y
Fully depress the clutch pedal before
shifting to help prevent transmission
damage.
y
Stop the vehicle completely before
shifting into the “R” (Reverse) position.
y
When the vehicle is stopped for a period
of time, for example, waiting at stoplights,
shift to the “N” (Neutral) position and
release the clutch pedal with the foot
brake pedal depressed.
Starting vehicle
1.
2.
After starting the engine, depress the
clutch pedal to the floor and move the shift
lever to the “1” (1st), “2” (2nd) or “R” (Reverse)
position. NISSAN recommends to start the
vehicle in the 2nd gear on level, flat ground
and in the unladen condition.
Slowly depress the accelerator pedal,
releasing the clutch pedal and parking
brake at the same time.
5-16
Shifting gear
To change gears, or when upshifting or
downshifting, fully depress the clutch pedal,
shift into the appropriate gear, then slowly and
smoothly release the clutch pedal.
Start the vehicle in the “1” (1st) or “2” (2nd)
position and shift to the “3” (3rd), “4” (4th), “5”
(5th) and “6” (6th) gear in sequence according to
the vehicle speed.
WARNING:
y
Do not attempt to raise two wheels off
the ground and shift the transmission
to any drive or reverse position with the
engine running. Doing so may result in
drivetrain damage or unexpected vehicle
movement which could result in serious
vehicle damage or personal injury.
y
Do not attempt to test a 4WD equipped
vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer or
similar equipment even if the other two
wheels are raised off the ground. Make
sure you inform test facility personnel
that your vehicle is equipped with 4WD
before it is placed on a dynamometer.
Using the wrong test equipment may
result in drivetrain damage or unexpected
vehicle movement which could result in
serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
y
Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or
4LO position on dry hard surface roads.
Driving on dry, hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO
may cause unnecessary noise, tyre wear
and increased fuel consumption.
If it is difficult to move the shift lever into the
“R” (Reverse) or “1” (1st) position, shift to the “N”
(Neutral) position, and then release the clutch
pedal once. Fully depress the clutch pedal again
and shift into “R” or “1”.
CAUTION:
JVS0450X
To back up, depress the shift lever and then
move it to the “R” (Reverse) position after the
vehicle has completely stopped.
If the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning
light turns on when driving on dry hard
surface roads:
— in the 4H position, shift the 4WD mode
switch to 2WD.
— in the 4LO position, stop the vehicle
and shift the transmission lever to the
“N” (Neutral) position with the brake
pedal depressed and shift the 4WD
mode switch to 2WD.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 16
2021/01/13 02:16:37 PM
If the 4WD warning light is still on after
the above operation, have your vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible.
y
The transfer case may be damaged if you
continue driving with the 4WD warning
light blinking.
See "On-pavement and off-road driving
precautions" (P.5-6) for other precautions.
PART TIME 4WD SYSTEM
The part time 4WD system provides three drive
modes: 2WD, 4H and 4LO. The desired drive
mode can be selected using the 4WD mode
switch according to the driving conditions.
4WD mode switch
4WD mode indicator
JVS0447X
JVS0445X
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 17
5-17
2021/01/13 02:16:37 PM
Indicator
4WD mode
switch
Wheels driven
2WD
Rear wheels
-
Four wheels
-
Neutral
Blinking
Four wheels
Stay on*
4WD mode
4LO
4H
4LO
Use conditions
Operation of 4WD mode switch
(See "4WD mode switch operation" (P.5-19).)
For driving on dry,
paved roads.
Shifting between the 2WD and 4H drive modes can be done
while driving.
For driving on rough, The indicator will change when the drive mode is changed.
Shifting between the 2WD and 4H modes must be performed
sandy or snowat speed below 100 km/h (60 MPH).
covered roads.
Shifting between the 4H and 4LO drive modes:
The 4LO indicator
y Stop the vehicle, depress the clutch pedal (MT models) and
blinks when shifting
the brake pedal and shift the shift lever to the N (Neutral)
between 4H and 4LO.
position.
For use when
y Depress and turn the 4WD mode switch. The 4WD mode
maximum power and
switch will not shift between 4H and 4LO if the transmission
traction are required
is not in the N (Neutral) position or the vehicle is moving.
at low speeds (for
y Wait for the 4LO indicator to stop blinking and stay on or off
example, on steep
before shifting your transmission into gear or releasing the
grades or rocky,
clutch pedal (MT models).
sandy, muddy roads).
*: When the 4LO position is selected, the VDC system is disabled and the VDC off indicator light illuminates. See "Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off
indicator light" (P.2-19).
WARNING:
AT model: If the 4WD mode indicator is “OFF”
or the ATP warning light is “ON”, this indicates
that the automatic transmission P (Park) position will not function and could result in the
vehicle moving unexpectedly, causing serious
personal injury or property damage. Always
set the parking brake.
Do not move the shift lever (AT model) or
release the clutch pedal (MT model) when
the 4LO indicator is blinking. Failure to
do this may cause the gears to grind and
damaging the powertrain.
3.
y
MT model: Do not accelerate rapidly from
a stopped position when the 4LO indicator
is blinking. Drive straight ahead at a low
speed until the 4LO indicator is lit. The 4LO
indicator blinks when shifting between
4LO and 4H.
The transfer case 4WD mode switch is used to
select either Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) or FourWheel Drive (4WD) depending on the driving
conditions. Turn the 4WD mode switch to select
a drive mode (2WD, 4H or 4LO).
y
If the 4WD warning light comes on,
perform the following procedure:
1.
Turn off the engine.
2.
Start the engine.
y
CAUTION:
To avoid vehicle damage:
y
Do not operate the 4WD mode switch
when cornering, reversing or if the rear
wheels are spinning freely. The vehicle
must be moving straight ahead.
5-18
Check if the 4WD warning light comes on.
If the 4WD warning light is still on after following the above procedure, have the system
checked and serviced immediately by a NISSAN dealer.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 18
2021/01/13 02:16:37 PM
To change into or out of 4LO mode:
1.
The vehicle MUST BE standing still.
2.
Depress the clutch pedal (MT model) and
the brake pedal and move the shift lever to
N (Neutral).
3.
Depress and turn the 4WD mode switch to
change into or out of 4LO.
y
When parking, apply the parking brake
before stopping the engine and make
sure that the 4WD mode indicator is on
and that the ATP warning light or ATP
warning message is off, otherwise, the
vehicle could unexpectedly move even
if the automatic transmission is in the P
(Park) position.
WARNING:
y
The 4LO indicator must stop blinking and
remain on or turn off before shifting the
transmission into gear. The vehicle may
move unexpectedly if the shift lever is
shifted from the N (Neutral) position to
any other gear while the 4LO indicator is
blinking.
y
y
The 4WD mode switch can be turned
between 2WD and 4H while driving
straight ahead. Do not turn the 4WD mode
switch while making a turn or reversing.
y
Do not turn the 4WD mode switch
between 2WD and 4H while driving on
steep downhill grades. Use the engine
brake and low transmission gears for
engine braking.
y
Do not turn the 4WD mode switch
between 2WD and 4H with the rear wheels
spinning.
y
y
CAUTION:
y
Never turn the 4WD mode switch between
4LO and 4H while driving.
y
The 4H drive mode provides greater power
and traction. Avoid excessive speed as it
will cause increased fuel consumption
and higher oil temperatures, and could
damage power train components. Speeds
over 100 km/h (60 MPH) in 4H are not
recommended.
The 4LO drive mode provides maximum
power and traction. Avoid raising vehicle
speed excessively. The maximum speed is
approximately 50 km/h (30 MPH).
Do not drive the vehicle in 4H or 4LO
mode on dry, hard surfaced roads. This
may cause unnecessary noise and tyre
wear. NISSAN recommends driving in 2WD
under these conditions.
It is not possible to shift the 4WD transfer
case between 4H and 4LO at low ambient
temperatures when the engine is cold.
Doing so may cause the 4LO indicator to
blink. Wait until the 4WD transfer case has
reached operational temperature (after
driving for a while) before using the 4WD
mode switch to change between 4H and
4LO.
If the vehicle gets stuck
y
Place stones or wooden blocks under the
tyres to free the vehicle.
y
Set the 4WD mode switch to 4H or 4LO.
y
Use the rear differential locking system (if
equipped). Turn the switch on while the
vehicle is stationary and apply the throttle
to try to free the vehicle.
y
If it is difficult to free the vehicle, drive the
vehicle forwards and backwards to increase
the momentum. If the vehicle is stuck deep
in mud, tyre chains may be effective.
y
Do not spin the wheels excessively. The
wheels will sink deep into the mud and it
will be difficult to free the vehicle from the
mud.
y
Avoid shifting gears with the engine
running at high speeds as this may cause
a malfunction.
CAUTION:
4WD MODE SWITCH OPERATION
When driving on rough roads
y
Set the 4WD mode switch to 4H or 4LO.
y
Drive carefully and according to the road
surface conditions.
JVS0445X
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 19
5-19
2021/01/13 02:16:38 PM
y
Set the 4WD mode switch to 2WD, 4H or 4LO,
depending on driving conditions.
y
You may feel a slight vehicle movement
if the 4WD mode switch is operated while
making a turn, accelerating or decelerating,
or if the ignition switch is placed in the “OFF”
position while the 4WD mode switch is set
to 4H or 4LO. This is normal.
y
When the vehicle is stopped after making a
turn, you may feel a slight jolt after the shift
lever is moved to “N” (Neutral) or “P” (Park).
This occurs because the transfer clutch is
released and not because of a malfunction.
CAUTION:
y
y
The 4WD mode switch can be turned
between 2WD and 4H while driving
straight ahead. Do not turn the 4WD mode
switch while making a turn or reversing.
Do not operate the 4WD mode switch
while driving on steep downhill grades.
Use the engine brake and low automatic
transmission gears for engine braking.
y
Do not operate the 4WD mode switch with
the rear wheels spinning.
y
Before turning the 4WD mode switch to
4H from 2WD, make sure that the vehicle
speed is less than 100 km/h (60 MPH).
Failure to do so can damage the 4WD
system.
y
Never turn the 4WD mode switch between
4LO and 4H while driving.
5-20
4WD MODE INDICATOR
y
If the 4WD warning light comes on or 4WD
Error warning (if equipped) appears, the
4WD mode indicator turns off.
4WD WARNING
Warning light
Warning light
Illuminates
JVS0447X
Blinks
The 4WD mode indicator is displayed in the
vehicle information display.
While the engine is running, the 4WD mode
indicator will illuminate the position selected by
the 4WD mode switch.
y
y
The 4WD mode indicator may blink while
shifting from one drive mode to the
other. When the shifting is completed, the
4WD mode indicator will come on. If the
indicator does not come on immediately,
make sure the area around the vehicle
is safe, and drive the vehicle straight,
accelerate or decelerate or move the
vehicle in reverse, then shift the 4WD
mode switch.
When the 4WD mode indicator blinks even
if you switch the 4WD mode switch from
2WD or 4H to 4LO, move the vehicle and
depress the brake pedal, then shift the
transmission lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position. If the 4WD mode indicator is still
blinking after the operation, perform the
procedure again.
Comes on or
blinks when:
There is a malfunction in the 4WD
system
The difference in
wheel rotation is
large
The Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning light is
located in the meter.
The 4WD warning light comes on when the
ignition switch is placed in the “ON” position. It
turns off soon after the engine is started.
If any malfunction occurs in the 4WD system
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the 4WD warning light will either remain
illuminated or blink.
If the 4WD warning light comes on, the 4WD
mode indicator turns off.
A large difference between the diameters
of front and rear wheels will make the 4WD
warning light blink. Change the 4WD mode
switch to 2WD and do not drive fast.
CAUTION:
y
If the 4WD warning light comes on or
blinks during operation for a while, have
your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer
as soon as possible.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 20
2021/01/13 02:16:38 PM
y
Shifting between 4H and 4LO is not
recommended when the 4WD warning
light turns on.
y
When the 4WD warning light comes on,
the 2WD mode may be engaged even if the
4WD mode switch is in 4H. Be especially
careful when driving. If corresponding
parts are malfunctioning, the 4WD mode
will not be engaged even if the 4WD mode
switch is shifted.
y
Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or
4LO position on dry hard surface roads.
Driving on dry, hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO
may cause unnecessary noise, tyre wear
and increased fuel consumption.
If the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning
light turns on when driving on dry hard
surface roads:
— in the 4H position, shift the 4WD mode
switch to 2WD.
— in the 4LO position, stop the vehicle
and shift the transmission lever to the
“N” (Neutral) position with the brake
pedal depressed and shift the 4WD
mode switch to 2WD.
If the 4WD warning light is still on after
the above operation, have your vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible.
y
The transfer case may be damaged if you
continue driving with the warning light
blinking.
Warning indicator (models with color
display)
WAF0763X
If any malfunction occurs in the Four-Wheel
Drive (4WD) system while the engine is running,
a warning message appears in the vehicle
information display.
If the “4WD Error” warning appears, there may
be a malfunction in the 4WD system. Reduce
vehicle speed and have your vehicle checked by
a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.
CAUTION:
y
Do not operate the engine on a free roller
when any of the wheels raised.
y
If the “4WD Error” warning appears while
driving, there may be a malfunction in
the 4WD system. Reduce the vehicle
speed and have your vehicle checked by
a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible. Be
especially careful when driving.
y
The power train may be damaged if you
continue driving with the “4WD Error”
warning on.
TYRE RECOMMENDATION FOR 4WD
CAUTION:
y
Always use tyres of the same size,
brand, construction (bias, bias-belted
or radial), and tread pattern on all four
wheels. Failure to do so may result in
a circumference difference between
tyres on the front and rear axles, which
will cause excessive tyre wear and may
damage the transmission, transfer case
and differential gears.
y
ONLY use spare tyres specified for the
Four- Wheel Drive (4WD) models.
If excessive tyre wear is found, it is recommended
that all four tyres be replaced with tyres of
the same size, brand, construction and tread
pattern. The tyre pressure and wheel alignment
should also be checked and corrected as
necessary. Contact a NISSAN dealer.
Snow tyres
If you install snow tyres, they must also be of
the same size, brand, construction and tread
pattern on all four wheels.
Tyre inflation pressure
Periodically check the pressures of all tyres,
including the spare, with a gauge while at
a service station. If necessary, adjust to the
specified pressure. Tyre pressures are shown
on the tyre placard affixed to the driver’s side
center pillar or rear access door.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 21
5-21
2021/01/13 02:16:38 PM
REAR DIFFERENTIAL LOCKING
SYSTEM (if equipped)
Tyre rotation
y
NISSAN recommends that tyres should be
rotated every 5,000 km (3,000 miles).
The rear differential lock-up device
operates only when the engine is running.
y
In 4H mode, the rear differential lockup device does not operate when the
differential lock mode switch is turned
to the “ON” position. (The differential lock
indicator light will flash.) (4WD model)
y
Use the rear differential lock only in an
emergency when it is not possible to
free a stuck vehicle even using the 4LO
position. (4WD model)
y
When the differential lock is in operation,
turning the vehicle becomes hard and,
especially at high speeds, is dangerous.
y
While differential lock is on, the Anti-lock
Braking System (ABS) warning light and
the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off
indicator light illuminate. This indicates
that anti-lock function may not fully
operate.
y
Do not operate the differential lock when
the vehicle is turning or when one side
wheel is rotating. Otherwise the power
train system parts could be damaged.
y
Avoid quick starts while the differential
lock is in operation. Otherwise the power
train system parts could be damaged.
Snow chains
Snow chains must be installed only on the
rear wheels and not on the front wheels.
Do not drive with snow chains on paved roads
that are clear of snow. Driving with chains in
such conditions can cause damage to the
various mechanisms of the vehicle due to
overstress. When driving on clear paved roads,
be sure to change to Two-Wheel Drive (2WD)
mode.
WARNING:
JVS0533X
The rear differential lock is designed to transmit
engine power to the left and right wheels
equally.
If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc. or
one wheel is off the ground and the differential
lock is not on, engine power is transmitted
to one wheel causing it to spin, so leaving
insufficient traction on the other wheel. The
rear differential lock allows the left and right
wheels to rotate as a unit, enabling your vehicle
to free itself.
To lock the rear differential gear, reduce the
vehicle speed below 7 km/h (4 MPH) and turn
the 4WD mode switch to the 4LO position (4WD
model). Then push the differential lock mode
switch to the “ON” position. The differential
lock indicator light “ ” will blink in the meter
and then stay on when the differential gear is
completely locked.
After using the rear differential lock, or during
normal driving, push the differential lock mode
switch to the “OFF” position. The differential lock
indicator light will turn off after the differential
lock is released.
5-22
Observe the above precautions. Otherwise,
loss of normal steering control may result.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 22
2021/01/13 02:16:38 PM
VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)
SYSTEM (if equipped)
WARNING:
y
y
y
y
y
The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system
is designed to help the driver maintain
stability but does not prevent accidents
due to abrupt steering operation at high
speeds or by careless or dangerous
driving techniques. Reduce vehicle speed
and be especially careful when driving
and cornering on slippery surfaces and
always drive carefully.
Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension.
If suspension parts such as shock
absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer
bars, bushings and wheels are not
NISSAN recommended for your vehicle
or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC
system may not operate properly. This
could adversely affect vehicle handling
performance, and the VDC warning light
may illuminate.
If brake related parts such as brake
pads, rotors and calipers are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely
deteriorated, the VDC system may not
operate properly and the VDC warning
light
may illuminate.
If engine control related parts are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely
deteriorated, the VDC warning light
may illuminate.
When driving on extremely inclined
surfaces such as higher banked corners,
the VDC system may not operate properly
and the VDC warning light
may
illuminate. Do not drive on these types of
roads.
y
y
y
When driving on an unstable surface such
as a turntable, ferry, elevator or ramp, the
VDC warning light
may illuminate. This
is not a malfunction. Restart the engine
after driving onto a stable surface.
If wheels or tyres other than the NISSAN
recommended ones are used, the VDC
system may not operate properly and the
VDC warning light
may illuminate.
The VDC system is not a substitute for
winter tyres or tyre chains on a snow
covered road.
The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system
uses various sensors to monitor driver inputs
and vehicle motion. Under certain driving
conditions, the VDC system helps to perform
the following functions.
y
Controls brake pressure to reduce wheel
slip on one slipping drive wheel so power is
transferred to a non slipping drive wheel on
the same axle.
y
Controls brake pressure and engine output
to reduce drive wheel slip based on vehicle
speed (traction control function).
y
Controls brake pressure at individual wheels
and engine output to help the driver maintain control of the vehicle in the following
conditions:
— understeer (vehicle tends to not follow
the steered path despite increased
steering input)
— oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due to
certain road or driving conditions).
The VDC system can help the driver to maintain
control of the vehicle, but it cannot prevent loss
of vehicle control in all driving situations.
When the VDC system operates, the VDC
warning light
in the instrument panel
flashes so note the following:
y
The road may be slippery or the system
may determine some action is required to
help the vehicle on the steered path.
y
You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal
and hear a noise or vibration from under
the hood. This is normal and indicates that
the VDC system is working properly.
y
Adjust your speed and driving to the road
conditions.
If a malfunction occurs in the system, the VDC
warning light
illuminates in the instrument
panel. The VDC system automatically turns off.
The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the
VDC system. The VDC off indicator light
illuminates to indicate the VDC system is off.
When the VDC OFF switch is used to turn off
the system, the VDC system still operates
to prevent one drive wheel from slipping by
transferring power to a non slipping drive
wheel. The VDC warning light
flashes if this
occurs. All other VDC functions are off and the
VDC warning light
will not flash. The VDC
system is automatically reset to on when the
ignition switch is placed in the “OFF” position
then back to the “ON” position.
When the 4LO position is selected with the
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch, the VDC
system is disabled and the VDC off indicator
light illuminates.
See "Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning
light" (P.2-16) and "Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) off indicator light" (P.2-17).
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 23
5-23
2021/01/13 02:16:38 PM
HILL DESCENT CONTROL SYSTEM
(if equipped)
The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature
that tests the system each time you start the
engine and move the vehicle forward or in
reverse at a slow speed. When the self-test
occurs, you may hear a “clunk” noise and/or feel
a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal
and is not an indication of a malfunction.
WARNING:
y
VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) OFF
SWITCH
y
SSD1149
The vehicle should be driven with the Vehicle
Dynamic Control (VDC) system ON for most
driving conditions.
When the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the
VDC system reduces the engine output to
reduce wheel spin. The engine speed will be
reduced even if the accelerator is depressed to
the floor. If maximum engine power is needed
to free a stuck vehicle, turn the VDC system off.
To turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)
system, push the VDC OFF switch. The VDC off
indicator light
will illuminate.
Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the
engine to turn ON the system.
5-24
Never rely solely on the hill descent
control system to control vehicle speed
when driving on steep downhill grades.
Always drive carefully when using the hill
descent control system and decelerate
the vehicle speed by depressing the
brake pedal if necessary. Be especially
careful when driving on frozen, muddy or
extremely steep downhill roads. Failure
to control vehicle speed may result in a
loss of control of the vehicle and possible
serious injury or death.
The hill descent control system may not
control the vehicle speed on a hill under
all load or road conditions. Always be
prepared to depress the brake pedal to
control vehicle speed. Failure to do so may
result in a collision or serious personal
injury.
When the hill descent control system is activated,
it automatically applies smooth brakes to
control speed on a steep and slippery descent
or off the road without brake or accelerator
operation. The hill descent control system helps
maintain vehicle speed when driving under 25
km/h (16 MPH) on a steep descent that engine
braking alone in the 4H or 4LO mode cannot
control the speed.
NOTE:
When the hill descent control system operates
continuously for a long time, the temperature
of the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system
actuator may increase and the hill descent
control system may be temporarily disabled.
The hill descent control system on indicator
light will turn off. The hill descent control sys-
tem will resume operating automatically and
the indicator light will illuminate again when
the temperature of the VDC system actuator
is reduced. If the indicator light does not illuminate, turn off the system.
HILL DESCENT CONTROL SWITCH
JVS0402X
When additional braking is required on steep
downhill roads, activate the hill descent control
system by pushing the hill descent control
switch on.
When the hill descent control system is
activated, the hill descent control system on
indicator light will illuminate. (See "Hill descent
control system ON indicator light" (P.2-16).)
Also, the stop/tail lights illuminate while the hill
descent control system is applying the brakes
to control the vehicle speed.
To activate the hill descent control system,
satisfy all of the following conditions:
y
Shift the transmission to the forward (only
1st gear for MT model) or reverse gear.
y
Shift the 4WD mode switch to the 4H or 4LO
position and drive the vehicle at a speed
under 25 km/h (16 MPH).
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 24
2021/01/13 02:16:39 PM
HILL START ASSIST SYSTEM (if
equipped)
y
Push the hill descent control switch to the
“ON” position.
If the accelerator or brake pedal is depressed
while the hill descent control system is on, the
system will stop operating temporarily. As soon
as the accelerator or brake pedal is released, the
hill descent control system begins to function
again if the hill descent control operating
conditions are fulfilled.
The hill descent control system on indicator
light blinks if the hill descent control switch is
on and all conditions for system activation are
not met, or if the system becomes disengaged
for any reason.
WARNING:
y
Never rely solely on the hill start assist
system to prevent the vehicle from
moving backward on a hill. Always drive
carefully and attentively. Depress the
brake pedal when the vehicle is stopped
on a steep hill. Be especially careful when
stopped on a hill on frozen or muddy
roads. Failure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling backwards may result in a loss of
control of the vehicle and possible serious
injury or death.
y
The hill start assist system is not designed
to hold the vehicle at a standstill on a hill.
Depress the brake pedal when the vehicle
is stopped on a steep hill. Failure to do so
may cause the vehicle to roll backwards
and may result in a collision or serious
personal injury.
y
The hill start assist system may not
prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards
on a hill under all load or road conditions.
Always be prepared to depress the brake
pedal to prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards. Failure to do so may result in a
collision or serious personal injury.
To turn off the hill descent control system, push
the hill descent control switch to the “OFF”
position.
y
The vehicle is stopped completely on a hill
by applying the brake.
The maximum holding time is 2 seconds. After
2 seconds the vehicle will begin to roll back and
the hill start assist system will stop operating
completely.
The hill start assist system will not operate
when the transmission is shifted to the “N”
(Neutral) or “P” (Park) position or on a flat and
level road.
When the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)
warning light illuminates in the meter, the
hill start assist system will not operate. (See
"Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning light"
(P.2-16).)
The hill start assist system automatically keeps
the brakes applied to help prevent the vehicle
from rolling backwards in the time it takes the
driver to release the brake pedal and apply the
accelerator when the vehicle is stopped on a
hill.
The hill start assist system will operate
automatically under the following conditions:
y
The transmission is shifted to a forward or
reverse gear.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 25
5-25
2021/01/13 02:16:39 PM
LANE DEPARTURE WARNING (LDW)
(if equipped)
WAF0635X
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the LDW system could
result in serious injury or death.
y
This system is only a warning device to
inform the driver of a potential unintended
lane departure. It will not steer the vehicle
or prevent loss of control. It is the driver's
responsibility to stay alert, drive safely,
keep the vehicle in the traveling lane, and
be in control of the vehicle at all times.
The LDW system will operate when the vehicle
is driven at speeds of approximately 70 km/h
(43 MPH) and above, and only when the lane
markings are clearly visible on the road.
The LDW system monitors the lane markers
on the traveling lane using the camera unit
located above the inside rearview mirror.
The LDW system warns the driver with an
indicator on the vehicle information display and
chime that the vehicle is beginning to leave the
driving lane. For additional information, refer to
"LDW system operation" (P.5-26).
5-26
WAF0525X
LDW indicator (on the vehicle information
display)
Vehicle information display
LDW SYSTEM OPERATION
The LDW system operates above approximately
70 km/h (43 MPH) and when the lane markings
are clear.
If the vehicle approaches either the left or right
side of the traveling lane, the LDW indicator
(orange) on the vehicle information display will
flash and a warning chime will sound.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 26
2021/01/13 02:16:39 PM
NOTE:
The LDW system is not designed to warn
when you operate the lane change signal and
change traveling lanes in the direction of the
signal. (The LDW system will become operable
again approximately 2 seconds after the lane
change signal is turned off.)
HOW TO ENABLE/DISABLE THE LDW SYSTEM
WAF0526X
Steering-wheel-mounted
side)
controls
(left
Vehicle information display
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the LDW system.
1.
Press the
button until “Settings”
displays in the vehicle information display.
Use the
button to select “Driver
Assistance”. Then press the “OK” button.
2.
Use the
button to select “Lane” and press
the “OK” button.
3.
Use the
button to select “Warning (LDW)”
and press the “OK” button to turn on or off
the LDW system.
NOTE:
When enabling/disabling the system, the
system will retain current settings even if the
engine is restarted.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 27
5-27
2021/01/13 02:16:39 PM
LDW SYSTEM LIMITATIONS
sion parts.
— When you are towing a trailer or other
vehicle).
WARNING:
Listed below are the system limitations for
the LDW system. Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the
LDW system could result in serious injury or
death.
y
The system will not operate at speeds
below approximately 70 km/h (43 MPH)
or if it cannot detect lane markers.
y
Excessive noise will interfere with the
warning chime sound, and the chime may
not be heard.
y
Do not use the LDW system under the
following conditions as it may not
function properly:
— During bad weather (rain, fog, snow,
etc.).
— When driving on slippery roads, such
as on ice or snow.
— When driving on winding or uneven
roads.
— When there is a lane closure due to
road repairs.
— When driving in a makeshift or temporary lane.
— When driving on roads where the lane
width is too narrow.
— When driving without normal tyre
conditions (for example, tyre wear, low
tyre pressure, installation of spare tyre,
tyre chains, non-standard wheels).
— When the vehicle is equipped with
non-original brake parts or suspen-
5-28
y
The system may not function properly
under the following conditions:
— On roads where there are multiple parallel lane markers; lane markers that
are faded or not painted clearly; yellow
painted lane markers; non-standard
lane markers; or lane markers covered
with water, dirt, snow, etc.
— When strong light enters the lane
camera unit. (For example, the light directly shines on the front of the vehicle
at sunrise or sunset.)
— When a sudden change in brightness
occurs. (For example, when the vehicle
enters or exits a tunnel or under a
bridge.)
— Excessive noise will interfere with the
warning chime sound, and the chime
may not be heard.
— On roads where discontinued lane
markers are still detectable.
— On roads where there are sharp
curves.
— On roads where there are sharply
contrasting objects, such as shadows,
snow, water, wheel ruts, seams or lines
remaining after road repairs. (The LDW
system could detect these items as
lane markers.)
— On roads where the traveling lane
merges or separates.
— When the vehicle’s traveling direction
does not align with the lane marker.
— When traveling close to the vehicle in
front of you, which obstructs the lane
camera unit detection range.
— When rain, snow, dirt or object adheres
to the windshield in front of the lane
camera unit.
— When the headlights are not bright
due to dirt on the lens or if the aiming
is not adjusted properly.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 28
2021/01/13 02:16:39 PM
SYSTEM TEMPORARILY UNAVAILABLE
The LDW system is not designed to warn under
the following conditions:
y
When you operate the lane change signal
and change traveling lanes in the direction
of the signal. (The LDW system will become
operable again approximately 2 seconds
after the lane change signal is turned off.)
y
When the vehicle speed lowers to less than
approximately 70 km/h (43 MPH).
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
After the above conditions have finished
and the necessary operating conditions are
satisfied, the LDW system will resume.
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
If the LDW system malfunctions, it will cancel
automatically. The LDW indicator (orange)
will illuminate and “Not Available System
Malfunction” warning message appears in the
vehicle information display.
WAF0666X
If the vehicle is parked in direct sunlight
under high temperature conditions (over
approximately
40°C
(104°F))
and
then
started, the LDW system may be deactivated
automatically, and the following message
will appear in the vehicle information display:
“Unavailable High Cabin Temperature”.
When the interior temperature is reduced,
the LDW system will resume operating
automatically.
If the warning message appears in the vehicle
information display, pull off the road to a safe
location and stop the vehicle. Place the ignition
switch in the “OFF” position and restart the
engine. If the warning message continues to
appear in the vehicle information display, have
the system checked at a NISSAN dealer.
WAF0635X
The camera unit for the LDW system is located
above the inside rearview mirror.
To keep the proper operation of the LDW system
and prevent a system malfunction, be sure to
observe the following:
y
Always keep the windshield clean.
y
Do not attach a sticker (including transparent material) or install an accessory near
the camera unit.
y
Do not place reflective materials, such as
white paper or a mirror, on the instrument
panel. The reflection of sunlight may adversely affect the camera unit’s capability of
detecting the lane markers.
y
Do not strike or damage the areas around
the camera unit. Do not touch the camera
lens or remove the screw located on the
camera unit. If the camera unit is damaged
due to an accident, it is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 29
5-29
2021/01/13 02:16:40 PM
BLIND SPOT WARNING (BSW) (if
equipped)
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the BSW system could
result in serious injury or death.
y
The BSW system is not a replacement
for proper driving procedures and is not
designed to prevent contact with vehicles
or objects. When changing lanes, always
use the side and rear mirrors and turn
and look in the direction your vehicle will
move to ensure it is safe to change lanes.
Never rely solely on the BSW system.
The BSW system helps alert the driver of other
vehicles in adjacent lanes when changing lanes.
Detection zone
SSD1030
The radar sensors can detect vehicles on either
side of your vehicle within the detection zone
shown as illustrated. This detection zone starts
from the outside mirror of your vehicle and
extends approximately 3.0 m (10 ft) behind the
rear bumper, and approximately 3.0 m (10 ft)
sideways.
WAF0636X
The BSW system uses radar sensors installed
near the rear bumper to detect other vehicles in
an adjacent lane.
5-30
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 30
2021/01/13 02:16:40 PM
detection zone.
The side indicator light illuminates for a few
seconds when the ignition switch is placed in
the “ON” position.
The brightness of the side indicator light is
adjusted automatically depending on the
brightness of the ambient light.
If a vehicle comes into the detection zone after
the driver activates the turn signal, then only
the side indicator light flashes and no chime
sounds. For additional information, refer to
"BSW driving situations" (P.5-33).
WAF0668X
Side indicator light
BSW SYSTEM OPERATION
BSW indicator
The BSW system operates above approximately
32 km/h (20 MPH).
If the radar sensors detect a vehicle in the
detection zone, the side indicator light
illuminates.
If the turn signal is then activated, the system
chimes (twice) and the side indicator light
flashes. The side indicator light continues to
flash until the detected vehicle leaves the
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 31
5-31
2021/01/13 02:16:40 PM
BSW SYSTEM LIMITATIONS
HOW TO ENABLE/DISABLE THE BSW SYSTEM
WARNING:
Listed below are the system limitations for
the BSW system. Failure to operate the vehicle
in accordance with these system limitations
could result in serious injury or death.
WAF0526X
Steering-wheel-mounted
side)
controls
(left
Vehicle information display
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the BSW system.
1.
Press the
button until “Settings”
displays in the vehicle information display.
Use the
button to select “Driver
Assistance”. Then press the “OK” button.
5-32
2.
Use the
button to select “Blind Spot”
and press the “OK” button.
3.
Press the
button to select "Warning
(BSW)" and press the "OK" button to turn
on or off the BSW system.
NOTE:
When enabling/disabling the system, the
system will retain the current settings even if
the engine is restarted.
y
The BSW system cannot detect all vehicles
under all conditions.
y
The radar sensors may not be able to
detect and activate BSW when certain
objects are present such as:
—
Pedestrians, bicycles, animals.
—
Vehicles such as motorcycles, low
height vehicles, or high ground clearance vehicles.
—
Oncoming vehicles.
—
Vehicles remaining in the detection
zone when you accelerate from a stop.
—
A vehicle merging into an adjacent
lane at a speed approximately the
same as your vehicle.
—
A vehicle approaching rapidly from
behind.
—
A vehicle which your vehicle overtakes
rapidly.
—
A vehicle that passes through the
detection zone quickly.
—
When overtaking several vehicles in a
row, the vehicles after the first vehicle
may not be detected if they are traveling close together.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 32
2021/01/13 02:16:40 PM
y
y
y
The radar sensor's detection zone is
designed based on a standard lane width.
When driving in a wider lane, the radar
sensors may not detect vehicles in an
adjacent lane. When driving in a narrow
lane, the radar sensors may detect
vehicles driving two lanes away.
BSW DRIVING SITUATIONS
The radar sensors are designed to
ignore most stationary objects, however
objects such as guardrails, walls, foliage
and parked vehicles may occasionally
be detected. This is a normal operation
condition.
Another vehicle approaching from
behind
Indicator on
Indicator off
Indicator flashing
JVS0738X
Illustration 2 - Approaching from behind
Illustration 2: If the driver activates the turn
signal, then the system chimes (twice) and the
side indicator light flashes.
The following conditions may reduce
the ability of the radar to detect other
vehicles:
NOTE:
— Severe weather
— Road spray
y
The radar sensors may not detect
vehicles which are approaching rapidly
from behind.
y
If the driver activates the turn signal
before a vehicle enters the detection
zone, the side indicator light will flash
but no chime will sound when the other
vehicle is detected.
— Ice/frost/dirt build-up on the vehicle
y
y
Do not attach stickers (including
transparent material), install accessories
or apply additional paint near the radar
sensors. These conditions may reduce
the ability of the radar to detect other
vehicles.
JVS0737X
Illustration 1 - Approaching from behind
Illustration 1: The side indicator light illuminates
if a vehicle enters the detection zone from
behind in an adjacent lane.
Excessive noise (for example, audio
system volume, open vehicle window)
will interfere with the chime sound, and it
may not be heard.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 33
5-33
2021/01/13 02:16:40 PM
Overtaking another vehicle
JVS0739X
Illustration 3 - Overtaking another vehicle
Illustration 3: The side indicator light illuminates
if you overtake a vehicle and that vehicle stays
in the detection zone for approximately 2
seconds.
NOTE:
y
When overtaking several vehicles in a row,
the vehicles after the first vehicle may
not be detected if they are traveling close
together.
y
The radar sensors may not detect slower
moving vehicles if they are passed quickly.
y
If the driver activates the turn signal
before a vehicle enters the detection
zone, the side indicator light will flash
but no chime will sound when the other
vehicle is detected.
Illustration 6: If the driver activates the turn
signal, then the system chimes (twice) and the
side indicator light flashes.
Entering from the side
NOTE:
Illustration 5 - Entering from the side
JVS0740X
Illustration 4 - Overtaking another vehicle
WAF0555X
Illustration 6 - Entering from the side
JVS0741X
y
The radar sensors may not detect a
vehicle which is traveling at about the
same speed as your vehicle when it enters
the detection zone.
y
If the driver activates the turn signal
before a vehicle enters the detection
zone, the side indicator light will flash
but no chime will sound when the other
vehicle is detected.
Illustration 5: The side indicator light illuminates
if a vehicle enters the detection zone from
either side.
Illustration 4: If the driver activates the turn
signal while another vehicle is in the detection
zone, then the system chimes (twice) and the
side indicator light flashes.
5-34
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 34
2021/01/13 02:16:41 PM
SYSTEM TEMPORARILY UNAVAILABLE
Action to take:
When the above conditions no longer exist, the
system will resume automatically.
If the “Unavailable Side Radar Obstruction”
warning message continues to appear, have
the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
When the BSW system malfunctions, it will be
turned off automatically. The BSW indicator
(orange) will illuminate and the “Not Available
System Malfunction” warning message will
appear in the vehicle information display.
NOTE:
If the BSW system stops working, the RCTA
and Intelligent Blind Spot Intervention system (if equipped) will also stop working.
Action to take:
Stop the vehicle in a safe location, turn the
engine off and restart the engine. If the
message continues to appear, have the BSW
system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
WAF0667X
When radar blockage is detected, the BSW
system will be turned off automatically, a chime
will sound and the “Unavailable Side Radar
Obstruction” warning message will appear in
the vehicle information display.
The system is not available until the conditions
no longer exist.
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water,
mist or fog. The blocked condition may also
be caused by objects such as ice, frost or dirt
obstructing the radar sensors.
NOTE:
If the BSW system stops working, the RCTA
and Intelligent Blind Spot Intervention system (if equipped) will also stop working.
WAF0636X
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 35
5-35
2021/01/13 02:16:41 PM
REAR CROSS TRAFFIC ALERT
(RCTA) (if equipped)
The two radar sensors
for the BSW system
are located near the rear bumper. Always keep
the area near the radar sensors clean.
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water,
mist or fog.
The blocked condition may also be caused by
objects such as ice, frost or dirt obstructing the
radar sensors.
Check for and remove objects obstructing the
area around the radar sensors.
Do not attach stickers (including transparent
material), install accessories or apply additional
paint near the radar sensors.
Do not strike or damage the area around the
radar sensors.
See a NISSAN dealer if the area around the radar
sensors is damaged due to a collision.
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the RCTA system could
result in serious injury or death.
y
The RCTA system is not a replacement
for proper driving procedures and is not
designed to prevent contact with vehicles
or objects. When backing out of a parking
space, always use the side and rear
mirrors and turn and look in the direction
your vehicle will move. Never rely solely
on the RCTA system.
The RCTA system will assist you when backing
out from a parking space. When the vehicle is in
reverse, the system is designed to detect other
vehicles approaching from the right or left of
the vehicle. If the system detects cross traffic, it
will alert you.
For the radio approval numbers and
information, see "Radio approval number and
information" (P.9-11).
5-36
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 36
2021/01/13 02:16:41 PM
JVS0173X
WAF0636X
WAF0533X
Side indicator light
RCTA SYSTEM OPERATION
The RCTA system uses radar sensors installed
on both sides near the rear bumper to detect
an approaching vehicle.
Vehicle information display
The RCTA system can help alert the driver of an
approaching vehicle when the driver is backing
out of a parking space.
The radar sensors can detect an approaching
vehicle from up to approximately 20 m (66 ft)
away.
When the shift position is in “R” (Reverse) and
the vehicle speed is less than approximately 8
km/h (5 MPH), the RCTA system is operational.
If the radar detects an approaching vehicle
from either side, the system chimes (once) and
the side indicator light flashes on the side the
vehicle is approaching from.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 37
5-37
2021/01/13 02:16:42 PM
HOW TO ENABLE/DISABLE THE RCTA SYSTEM
WAF0526X
Steering-wheel-mounted controls (left side)
Vehicle information display
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the RCTA system.
1.
Press the
button until “Settings”
displays in the vehicle information display.
Use the
button to select “Driver
Assistance”. Then press the “OK” button.
5-38
2.
Use the
button to select “Cross Traffic
Alert” and press the “OK” button to turn on
or off the RCTA system.
NOTE:
When enabling/disabling the system, the system setting will be retained even if the engine
is restarted.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 38
2021/01/13 02:16:42 PM
y
The radar sensors may not detect
approaching vehicles in certain situations:
— Illustration
: When a vehicle parked
next to you obstructs the beam of the
radar sensor.
— Illustration
: When the vehicle is
parked in an angled parking space.
— Illustration
: When the vehicle is
parked on inclined ground.
— Illustration
: When an approaching
vehicle turns into your vehicle’s parking lot aisle.
— Illustration
: When the angle formed
by your vehicle and approaching vehicle is small
y
The following conditions may reduce
the ability of the radar to detect other
vehicles:
— Severe weather
— Road spray
— Ice/frost/dirt build-up on the vehicle
y
Do not attach stickers (including
transparent material), install accessories
or apply additional paint near the radar
sensors. These conditions may reduce
the ability of the radar to detect other
vehicles
y
Excessive noise (e.g. audio system volume,
open vehicle window) will interfere with
the chime sound, and it may not be heard.
JVS0479X
RCTA SYSTEM LIMITATIONS
WARNING:
Listed below are the system limitations for the
RCTA system. Failure to operate the vehicle
in accordance with these system limitations
could result in serious injury or death.
y
Always check surroundings and turn to
check what is behind you before backing
up. The radar sensors detect approaching
(moving) vehicles. The radar sensors
cannot detect every object such as:
— Pedestrians, bicycles, motorcycles,
animals or child-operated toy vehicles
— A vehicle that is passing at speeds
greater than approximately 30 km/h
(19 MPH)
— A vehicle that is passing at speeds
lower than approximately 8 km/h (5
MPH)
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 39
5-39
2021/01/13 02:16:42 PM
SYSTEM TEMPORARILY UNAVAILABLE
Illustration 1
Illustration 2
JVS0172X
JVS0173X
NOTE:
In the case of several vehicles approaching
in a row (Illustration 1) or in the opposite
direction (Illustration 2), a chime may not be
sounded by the RCTA system after the first
vehicle passes the sensors.
WAF0667X
When radar blockage is detected, the system will
be deactivated automatically. The “Unavailable
Side Radar Obstruction” warning message will
appear in the vehicle information display.
The blocked condition may also be caused by
objects such as ice, frost or dirt obstructing the
radar sensors.
The system is not available until the conditions
no longer exist.
If the BSW system stops working, the RCTA
system will also stop working.
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water,
mist or fog.
5-40
NOTE:
Action to take:
When the above conditions no longer exist,
the system will resume automatically.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 40
2021/01/13 02:16:43 PM
CRUISE CONTROL (if equipped)
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
When the RCTA system malfunctions, it will turn
off automatically. The “Not Available System
Malfunction” warning message will appear in
the vehicle information display.
NOTE:
If the BSW system stops working, the RCTA
system will also stop working.
Action to take:
Stop the vehicle in a safe location, turn the
engine off and restart the engine. If the message
continues to appear, have the system checked
by a NISSAN dealer.
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
Check for and remove objects obstructing the
area around the radar sensors.
Do not attach stickers (including transparent
material), install accessories or apply additional
paint near the radar sensors.
Do not strike or damage the area around the
radar sensors. It is recommended that you visit
a NISSAN dealer if the area around the radar
sensors is damaged due to a collision.
For the radio approval numbers and
information, see "Radio approval number and
information (P.9-11).
JVS1005X
1.
RES+ switch
2.
CANCEL switch
3.
SET— switch
4.
Cruise control MAIN switch
y
Always observe the posted speed limits
and do not set the speed over them.
y
Do not use the cruise control when driving
under the following conditions. Doing so
could cause a loss of vehicle control and
result in an accident.
WARNING:
WAF0636X
The two radar sensors
for the RCTA system
are located near the rear bumper. Always keep
the area near the radar sensors clean.
The radar sensors may be blocked by temporary
ambient conditions such as splashing water,
mist or fog.
The blocked condition may also be caused by
objects such as ice, frost or dirt obstructing the
radar sensors.
—
When it is not possible to keep the
vehicle at a constant speed
—
When driving in heavy traffic
—
When driving in traffic that varies
speed
—
When driving in windy areas
—
When driving on winding or hilly roads
—
When driving on slippery (rain, snow,
ice, etc.) roads
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 41
5-41
2021/01/13 02:16:43 PM
CAUTION:
Turning on cruise control
On manual Transmission (MT) model, do not
shift to the “N” (Neutral) position without
depressing the clutch pedal when the cruise
control is operated. Should this occur, depress
the clutch pedal and turn the cruise control
MAIN switch off immediately. Failure to do so
may cause engine damage.
Push the cruise control MAIN switch
CRUISE indicator appears.
PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE CONTROL
The vehicle will maintain the set speed.
y
y
y
If the cruise control system malfunctions,
it will cancel automatically. The CRUISE
indicator in the vehicle information display
will then blink to warn the driver.
If the CRUISE indicator blinks, turn the cruise
control MAIN switch off and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
The CRUISE indicator may blink when the
cruise control MAIN switch is turned ON
while pushing the RES+, SET— or CANCEL
switch. To properly set the cruise control
system, perform the following procedures.
CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS
The cruise control allows driving at speeds
above 40 km/h (25 MPH) without keeping your
foot on the accelerator pedal.
The cruise control will automatically be
canceled if the vehicle slows down more than
approximately 13 km/h (8 MPH) below the set
speed.
Moving the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral) position
(Automatic Transmission models) or depressing
the clutch pedal (Manual Transmission models)
will cancel the cruise control.
5-42
release the SET— switch
. The
Setting cruising speed
1.
Accelerate to the desired speed.
2.
Push the SET— switch
3.
Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
Push and hold the RES+ switch . When the
vehicle reaches the desired speed, release
the RES+ switch .
y
Quickly push and release the RES+ switch
. This will increase the vehicle speed by
about 1 km/h (0.6 MPH).
and release it.
Passing another vehicle:
Depress the accelerator pedal to accelerate.
After releasing the accelerator pedal, the vehicle
will return to the previously set speed.
The vehicle may not maintain the set speed
when going up or down steep hills. In such
cases, drive without the cruise control.
Resetting to slower speed:
Use any one of the following methods to reset
to a slower speed.
y
Lightly tap the foot brake pedal. When the
vehicle reaches the desired speed, push and
release the SET— switch .
y
Push and hold the SET— switch When the
vehicle reaches the desired speed, release
the SET— switch .
y
Quickly push and release the SET— switch
. This will reduce the vehicle speed by
about 1 km/h (0.6 MPH).
.
y
Resuming at preset speed:
Push and release the RES+ switch
.
The vehicle will resume the last set cruising
speed when the vehicle speed is over 40 km/h
(25 MPH).
Canceling cruising speed
Use any one of the following methods to cancel
the set speed.
y
Push the CANCEL switch
y
Tap the foot brake pedal.
.
y
Push the cruise control MAIN switch
CRUISE indicator will turn off.
. The
Resetting to faster speed:
Use any one of the following methods to reset
to a faster speed.
y
Depress the accelerator pedal. When the
vehicle reaches the desired speed, push and
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 42
2021/01/13 02:16:43 PM
INTELLIGENT EMERGENCY
BRAKING (if equipped)
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the Intelligent Emergency Braking system could result in serious
personal injury or death.
y
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system
is a supplemental aid to the driver. It is not
a replacement for the driver’s attention
to traffic conditions or responsibility to
drive safely. It cannot prevent accidents
due to carelessness or dangerous driving
techniques.
y
The Intelligent Emergency Braking
system does not function in all driving,
traffic, weather and road conditions.
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system
can assist the driver when there is a risk of a
forward collision with the vehicle ahead in the
traveling lane.
WAF0669
Vehicle ahead detection indicator
Intelligent Emergency Braking emergency
warning indicator
WAF0638X
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system uses
a radar sensor
located on the front of the
vehicle to measure the distance to the vehicle
ahead in the same lane.
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light (on the meter panel)
INTELLIGENT EMERGENCY BRAKING
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system will
function when your vehicle is driven at speeds
above approximately 5 km/h (3 MPH).
If a risk of a forward collision is detected,
detection system will firstly provide the warning
to the driver by illuminating the warning (yellow)
in the vehicle information display and providing
an audible alert.
If the driver applies the brakes quickly and
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 43
5-43
2021/01/13 02:16:43 PM
forcefully after the warning, and the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system detects that there
is still the possibility of a forward collision, the
system will automatically increase the braking
force.
If the driver does not take action, the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system issues the second
visual (flashing) (red) and audible warning. If the
driver releases the accelerator pedal, then the
system applies partial braking.
necessary to avoid a collision.
y
When the accelerator pedal is depressed.
y
When there is no longer a vehicle detected
ahead.
If the Intelligent Emergency Braking system has
stopped the vehicle, the vehicle will remain at
a standstill for approximately 2 seconds before
the brakes are released.
If the risk of a collision becomes imminent, the
Intelligent Emergency Braking system applies
harder braking automatically.
While the Intelligent Emergency Braking system
is operating, you may hear the sound of brake
operation. This is normal and indicates that
the Intelligent Emergency Braking system is
operating properly.
NOTE:
The vehicle’s stop lights come on when braking is performed by the Intelligent Emergency
Braking system.
Depending on vehicle speed and distance to the
vehicle ahead, as well as driving and roadway
conditions, the system may help the driver
avoid a forward collision or may help mitigate
the consequences of a collision should one be
unavoidable.
If the driver is handling the steering wheel,
accelerating or braking, the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system will function later or
will not function.
The automatic braking will cease under the
following conditions:
y
When the steering wheel is turned as far as
5-44
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 44
2021/01/13 02:16:43 PM
TURNING THE INTELLIGENT EMERGENCY BRAKING SYSTEM ON/OFF
NOTE:
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system
will be automatically turned ON when the
engine is restarted.
INTELLIGENT EMERGENCY BRAKING
SYSTEM LIMITATIONS
WARNING:
Listed below are the system limitations for
the Intelligent Emergency Braking system.
Failure to operate the vehicle in accordance
with these system limitations could result in
serious injury or death.
y
The Intelligent Emergency Braking
system cannot detect all vehicles under
all conditions.
y
The radar sensor does not detect the
following objects:
WAF0670X
Intelligent Emergency
warning light
Braking
system
Vehicle information display
Steering-wheel-mounted
side)
2.
controls
(left
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the Intelligent Emergency Braking system.
1.
Use the
button to select “Driver
Assistance”. Then press the “OK” button.
Press the
button until “Settings”
displays in the vehicle information display.
Use the
button to select “Emergency
Brake” and press the “OK” button to turn
on or off the Intelligent Emergency Braking
system.
When the Intelligent Emergency Braking system
is turned off, the Intelligent Emergency Braking
system warning light (orange) illuminates.
y
—
Pedestrians, animals or obstacles in
the roadway
—
Animals of any size
—
Obstacles (for example, cargo or debris) on the roadway or roadside
—
Oncoming or crossing vehicles
—
Vehicles where the tyres are difficult
to see or the shape of the rear of the
vehicle is unclear or obstructed.
—
Parked vehicles
The radar sensor has some performance
limitations. If a stationary vehicle is in the
vehicle’s path, the Intelligent Emergency
Braking system will not function when
the vehicle is driven at speeds over
approximately 80 km/h (50 MPH).
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 45
5-45
2021/01/13 02:16:44 PM
y
The radar sensor may not detect a vehicle
ahead in the following conditions:
— In poor visibility conditions (such as
rain, snow, fog, dust storms, sand
storms, smoke, and road spray from
other vehicles).
motorcycle).
— While towing a trailer or other vehicle.
y
— If there is interference by other radar
sources.
y
y
y
— If the speed difference between the
two vehicles is small.
y
— If the vehicle ahead has a unique or
unusual shape, extremely low or high
clearance heights, or unusual cargo
loading or is narrow (for example, a
5-46
Braking
— objects on the roadside (traffic sign,
guardrail, vehicle, etc.)
— Excessively heavy baggage is loaded
in the rear seat (if equipped) or the
cargo area of your vehicle.
— When the vehicle is offset from the
vehicle’s forward path.
— For approximately 15 seconds after
starting the engine.
The Intelligent Emergency
system may react to:
— The vehicle is driven on a slope.
— When your vehicle’s position or
movement is changed quickly or significantly (for example, lane change,
turning vehicle, abrupt steering, sudden acceleration or deceleration).
— When your vehicle or the vehicle
ahead moves quickly or significantly
such that the system cannot detect
and react in time (for example, vehicle
cutting in, changing lanes, making a
turn, steering abruptly, sudden acceleration or deceleration).
The system performance may be
degraded in the following conditions:
— The vehicle is driven on a slippery
road.
— If dirt, ice, snow, fog or other material
is covering the radar sensor area.
— When driving on a steep downhill
slope, on roads with sharp curves,
and/or bumpy or dirt roads.
vehicle in front of your vehicle.
y
y
The system is designed to automatically
check the sensor’s functionality, within
certain limitations. The system may not
detect some forms of obstruction of the
sensor area such as ice, snow, stickers, for
example. In these cases, the system may
not be able to warn the driver properly. Be
sure that you check, clean and clear the
sensor area regularly.
WAF0269X
— objects above road (low bridge, traffic
sign, etc.)
— objects on the road surface (railroad
track, grate, steel plate, etc.)
In some road or traffic conditions, the
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
may unexpectedly apply partial braking.
When acceleration is necessary, continue
to depress the accelerator pedal to
override the system.
The system may keep operating when the
vehicle ahead is turning right or left.
The system may operate when your
vehicle is approaching and passing a
vehicle ahead.
Depending on the road shape (curved
road, entrance and exit of the curve,
winding road, lane regulation, under
construction, etc.), the system may
operate temporarily for the oncoming
— objects in the parking garage (beam,
pillar, etc.)
— vehicles or objects in adjacent lane or
close to the vehicle
— objects on the road (such as trees)
y
Braking distances increase on slippery
surfaces.
y
Excessive noise will interfere with the
warning chime sound, and the chime may
not be heard.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 46
2021/01/13 02:16:44 PM
SSD0253
When driving on some roads, such as winding,
hilly, curved, narrow roads, or roads which are
under construction, the sensor may detect
vehicles in a different lane, or may temporarily
not detect a vehicle traveling ahead. This may
cause the system to work inappropriately.
The detection of vehicles may also be affected
by vehicle operation (steering maneuver or
traveling position in the lane, etc.) or vehicle
condition. If this occurs, the system may warn
you by blinking the system indicator and
sounding the chime unexpectedly. You will
have to manually control the proper distance
away from the vehicle traveling ahead.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 47
5-47
2021/01/13 02:16:44 PM
SYSTEM TEMPORARILY UNAVAILABLE
y
The sensor area on the front of the vehicle
is covered with dirt or is obstructed.
Action to take
If the warning light (orange) comes on, stop the
vehicle in a safe place and turn the engine off.
Clean the radar cover on the front of the vehicle
with a soft cloth, and restart the engine. If the
warning light continues to illuminate, have the
Intelligent Emergency Braking system checked
by a NISSAN dealer.
y
When driving on roads with limited road
structures or buildings (for example, long
bridges, deserts, snow fields, driving next to
long walls).
Action to take
When the above conditions no longer exist,
the Intelligent Emergency Braking system will
resume automatically.
Condition C
WAF0671X
Condition A
Action to take
When the radar sensor picks up interference
from another radar source, making it impossible
to detect a vehicle ahead, the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system is automatically
turned off.
When the above conditions no longer exist,
the Intelligent Emergency Braking system will
resume automatically.
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light (orange) will illuminate.
5-48
When Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system
is OFF, the Intelligent Emergency Braking
brake will not operate. In this case only visible
and audible warning operates. The Intelligent
Emergency Braking system warning light
(orange) will illuminate.
Action to take
When the VDC system is ON, the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system will resume
automatically.
Condition B
In the following condition, the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system warning light
(orange) will illuminate and the “Not Available
Front Radar Blocked” warning message will
appear in the vehicle information display.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 48
2021/01/13 02:16:44 PM
INTELLIGENT FORWARD COLLISION
WARNING SYSTEM (if equipped)
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
y
If the Intelligent Emergency Braking system
malfunctions, it will be turned off automatically,
a chime will sound, the Intelligent Emergency
Braking system warning light (orange) will
illuminate and the “Not Available System
Malfunction” warning message will appear in
the vehicle information display.
y
Do not cover or attach stickers or similar
objects on the front of the vehicle near
the sensor area. This could cause failure or
malfunction.
y
Do not attach metallic objects near the
sensor area (brush guard, etc.). This could
cause failure or malfunction.
y
Do not alter, remove or paint the front of the
vehicle near the sensor area. Contact a NISSAN dealer before customizing or restoring
the sensor area.
Action to take:
If the Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light (orange) comes on, stop the
vehicle in a safe location. Turn the engine off
and restart the engine. If the warning light
continues to illuminate, have the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
Do not strike or damage the areas around
the sensor.
For the radio approval numbers and
information, see "Radio approval number and
information" (P.9-11).
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the Intelligent Forward
Collision Warning system could result in serious injury or death.
y
The Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system can help warn the driver before
a collision occurs but will not avoid a
collision. It is the driver’s responsibility to
stay alert, drive safely and be in control of
the vehicle at all times.
The Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system can help alert the driver when there is a
sudden braking of a second vehicle traveling
in front of the vehicle ahead in the same lane.
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
WAF0638X
WAF0638X
The radar sensor
vehicle.
is located on the front of the
The Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system uses a radar sensor
located on the
front of the vehicle to measure the distance to
the vehicle ahead in the same lane.
To keep the system operating properly, be sure
to observe the following:
y
Always keep the sensor area on the front of
the vehicle clean.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 49
5-49
2021/01/13 02:16:44 PM
INTELLIGENT FORWARD COLLISION WARNING SYSTEM OPERATION
WAF0672X
Vehicle ahead detection indicator
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light (on the meter panel)
5-50
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 50
2021/01/13 02:16:45 PM
JVS0294X
The Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system operates at speeds above approximately
5 km/h (3 MPH).
If there is a potential risk of a forward collision,
the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system will warn the driver by blinking the
vehicle ahead detection indicator, and sounding
an audible alert.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 51
5-51
2021/01/13 02:16:45 PM
TURNING THE INTELLIGENT FORWARD COLLISION WARNING SYSTEM ON/OFF
Braking system warning light illuminates.
NOTE:
When the Intelligent Emergency Braking
system is turned off, the Intelligent Forward
Collision Warning system is also turned off.
For details about the Intelligent Emergency
Braking system, see "Intelligent Emergency
Braking" (P.5-43).
INTELLIGENT FORWARD COLLISION
WARNING SYSTEM LIMITATIONS
Illustration A
JVS0295X
WAF0670X
Intelligent Emergency
warning light
Braking
system
1.
Press the
button until “Settings”
appears in the vehicle information display.
Use the
button to select “Driver
Assistance”. Then press the “OK” button.
2.
Use the
button to select “Emergency
Brake” and press the “OK” button to turn
on or off the Intelligent Forward Collision
Warning system.
Vehicle information display
Steering-wheel-mounted
side)
controls
(left
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system.
5-52
When the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system is turned off, the Intelligent Emergency
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 52
2021/01/13 02:16:45 PM
able to warn the driver properly. Be sure
that you check, clean and clear the sensor
area regularly.
y
JVS0296X
Illustration B
WARNING:
—
Listed below are the system limitations for the
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system.
Failure to operate the vehicle in accordance
with these system limitations could result in
serious injury or death.
y
The Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system cannot detect all vehicles under
all conditions.
y
The radar sensor does not detect the
following objects:
y
y
—
Pedestrians, animals or obstacles in
the roadway
—
Oncoming vehicles
—
Crossing vehicles
(Illustration A) The Intelligent Forward
Collision Warning system does not
function when a vehicle ahead is a narrow
vehicle, such as a motorcycle.
The radar sensor may not detect a vehicle
ahead in the following conditions:
—
Snow or heavy rain
y
Excessive noise will interfere with the
warning chime sound, and the chime may
not be heard.
Dirt, ice, snow or other material covering the radar sensor.
—
Interference by other radar sources.
—
Snow or road spray from traveling
vehicles.
—
Driving in a tunnel
—
When your vehicle is towing a trailer,
etc.
—
(Illustration B) When the vehicle ahead
is being towed.
—
(Illustration C) When the distance to
the vehicle ahead is too close, the
beam of the radar sensor is obstructed.
—
(Illustration D) When driving on a steep
downhill slope or roads with sharp
curves.
The system is designed to automatically
check the sensor’s functionality, within
certain limitations. The system may not
detect some forms of obstruction of the
sensor area such as ice, snow, stickers,
etc. In these cases, the system may not be
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 53
5-53
2021/01/13 02:16:45 PM
When driving on some roads, such as winding,
hilly, curved, narrow roads, or roads which are
under construction, the radar sensor may detect
vehicles in a different lane, or may temporarily
not detect a vehicle traveling ahead. This may
cause the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system to work inappropriately.
Illustration C
Illustration D
JVS0297X
The detection of vehicles may also be affected
by vehicle operation (steering maneuver or
traveling position in the lane, etc.) or vehicle
condition. If this occurs, the system may warn
you by blinking the system indicator and
sounding the chime unexpectedly. You will
have to manually control the proper distance
away from the vehicle traveling ahead.
JVS0298X
SSD0253
5-54
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 54
2021/01/13 02:16:45 PM
SYSTEM TEMPORARILY UNAVAILABLE
automatically turned off.
y
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light (orange) will illuminate and
the “Not Available Front Radar Blocked”
warning message will appear in the vehicle
information display.
Action to take:
If the warning light (orange) comes on, stop the
vehicle in a safe place, press the Park button to
place the vehicle in the “P” (Park) position and
turn the engine off. Clean the radar cover area
with a soft cloth, and restart the engine. If the
warning light continues to illuminate, have the
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
y
When driving on roads with limited road
structures or buildings (for example, long
bridges, deserts, snow fields, driving next to
long walls).
Action to take:
When the above conditions no longer exist the
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
will resume automatically.
NOTE:
WAF0671X
Condition A:
Action to take:
When the radar sensor picks up interference
from another radar source, making it
impossible to detect a vehicle ahead, the
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system is
automatically turned off.
When the above conditions no longer exist, the
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system
will resume automatically.
The Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light (orange) will illuminate.
Condition B:
When the sensor area of the front of the vehicle
is covered with dirt or is obstructed, making
it impossible to detect a vehicle ahead, the
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system is
If the Intelligent Emergency Braking system
stops working, the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning system will also stop working.
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
If the Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system malfunctions, it will be turned off
automatically, a chime will sound, the Intelligent
Emergency Braking system warning light
(orange) will illuminate and the warning
message “Not Available System Malfunction”
will appear in the vehicle information display.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 55
5-55
2021/01/13 02:16:45 PM
INTELLIGENT DRIVER ALERTNESS
(if equipped)
Action to take:
y
If the warning light (orange) comes on, stop
the vehicle in a safe location, turn the engine
off and restart the engine. If the warning light
continues to illuminate, have the Intelligent
Forward Collision Warning system checked by a
NISSAN dealer.
Do not alter, remove or paint the front
bumper. Before customizing or restoring
the front bumper, it is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer.
WARNING:
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the Intelligent Driver
Alertness system could result in serious injury
or death.
y
The Intelligent Driver Alertness system
is only a warning to inform the driver of
a potential lack of driver attention or
drowsiness. It will not steer the vehicle or
prevent loss of control.
y
The Intelligent Driver Alertness system
does not detect and provide an alert of
the driver’s lack of attention or fatigue in
every situation.
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
y
WAF0638X
The radar sensor
vehicle.
is located on the front of the
To keep the system operating properly, be sure
to observe the following:
y
Always keep the sensor area of the front
bumper clean.
y
Do not strike or damage the areas around
the sensor.
y
Do not cover or attach stickers or similar
objects on the front bumper near the
sensor area. This could cause failure or
malfunction.
y
Do not attach metallic objects near the
sensor area (brush guard, etc.). This could
cause failure or malfunction.
5-56
It is the driver’s responsibility to:
—
stay alert,
—
drive safely,
—
keep the vehicle in the traveling lane,
—
be in control of the vehicle at all times,
—
avoid driving when tired,
—
avoid distractions (texting, etc.).
The Intelligent Driver Alertness system helps
alert the driver if the system detects a lack of
attention or driving fatigue.
The system monitors driving style and steering
behavior over a period of time, and it detects
changes from the normal pattern. If the system
detects that driver attention is decreasing over
a period of time, the system uses audible and
visual warnings to suggest that the driver take
a break.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 56
2021/01/13 02:16:46 PM
INTELLIGENT DRIVER ALERTNESS
SYSTEM OPERATION
HOW TO ENABLE/DISABLE THE INTELLIGENT DRIVER ALERTNESS SYSTEM
JVI1623X
If the system detects driver fatigue or that driver
attention is decreasing, the message “Take
a break?” appears in the vehicle information
display and a chime sounds when the vehicle is
driven at speeds above 60 km/h (37 MPH).
The system continuously monitors driver
attention and can provide multiple warnings per
trip. The system resets and starts reassessing
driving style and steering behavior when the
ignition switch is cycled from the “ON” to the
“OFF” position and back to the “ON” position.
WAF0526X
Steering-wheel-mounted
side)
controls
(left
Vehicle information display
Perform the following steps to enable or disable
the Intelligent Driver Alertness system.
1.
Press the
button until “Settings”
appears in the vehicle information
display. Use the
button to select “Driver
Assistance”. Then press the “OK” button.
2.
Use the
button to select “Driver Attention
Alert” and press the “OK” button to turn on
or off the Intelligent Driver Alertness system.
NOTE:
The setting will be retained even if the engine
is restarted.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 57
5-57
2021/01/13 02:16:46 PM
ECO DRIVE REPORT (if equipped)
INTELLIGENT DRIVER ALERTNESS
SYSTEM LIMITATIONS
WARNING:
Listed below are the system limitations
for the Intelligent Driver Alertness system.
Failure to operate the vehicle in accordance
with these system limitations could result in
serious injury or death.
y
The Intelligent Driver Alertness system
may not operate properly and may
not provide an alert in the following
conditions:
—
Poor road conditions such as an uneven road surface or pot holes.
—
Strong side wind.
—
If you have adopted a sporty driving
style with higher cornering speeds or
higher rates of acceleration.
—
y
Frequent lane changes or changes to
vehicle speed.
The Intelligent Driver Alertness system
may not provide an alert in the following
conditions:
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION
If the Intelligent Driver Alertness system
malfunctions, a warning message will appear in
the vehicle information display and the function
will be stopped automatically.
Action to take:
Stop the vehicle in a safe location, place the
vehicle in “P” (Park) position, turn the engine off
and restart the engine. If the system warning
message continues to appear, have the system
checked by a NISSAN dealer.
WAF0554X
When the ignition switch is in the “OFF” position,
ECO management display appears.
Previous 5 times (History)
Current fuel economy
Best fuel economy
The result of ECO evaluation is displayed 30
seconds after the ignition switch is placed in
the on position and the vehicle is driven at least
500 meters (1/3 miles).
: The average fuel economy for the previous 5
times will be displayed.
: The average fuel economy since the last
reset will be displayed.
—
Vehicle speeds lower than 60 km/h (37
MPH).
—
Short lapses of attention.
: The best fuel economy of the past history will
be displayed.
—
Instantaneous distractions such as
dropping an object.
The ECO drive report can be set to be “ON” or
“OFF”. See "Settings" (P.2-19).
5-58
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 58
2021/01/13 02:16:46 PM
FUEL EFFICIENCY AND CARBON
DIOXIDE REDUCTION DRIVING TIPS
Follow these easy-to-use Fuel Efficiency and
Carbon Dioxide Reduction Driving Tips to help
you achieve the most fuel economy from your
vehicle and reduce carbon dioxide emissions.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Use smooth accelerator and brake pedal
application.
y Avoid rapid starts and stops.
y Use smooth, gentle accelerator and
brake application whenever possible.
y Maintain constant speed while commuting and coast whenever possible.
Maintain constant speed.
y Look ahead to try and anticipate and
minimize stops.
y Synchronizing your speed with traffic
lights allows you to reduce your number
of stops.
y Maintaining a steady speed can minimize red light stops and improve fuel
efficiency.
Drive at economical speeds and distances.
y Observing the speed limit and not exceeding 97 km/h (60 MPH) (where legally
allowed) can improve fuel efficiency due
to reduced aerodynamic drag.
y Maintaining a safe following distance behind other vehicles reduces unnecessary
braking.
y Safely monitoring traffic to anticipate
changes in speed permits reduced braking and smooth acceleration changes.
y Select a gear range suitable to road
conditions.
Use cruise control (if equipped).
y Using cruise control during highway
driving helps maintain a steady speed.
y Cruise control is particularly effective in
providing fuel savings when driving on
flat terrains.
5.
Plan for the shortest route.
y Utilize a map or navigation system (if
equipped) to determine the best route
to save time.
6.
Avoid idling.
y Shutting off your engine when safe for
stops exceeding 30-60 seconds saves
fuel and reduces emissions.
7.
Buy an automated pass for toll roads.
y Automated passes permit drivers to use
special lanes to maintain cruising speed
through the toll and avoid stopping and
starting.
8.
Winter warm up.
y Limit idling time to minimize impact to
fuel economy.
y Vehicles typically need no more than 30
seconds of idling at start-up to effectively circulate the engine oil before driving.
y Your vehicle will reach its ideal operating
temperature more quickly while driving
versus idling.
9.
INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY
AND REDUCING CARBON DIOXIDE
EMISSIONS
y
Keep your engine tuned up.
y
Follow the recommended scheduled maintenance.
y
Keep the tyres inflated to the correct pressure. Low tyre pressure increases tyre wear
and lowers fuel economy.
y
Keep the wheels in correct alignment. Improper alignment increases tyre wear and
lowers fuel economy.
y
Use the recommended viscosity engine oil.
(See "Recommended fluids/lubricants and
capacities" (P.9-2).)
Keeping your vehicle cool.
y
y
Park your vehicle in a covered parking
area or in the shade whenever possible.
When entering a hot vehicle, opening the
windows will help to reduce the inside
temperature faster, resulting in reduced
demand on your A/C system.
10. Do not carry excessive weight.
y
Remove unnecessary objects from the
vehicle to reduce vehicle weight.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 59
5-59
2021/01/13 02:16:46 PM
PARKING
WARNING:
y
Do not stop or park the vehicle over
flammable materials such as dry grass,
waste paper or rags. They may ignite and
cause a fire.
y
Safe parking procedures require that
both the parking brake be applied and
the shift lever placed into the “P” (Park)
position for Automatic Transmission
(AT) model or in an appropriate gear for
Manual Transmission (MT) model. Failure
to do so could cause the vehicle to move
unexpectedly or roll away and result in an
accident.
y
When parking the vehicle, make sure
the shift lever is moved to the “P” (Park)
position. The shift lever cannot be moved
out of the “P” (Park) position without
depressing the foot brake pedal (AT
model).
y
Never leave the engine running while the
vehicle is unattended.
y
Do not leave children unattended inside
the vehicle. They could unknowingly
activate switches or controls. Unattended
children could become involved in serious
accidents.
y
To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not
leave children, people who require the
assistance of others or pets unattended in
your vehicle. Additionally, the temperature
inside a closed vehicle on a warm day can
quickly become high enough to cause
a significant risk of injury or death to
people and pets.
5-60
SSD0488
Left-Hand Drive (LHD) model
SSD0489
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model
1.
Firmly apply the parking brake.
HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB
2.
Automatic Transmission (AT) model: Move
the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
Turn the wheels into the curb and move the
vehicle forward until the curb side wheel
gently touches the curb. Then apply the
parking brake.
Manual Transmission (MT) model: Move
the shift lever to the “R” (Reverse) position.
When parking on an uphill grade, move the
shift lever to the “1” (1st) position.
3.
To help prevent the vehicle from moving
into traffic when parked on an incline, it
is a good practice to turn the wheels as
illustrated.
HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB
Turn the wheels away from the curb and
allow the vehicle to move back until the
curb side wheel gently touches the curb.
Then apply the parking brake.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 60
2021/01/13 02:16:46 PM
PARKING SENSOR (sonar) SYSTEM
(if equipped)
HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, WITHOUT
CURB
Turn the wheels toward the side of the road
so the vehicle will move away from the
center of the road if the vehicle moves. Then
apply the parking brake.
4.
Model with Intelligent Key:
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF” position.
Model without Intelligent Key:
Place the ignition switch in the “LOCK” position and remove the key.
JVS0532X
The parking sensor (sonar) system sounds a
tone to inform the driver of obstacles near the
bumper.
When the “Sensor” key is ON, the sensor view will
automatically appear in the vehicle information
display.
this may include reduced performance or
a false activation.
y
This function is designed as an aid to
the driver in detecting large stationary
objects to help avoid damaging the
vehicle. The system is not designed to
prevent contact with small or moving
objects. Always move slowly.
y
The system will not detect small objects
below the bumper, and may not detect
objects close to the bumper or on the
ground.
y
The system may not detect the following
objects.
WARNING:
y
y
The parking sensor (sonar) system is a
convenience but it is not a substitute
for proper parking. The driver is always
responsible for safety during parking and
other manoeuvres. Always look around
and check that it is safe to do so before
parking.
Read and understand the limitations
of the parking sensor (sonar) system
as contained in this section. The colors
of the corner sensor indicator and the
distance guide lines in the rear view
indicate different distances to the object.
Inclement weather or ultrasonic sources
such as an automatic car wash, a truck's
compressed-air brakes or a pneumatic
drill may affect the function of the system;
— Fluffy objects such as snow, cloth,
cotton, glass-wool, etc.
— Thin objects such as rope, wire and
chain, etc.
— Wedge-shaped objects
y
If your vehicle sustains damage to the
bumper fascia, leaving it misaligned or
bent, the sensing zone may be altered
causing inaccurate measurement of
obstacles or false alarms.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 61
5-61
2021/01/13 02:16:46 PM
y
The sensors may cause malfunction when
a horn, etc. sounds or there is a ultrasonic
source (such as parking sensors of other
vehicles) around the vehicle because the
sensors detect the distance between the
vehicle and the obstacle by detecting the
sound wave reflected from the surface of
an obstacle.
y
Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible to hear the tone clearly.
y
Keep the sensors (located on the bumper
fascia) free from snow, ice and large
accumulations of dirt. Do not clean the
sensors with sharp objects. If the sensors
are covered, the accuracy of the sensor
function will be diminished.
PARKING SENSOR (sonar) SYSTEM OFF
SWITCH
CAUTION:
The system inform with visual and audible
signal of rear obstacles when the shift lever is in
the “R” (Reverse) position.
The system is deactivated at speeds above 10
km/h (6 MPH). It is reactivated at lower speeds.
The intermittent tone will stop after 3 seconds
when an obstacle is detected by only the corner
sensor and the distance does not change. The
tone will stop when the obstacle get away from
the vehicle.
5-62
WAF0575X
When the corner of the vehicle moves closer
to an object, the corner sensor indicators
appears.
When the center of the vehicle moves close
to an object, the center sensor indicator
appears.
When the object is detected, the indicator (green)
appears and the tone sounds intermittently.
When the vehicle moves closer to the object,
the color of the indicator turns yellow. When the
vehicle is very close to the object, the indicator
turns red, and the tone sounds continuously.
JVS0534X
The parking sensor (sonar) system OFF switch
on the instrument panel allows the driver to
turn the parking sensor (sonar) system on and
off. To turn the parking sensor (sonar) system
on and off, the ignition switch must be in the
“ON” position.
The indicator light on the switch will illuminate
when the system is turned on.
If the indicator light flashes when the parking
sensor (sonar) system is not turned off, it may
indicate a malfunction in the parking sensor
(sonar) system.
The parking sensor (sonar) system will be
turned on automatically under the following
conditions:
y
When the ignition switch is switched from
the “OFF” position to the “ON” position.
y
When the shift lever is shifted into the “R”
(Reverse) position.
y
When the vehicle speed increases to 10
km/h (6 MPH) and decreases.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 62
2021/01/13 02:16:47 PM
TRAILER TOWING
The automatic turning on function can be
turned on and off by “Sensor” key in the setting
menu. See "Settings" (P.2-19).
PARKING SENSOR (sonar) SYSTEM
SETTING
The following status of the parking sensor
(sonar) system can be changed by switches
on the steering-wheel-mounted controls. For
details, see "Settings" (P.2-19).
Sensor
Activate or deactivate the use of sensor.
Your new vehicle was designed to be used
primarily to carry passengers and luggage.
Towing a trailer will place additional loads
on your vehicle's engine, drive train, steering,
braking and other systems. The towing of a
trailer will exaggerate other conditions such
as sway caused by crosswinds, rough road
surfaces or passing trucks.
Your driving style and speed must be adjusted
according to the circumstances. Before towing
a trailer, see a NISSAN dealer for an explanation
about the proper use of towing equipment.
ON (default) - OFF
OPERATING PRECAUTIONS
Volume
y
Avoid towing a trailer during the break-in
period.
y
Before driving, make sure that the lighting
system of the trailer works properly.
y
Observe the legal maximum speeds for
trailer operation.
y
Avoid abrupt starts, accelerations and
stops.
y
Avoid sharp turns and lane changes.
y
Always drive your vehicle at a moderate
speed.
y
Do not use the following systems (if
equipped) while towing a trailer:
Adjust the volume of the tone.
High - Medium (default) - Low
Distance
Adjust the detection range of the sensor.
Long- Medium (default) - Short
hitch, safety chain, roof carrier, etc.) for
your vehicle and trailer. These devices are
available from a NISSAN dealer where you
can also obtain more detailed information
about trailer towing.
y
Never allow the total trailer load (trailer
weight plus its cargo weight) to exceed the
maximum set for the vehicle and the coupling device. See a NISSAN dealer for more
information.
y
The trailer must be loaded so that heavy
goods are placed over the axle. The maximum allowable vertical load on the trailer
hitch must not be exceeded.
y
Have your vehicle serviced more often
than at the intervals specified in a separate
maintenance booklet.
y
Trailer towing requires more fuel than
under normal circumstances because of a
considerable increase in traction power and
resistance.
While towing a trailer, check the engine
coolant temperature indicator to prevent the
vehicle from overheating.
— Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system
— Intelligent Emergency Braking system
— Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system
y
Follow the trailer manufacturer's instructions.
y
Choose proper coupling devices (trailer
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 63
5-63
2021/01/13 02:16:47 PM
MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS
CA0011-A
Maximum trailer loads (including tyres and
other loaded equipment):
1.
2.
Never allow the total trailer load to exceed:
y
The maximum 750 kg (1,654 lb) for a
trailer without brakes.
y
The maximum 3,500 kg (7,718 lb) for a
trailer with brakes. (YD25DDTi engine)
y
The maximum 1,560 kg (3,440 lb) for a
trailer with brakes. (QR25DE engine)
equipment fitted but also to use it correctly.
Towing loads greater than the value specified
for your vehicle or using towing equipment
which is not provided by NISSAN could seriously
affect the handling and/or performance of your
vehicle.
GAWR:
Vehicle damage resulting from improper
towing procedures is not covered by NISSAN
warranties. Information on trailer towing and
the required equipment should be obtained
from a NISSAN dealer.
QR25DE engine
“Never exceed the Gross Vehicle Mass (GVM),
Gross Combination Mass (GCM) or Front/Rear
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)”
TYRE PRESSURE
Maximum tongue load
Never allow the tongue load to exceed 10% of
the total trailer load. If the tongue load exceeds
10%, rearrange the cargo in the trailer.
Maximum rear gross axle weight
Towing capacity displayed on a tow-bar.
y
Trailer's gross vehicle mass marked on a
coupling body.
y
Gross vehicle mass marked on a trailer
data plate.
The maximum trailer load which can be
towed by your vehicle depends on the towing
equipment fitted to the vehicle. Therefore,
it is important to not only have the correct
5-64
YD25DDTi engine
MT model: 1,785 kg (3,936 lb)
AT model: 1,850 kg (4,079 lb)
1,685 kg (3,715 lb)
The trailer must be loaded so that heavy goods
are placed over the axle.
When towing a trailer, inflate the vehicle tyres
to the maximum recommended COLD tyre
pressure (for full loading) indicated on the tyre
placard.
Do not tow a trailer when the vehicle is installed
with a temporary spare tyre or a compact spare
tyre.
SAFETY CHAINS
Always use a suitable chain between the vehicle
and trailer. The chain should be crossed and
should be attached to the hitch, not to the
vehicle bumper or axle. Be sure to leave enough
slack in the chain to permit turning corners.
The total trailer load must be lower than
the following three values even if it does
not exceed the maximum permissible trailer
loads.
y
Rear
TRAILER BRAKES
CA0050
The rear gross axle weight must not exceed the
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
Ensure that trailer brakes are installed as
required by local regulations. Also check that
all other trailer equipment conforms to local
regulations.
Always block the wheels on both the vehicle
and trailer when parking. Apply the hand brake
on the trailer if equipped. Parking on a steep
slope is not recommended.
If parking on a steep slope is unavoidable,
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 64
2021/01/13 02:16:47 PM
POWER STEERING
place the shift lever in the “P” (Park) position
(Automatic transmission model), or in an
appropriate position (Manual transmission
model), and turn the front wheels towards the
curb.
TRAILER DETECTION (if equipped)
When towing a trailer with a genuine NISSAN
tow bar electrical kit and the turn signal switch
is used, the electrical system of the vehicle will
detect the additional electrical load of the trailer
lighting. As a result, the direction indicator tone
will be different.
WARNING:
If the engine is not running or is turned off
while driving, the power assist for the steering will not work. The steering will be much
harder to operate.
The power assisted steering is designed to use
a hydraulic pump driven by the engine, to assist
steering.
If the engine stops or the drive belt breaks, you
will still have control of the vehicle. However,
greater steering effort is needed, especially in
sharp turns and at low speeds.
BRAKE SYSTEM
The brake system has two separate hydraulic
circuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will still
have braking ability at two wheels.
BRAKE PRECAUTIONS
Vacuum assisted brakes
The brake booster aids braking by using engine
vacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop the
vehicle by depressing the foot brake pedal.
However, greater foot pressure on the foot
brake pedal will be required to stop the vehicle.
The stopping distance will be longer.
If the engine is not running or is turned off
while driving, the power assisted brakes will not
function. Braking will be harder.
WARNING:
Do not coast with the engine stopped.
Using brakes
Avoid resting your foot on the foot brake pedal
while driving. This will overheat the brakes, wear
out the brake linings/pads faster, and increase
fuel consumption.
To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the
brakes from overheating, reduce speed and
downshift to a lower gear before going down
a slope or long grade. Overheated brakes may
reduce braking performance and could result in
loss of vehicle control.
While driving on a slippery surface, be careful
when braking, accelerating or downshifting.
Abrupt braking or acceleration could cause the
wheels to skid and result in an accident.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 65
5-65
2021/01/13 02:16:47 PM
Wet brakes
When the vehicle is washed or driven through
water, the brakes may get wet. As a result, your
braking distance will be longer and the vehicle
may pull to one side during braking.
To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe
speed while lightly depressing the foot brake
pedal to heat up the brakes. Do this until the
brakes return to normal. Avoid driving the
vehicle at high speeds until the brakes function
correctly.
Parking brake break-in
Break in the parking brake shoes whenever
the stopping effect of the parking brake is
weakened or whenever the parking brake
shoes and/or drums/rotors are replaced, in
order to assure the best braking performance.
This procedure is described in the vehicle
service manual and can be performed by a
NISSAN dealer.
BRAKE ASSIST (if equipped)
When the force applied to the brake pedal
exceeds a certain level, the Brake Assist is
activated generating greater braking force than
a conventional brake booster even with light
pedal force.
WARNING:
The Brake Assist is only an aid to assist braking operation and is not a collision warning or
avoidance device. It is the driver’s responsibility to stay alert, drive safely and be in control
of the vehicle at all times.
5-66
ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM (ABS) (if
equipped)
WARNING:
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is a
sophisticated device, but it cannot prevent
accidents resulting from careless or dangerous driving techniques. It can help maintain
vehicle control during braking on slippery
surfaces. Remember that stopping distances
on slippery surfaces will be longer than on
normal surfaces even with ABS. Stopping
distances may also be longer on rough, gravel
or snow covered roads, or if you are using
tyre chains. Always maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front of you. Ultimately, the
driver is responsible for safety.
Tyre type and condition may also affect braking effectiveness.
y
When replacing tyres, install the specified
size of tyres on all four wheels.
y
When installing a spare tyre, make sure
that it is the proper size and type as
specified on the tyre placard. (See Tyre
placard" (P9-10).)
y
For detailed information, see" Tyres and
wheels (P.8-30).
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls the
brakes so the wheels do not lock during hard
braking or when braking on slippery surfaces.
The system detects the rotation speed at each
wheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to
prevent each wheel from locking and sliding. By
preventing each wheel from locking, the system
helps the driver maintain steering control and
helps to minimize swerving and spinning on
slippery surfaces.
Using system
Depress the brake pedal and hold it down.
Depress the brake pedal with firm steady
pressure, but do not pump the brakes. The ABS
will operate to prevent the wheels from locking
up. Steer the vehicle to avoid obstacles.
WARNING:
Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so may
result in increased stopping distances.
Self-test feature
The ABS includes electronic sensors, electric
pumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer.
The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature
that tests the system each time you start the
engine and move the vehicle at a low speed in
forward or reverse. When the self-test occurs,
you may hear a “clunk” noise and/or feel a
pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal
and does not indicate a malfunction. If the
computer senses a malfunction, it switches the
ABS off and illuminates the ABS warning light
on the instrument panel. The brake system
then operates normally, but without anti-lock
assistance. If the ABS warning light illuminates
during the self-test or while driving, have the
vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Normal operation
The ABS operates at speeds above 5 to 10 km/h
(3 to 6 MPH). The speed varies according to road
conditions.
When the ABS senses that one or more wheels
are close to locking up, the actuator rapidly
applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 66
2021/01/13 02:16:47 PM
VEHICLE SECURITY
action is similar to pumping the brakes very
quickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brake
pedal and hear a noise from under the hood
or feel a vibration from the actuator when it
is operating. This is normal and indicates that
the ABS is operating properly. However, the
pulsation may indicate that road conditions
are hazardous and extra care is required while
driving.
When the differential lock (if equipped) is
engaged, the ABS warning light illuminates.
This indicates that the anti-lock function is not
fully operating. (See "Rear differential locking
system" (P.5-22) for the rear differential lock
function.)
COLD WEATHER DRIVING
When leaving your vehicle unoccupied:
y
Always take the key with you - even when
leaving the vehicle in your own garage.
y
Close all windows completely and lock all
doors.
y
Always park your vehicle where it can be
seen. Park in a well lit area during the night.
y
If the security system is equipped, use it even for a short period.
y
Never leave children or pets in the vehicle
unattended.
y
Never leave valuables inside the vehicle.
Always take valuables with you.
y
Never leave the vehicle documents in the
vehicle.
y
Never leave articles on a roof rack. Remove
them from the rack and keep and lock them
inside the vehicle.
y
WARNING:
y
Whatever the condition, drive with
caution. Accelerate and decelerate with
great care. If accelerating or decelerating
too fast, the drive wheels will lose even
more traction.
y
Allow more stopping distance in cold
weather driving. Braking should be
started sooner than on dry pavement.
y
Keep at a greater distance from the
vehicle in front of you on slippery roads.
y
Wet ice (0°C, 32°F and freezing rain), very
cold snow and ice can be slick and very
difficult to drive on. The vehicle will have
a lot less traction or grip under these
conditions. Try to avoid driving on wet ice
until the road is salted or sanded.
y
Watch for slippery spots (glaring ice).
These may appear on an otherwise clear
road in shaded areas. If a patch of ice is
seen ahead, brake before reaching it. Try
not to brake while actually on the ice, and
avoid any sudden steering maneuvers.
y
Do not use cruise control on slippery
roads.
y
Snow can trap dangerous exhaust gas
under your vehicle. Keep snow clear of
the exhaust pipe and from around your
vehicle.
Never leave the spare key in the vehicle.
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 67
5-67
2021/01/13 02:16:48 PM
BATTERY
to the chain manufacturer’s instructions.
Use chain tensioners when recommended
by the tyre chain manufacturer to ensure a
tight fit. Loose end links of the tyre chains
must be secured or removed to prevent the
possibility of whipping action damage to the
fenders or underbody. In addition, drive at a
reduced speed, otherwise, your vehicle may
be damaged and/or vehicle handling and
performance may be adversely affected.
If the battery is not fully charged during
extremely cold weather conditions, the battery
fluid may freeze and damage the battery. To
maintain maximum efficiency, the battery
should be checked regularly. For details, see
"Battery: (P.8-18) of this manual.
ENGINE COOLANT
If the vehicle is to be left outside without antifreeze, drain the cooling system, including the
engine block. Refill before operating the vehicle.
For details, see "Changing engine coolant"
(P.8-7) of this manual.
SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT
It is recommended that the following items be
carried in the vehicle during the winter:
y
A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to remove
ice and snow from the windows.
If you have snow tyres installed on the
front/rear wheels of your vehicle, they
should be of the same size, loading range,
construction and type (bias, bias-belted or
radial) as the rear/front tyres.
y
A sturdy, flat board to be placed under the
jack to give it firm support.
y
A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts.
2.
If the vehicle is to be operated in severe
winter conditions, snow tyres should be
installed on all four wheels.
3.
For additional traction on icy roads,
studded tyres may be used. However, some
countries, provinces and states prohibit
their use. Check local, state and provincial
laws before installing studded tyres.
When parking in the area where the outside
temperature is below 0°C (32°F), do not apply
the parking brake to prevent it from freezing.
For safe parking:
TYRE EQUIPMENT
1.
Skid and traction capabilities of studded
snow tyres, on wet or dry surfaces, may
be poorer than that of non-studded snow
tyres.
4.
CORROSION PROTECTION
Chemicals used for road surface deicing
are extremely corrosive and will accelerate
corrosion and the deterioration of underbody
components such as the exhaust system, fuel
and brake lines, brake cables, floor pan and
fenders.
In the winter, the underbody must be cleaned
periodically. For additional information, see
of this manual.
For additional protection against rust and
corrosion, which may be required in some areas,
consult a NISSAN dealer.
PARKING BRAKE
y
Place the shift lever in the “P” (Park) position
(Automatic transmission model).
y
Place the shift lever in the “1” (1st) or “R” (Reverse) gear (Manual transmission model).
y
Securely block the wheels.
Snow chains may be used if desired. Make
sure they are the proper size for the tyres
on your vehicle and are installed according
5-68
Starting and driving
5-Chapter 5.indd 68
2021/01/13 02:16:48 PM
6 In case of emergency
Hazard indicator flasher switch ......................................................... 6-2
Flat tyre................................................................................................................. 6-2
Stopping vehicle ................................................................................... 6-2
Preparing tools ...................................................................................... 6-2
Removing the spare tyre................................................................ 6-3
Blocking wheels .................................................................................... 6-4
Removing tyre ........................................................................................ 6-4
Installing spare tyre ........................................................................... 6-6
Stowing damaged tyre and tools ........................................... 6-7
Jump starting .................................................................................................. 6-7
Push starting ................................................................................................. 6-10
If your vehicle overheats ...................................................................... 6-10
Towing your vehicle ................................................................................. 6-11
Towing precautions ........................................................................ 6-11
Towing recommended by NISSAN ....................................... 6-11
6-Chapter 6.indd 1
2020/12/07 09:46:00 AM
HAZARD INDICATOR FLASHER
SWITCH
FLAT TYRE
If you have a flat tyre, follow the instructions in
this section.
STOPPING VEHICLE
WARNING:
y
Be sure to apply the parking brake firmly.
y
Be sure to move the shift lever to the “P”
(Park) position (automatic transmission
model).
y
The hazard indicator flasher switch operates
regardless of the ignition switch position except
when the battery is discharged.
Be sure to move the shift lever to the “R”
(Reverse) position (manual transmission
model).
y
The hazard indicator flasher is used to warn
other drivers when you have to stop or park
under emergency conditions.
Never change tyres when the vehicle
is on a slope, ice or slippery area. This is
hazardous.
y
When the hazard indicator flasher switch is
pushed, all turn signal lights will flash. To turn
off the hazard indicator flasher, push the hazard
indicator flasher switch again.
Never change tyres when the oncoming
traffic is close to your vehicle. Call for
professional road assistance.
1.
Safely move the vehicle off the road away
from traffic.
2.
Turn on the hazard indicator flasher lights.
3.
Park on a level surface.
4.
Apply the parking brake.
5.
Automatic transmission model:
SIC2574
When an impact that could activate the supplemental air bags is detected, the hazard warning
flasher lights blink automatically. If the hazard
warning flasher switch is pushed, the hazard
warning flashers will turn off. (if equipped)
6-2
Have all passengers get out from the vehicle
and stand in a safe place, away from other
traffic and clear of the vehicle.
PREPARING TOOLS
For Double Cab model
The tool storage compartment is located under
the rear seats.
JVE0201X
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
WARNING:
Do not turn the hazard warning flasher switch
to off until you can make sure that it is safe to
do so. Also, the hazard flasher warning may
not blink automatically depending on the
force of impact.
8.
Manual transmission model:
Move the shift lever to the “R” (Reverse)
position.
6.
7.
Turn off the engine.
Open the hood:
y
To warn other traffic.
y
To signal professional road assistance
personnel that you need assistance.
JVE0202X
1.
Fold the rear seat up
and remove tool
storage compartment lids .
2.
Remove the jack and necessary tools.
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 2
2020/12/07 09:46:00 AM
For Single Cab model
REMOVING THE SPARE TYRE
of the tailgate (if equipped) or under the license
plate. Pass the T-shaped end of the jack rod
through the opening and direct it towards the
spare tyre winch, located directly above the
spare tyre.
Seat the T-shaped end of the jack rod into the
T-shaped opening of the spare tyre winch, and
turn the jack rod counterclockwise
to lower
the spare tyre.
Once the spare tyre is completely lowered
,
reach under the vehicle, remove the retainer
chain, and carefully slide the tyre from under
the rear of the vehicle.
JVR0417X
The tool storage compartment is located behind the front seat.
1.
Pull the lever up
passenger's seat.
and recline the front
2.
Remove the jack and necessary tools.
SCE0514
Find the oval shaped opening under the middle
SCE0982
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 3
6-3
2020/12/07 09:46:00 AM
REMOVING TYRE
CAUTION:
When storing the wheel, be sure to mount the
wheel horizontally. Securing a wheel that is
in a tilted position as illustrated may cause
looseness and dropping of the wheel while
driving. Lower the wheel on the ground again,
and make sure that the hanging plate is properly set. Hang the wheel again and make sure
that the wheel is held horizontally, then store
the wheel.
WARNING:
y
Be sure to read and follow the instructions
in this section.
y
DO NOT GET UNDER A VEHICLE THAT IS
SUPPORTED BY A JACK.
y
Never use a jack which was not provided
with your vehicle.
y
The jack, which is provided with your
vehicle, is designed only to lift your
vehicle during a tyre change.
y
Never jack up the vehicle at a location
other than the jack-up point that is
specified.
y
Never lift the vehicle more than necessary.
y
Never use blocks on or under the jack.
y
Never start or run the engine while the
vehicle is on the jack. The vehicle may
move suddenly, and this may cause an
accident.
y
Never allow passengers to remain in the
vehicle while the tyre is off the ground.
y
Be sure to read the caution label attached
to the jack body before using.
BLOCKING WHEELS
MCE0001D
WARNING:
Be sure to block the appropriate wheel to
prevent the vehicle from moving, which may
cause personal injury.
Removing the wheel cap (if equipped)
SCE0139H
Remove the center wheel cap
as illustrated.
Place suitable blocks
at both the front and
back of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat
tyre to prevent the vehicle from moving when
it is jacked up.
6-4
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 4
2020/12/07 09:46:00 AM
Jacking up vehicle
For leaf suspension models
JVE0212X
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 5
6-5
2020/12/07 09:46:00 AM
3.
Install the assembled jack rod into the jack
as shown.
4.
Carefully raise the vehicle until the clearance
between the tyre and ground is achieved.
5.
To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jack
lever and rod with both hands and turn the
jack lever.
Removing tyre
1.
Remove the wheel nuts.
2.
Remove the damaged tyre.
CAUTION:
The tyre is heavy. Be sure that your feet are
clear from the tyre and use gloves as necessary to avoid injury.
INSTALLING SPARE TYRE
For coil suspension models
WAG0092X
For front wheel
For rear wheel
1.
JVE0208X
Place the jack directly under the jack-up
points or as illustrated.
WARNING:
The jack should be placed on firm level
ground.
2.
y
Loosen each wheel nut, counterclockwise,
one or two turns with the wheel nut wrench.
Do not remove the wheel nuts until the
tyre is off the ground.
6-6
NCE130
Never use wheel nuts which are not
provided with your vehicle. Incorrect
wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel
nuts may cause the wheel to become
loose or come off. This could cause an
accident.
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 6
2020/12/07 09:46:01 AM
JUMP STARTING
Never use oil or grease on the wheel studs
or nuts. This may cause the wheel nuts to
become loose.
STOWING DAMAGED TYRE AND TOOLS
y
The temporary-use spare tyre (if
equipped) is designed for emergency use
only.
y
1.
Clean any mud or dirt from the surface
between the wheel and hub.
Be sure that the tyre, jack and tools are
properly stored after use. Such items
can become dangerous projectiles in an
accident or sudden stop.
y
2.
Carefully put the spare tyre on and tighten
the wheel nuts with your fingers. Check
that all the wheel nuts contact the wheel
surface horizontally.
The temporary-use spare tyre (if
equipped) is designed for emergency use
only.
y
3.
Tighten the wheel nuts alternately and
evenly in the sequence illustrated (
- ), more than 2 times with the wheel nut
wrench, until they are tight.
4.
Lower the vehicle slowly until the tyre
touches the ground.
5.
Tighten the wheel nuts securely, with
the wheel nut wrench, in the sequence
illustrated.
6.
Lower the vehicle completely.
Tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque
with a torque wrench as soon as possible.
Wheel nut tightening torque:
133 N·m (13.6 kg-m, 98 ft-lb)
The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to
specification at all times. It is recommended
that the wheel nuts be tightened to specification at each lubrication interval.
WARNING:
Securely store the damaged tyre, jack and
tools in the storage area in the reverse order
of removal. (See "Preparing tools" (P.6-2) and
"Removing the spare tyre" (P.6-3).)
WARNING:
y
Incorrect jump starting can lead to a
battery explosion. The battery explosion
may result in severe injury or death. It
may also result in damage to the vehicle.
Be sure to follow the instructions in this
section.
y
Explosive hydrogen gas is always present
in the vicinity of the battery. Keep all
sparks and flames away from the battery.
y
Always wear suitable eye protection and
remove rings, bracelets, and any other
jewelry whenever working on or near a
battery.
y
Never lean over the battery while jump
starting.
y
Never allow battery fluid to come into
contact with eyes, skin, clothes or the
vehicle’s painted surfaces. Battery fluid
is a corrosive sulfuric acid which can
cause severe burns. If the fluid comes into
contact with anything, immediately flush
the contacted area with plenty of water.
y
Keep the battery out of the reach of
children.
y
The booster battery must be rated at 12
volts. Use of an incorrectly rated battery
will damage your vehicle.
y
Never attempt to jump start a frozen
battery. It could explode and cause
serious injury.
WARNING:
Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle
has been driven for 1,000 km (600 miles) (also
in case of a flat tyre, etc.).
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 7
6-7
2020/12/07 09:46:01 AM
QR25DE engine models
6-8
JVE0232X
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 8
2020/12/07 09:46:01 AM
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
4.
Switch off all unnecessary electrical systems
(headlights, heater, air conditioner, etc.).
5.
Place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
position.
6.
Remove the vent caps, if equipped, on the
battery.
7.
Cover the battery with a firmly wrung out
moist cloth to reduce the hazard of an
explosion.
8.
Connect the jumper cables in the sequence
as illustrated ( , , , ).
y
Always connect positive
to positive
and negative
to body ground, NOT to
the battery’s negative .
y
Be sure that the jumper cables do
not touch moving parts in the engine
compartment.
y
Be sure that the jumper cable’s clamps do
not contact any other metal.
9.
Start the engine of the booster vehicle
and let it run for a few minutes.
CAUTION:
YD25DDTi engine models
1.
If the booster battery is in another vehicle
position the two vehicles
and
to bring
the batteries into close proximity to each
other.
CAUTION:
y
Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.
y
If the battery of vehicle
equipped with
the Intelligent Key system is discharged,
the steering wheel will lock and cannot
be turned with the ignition switch in
JVE0235X
the “OFF” position. Supply power using
jumper cables before pushing the ignition
switch to any position other than the
“OFF” position and disengaging the
steering lock.
2.
Apply the parking brake.
3.
Automatic transmission (AT) model:
10. Depress the accelerator pedal of the
booster vehicle at about 2,000 rpm.
11. Start the engine of the jumped vehicle
the normal manner.
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
Manual transmission (MT) model:
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 9
in
6-9
2020/12/07 09:46:02 AM
PUSH STARTING
CAUTION:
Never keep the starter motor engaged for
more than 10 seconds. If the engine does not
start right away, place the ignition switch in
the “LOCK” position and wait at least 10 seconds before trying again.
Do not attempt to start the engine by pushing
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
y
Automatic Transmission (AT) model
cannot be started by pushing. Attempting
to do so may cause damage to the
transmission.
12. After the engine is started, carefully
disconnect the jumper cables in the
opposite sequence from that illustrated (
, , ).
y
13. Remove and dispose of the cloth properly
as it may be contaminated with corrosive
acid.
Diesel Oxidation Catalyst equipped
model should not be started by pushing.
Attempting to do so may cause damage
to the catalyst.
y
Never try to start the engine by towing.
When the engine starts, the forward surge
could cause the vehicle to collide with the
towing vehicle.
14. Replace the vent caps, if removed.
IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS
WARNING:
y
Never continue driving if your vehicle
overheats. Doing so could cause engine
damage and/or a vehicle fire.
y
Never open the hood if steam is coming
out.
y
Never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap while the engine is hot.
If the radiator or coolant reservoir cap
is removed when the engine is hot,
pressurized hot water will spurt out
and possibly cause burning, scalding or
serious injury.
y
If steam or coolant is coming from the
engine, stand clear of the vehicle to
prevent getting scalded.
y
The engine cooling fan can start at any
time when the coolant temperature
exceeds preset degrees.
y
Be careful not to allow your hands, hair,
jewelry or clothing to come into contact
with, or to get caught in the cooling fan or
drive belts.
If your vehicle is overheating, or if you feel a lack
of engine power, detect unusual noise, etc., take
the following steps:
1.
Safely move the vehicle off the road away
from traffic.
2.
Turn on the hazard indicator flashers.
3.
Apply the parking brake.
4. Automatic transmission model:
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position.
6-10
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 10
2020/12/07 09:46:02 AM
TOWING YOUR VEHICLE
5.
Open all the windows.
6.
Turn off the air conditioner. Move the
temperature control to maximum hot and
the fan control to high speed.
When towing your vehicle, local regulations
for towing must be followed. Incorrect towing
equipment could damage your vehicle. To
assure proper towing and to prevent accidental
damage to your vehicle, NISSAN recommends
that you have professional road assistance personnel tow your vehicle. It is advisable to have
the professional road assistant carefully read
the following precautions.
7.
Get out from the vehicle.
8.
Visually inspect and listen for steam or
coolant escaping from the radiator before
opening the hood. Wait until no steam or
coolant can be seen before proceeding.
TOWING PRECAUTIONS
9.
Open the engine hood.
Manual transmission model:
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
DO NOT STOP THE ENGINE.
y
Be sure that the transmission, steering
system and powertrain are in working
condition before towing. If any units are
damaged, the vehicle must be towed using
a dolly or flatbed tow truck. (Two- Wheel
Drive (2WD) model)
11. Visually inspect the radiator and radiator
hoses for leakage. If the cooling fan is not
running or the coolant is leaking, stop the
engine.
y
NISSAN recommends that your vehicle
be towed with the driving wheels off the
ground. (Two- Wheel Drive (2WD) model)
y
Always attach safety chains before towing.
12. After the engine cools down, check the
coolant level in the reservoir with the
engine running. Do not open the radiator
or coolant reservoir cap.
y
Never tow Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) model
with any of the wheels on the ground as
this may cause serious and expensive damage to the drivetrain.
10. Visually inspect if the cooling fan is running.
TOWING RECOMMENDED BY NISSAN
Towing Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) models
13. Add coolant to the reservoir if necessary.
Have your vehicle inspected/repaired at a NISSAN dealer.
SCE0185
Front wheels on the ground:
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position
and turn all accessories off.
2.
Secure the steering wheel in a straight
ahead position with rope or similar device.
3.
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 11
6-11
2020/12/07 09:46:02 AM
4.
Release the parking brake.
5.
Attach safety chains before towing.
Rear wheels on the ground:
NISSAN recommends that towing dollies be
used under the rear wheels when towing your
vehicle or the vehicle be placed on a flatbed tow
truck as illustrated.
CAUTION:
Never tow Automatic Transmission (AT) model with the rear wheels on the ground. Doing
so will cause serious and expensive damage
to the transmission.
CAUTION:
Never tow Automatic Transmission (AT) model with all four wheels on the ground. Doing
so will cause serious and expensive damage
to the drivetrain.
Manual Transmission (MT) model:
If you have to tow a MT vehicle with all four
wheels on the ground, perform the following
procedures.
CAUTION:
y
Never tow a Manual Transmission (MT)
model backward with all four wheels on
the ground.
y
Observe the following restricted towing
speeds and distances.
Manual Transmission (MT) model:
If you have to tow a MT vehicle with rear wheel
on the ground, perform the following procedures.
— Speed: Below 50 km/h (30 MPH)
CAUTION:
Observe the following restricted towing
speeds and distances.
y
Speed: Below 50 km/h (30 MPH)
y
Distance: Less than 65 km (40 miles)
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position
and turn all accessories off.
2.
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
3.
Release the parking brake.
4.
Attach safety chains whenever towing.
Towing Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) models
— Distance: Less than 65 km (40 miles)
1.
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position
and turn all accessories off.
2.
Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
position.
3.
Release the parking brake.
ACE0705
All four wheels on the ground:
NISSAN recommends that the vehicle be placed
on a flatbed tow truck as illustrated.
6-12
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 12
2020/12/07 09:46:02 AM
Freeing trapped vehicle
y
The towing hook is under tremendous
stress when used to free a trapped vehicle.
Always pull the pulling device straight out
from the vehicle. Never pull on the towing
hook at an angle.
CAUTION:
In order to not break the towing line, tension
it slowly.
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model
WAG0090X
The layout illustrated is for the Right-Hand
Drive (RHD) model. On the Left-Hand Drive
(LHD) model, the towing hook is located on the
opposite side.
WARNING:
y
Never allow anyone to stand near the
towing line during the pulling operation.
y
Never spin the tyres at high speed. This
could cause them to explode and result
in serious injury. Parts of the vehicle could
also overheat and be damaged.
JVE0209X
NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towed
with all wheels off the ground as illustrated or
place the vehicle on a flatbed truck.
CAUTION:
Never tow 4WD models with any of the wheels
on the ground. Doing so will cause serious
and expensive damage to the drivetrain.
In the event that your vehicle’s tyres become
trapped in sand, snow, or mud, and the vehicle
is unable to free itself without being pulled, use
the towing hook.
y
Use the towing hook only. Do not attach
the pulling device to any other part of the
vehicle body. Otherwise, the vehicle body
may be damaged.
y
Use the towing hook to free a vehicle only.
Never tow a vehicle using only the towing
hook.
In case of emergency
6-Chapter 6.indd 13
6-13
2020/12/07 09:46:02 AM
MEMO
6-14
Illustrated table of contents
6-Chapter 6.indd 14
2020/12/07 09:46:02 AM
7 Appearance and care
Cleaning exterior ...........................................................................................
Washing ......................................................................................................
Removing spots ....................................................................................
Waxing..........................................................................................................
Glass ..............................................................................................................
Underbody ................................................................................................
Wheels ..........................................................................................................
Aluminum alloy wheels ...................................................................
Side step boards (if equipped) ...................................................
Chrome parts .........................................................................................
Cleaning interior ............................................................................................
Air fresheners .........................................................................................
Floor mats .................................................................................................
Glass ..............................................................................................................
Seat belts ...................................................................................................
Corrosion protection ..................................................................................
Most common factors contributing to vehicle
corrosion ....................................................................................................
Environmental factors influence the rate of
corrosion ....................................................................................................
To protect your vehicle from corrosion ..............................
7-Chapter 7.indd 1
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-4
7-4
7-4
7-4
7-5
7-5
7-5
7-5
7-5
2020/12/07 09:47:38 AM
CLEANING EXTERIOR
In order to maintain the appearance of your
vehicle, it is important to take proper care of it.
Whenever possible, park your vehicle inside
a garage or in a covered area to minimize the
chances of damaging the paint surface of your
vehicle.
When it is necessary to park outside, park in a
shady area or protect the vehicle with a body
cover. Be careful not to scratch the paint surface when putting on or removing the body
cover.
WASHING
In the following instances, wash your vehicle as
soon as possible to protect the paint surface:
y
After a rainfall, which may cause the paint
surface damage from acid rain.
y
After driving on coastal roads, which may
cause rusting from the sea breeze.
y
When contaminants such as soot, bird
droppings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs
get on the paint surface.
y
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight
or while the vehicle body is hot, as the
paint surface may become water-spotted.
y
Avoid using tight-napped or rough cloths,
such as washing mitts. Care must be
taken when removing caked-on dirt or
other foreign substances so the paint
surface is not scratched or damaged.
y
Lock all doors before going through
automatic car wash. Locking doors helps
prevent fuel-filler lid from opening and
becoming damaged.
y
For models with decorative
observe the following:
sticker,
— Wash dirt off the vehicle with a wet
sponge and plenty of water. Then wipe
the vehicle gently using a soft cloth.
— Do not apply direct water pressure,
such as high-pressure sprayer, on the
vehicle body around the sticker. This
may cause the sticker edges to peel
away or come off from the vehicle.
wheel wells to loosen the dirt and/or wash
away road salt.
REMOVING SPOTS
Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects, and tree sap as quickly as possible from
the paint surface to avoid lasting damage or
staining. Special cleaning products are available
at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessory
store.
WAXING
Regular waxing protects the paint surface and
helps maintain a new vehicle appearance.
After waxing, polishing is recommended to remove built-up residue and to avoid a weathered
appearance.
A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the
appropriate waxing products.
CAUTION:
y
Wash your vehicle thoroughly and
completely before applying wax to the
paint surface.
y
When dust or mud builds up on the paint
surface.
3.
Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of
clean water.
y
1.
Wash the vehicle surface with a wet sponge
and plenty of water.
4.
Use a dampened chamois to dry the paint
surface and avoid leaving water spots.
Always
follow
the
manufacturer’s
instructions supplied with the wax.
y
2.
Clean the vehicle surface gently and thoroughly using a mild soap, a special vehicle
soap or a general purpose dishwashing
liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm (never
hot) water.
When washing the vehicle, take care of the
following:
Do not use a wax containing any abrasives,
cutting compounds or cleaners that may
damage the vehicle finish.
CAUTION:
y
Do not wash the vehicle with strong
household
soap,
strong
chemical
detergents, gasoline or solvents.
7-2
y
Inside flanges, joints and folds on the doors,
hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to the effects of road salt. Therefore,
these areas must be cleaned regularly.
y
Be sure that the drain holes in the lower
edge of the doors are not clogged.
y
Spray water to the underbody and in the
Machine compounding or aggressive polishing
on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull
the finish or leave swirl marks.
Appearance and care
7-Chapter 7.indd 2
2020/12/07 09:47:38 AM
GLASS
ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS
CHROME PARTS
Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust
film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for
glass to become coated with a film after the
vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner
and a soft cloth will easily remove this film.
Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution, especially during
winter in areas where road salt is used. The salt
residue from road salt could discolor the wheels
if it is not washed off regularly.
Clean all chrome parts regularly with a nonabrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.
UNDERBODY
In areas where road salt is used in the winter,
it is necessary to clean the vehicle’s underbody
regularly in order to prevent dirt and salt from
building up and causing the acceleration of
corrosion on the underbody and suspension.
Before the winter and again in the spring, the
underseal must be checked and, if necessary,
re-treated.
WHEELS
y
Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle
to maintain their appearance.
y
Clean the inner side of the wheels when the
wheel is changed or the underside of the
vehicle is washed.
y
Do not use abrasive cleaners when washing
the wheels.
y
Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or
corrosion. This may cause loss of pressure
or damage the tyre bead.
y
NISSAN recommends that the road wheels
be waxed to protect against road salt in
areas where it is used during winter.
CAUTION:
Follow the directions below to avoid staining
or discoloring the wheels:
y
Do not use a cleaner that uses strong acid
or alkali contents to clean the wheels.
y
Do not apply wheel cleaners to the
wheels when they are hot. The wheel
temperature should be the same as
ambient temperature.
y
Rinse the wheel to completely remove
the cleaner within 15 minutes after the
cleaner is applied.
SIDE STEP BOARDS (if equipped)
CAUTION:
When cleaning the side step boards, follow
the instruction below:
y
Do not use a cleaner that uses strong
acid or alkali contents to clean the side
step boards. Using strong acid or alkali
contents may damage the side step
board surface.
y
Rinse the side step boards to completely
remove the cleaner within 15 minutes
after the cleaner is applied.
Appearance and care
7-Chapter 7.indd 3
7-3
2020/12/07 09:47:38 AM
CLEANING INTERIOR
Occasionally remove loose dust from the interior trim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuum
cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl and
leather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth dampened in mild soap solution, then wipe clean with
a dry, soft cloth.
AIR FRESHENERS
y
Hanging-type air fresheners can cause
permanent discoloration when they contact vehicle interior surfaces. Place the air
freshener in a location that allows it to hang
free and not contact an interior surface.
y
Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip
on the vents. These products can cause
immediate damage and discoloration when
spilled on interior surfaces.
Regular care and cleaning is required in order to
maintain the appearance of the leather.
Before using any fabric protector, read the
manufacturer’s recommendations. Some fabric
protectors contain chemicals that may stain or
bleach the seat material.
Use a soft cloth dampened only with water to
clean the meter and gauge lens covers.
CAUTION:
y
Never use benzine, thinner or any similar
material.
y
Small dirt particles can be abrasive and
damaging to leather surfaces and should
be removed promptly. Do not use saddle
soap, car waxes, polishes, oils, cleaning
fluids, solvents, detergents or ammoniabased cleaners as they damage the
leather natural finish.
y
Never use fabric protectors unless
recommended by the manufacturer.
y
Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on
meter or gauge lens covers. It may
damage the lens covers.
7-4
Appearance and care
7-Chapter 7.indd 4
Floor mat positioning aid
Most air fresheners use a solvent that could
affect the vehicle interior. If you use an air freshener, take the following precautions:
Carefully read and follow the manufacturer’s
instructions before using air fresheners.
FLOOR MATS
The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats (if
equipped) can extend the life of your vehicle
carpet and make it easier to clean the interior.
Regardless of what mats are used, be sure
they are fitted for your vehicle and are properly
positioned in the foot well to prevent interference with pedal operation. Mats should be
maintained with regular cleaning and replaced
if they become excessively worn.
Example
JVA0022X
This vehicle includes floor mat brackets to act
as a floor mat positioning aid. NISSAN floor mats
have been specially designed for your vehicle
model.
Position the mat by placing the floor mat bracket hook through the floor mat grommet hole
while centering the mat in the foot area.
Periodically check that the mats are properly
positioned.
GLASS
Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust
film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for
glass to become coated with a film after the
vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner
and a soft cloth will easily remove this film.
CAUTION:
When cleaning the inside of the windows, do
not use sharp-edged tools, abrasive cleaners
or chlorine-based disinfectant cleaners. They
could damage the electrical conductors, such
as radio antenna elements or rear window
defogger elements.
2020/12/07 09:47:38 AM
CORROSION PROTECTION
SEAT BELTS
WARNING:
y
Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in the
retractor.
y
Never use bleach, dye or chemical
solvents to clean the seat belts, since
these materials may severely weaken the
seat belt webbing.
The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them
with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution.
Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade
before using them. (See "Seat belts" (P.1-8).)
MOST COMMON FACTORS CONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLE CORROSION
y
The accumulation of moisture-retaining
dirt and debris in body panel sections, cavities, and other areas.
y
Damage to the paint surface and other protective coatings caused by gravel and stone
chips or minor traffic accidents.
ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS INFLUENCE
THE RATE OF CORROSION
TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM
CORROSION
y
Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep
the vehicle clean.
y
Always check for minor damage to the
paint surface and if any exists, repair it as
soon as possible.
y
Keep the drain holes in the lower edge of the
doors open to avoid water accumulation.
y
Check the vehicle underbody for accumulation of sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash
with water as soon as possible.
y
Never remove dirt, sand or other debris
from the passenger compartment by
washing it out with a hose. Remove dirt
with a vacuum cleaner.
y
Never allow water or other liquids to come
in contact with electronic components
inside the vehicle as this may damage
them.
Moisture
The accumulation of sand, dirt and water on
the inside floor of the vehicle can accelerate
corrosion. Wet floor carpet/floor mats will not
dry completely inside the vehicle. They should
be removed and completely dried to avoid floor
panel corrosion.
Relative humidity
Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high
relative humidity.
Temperature
High temperatures accelerate the rate of
corrosion to those parts which are not well
ventilated.
Corrosion will also be accelerated in areas
where the temperatures stay above freezing.
Air pollution
Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in the
air in coastal areas, or heavy road salt use accelerates the corrosion process. Road salt also
accelerates the disintegration of paint surfaces.
CAUTION:
Chemicals used for road surface deicing are
extremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosion
and deterioration of underbody components
such as the exhaust system, fuel and brake
lines, brake cables, floor pan and fenders.
In the winter, the underbody must be cleaned
periodically.
For additional protection against rust and corrosion, which may be required in some areas,
consult a NISSAN dealer.
Appearance and care
7-Chapter 7.indd 5
7-5
2020/12/07 09:47:38 AM
MEMO
7-6
Illustrated table of contents
7-Chapter 7.indd 6
2020/12/07 09:47:38 AM
8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
Maintenance requirements ................................................................... 8-2
Scheduled maintenance ................................................................ 8-2
General maintenance ....................................................................... 8-2
Where to go for service ................................................................... 8-2
General maintenance ................................................................................ 8-2
Explanation of general maintenance items .................... 8-2
Maintenance precautions ............................................................. 8-4
Engine compartment check locations ......................................... 8-5
YD25DDTi engine ................................................................................ 8-5
QR25DE engine .................................................................................... 8-6
Engine cooling system .............................................................................. 8-6
Checking engine coolant level .................................................. 8-7
Changing engine coolant.............................................................. 8-7
Engine oil ............................................................................................................. 8-8
Checking engine oil level ............................................................... 8-8
Changing engine oil and oil filter............................................. 8-8
Protect environment...................................................................... 8-10
Fuel filter (YD25DDTi engine model) ........................................... 8-11
Draining water .................................................................................... 8-11
Bleeding the fuel system ............................................................ 8-11
Drive belt........................................................................................................... 8-11
Spark plugs (QR25DE engine model) ......................................... 8-12
Iridium-tipped spark plugs ........................................................ 8-12
Brakes ................................................................................................................. 8-12
Checking parking brake .............................................................. 8-12
Checking foot brake ....................................................................... 8-13
Brake booster ...................................................................................... 8-13
Brake fluid ........................................................................................................ 8-14
Clutch fluid (if equipped)....................................................................... 8-14
Automatic transmission fluid (ATF) (if equipped) ............... 8-15
8-Chapter 8.indd 1
7-speed Automatic Transmission (AT) model............. 8-15
Power steering fluid ................................................................................. 8-15
Air cleaner filter............................................................................................ 8-16
Wiper blades .................................................................................................. 8-16
Windshield wiper blades ............................................................ 8-16
Window washer fluid ............................................................................... 8-17
Battery ............................................................................................................... 8-18
Vehicle battery ................................................................................... 8-18
Remote controller battery (if equipped).......................... 8-19
Intelligent Key battery (if equipped) ................................... 8-20
Variable voltage control system (if equipped) ..................... 8-21
Fuses.................................................................................................................... 8-21
Engine compartment .................................................................... 8-21
Passenger compartment ........................................................... 8-22
Lights................................................................................................................... 8-23
Headlights .............................................................................................. 8-23
Exterior lights ...................................................................................... 8-25
Interior lights........................................................................................ 8-25
Light locations .................................................................................... 8-26
Tyres and wheels........................................................................................ 8-30
Tyre inflation pressure .................................................................. 8-30
Types of tyres ...................................................................................... 8-30
Tyre chains ............................................................................................ 8-30
Tyre rotation ......................................................................................... 8-31
Tyre wear and damage ................................................................ 8-31
Tyre age ................................................................................................... 8-32
Changing tyres and wheels ...................................................... 8-32
Wheel balance ..................................................................................... 8-32
Spare tyre ............................................................................................... 8-32
2021/03/02 03:34:36 PM
MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS
Some day-to-day and regular maintenance is
essential to maintain your vehicle's good mechanical condition, as well as its emission and
engine performance.
It is the owner’s responsibility to make sure that
the specified maintenance, as well as general
maintenance, is performed.
As the vehicle owner, you are the only one who
can ensure that your vehicle receives the proper
maintenance care.
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE
For your convenience, the required scheduled
maintenance items are described and listed in
a separate Warranty Information and Maintenance booklet. You must refer to that booklet
to ensure that necessary maintenance is performed on your vehicle at regular intervals.
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
General maintenance includes those items
which should be checked during normal day-today operation of the vehicle. They are essential
if your vehicle is to continue to operate properly.
It is your responsibility to perform these procedures regularly as prescribed.
Performing general maintenance checks requires minimal mechanical skill and only a few
general automotive tools.
These checks or inspections can be done by
yourself, a qualified technician, or if you prefer,
your NISSAN dealer.
8-2
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
WHERE TO GO FOR SERVICE
If maintenance service is required or your vehicle appears to malfunction, have the systems
checked and tuned by an authorized NISSAN
dealer.
During normal day-to-day operation of the
vehicle, general maintenance should be performed regularly as prescribed in this section.
If you detect any unusual sounds, vibrations or
smells, be sure to check for the cause or have
a NISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, you
should notify a NISSAN dealer if you think that
repairs are required.
When performing any checks or maintenance
work, closely observe "Maintenance precautions" (P.8-4).
EXPLANATION OF GENERAL MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Additional information on the following items
with “*” is found later in this section.
Outside vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should be
performed from time to time, unless otherwise
specified.
Doors and hood:
Check that all doors and the hood operate
smoothly as well as the back door, trunk lid
and hatch. Also make sure that all latches lock
securely. Lubricate if necessary. Make sure that
the secondary latch keeps the hood from opening when the primary latch is released. When
driving in areas using road salt or other corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.
Lights*:
Clean the headlights on a regular basis. Make
sure that the headlights, stop lights, tail lights,
turn signal lights, and other lights are all operating properly and installed securely. Also check
the aim of the headlights.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 2
2021/03/02 03:34:36 PM
Tyres*:
Windshield:
Seat belts:
Check the pressure with a gauge often and
always prior to long distance trips. Adjust the
pressure in all tyres, including the spare, to the
pressure specified. Check carefully for damage,
cuts or excessive wear.
Clean the windshield on a regular basis. Check
the windshield at least every six months for
cracks or other damage. Repair as necessary.
Check that all parts of the seat belt system
(for example, buckles, anchors, adjusters and
retractors) operate properly and smoothly, and
are installed securely. Check the belt webbing
for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.
Tyre rotation*:
In the case that Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) and
front and rear tyres are same size; tyres should
be rotated every 10,000 km (6,000 miles). Tyres
marked with directional indicators can only be
rotated between front and rear. Make sure that
the directional indicators point in the direction
of wheel rotation after the tyre rotation is completed.
In the case that Four-Wheel Drive and All Wheel
Drive (4WD/AWD) and front and rear tyres are
same size; tyres should be rotated every 5,000
km (3,000 miles). Tyres marked with directional
indicators can only be rotated between front
and rear. Make sure that the directional indicators point in the direction of wheel rotation
after the tyre rotation is completed.
In the case that front tyres are different size
from rear tyres; tyres cannot be rotated.
The timing for tyre rotation may vary according
to your driving habits and the road surface
conditions.
Wheel alignment and balance:
If the vehicle should pull to either side while
driving on a straight and level road, or if you
detect uneven or abnormal tyre wear, there
may be a need for wheel alignment. If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal highway
speeds, wheel balancing may be needed.
Wiper blades*:
Check for cracks or wear if not functioning
correctly. Replace as necessary.
Inside vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should
be checked on a regular basis, such as when
performing periodic maintenance, cleaning the
vehicle, etc.
Accelerator pedal:
Check the pedal for smooth operation and
make sure that the pedal does not catch or
require uneven effort. Keep the floor mats away
from the pedal.
Steering wheel:
Check for changes in the steering condition,
such as excessive play, hard steering or strange
noises.
Warning lights and chimes:
Make sure that all warning lights and chimes
are operating properly.
Windshield defogger:
Check that the air comes out of the defogger
outlets properly and in good quantity when
operating the heater or air conditioner.
Brake pedal*:
Windshield wiper and washer*:
Check the pedal for smooth operation and
make sure that it is the proper distance from
the floor mat when depressed fully. Check the
brake booster function. Be sure to keep the
floor mats away from the pedal.
Check that the wipers and washer operate
properly and that the wipers do not streak.
Parking brake*:
Check the parking brake operation regularly.
Check that the lever (if so equipped) or the
pedal (if so equipped) has the proper travel. Also
make sure that the vehicle is held securely on
a fairly steep hill when only the parking brake
is applied.
Under hood and vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should be
checked periodically (for example, each time
you check the engine oil or refuel).
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 3
8-3
2021/03/02 03:34:37 PM
Battery (except for maintenance free
batteries)*:
Check the fluid level in each cell. It should be
between the UPPER and LOWER lines. Vehicles
operated in high temperatures or under severe
conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level.
Brake (and clutch) fluid level(s)*:
For Manual Transmission (MT) model; make sure
that the brake and clutch fluid levels are between the MAX and MIN lines on the reservoirs.
Except for Manual Transmission (MT) model;
make sure that the brake fluid level is between
the MAX and MIN lines on the reservoir.
Engine coolant level*:
Check the coolant level when the engine is cold.
Make sure that the coolant level is between the
MAX and MIN lines on the reservoir.
Power steering fluid level and lines*:
Check the level when the fluid is cold with the
engine off. Check the lines for proper attachment, leaks, cracks, etc.
Windshield washer fluid*:
Check that there is adequate fluid in the reservoir.
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
When performing any inspection or maintenance work on your vehicle, always take care
to prevent serious accidental injury to yourself
or damage to the vehicle. The following are
general precautions which should be closely
observed.
Make sure that drive belt(s) is not frayed, worn,
cracked or oily.
Check the level after parking the vehicle (on a
level ground) and turning off the engine.
8-4
Park the vehicle on a level surface, apply
the parking brake securely and block
the wheels to prevent the vehicle from
moving. Move the shift lever to the “P”
(Park) position (AT model) or the shift lever
to the “N” (Neutral) position (MT model).
y
Be sure the ignition switch is in the “LOCK”
position when performing any parts
replacement or repairs.
y
Do not work under the hood while the
engine is hot. Always turn off the engine
and wait until it cools down.
y
If you must work with the engine running,
keep your hands, clothing, hair and tools
away from moving fans, belts and any
other moving parts.
y
It is advisable to secure or remove any
loose clothing and any jewelry, such as
rings, watches, etc. before working on
Fluid leaks:
Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil, water or
other fluid leaks after the vehicle has been
parked for a while. Water dripping from the air
conditioner after use is normal. If you should
notice any leaks or if fuel fumes are evident,
check for cause and have it corrected immediately.
If you must run the engine in an enclosed
space such as a garage, be sure there is
proper ventilation for exhaust gases to
escape.
y
Never get under the vehicle while it is
supported by a jack.
y
Keep smoking materials, flame and
sparks away from fuel and the battery.
y
Never connect or disconnect either the
battery or any transistorized component
connector while the ignition switch is in
the “ON” position.
y
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic
engine cooling fan. It may come on at any
time without warning, even if the ignition
switch is in the “OFF” position and the
engine is not running. To avoid injury,
always disconnect the negative battery
cable before working near the fan.
y
Always wear eye protection whenever
you work on your vehicle.
y
Never leave the engine or the transmission
related component harness connector
disconnected while the ignition switch is
in the “ON” position.
y
Avoid direct contact with used engine oil
and coolant. Improperly disposed engine
oil, engine coolant, and/or other vehicle
fluids can hurt the environment. Always
conform to local regulations for disposal
of vehicle fluids.
WARNING:
y
Engine drive belt(s)*:
Engine oil level*:
your vehicle.
y
This “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section
provides instructions regarding only those
items which are relatively easy for an owner to
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 4
2021/03/02 03:34:37 PM
ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK LOCATIONS
perform.
You should be aware that incomplete or
improper servicing may result in operating difficulties or excessive emissions, and could affect
your warranty coverage. If in doubt about any
servicing, have it done by a NISSAN dealer.
YD25DDTI ENGINE
WAA0238X
1.
Window washer fluid reservoir
9.
2.
Brake and clutch*1 fluid reservoir*2
10. Engine drive belt location
Power steering fluid reservoir
3.
Engine oil dipstick
11. Radiator filler cap
4.
Fuel filter
12. Engine coolant reservoir
5.
Engine oil filler cap
*1:
6.
Fuse/fusible link holder
7.
Battery
8.
Air cleaner
*2: The layout illustrated is for the Right-Hand
Drive (RHD) model. On the Left-Hand Drive
(LHD) model, brake (and clutch) fluid reservoir is located on the opposite side.
For Manual Transmission (MT) model
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 5
8-5
2021/03/02 03:34:37 PM
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM
QR25DE ENGINE
WARNING:
y
Never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
Serious burns could be caused by highpressure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wait until the engine and radiator cool
down.
y
Engine coolant is poisonous and should
be stored carefully in marked containers
out of the reach of children.
The engine cooling system is filled at the factory with a high-quality, year-round, anti-freeze
coolant solution. The anti-freeze solution
contains rust and corrosion inhibitors, therefore
additional cooling system additives are not
necessary.
CAUTION:
JVC0772X
1.
Window washer fluid reservoir
9.
2.
Brake and clutch* fluid reservoir
10. Radiator filler cap
3.
Engine oil filler cap
11. Power steering fluid reservoir
4.
Engine oil dipstick
*:
5.
Fuse/fusible link holder
6.
Battery
7.
Air cleaner
8.
Engine coolant reservoir
8-6
Engine drive belt location
y
Never use any cooling system additives
such as radiator sealer. Additives may clog
the cooling system and cause damage to
the engine, transmission and/or cooling
system.
y
When adding or replacing coolant, be
sure to use only Genuine NISSAN Engine
Coolant or equivalent in its quality with
the proper mixture ratio. Examples of the
mixture ratio of coolant and water are
shown in the following table:
For Manual Transmission (MT) model
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 6
2021/03/02 03:34:37 PM
Outside
temperature Engine coolant Demineralized
or distilled
down to
(concentrated)
water
°C
°F
−15
5
30%
70%
−35
−30
50%
50%
CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
If the cooling system frequently requires
coolant, have it checked by a NISSAN dealer.
CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT
Contact a NISSAN dealer if replacement is
required.
Use Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant or
equivalent in its quality. Genuine NISSAN Engine
Coolant is a premixed (mixture ratio 50%) type
coolant.
Major engine cooling system repair should be
performed by a NISSAN dealer. The service procedures can be found in the appropriate NISSAN
Service Manual.
The use of other types of coolant solutions may
damage the engine cooling system.
Improper servicing can result in reduced heater
performance and engine overheating.
The radiator is equipped with a pressure cap.
To prevent engine damage, use only a Genuine
NISSAN radiator cap or its equivalent when
replacement is required.
YD25DDTi engine
QR25DE engine
JVM0446X
JVM0529X
Check the coolant level in the reservoir when
the engine is cold. If the coolant level is below
the MIN level , add coolant up to the MAX level
. If the reservoir is empty, check the coolant
level in the radiator when the engine is cold.
If there is insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill
the radiator with coolant up to the filler opening
and also add it to the reservoir up to the MAX
level . Tighten the cap securely after adding
engine coolant.
WARNING:
y
To avoid being scalded, never change the
coolant when the engine is hot.
y
Never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
Serious burns could be caused by high
pressure fluid escaping from the radiator.
y
Avoid direct skin contact with used
coolant. If skin contact is made, wash
thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as
soon as possible.
y
Keep coolant out of reach of children and
pets.
Engine coolant must be disposed of properly.
Check your local regulations.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 7
8-7
2021/03/02 03:34:38 PM
ENGINE OIL
CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL
5.
Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean.
6.
Reinsert the dipstick all the way.
7.
Remove the dipstick and check the oil level.
It should be within the range .
8.
If the oil level is below , remove the oil filler
cap and pour the recommended oil into the
opening. Do not overfill .
9.
YD25DDTi engine
y
Avoid direct skin contact with used oil. If
contacted, wash thoroughly with soap or
hand cleaner and plenty of water as soon
as possible.
y
Store used engine oil in marked containers
out of the reach of children.
Vehicle set-up
When filling the engine oil, do not remove
the dipstick.
1.
Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply
the parking brake.
Recheck the oil level with the dipstick.
2.
Start the engine and warm it up until the
engine temperature reaches the normal
operating temperature (approximately 5
minutes).
3.
Stop the engine.
4.
Wait at least 10 minutes for the engine oil to
drain back to the oil pan.
CAUTION:
JVM0447X
y
y
The oil level should be checked regularly.
Operating your vehicle with an insufficient
amount of oil can damage the engine,
and such damage is not covered by the
warranty.
It is normal to add some oil between
oil maintenance intervals or during
the break-in period, depending on the
severity of operating conditions.
CHANGING ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
QR25DE engine
1.
Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply
the parking brake.
2.
Start the engine and warm it up until the
engine temperature reaches the normal
operating temperature (approximately 5
minutes).
3.
Stop the engine.
4.
Wait at least 10 minutes for the engine oil to
drain back to the oil pan.
8-8
WARNING:
JVM0530X
y
Used oil must be disposed of properly.
Never pour or dump oil into the ground,
canals, rivers, etc. It should be disposed
of at proper waste facilities. NISSAN
recommends having your oil changed by
a NISSAN dealer.
y
Be careful not to burn yourself, as the
engine oil may be hot.
y
Prolonged and repeated contact with
used engine oil may cause skin cancer.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 8
2021/03/02 03:34:38 PM
Engine oil and filter
YD25DDTi engine
YD25DDTi engine
WAI0206X
JVM0531X
QR25DE engine - Two Wheel Drive (2WD) models
WAI0206X
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 9
8-9
2021/03/02 03:34:38 PM
Loosen the oil filter
wrench.
with an oil filter
5.
Remove the oil filter by turning it by hand.
6.
Wipe the engine oil filter mounting surface
with a clean cloth.
Dispose of waste oil and filter properly. Check
your local regulations.
7.
Apply new engine oil to the gasket of a new
oil filter.
PROTECT ENVIRONMENT
8.
Screw in the oil filter clockwise until a slight
resistance is felt, and then tighten an additional 2/3 of a turn to secure the oil filter.
QR25DE engine
15 to 20 N·m
(1.5 to 2.0 kg-m, 11 to 15 ft-lb)
9.
1.
Place a large drain pan under the drain plug
.
2.
Remove the oil filler cap
drain the oil.
3.
Remove the drain plug
and completely
with a wrench.
Waste oil must be disposed of properly.
Check your local regulations.
4.
(Perform steps 4 to 8 only when the engine
oil filter change is needed.)
8-10
After operation
Be sure to remove any old gasket remaining on the mounting surface.
Oil filter tightening torque:
YD25DDTi engine
16 to 20 N·m
(1.6 to 2.0 kg-m, 12 to 15 ft-lb)
JVM0542X
QR25DE engine - Four Wheel Drive (4WD) models
15. Wait at least 10 minutes. Check the engine
oil level according to the proper procedure.
(See "Checking engine oil level" (P.8-8).)
Add engine oil if necessary.
It is illegal to pollute drains, watercourses and
soil. Use authorized waste collection facilities,
including civil amenity sites and garages providing facilities for disposal of used oil and used
oil filters. If in doubt, contact your local authority
for advice on disposal.
The regulations concerning the pollution of
the environment will vary from country to
country.
Clean and reinstall the drain plug and new
washer. Securely tighten the drain plug with
a wrench. Do not use excessive force.
Drain plug tightening torque:
29 to 39 N·m
(3.0 to 4.0 kg-m, 22 to 29 ft-lb)
10. Sufficiently refill with the recommended
engine oil. (See "Recommended fluids/
lubricants and capacities" (P.9-2).)
11. Securely install the oil filler cap.
12. Start the engine.
13. Check the drain plug and the oil filter for any
sign of leakage. Correct as required.
14. Stop the engine.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 10
2021/03/02 03:34:38 PM
FUEL FILTER (YD25DDTi engine
model)
DRAINING WATER
DRIVE BELT
BLEEDING THE FUEL SYSTEM
If the water-in-fuel warning light “
” comes on
while the engine is running, drain water in the
fuel filter as follows:
JVM0472X
JVM0477X
1.
Connect a suitable drain hose
drain plug .
under the hose
to the
2.
Place a drain pan
.
3.
Loosen manually the drain plug with 4 to
5 turns and operate the priming valve to
drain the water out of the fuel filter.
Bleed the air out of the fuel system after refilling
an empty fuel tank by the following procedure:
1.
2.
Operate the priming valve
several times
until there is a sudden resistance felt in the
pressure, then stop.
Crank the engine until the engine starts.
YD25DDTi engine
1.
Water pump
2.
Automatic tensioner
3.
Crankshaft pulley
4.
Alternator
5.
Air conditioner compressor.
CAUTION:
Do not crank the engine for more than 30
seconds.
4.
After draining, close the drain plug manually.
y
If the drain plug is tightened excessively, it
can be damaged and as a result, fuel will
leak.
y
Do not use tools to tighten the drain plug.
5.
Bleed air from the fuel system. For details,
see "Bleeding the fuel system" (P.8-11).
1.
Crankshaft pulley
Start the engine and make sure there is no
fuel leakage. Correct as required.
2.
Automatic tensioner
3.
Alternator
4.
Idler pulley
CAUTION:
6.
JVM0471X
NOTE:
y If the engine does not start, stop cranking
and repeat step 1 of the procedure.
y
If the engine does not operate smoothly
after it has started, race it two or three
times.
QR25DE engine
JVM0533x
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 11
8-11
2021/03/02 03:34:39 PM
SPARK PLUGS (QR25DE engine
model)
5.
Power steering fluid pump
6.
Water pump
7.
Air conditioner compressor
Be sure the ignition switch is in the “LOCK”
position.
Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual
wear, cuts, fraying or looseness. Check the condition regularly. If the belt is in poor condition or
loose, have it replaced or adjusted by a NISSAN
dealer.
WARNING:
Be sure the engine and ignition switch are
off and that the parking brake is applied.
Replace the spark plugs according to the
maintenance schedule log in a separate
maintenance booklet.
If the replacement is required, contact a
NISSAN dealer.
BRAKES
CHECKING PARKING BRAKE
IRIDIUM-TIPPED SPARK PLUGS
SDI1447A
From the released position, pull the parking
brake lever slowly and firmly. If the number of
clicks is out of the range listed, see a NISSAN
dealer.
8 to 9 clicks under a pulling force of 196 N
(20 kg, 44 lb)
SDI2020
It is not necessary to replace the iridium-tipped
spark plugs as frequently as the conventional
type of spark plugs. These spark plugs are
designed to last much longer than the conventional type of spark plug.
CAUTION:
8-12
y
Do not reuse the iridium-tipped spark
plugs by cleaning or re-gapping.
y
Always replace with the recommended
iridium-tipped spark plugs.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 12
2021/03/02 03:34:39 PM
CHECKING FOOT BRAKE
Brake pad wear warning
DI1020MM
WARNING:
See a NISSAN dealer for a brake system check
if the brake pedal height does not return to
normal.
With the engine running, check the distance
between the upper surface of the pedal and
the metal floor. If it is out the range listed, see a
NISSAN dealer.
Depressing force
490 N (50 kg, 110 lb)
LHD model
110 mm (4.3 in) or
more
RHD model
100 mm (3.9 in) or
more
little.
The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings. When a brake pad requires replacement, it
will make a high pitched scraping sound when
the vehicle is in motion. This scraping sound
will first occur only when the brake pedal is
depressed. After more wear of the brake pad,
the sound will always be heard even if the
brake pedal is not depressed. Have the brakes
checked as soon as possible if the wear warning sound is heard.
3.
With the foot brake pedal depressed, stop
the engine. Keep the pedal depressed for
about 30 seconds. The pedal height should
not change.
4.
Run the engine for 1 minute without depressing the foot brake pedal, then turn it
off. Depress the foot brake pedal several
times. The pedal travel distance will decrease gradually with each depression as
the vacuum is released from the booster.
Under some driving or climate conditions, occasional brake squeaks, squeals or other noises
may be heard. Occasional brake noise during
light to moderate stops is normal and does not
affect the function or performance of the brake
system.
If the brakes do not operate properly, have the
brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer.
The rear drum brakes do not have audible wear
indicators. Should you ever hear an unusually
loud noise from the rear drum brakes, have
them checked as soon as possible by a NISSAN
dealer.
Proper brake inspection intervals should be
followed. For additional information, see a separate maintenance booklet.
BRAKE BOOSTER
Check the brake booster function as follows:
1.
With the engine off, depress and release
the foot brake pedal several times. When
the brake pedal movement (distance of
travel) remains the same from one pedal
application to the next, continue on to the
next step.
2.
While depressing the foot brake pedal, start
the engine. The pedal height should drop a
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 13
8-13
2021/03/02 03:34:39 PM
BRAKE FLUID
CLUTCH FLUID (if equipped)
WARNING:
y
Use only new fluid from a sealed container.
Old, inferior, or contaminated fluid may
damage the brake system. The use of
improper fluids can damage the brake
system and affect the vehicle's stopping
ability.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir. If the fluid
is below the MIN line , the brake warning light
will illuminate. Add fluid up to the MAX line .
WARNING:
y
Use only new fluid from a sealed container.
Old, inferior, or contaminated fluid may
damage the clutch system.
y
Clean the filler cap before removing.
y
Clutch fluid is poisonous and should be
stored carefully in marked containers out
of the reach of children.
y
Refilling and checking the brake system
should be left to a NISSAN dealer who
will have the necessary brake fluid and
technical knowledge.
Refilling and checking the clutch system
should be left to a NISSAN dealer who
will have the necessary clutch fluid and
technical knowledge.
y
Do not spill the fluid on painted surfaces.
This will damage the paint. If fluid is
spilled, wash with water.
Do not spill the fluid on painted surfaces.
This will damage the paint. If fluid is
spilled, wash with water.
See "Recommended fluids/lubricants and
capacities (P.9-2) for recommended types of
fluid.
y
Clean the filler cap before removing.
y
Brake fluid is poisonous and should be
stored carefully in marked containers out
of the reach of children.
If fluid must be added frequently, the system
should be thoroughly checked by your NISSAN
dealer.
CAUTION:
CAUTION:
y
y
See "Recommended fluids/lubricants and
capacities (P.9-2) for recommended types of
fluid.
JVM0450X
JVM0450X
8-14
Check the fluid level in the reservoir. If the fluid
is below the MIN line , the brake warning light
will illuminate. Add fluid up to the MAX line .
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 14
2021/03/02 03:34:39 PM
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
(ATF) (if equipped)
If fluid must be added frequently, the system
should be thoroughly checked by your NISSAN
dealer.
POWER STEERING FLUID
7-SPEED AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
(AT) MODEL
Contact a NISSAN dealer if checking or replacement is required.
CAUTION:
y
Use only Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF. Do
not mix with other fluids.
y
Using Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
other than Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF
will cause deterioration in driveability and
automatic transmission durability, and
may damage the automatic transmission,
which is not covered by the warranty.
SDI1718A
WARNING:
Power steering fluid is poisonous and should
be stored carefully in marked containers out
of the reach of children.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir. The fluid
level should be checked in the HOT range ( :
HOT MAX., : HOT MIN.) at fluid temperatures of
50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F) or in the COLD range (
: COLD MAX., : COLD MIN.) at fluid temperatures
of 0 to 30°C (32 to 86°F).
If it is necessary to add fluid, use only specified
fluid. Do not overfill. (See "Recommended
fluids/lubricants and capacities" (P.9-2) for
recommended types of fluid.)
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 15
8-15
2021/03/02 03:34:39 PM
AIR CLEANER FILTER
WIPER BLADES
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
Cleaning
If the windshield does not become clear after
using the windshield washer or if the wiper
blades chatter when operating the windshield
wipers, wax or other materials may be on the
windshield and/or wiper blades.
JVM0451X
WARNING:
y
Operating the engine with the air cleaner
filter off can cause you or others to be
burned. The air cleaner filter not only
cleans the intake air, it also stops flame if
the engine backfires. If the air cleaner filter
is not installed and the engine backfires,
you could be burned. Never drive with the
air cleaner filter off.
y
Never pour fuel into the throttle body or
attempt to start the engine with the air
cleaner removed. Doing so could result in
serious injury.
To remove the filter, release the lock pins
pull the unit upward .
and
The dry paper type filter element may be
cleaned and reused. Replace the air filter
according to the maintenance schedule shown
in a separate maintenance booklet.
Clean the outside of the windshield surface
with a washer solution or mild detergent. Your
windshield is clean if beads do not form when
rinsing with water.
Clean the blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked
in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Rinse
the blade with water. If your windshield is still
not clear after cleaning the blades and using
the wipers, replace the blades.
SDI2693
When a washer nozzle is clogged:
See a NISSAN dealer if a washer nozzle is
clogged or any malfunction occurs. Do not
attempt to clean the nozzle using a needle or a
pin. Doing so may damage the nozzle.
When replacing the filter, wipe the inside of the
air cleaner housing and the cover with a damp
cloth.
8-16
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 16
2021/03/02 03:34:40 PM
WINDOW WASHER FLUID
Replacing
JVM0452X
SDI2048
Replace the wiper blades if they are worn.
1.
Pull the wiper arm.
2.
Push and hold the release tab
move the wiper blade down
arm to remove.
3.
Remove the wiper blade.
4.
Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper
arm until it clicks into place.
y
After wiper blade replacement, return
the wiper arm to its original position.
Otherwise the wiper arm or the engine
hood may be scratched and may cause
damage.
y
Worn windshield wiper blades can
damage the windshield and impair driver
vision.
, and then
the wiper
CAUTION:
WARNING:
Anti-freeze is poisonous and should be
stored carefully in marked containers out of
the reach of children.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir tank and
add fluid if necessary.
Add a washer solvent to the water for better
cleaning. In the winter season, add windshield
washer antifreeze. Follow the manufacturer’s
instructions for the mixture ratio.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 17
8-17
2021/03/02 03:34:40 PM
BATTERY
SDI1573
VEHICLE BATTERY
WARNING:
Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in the
battery is low. Low battery fluid can cause a
higher load on the battery which can generate heat, reduce battery life, and in some
cases lead to an explosion.
8-18
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 18
2021/03/02 03:34:40 PM
Checking battery fluid level
If the side of the battery is not clear, check
the distilled water level by looking directly
above the cell; the condition
indicates
OK and the condition
needs more to be
added.
3.
Replace and tighten the cell plugs.
y
Vehicles operated in high temperatures or
under severe conditions require frequent
checks of the battery fluid level.
y
Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Any
corrosion should be cleared with a firmly
wrung out moist cloth.
y
Make certain the terminal connections are
clean and securely tightened.
y
If the vehicle is not to be used for more than
30 days, disconnect the negative (−) battery
terminal cable to prevent battery discharge.
DI0137MD
y
When changing batteries, do not let dust
or oil get on the components.
y
There is danger of explosion if lithium
battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace
only with the same or equivalent type.
y
Do not expose the battery to excessive
heat such as sunshine, fire, etc.
Jump starting
SDI1480D
If jump starting is necessary, see "Jump starting" (P.6-7). If the engine does not start by
jump starting or the battery does not charge,
the battery may have to be replaced. Contact a
NISSAN dealer for replacing the battery.
Check the fluid level in each cell. The battery
fluid level should be between the UPPER LEVEL
and LOWER LEVEL lines.
REMOTE CONTROLLER BATTERY (If
equipped)
If it is necessary to add fluid, add only
demineralized/distilled water to bring the level
to the indicator in each filler opening. Do not
overfill.
y
Be careful not to allow children to swallow
the battery and removed parts.
y
An improperly disposed battery can harm
the environment. Always confirm local
regulations for battery disposal.
1.
Remove the cell plugs
tool.
using a suitable
2.
Add demineralized/distilled water up to the
UPPER LEVEL line.
Battery replacement
CAUTION:
JVM0381X
To replace the battery:
1.
Insert a small screwdriver into the slit
to open the lid. Use a cloth to protect the
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 19
8-19
2021/03/02 03:34:40 PM
casing.
2.
y
Recommended battery: CR2032 or equivalent
When changing batteries, do not let dust
or oil get on the components.
y
Do not touch the internal circuit and
electric terminals as doing so could
cause a malfunction.
There is danger of explosion if lithium
battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace
only with the same or equivalent type.
y
Do not expose the battery to excessive
heat such as sunshine, fire, etc.
y
Make sure that the
bottom of the case .
y
Intelligent Key and remove the mechanical
key.
regulations for battery disposal.
Replace the battery with a new one.
side faces the
3.
Close the lid securely.
4.
Operate the buttons to check its operation.
2.
3.
See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for
replacement.
FCC Notice:
Insert a small screwdriver into the slit of the
corner and twist it to separate the upper
part from the lower part. Use a cloth to
protect the casing.
Replace the battery with a new one.
y
Recommended
equivalent
battery:
CR2025
or
y
Do not touch the internal circuit and
electric terminals as doing so could
cause a malfunction.
y
Make sure that the
bottom of the case.
side faces the
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
Note: Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
SDI2452
INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY (if equipped)
Battery replacement
CAUTION:
y
Be careful not to allow children to swallow
the battery and removed parts.
y
An improperly disposed battery can harm
the environment. Always confirm local
8-20
SDI2451
To replace the battery:
1.
Release the lock knob at the back of the
4.
Align the tips of the upper and lower parts
, and then push them together until it is
securely closed .
5.
Operate the buttons to check its operation.
See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for
replacement.
FCC Notice:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 20
2021/03/02 03:34:41 PM
VARIABLE VOLTAGE CONTROL
SYSTEM (if equipped)
two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
Note: Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
The variable voltage control system measures
the amount of electrical discharge from the
battery and controls voltage generated by the
alternator.
FUSES
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
CAUTION:
y
Do not ground accessories directly to the
battery terminal. Doing so will bypass
the variable voltage control system
and the vehicle battery may not charge
completely.
y
Use electrical accessories with the engine
running to avoid discharging the vehicle
battery.
JVM0453X
CAUTION:
Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than that specified on the fuse
box cover. This could damage the electrical
system or cause a fire.
The location and the amperage rating of fuses
are shown on the backside of the fuse box lid.
The number of fuses may vary depending on
the features equipped to the vehicle.
If any electrical equipment does not operate,
check for an open fuse.
1.
Be sure the ignition switch is in the “OFF” or
“LOCK” position.
2.
Be sure the headlights are off.
3.
Open the engine hood.
4.
Remove the fuse/fusible link cover by pushing the tab.
5.
Locate the fuse which needs to be replaced.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 21
8-21
2021/03/02 03:34:41 PM
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
SDI1753
6.
Remove the fuse using the fuse puller located in the passenger compartment fuse box.
7.
If the fuse is open
fuse .
JVM0473X
1.
Be sure the ignition switch is in the “OFF”
position.
2.
Be sure the headlights are off.
3.
Open the glove box.
4.
Hold the glove box lid and pull it up to release the hinges located on the underside
of the glove box.
5.
Carefully release the left and right stoppers
and remove the glove box.
6.
Locate the fuse that needs to be replaced.
7.
Remove the fuse using the fuse puller
.
, replace it with a new
If the new fuse also opens, after installing,
have the electrical system checked, and if
necessary repaired, by a NISSAN dealer.
Fusible links
If any electrical equipment does not operate
and the fuses are in good condition, check
the fusible links. If any of these fusible links are
melted, replace only with genuine NISSAN parts.
JVM0474X
SDI1754
8.
If the fuse is open
fuse .
, replace it with a new
9.
Install the glove box following removal
steps in opposite sequence.
If the new fuse also opens, after installing, have
the electrical system checked, and if necessary
repaired, by a NISSAN dealer.
JVM0461X
8-22
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 22
2021/03/02 03:34:41 PM
LIGHTS
Extended storage fuse switch (if
equipped)
How to remove the extended storage fuse
switch:
1.
To remove the extended storage fuse
switch, be sure the ignition switch is in the
“OFF” or “LOCK” position.
2.
Be sure the headlights are off.
3.
Remove the fuse box cover.
4.
Pinch the locking tabs found on each side
of the storage fuse switch.
5.
Pull the extended storage fuse switch
straight out from the fuse box .
HEADLIGHTS
Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of
the exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. A
temperature difference between the inside and
the outside of the lens causes the fog. This is
not a malfunction. If large drops of water collect
inside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.
Replacing LED headlight
If replacement is required, contact a NISSAN
dealer.
JVM0462X
To reduce battery drain, the extended storage
fuse switch comes from the factory switched
off. Prior to delivery of your vehicle, the switch
is pushed in (switched on) and should always
remain on.
If the extended storage fuse switch is not
pushed in (switched on), the “Shipping Mode
On Push Storage Fuse” warning may appear
in the vehicle information display (models with
color display). See "Vehicle information display
warnings and indicators" (P.2-22).
If any electrical equipment does not operate,
remove the extended storage fuse switch and
check for an open fuse.
NOTE:
If the extended storage fuse switch malfunctions or if the fuse is open, it is not necessary
to replace the switch. In this case, remove the
extended storage fuse switch and replace it
with a new fuse of the same rating.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 23
8-23
2021/03/02 03:34:41 PM
Replacing halogen headlight bulb
The halogen headlight is a semi-sealed beam
type which uses replaceable headlight (halogen) bulbs. They can be replaced from inside
the engine compartment without removing the
headlight assembly.
Aiming adjustment is not necessary if only the
bulbs are replaced. When aiming adjustment is
necessary, contact a NISSAN dealer.
CAUTION:
High-pressure halogen gas is sealed inside
the bulb. The bulb may break if the glass
envelope is scratched or the bulb is dropped.
1.
Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2.
Disconnect the electrical connector from
the rear end of the bulb.
3.
Pull off the rubber cap
4.
Push and turn the retaining pin
it.
5.
Remove the headlight bulb. Do not shake or
rotate the bulb when removing it.
6.
Install the new bulb in the reverse order of
removal.
y
When handling the bulb, do not touch the
glass envelope.
y
Use the same number and wattage as
originally installed:
.
to loosen
CAUTION:
Halogen headlight model
High/low beam bulb: 60W/55W (H4)
y
JVM0470X
8-24
Do not leave the bulb out of the headlight
reflector for a long period of time as
dust, moisture and smoke may enter
the headlight body and affect the
performance of the headlight.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 24
2021/03/02 03:34:41 PM
EXTERIOR LIGHTS
Item
Front turn signal light
Clearance light (Halogen headlight models)
Clearance light and daytime running light (LED headlight
models)*
Front fog light (LED type)* (if equipped)
Front fog light (bulb type) (if equipped)
Side turn signal light* (on the outside rearview mirror) (if
equipped)
Side turn signal light (on the front fender) (if equipped)
Rear combination light
Turn signal
Stop/tail (LED type)* (if equipped)
Stop/tail (bulb type) (if equipped)
Reverse
License plate light (LED type)* (if equipped)
License plate light (bulb type) (if equipped)
High-mounted stop light* (if equipped)
*:
INTERIOR LIGHTS
Wattage (W)
21
5
LED
LED
55
LED
Item
Map light (LED type)*
Map light (bulb type)
Room light (if equipped)
Step light (if equipped)
Vanity mirror light (if
equipped)
*:
Wattage (W)
LED
5
10
3.4
1.8
See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.
5
21
LED
21/5
21
LED
5
LED
See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 25
8-25
2021/03/02 03:34:42 PM
LIGHT LOCATIONS
1.
Front turn signal light
2.
Front clearance light and daytime running
light (LED type)
3.
Headlight (high beam) (LED type)
4.
Map light
5.
Room light (if equipped)
6.
Front fog light (if equipped)
7.
Headlight (low beam) (LED type)
8.
Side turn signal light (if equipped) (on the
front fender or the outside rearview mirror)
9.
Step light (if equipped)
10. Clearance light (halogen headlight model)
11. Headlight (halogen type)
12. High-mounted stop light (if equipped)
13. Rear combination light (LED type)
14. Rear combination light (bulb type)
15. License plate light (LED or bulb type)
: LED headlight model
: Halogen headlight model
: Models with LED type rear combination light
: Models with bulb type rear combination
light
WAI0197X
8-26
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 26
2021/03/02 03:34:44 PM
Replacement procedures
Removal of the front grille upper cover
before replacing bulbs:
Clearance light (bulb type)
JVM0457X
WAI0210X
1.
Remove the clips.
2.
Remove the front grille upper cover.
Install the front grille upper cover after replacing bulbs.
JVM0100X
Side turn signal light (on the front fender) (if equipped)
SDI2306
:
REMOVE
:
INSTALL
All other lights are either type A, B, C, D or E.
When replacing a bulb, first remove the lens
and/or cover.
Front turn signal light
JVM0456X
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 27
8-27
2021/03/02 03:34:44 PM
Front fog light (if equipped)
WAI0211X
WAI0227X
Rear combination light (models with truck box and LED
type stop/tail light)
: Turn signal light
: Reverse light or Rear fog light (if equipped)
8-28
WAI0212X
Rear combination light (models with truck box and bulb
type stop/tail light
: Stop/tail light
: Turn signal light
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 28
2021/03/02 03:34:44 PM
: Reverse light (if equipped)
CAUTION:
Do not use the rear combination light (LED
type) with the rear combination light (bulb
type) (and vice versa). Doing so may cause
malfunction of the light.
WAI0288X
License plate light (models without rear bumper)
Front map light (bulb type)
Room light (if equipped)
SDI2391
JVM0553X
Step light (if equipped)
Vanity mirror light (if equipped)
SDI1845
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 29
SDI1839
8-29
2021/03/02 03:34:45 PM
TYRES AND WHEELS
If you have a flat tyre, see "Flat tyre" (P.6-2).
TYRE INFLATION PRESSURE
Periodically check the pressure of the tyres,
including the spare. An incorrect tyre pressure
may adversely affect tyre life and vehicle handling. The tyre pressure should be checked
when tyres are COLD. Tyres are considered
COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or
more hours, or driven less than 1.6 km (1 mile).
COLD tyre pressures are shown on the tyre
placard.
Insufficient pressure can lead to an overheating
of the tyre and subsequent internal damage. At
high speeds, this could result in tread separation and even bursting of the tyre.
TYPES OF TYRES
CAUTION:
When changing or replacing tyres, be sure all
four tyres are of the same type (that is, summer, all season or snow) and construction. A
NISSAN dealer may be able to help you with
information about tyre type, size, speed rating and availability.
Replacement tyres may have a lower speed
rating than the factory equipped tyres, and they
may not match the potential maximum vehicle
speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating
of the tyre.
All season tyres
NISSAN specifies all season tyres on some
models to provide good performance all year,
including snowy and icy road conditions. All
season tyres are identified by ALL SEASON and/
or M&S on the tyre sidewall. Snow tyres have
8-30
better snow traction than all season tyres and
may be more appropriate in some areas.
Summer tyres
NISSAN specifies summer tyres on some models
to provide superior performance on dry roads.
Summer tyre performance is substantially
reduced in snow and ice. Summer tyres do not
have the tyre traction rating M&S on the tyre
sidewall.
If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or
icy conditions, NISSAN recommends the use of
snow or all season tyres on all four wheels.
Snow tyres
If snow tyres are needed, it is necessary to
select tyres equivalent in size and load rating
to the original equipment tyres. If you do not, it
can adversely affect the safety and handling of
your vehicle.
Generally, snow tyres have lower speed ratings
than factory equipped tyres and may not match
the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never
exceed the maximum speed rating of the tyre.
If you install snow tyres, they must be the same
size, brand, construction and tread pattern on
all four wheels.
For additional traction on icy roads, studded
tyres may be used. However, some states and
provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state
and provincial laws before installing studded
tyres. Skid and traction capabilities of studded
snow tyres on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer than that of non-studded snow tyres.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) model
CAUTION:
y
Always use tyres of the same type, size,
brand, construction (bias, bias-belted
or radial), and tread pattern on all four
wheels. Failure to do so may result in
a circumference difference between
tyres on the front and rear axles which
will cause excessive tyre wear and may
damage the transmission, transfer case
and differential gears.
y
ONLY use spare tyres specified for the
4WD model.
If excessive tyre wear is found, it is recommended that all four tyres be replaced with tyres of
the same size, brand, construction and tread
pattern. The tyre pressure and wheel alignment
should also be checked and corrected as necessary. Contact a NISSAN dealer.
TYRE CHAINS
Use of tyre chains may be prohibited according
to location. Check the local laws before installing
tyre chains. When installing tyre chains, make
sure that they are of proper size for the tyres on
your vehicle and are installed according to the
chain manufacturer’s instructions.
Use chain tensioners when recommended by
the tyre chain manufacturer to ensure a tight
fit. Loose end links of the tyre chains must be
secured or removed to prevent the possibility
of whipping action damage to the fenders or
underbody. If possible, avoid fully loading your
vehicle when using tyre chains. In addition, drive
at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your vehicle
may be damaged and/or vehicle handling and
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 30
2021/03/02 03:34:45 PM
performance may be adversely affected.
Tyre chains must be installed only on the rear
wheels and not on the front wheels.
TYRE ROTATION
TYRE WEAR AND DAMAGE
Never install tyre chains on a temporary-use
spare tyre (if equipped).
Do not drive with tyre chains on paved roads
which are clear of snow. Driving with chains
in such conditions can cause damage to the
various mechanisms of the vehicle due to some
overstress.
SDI1662
NISSAN recommends that tyres be rotated
every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) for Four-Wheel
Drive (4WD) or every 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
for Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) model. However,
the timing for tyre rotation may vary according
to your driving habits and the road surface
conditions. (See "Flat tyre" (P.6-2) for the tyre
replacement.)
WARNING:
y
After rotating the tyres, adjust the tyre
pressure.
y
Retighten the wheel nuts when the
vehicle has been driven for 1,000 km (600
miles) (also in cases of a flat tyre, etc.).
y
Do not include the spare tyre in tyre
rotation.
y
Incorrect tyre selection, fitting, care or
maintenance can affect vehicle safety
with risk of accident and injury. If in
doubt, consult a NISSAN dealer or the tyre
manufacturer.
SDI1663
:
Wear indicator
:
Wear indicator location
locations are shown by “
depending on tyre types.
marks. The
”, “TWI”, etc.
Tyres should be periodically inspected for wear,
cracking, bulging or objects caught in the tread.
If excessive wear, cracks, bulging or deep cuts
are found, the tyre should be replaced immediately.
The original tyres have a built-in tread wear
indicator. When the wear indicator is visible, the
tyre should be replaced.
Improper service of a spare tyre may result
in serious personal injury. If it is necessary to
repair the spare tyre, contact a NISSAN dealer.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 31
8-31
2021/03/02 03:34:45 PM
TYRE AGE
WHEEL BALANCE
Never use a tyre over six years old, regardless of
whether it has been used or not.
Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling
and tyre life. Even with regular use, wheels can
get out of balance. Therefore, they should be
balanced as required.
Tyres degrade with age as well as with the
vehicle usage. Have your tyres checked and
balanced often by a repair shop or, if you prefer,
a NISSAN dealer.
CHANGING TYRES AND WHEELS
WARNING:
SPARE TYRE
Conventional spare tyre
A standard tyre (the same size as the road
wheels) is supplied with your vehicle.
Do not install a deformed wheel or tyre even
if it has been repaired. Such wheels or tyres
could have structural damage and could fail
without warning.
When replacing a tyre, use the same size, speed
rating and load carrying capacity as originally
equipped. (See "Tyres and wheels" (P.9-7) for
recommended types and sizes of tyres and
wheels.) The use of tyres other than those
recommended or the mixed use of tyres of
different brands, construction (bias, bias-belted,
or radial), or tread patterns can adversely affect
the ride, braking, handling, ground clearance,
body-to-tyre clearance, snow chain clearance,
speedometer calibration, headlight aim and
bumper height. Some of these effects may lead
to accidents and could result in serious personal injury.
If the wheels are changed for any reason, always
replace with wheels which have the same offset
dimension. Wheels of a different offset could
cause early tyre wear, possibly degraded vehicle
handling characteristics and/or interference
with the brake discs/drums. Such interference
can lead to decreased braking efficiency and/or
early brake pad/shoe wear.
8-32
Maintenance and do-it-yourself
8-Chapter 8.indd 32
2021/03/02 03:34:45 PM
9 Technical information
Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities.................. 9-2
Fuel information ................................................................................... 9-4
Recommended SAE viscosity number ............................... 9-4
Air conditioner system refrigerant and lubricant ....... 9-5
Engine .................................................................................................................... 9-6
Tyres and wheels........................................................................................... 9-7
Dimensions ........................................................................................................ 9-8
When travelling or registering in another country ............. 9-9
Vehicle identification .................................................................................. 9-9
Vehicle identification label............................................................ 9-9
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) label (if
equipped)................................................................................................... 9-9
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)....................................... 9-9
Engine serial number .................................................................... 9-10
Tyre placard .......................................................................................... 9-10
Air conditioner specification label ....................................... 9-10
Installation of an RF-transmitter.................................................... 9-10
Radio approval number and information................................ 9-11
For South Africa ................................................................................. 9-11
For Ghana ............................................................................................... 9-12
For Nigeria.............................................................................................. 9-13
For Comoros ........................................................................................ 9-13
For Benin ................................................................................................. 9-14
For Zambia............................................................................................. 9-15
For Botswana ...................................................................................... 9-16
For Liberia and Seychelles ......................................................... 9-17
For Mauritius, Libya, Central Africa, Guinea Bissau
and Zimbabwe.................................................................................... 9-17
9-Chapter 9.indd 1
2021/01/15 11:35:14 AM
RECOMMENDED FLUIDS/
LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill quantities may be slightly different. When refilling, follow the procedures instructed in the “8.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity.
Fluid type
Fuel
Engine oil*1
QR25DE
Drain and refill
*1: For additional
information, see
"Changing engine
oil and oil filter"
(P.8-8).
Capacity (approximate)
Recommended Fluids/Lubricants
Metric
US
Imperial
Measure
Measure
Measure
80 L
21-1/8 gal 17-5/8 gal • See "Fuel information" (P.9-4).
With oil filter change
4.7 L
5 qt
4–1/8 qt
Without oil filter change
4.4 L
4–75/8 qt
3–7/8 qt
For 2WD models
For South Africa
• Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 5W-30 SN” is recommended.
• If the above motor oil is not available, use “NISSAN Motor Oil” or equivalent that matches the following grade and viscosity.
• Oil grade:
— API SN, ILSAC GF-5
— ACEA A3/B3, A3/B4 or A5/B5
• SAE Viscosity: See “Recommended SAE viscosity number” (P.9-4).
Except for South Africa
• Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 5W-30 SN” is recommended.
• If the above motor oil is not available, use “NISSAN Motor Oil” or equivalent that matches the following grade and viscosity.
• Oil grade: API SN, ILSAC GF-5
• SAE Viscosity: See “Recommended SAE viscosity number” (P.9-4).
For 4WD models
• Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 0W-20 SN” is recommended.
• If the above motor oil is not available, use “NISSAN Motor Oil” or equivalent that matches the following grade and viscosity.
• Oil grade: API SN, ILSAC GF-5
• SAE Viscosity: See “Recommended SAE viscosity number” (P.9-4).
YD25DDTi
Engine coolant
with reservoir
QR25DE
5.3 L
5-5/8 qt
4-5/8 qt
Without oil filter change
4.8 L
5-1/8 qt
4-1/4 qt
With heater
8.1 L
8-5/8 qt
7-1/8 qt
Without heater
YD25DDTi
9-2
With oil filter change
7.3 L
7-3/4 qt
6–3/8 qt
With heater
10.6 L
11-1/4 qt
9-3/8 qt
Without heater
9.8 L
10-3/8 qt
8-5/8 qt
• Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 5W-30 CF-4 or B1” is recommended.
• If the above motor oil is not available, use “NISSAN Motor Oil” or equivalent that matches the following grade and viscosity.
• Oil grade:
— API CF-4*2
— ACEA B1, B3, B4 or B5
*2: Never use API CG-4.
• SAE Viscosity: See "Recommended SAE viscosity number" (P.9-4).
• Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant (blue) or equivalent
• Use Genuine NISSAN Engine Coolant or equivalent in its quality, in
order to avoid possible aluminum corrosion within the engine cooling
system caused by the use of non-genuine engine coolant. Note that any
repairs for the incidents within the engine cooling system while using
non-genuine engine coolant may not be covered by the warranty even if
such incidents occurred during the warranty period.
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 2
2021/01/15 11:35:15 AM
Capacity (approximate)
Fluid type
Metric
Measure
-
US
Measure
-
Imperial
Measure
-
Recommended Fluids/Lubricants
Front
0.85 L
7/8 qt
3/4 qt
Rear
3.50 L
3–3/4 qt
3-1/8 qt
Multi-purpose grease
-
-
-
• Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 (mineral oil)
or equivalent
• NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super
GL-5 80W-90 ONLY in NISSAN final drive. Do not mix with other fluids.
Using fluids that are not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil
Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 may damage the final drive. Damage caused
by the use of fluids other than as recommended is not covered under
the warranty.
• Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super-S GL-5 (synthetic oil)
75W-90 or equivalent
• NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid
Super-S GL-5 synthetic 75W-90 ONLY in NISSAN final drive. Do not mix
with other fluids. Using fluids that are not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN
Differential Oil Hypoid Super-S GL-5 synthetic 75W-90 may damage the
final drive. Damage caused by the use of fluids other than as recommended is not covered under the warranty.
• NLGI No. 2 (Lithium soap base)
Air conditioner system refrigerant
-
-
-
• HFC-134a (R-134a)
Air conditioner system lubricants
-
-
-
• NISSAN A/C System Oil Type S or equivalent
Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Manual transmission (MT) gear
oil
2WD
4WD
Transfer fluid
Power steering fluid
Brake and clutch fluid
Differential gear oil
• Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF
• NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF ONLY in NISSAN
automatic transmissions. Do not mix with other fluids. Using fluids that
are not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF may damage the
automatic transmission. Damage caused by the use of fluids other than
as recommended is not covered under the warranty.
3.0 L
3-1/8 qt
2-5/8 qt • Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi 75W-85
• If Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi is not
available, API GL-4, Viscosity SAE 75W-85 may be used as a temporary
3.4 L
3-5/8 qt
3 qt
replacement. However, use Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid
(MTF) HQ Multi as soon as it is available.
1.5 L
1-5/8 qt
1-3/8 qt • Genuine NISSAN ATF D3M
• Using fluid other than Genuine NISSAN ATF D3M may cause deterioration
in driveability and transfer durability, and may damage the transfer,
which is not covered by the warranty.
Refill to the proper fluid level
• Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent
according to the instructions in the • DEXRONTM VI type ATF may also be used.
“8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” • Genuine NISSAN Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 or DOT4
section.
• Never mix different types of fluids (DOT 3 and DOT 4).
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 3
9-3
2021/01/15 11:35:15 AM
FUEL INFORMATION
RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY
NUMBER
For QR25DE 4WD model
QR25DE engine:
Gasoline engine oil
UNLEADED gasoline with an octane rating of at
least 91 (RON).
5W-30 is preferable.
If 0W-20 is not available, select the viscosity,from the chart below, that is suitable for the
outside temperature range.
Gasoline engine
CAUTION:
Do not use leaded gasoline. Using leaded
gasoline will damage the three-way catalyst.
0W-20 is preferable.
For QR25DE 2WD model
If 5W-30 is not available, select the viscosity,from the chart below, that is suitable for the
outside temperature range.
Diesel engine*
YD25DDTi engine:
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane and with a
maximum of 50 ppm of sulfur (EN590) must be
used.
*if two types of diesel fuel are available, use
summer or winter fuel properly according to
the following temperature conditions.
y
Above -7˚C (20˚F) - Summer type diesel fuel.
y
Below -7˚C (20˚F) - Winter type diesel fuel.
y
Do not use home heating oil, gasoline or
other alternate fuels in your diesel engine.
The use of those or adding those to diesel
fuel can cause engine damage.
y
Do not use summer fuel at temperatures
below −7˚C (20˚F). The cold temperatures
will cause wax to form in the fuel. As a
result, it may prevent the engine from
running smoothly.
CAUTION:
STI0732
STI0589
9-4
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 4
2021/01/15 11:35:15 AM
Diesel engine oil
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM REFRIGERANT AND LUBRICANT
5W-30 is preferable.
If 5W-30 is not available, select the viscosity,
from the chart below, that is suitable for the
outside temperature range.
The air conditioner system of your vehicle
must be charged with the refrigerant HFC-134a
(R134a) and the lubricant NISSAN A/C System Oil
Type S or equivalents.
CAUTION:
Use of any other refrigerants or lubricants will
cause severe damage, and you may need to
replace your vehicle’s entire air conditioner
system.
The release of refrigerants into the atmosphere
is prohibited in many countries and regions. The
refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your vehicle
will not harm the Earth’s ozone layer. However,
it may contribute in a small part to the global
warming effect. NISSAN recommends that
the refrigerant be appropriately recovered
and recycled. Contact a NISSAN dealer when
servicing the air conditioner system.
STI0387B
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 5
9-5
2021/01/15 11:35:15 AM
ENGINE
Engine Model
QR25DE
Type
Cylinder arrangement
Bore × Stroke
mm (in)
YD25DDTi
Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC
Diesel, 4-cycle
4-cylinder, in-line
4-cylinder, in-line
89.0 × 100.0 (3.504 × 3.937)
89 × 100 (3.504 × 3.937)
Displacement
cm3 (cu in)
2,488 (151.82)
2,488 (151.82)
Idle speed at the “N” (Neutral)
position
Ignition timing (B.T.D.C.) at the “N”
(Neutral) position
Spark plugs
rpm
625±50 (4WD)
650±50 (2WD)
750±50*1
10°±2
-
Type
Standard
FXE20HE11
-
Gap
mm (in)
1.0-1.1 (0.043)
-
Timing chain
Timing chain
Camshaft operation
*1: When driving at high altitude, idling speed will increase.
9-6
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 6
2021/01/15 11:35:15 AM
TYRES AND WHEELS
Tyre
Conventional
Spare
Conventional
Road wheel
Spare
Size
Size
Size
Offset mm (in)
Size
Offset
205R16C AT
16 × 6J
55 (2.17)
255/65R17 AT
Conventional
17 × 7J
45 (1.77)
Conventional
Conventional
255/60R18 108H
18 × 7J
45 (1.77)
See the Tyre placard on your vehicle for the recommended COLD tyre pressure.
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 7
9-7
2021/01/15 11:35:15 AM
DIMENSIONS
mm (in)
Destination
For South Africa
Body type
Overall length
Except for South Africa
Single Cab
Double Cab
Single Cab
Double Cab
with rear bumper
5,335 (210.0)
5,260 (207.1)
5,335 (210.0)
5,260 (207.1)
without rear bumper
5,235 (206.1)
5,210 (205.1)
5,235 (206.1)
Overall width
1,790 (70.5)
Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) models
1,750 (68.9)
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) models
1,760 (69.3)
Overall height
Front tread
1,550 (61.0)
1,850 (72.8) (without
over fender)
1,875 (73.8) (with
over fender)
1,815 (71.5) (without
roof rack)
1,845 (72.6) (with
roof rack)
1,825 (71.9) (without
roof rack)
1,855 (73.0) (with
roof rack)
1,570 (61.8)
1,790 (70.5)
1,755 (69.1)
1,760 (69.3)
1,550 (61.0)
5,210 (205.1)
1,850 (72.8) (without
over fender)
1,875 (73.8) (with
over fender)
1,805 (71.1) (without
roof rack)
1,835 (72.2) (with
roof rack)
1,810 (71.3) (without
roof rack)
1,840 (72.4) (with
roof rack)
1,570 (61.8)
Rear tread
1,550 (61.0)
1,570 (61.8)
1,550 (61.0)
1,570 (61.8)
Wheelbase
3,150 (124.0)
3,150 (124.0)
3,150 (124.0)
3,150 (124.0)
9-8
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 8
2021/01/15 11:35:16 AM
WHEN TRAVELLING OR
REGISTERING IN ANOTHER
COUNTRY
When planning to travel in another country
or region, find out whether the fuel required
for your vehicle is available in that country or
region. Using a low octane/cetane rated fuel
may cause engine damage. Therefore, be sure
that the required fuel is available wherever
you go. For additional information regarding
recommended fuel, see earlier in this section.
When transferring the registration of your
vehicle to another country, state, province or
district, contact the appropriate authorities to
find out that the vehicle complies with the local
legal requirements. In some cases, a vehicle
cannot meet the legal requirements, and it may
be necessary to modify the vehicle to meet local
laws and regulations. In addition, there may be
possibilities that a vehicle cannot be adapted in
certain areas.
The laws and regulations for motor vehicle
emission control and safety standards vary
according to the country, state, province or
district; therefore, the vehicle specification may
differ.
When any vehicles are to be taken into another country, state, province or district, its
modification, transportation, registration,
and any other expenses which may result, are
the responsibility of the user. NISSAN is not
responsible for any inconveniences that may
result.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
It is prohibited to cover, paint, weld, cut, drill,
alter or remove Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN).
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN)
LABEL (if equipped)
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION LABEL
JVT0352X
JVT0330X
The vehicle identification label is affixed as
illustrated.
The vehicle identification number label is
attached as shown.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN)
Built date (if equipped)
Built date is stamped
identification label.
on
the
vehicle
The built date means the calendar month and
the year in which the body shell and power train
sub assemblies are conjoined and the vehicle is
driven or moved from the production line.
STI0120A
The vehicle identification number (chassis
number)
is stamped on the frame
as
shown.
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 9
9-9
2021/01/15 11:35:16 AM
INSTALLATION OF AN RFTRANSMITTER
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
TYRE PLACARD
For countries conforming to UN regulation
No.10 or equivalent:
The installation of a RF transmitter in your
vehicle could affect electric equipment systems.
Be sure to check with your NISSAN dealer for
precautionary measures or special instructions
regarding installation. Upon request, your
NISSAN dealer will provide the detailed
information (frequency band, power, antenna
position, installation guide, etc.) regarding
installation.
QR25DE engine
STI0435
JVT0370X
The cold tyre pressures are shown on the tyre
placard affixed to the driver’s side center pillar
(Single Cab model and Double Cab model).
AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION
LABEL
YD25DDTi engine
STI0300A
The number is stamped on the engine as
shown.
JVT0274X
The air conditioner specification label is
attached to the underside of the hood as
shown.
9-10
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 10
2021/01/15 11:35:16 AM
RADIO APPROVAL NUMBER AND
INFORMATION
FOR SOUTH AFRICA
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
Front radar sensor (if equipped)
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
JVT0141X
JVT0500X
JVT0494X
Side radar sensor (if equipped)
JVT0495X
JVT0094X
JVT0499X
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 11
9-11
2021/01/15 11:35:17 AM
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
NCA APPROVED:ZRO-1H-7E3-151
JVT0185X
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
NCA APPROVED:1R3-1M-7E1-x05
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
FOR GHANA
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
NCA APPROVED:NCA/TA/11/44
NCA APPROVED:NCA/TA/11/40
NCA APPROVED:NCA/TA/11/99
9-12
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 12
2021/01/15 11:35:18 AM
FOR NIGERIA
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
FOR COMOROS
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
Numéro d'agrément : 17/005/AGR/GF/DG
Numéro d'agrément : 19/047/AGR/GF/DG
Date d'agrément : 19/08/2019
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
Numéro d'agrément : 17/003/AGR/GF/DG
Date d'agrément : 01/03/2017
Date d'agrément : 01/03/2017
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 13
9-13
2021/01/15 11:35:18 AM
Numéro d'agrément : 17/006/AGR/GF/DG
Date d'agrément : 01/03/2017
FOR BENIN
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
AGREE PAR L'ATRPT BENIN
Numero d'agrement :
117/ARCEP/SE/DR/DAJRC/GU/2019
Date d'agrement : 03/07/2019
AGREE PAR L'ATRPT BENIN
Numero d'agrement :
084/ARCEP/SE/DR/DAJRC/GU/2017
Date d'agrement : 05/05/2017
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
Numéro d'agrément : 17/007/AGR/GF/DG
Date d'agrément : 01/03/2017
AGREE PAR L'ATRPT BENIN
Numero d'agrement :
188/ARCEP/SE/DR/DAJRC/GU/2019
Date d'agrement : 28/10/2019
9-14
AGREE PAR L'ATRPT BENIN
Numero d'agrement :
083/ARCEP/SE/DR/DAJRC/GU/2017
Date d'agrement : 05/05/2017
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 14
2021/01/15 11:35:19 AM
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
AGREE PAR L'ATRPT BENIN
Numero d'agrement : 140/ARCEP/SE/DR/DAJRC/GU/2019
Date d'agrement :26 /07/2019
ZMB/ZICTA/TA/2013/7/1
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
ZMB/ZICTA/TA/2017/2/14
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
FOR ZAMBIA
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
ZMB/ZICTA/TA/2017/2/13
ZMB/ZICTA/TA/2013/7/2
ZMB/ZICTA/TA/2019/7/108
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 15
9-15
2021/01/15 11:35:20 AM
FOR BOTSWANA
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
BOCRA
REGISTERED No :
BOCRA/TA/2019/4825
BOCRA
REGISTERED No :
BOCRA/TA/2019/4624
9-16
BOCRA
REGISTERED No :
BOCRA/TA/2019/4623
BOCRA
REGISTERED No :
BOCRA/TA/2019/4624
BOCRA
REGISTERED No :
BOCRA/TA/2019/4676
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 16
2021/01/15 11:35:20 AM
FOR LIBERIA AND SEYCHELLES
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
FCC CAUTION
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
FCC CAUTION
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
FOR MAURITIUS, LIBYA, CENTRAL
AFRICA GUINEA BISSAU AND ZIMBABWE
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
immobilizer (if equipped)
JVT0495X
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
Remote keyless entry system (if
equipped)
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
FCC CAUTION
JVT0185X
Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
JVT0094X
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS)
immobilizer (if equipped)
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
JVT0141X
JVT0494X
Technical information
9-Chapter 9.indd 17
9-17
2021/01/15 11:35:21 AM
MEMO
9-18
Illustrated table of contents
9-Chapter 9.indd 18
2021/01/15 11:35:21 AM
10 Index
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System).......................... 5-66
Air bag system
Supplemental curtain side-impact air
bag system................................................... 1-25, 1-31
Supplemental driver’s knee air
bag system................................................... 1-25, 1-31
Supplemental front-impact air
bag system................................................... 1-25, 1-31
Supplemental side-impact air
bag system................................................... 1-25, 1-31
Air conditioner ................................................................. 4-18
Air conditioner operation ................................ 4-18
Air conditioner service ....................................... 4-23
Air conditioner specification label ............ 9-10
Air conditioning system refrigerant and
lubricant recommendations ......................... 4-23
Antenna................................................................................ 4-58
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS).......................... 5-66
Anti-lock braking system (ABS) warning
light .......................................................................................... 2-13
Appearance care
Exterior appearance care .................................... 7-2
Interior appearance care ..................................... 7-4
Armrest ..................................................................................... 1-5
Audible reminders ........................................................ 2-17
Audio operation precautions ............................... 4-23
Audio system.................................................................... 4-23
Audio control steering switch .................... 4-56
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD)
player ....................................4-31, 4-36, 4-43, 4-49
Automatic air conditioner ...................................... 4-21
Auxiliary input jack .......................... 4-35, 4-54, 4-55
Average speed................................................................. 2-28
B
Battery ....................................................................... 8-4, 8-18
Battery saver system............................ 2-35, 2-47
10-Index.indd 1
Intelligent Key battery discharge .............. 8-20
Intelligent Key battery replacement ...... 8-20
Remote controller battery
replacement .............................................................. 8-19
Variable voltage control system ................ 8-21
Bleeding the fuel system ......................................... 8-11
Blind Spot Warning (BSW) ...................................... 5-30
Bluetooth® audio player operation
....................................................................................... 4-42, 4-54
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System..................................................................... 4-59, 4-65
Brake
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) .................. 5-66
Brake assist ................................................................ 5-66
Brake booster ........................................................... 8-13
Brake fluid ................................................................... 8-14
Brake system ............................................................ 5-65
Parking brake check ............................................ 8-12
Parking brake operation .................................. 5-68
Warning light ............................................................. 2-13
Break-in schedule ............................................................. 5-4
Brightness control
Instrument panel ................................................... 2-11
Bulb check/instrument panel ............................. 2-13
Bulb replacement ......................................................... 8-24
C
C-Channel system ........................................................ 3-20
Card holder ........................................................................ 2-45
CD player operation .................................................... 4-33
CD/USB memory care and cleaning............... 4-56
Center ventilators ......................................................... 4-17
Child restraint installation using
ISOFIX ..................................................................................... 1-18
Child restraint installation using threepoint type seat belt ..................................................... 1-21
Child restraints................................................................ 1-12
Child safety ............................................................................ 1-9
Child safety rear door lock ......................................... 3-5
Chimes, Audible reminders .................................... 2-17
Circuit breaker, Fusible link ................................... 8-22
Cleaning exterior and interior ...................... 7-2, 7-4
Clock ....................................................................................... 2-29
Clutch
Clutch fluid ................................................................. 8-14
Cockpit ...................................................................................... 2-3
Cold weather driving .................................................. 5-67
Console box....................................................................... 2-43
Console light..................................................................... 2-46
Coolant
Changing engine coolant ................................... 8-6
Checking engine coolant level ....................... 8-7
Corrosion protection ...................................................... 7-5
Cruise control................................................................... 5-41
Cup holders ....................................................................... 2-43
D
Daytime running light system............................. 2-35
Defogger switch............................................................. 2-38
Dimensions ............................................................................ 9-8
Display
Vehicle information display (models
with color display) ................................................. 2-18
Vehicle information display (models
without color display)......................................... 2-29
Door open warning light ......................................... 2-14
Draining water................................................................. 8-11
Drive belt.............................................................................. 8-11
Driving
Cold weather driving .......................................... 5-67
On-pavement and off-road driving ............. 5-6
Precautions when starting and driving.... 5-4
Safety precautions ...................................................5-6
E
ECO drive report ............................................................. 5-58
Economy, Fuel .................................................................. 5-59
2021/01/11 01:28:11 PM
Elapsed time and trip odometer ....................... 2-28
Engine
Break-in schedule ..................................................... 5-4
Changing engine coolant ................................... 8-6
Checking engine coolant level ........................ 8-7
Checking engine oil level ..................................... 8-8
Coolant temperature gauge ............................. 2-9
Engine compartment check locations...... 8-5
Engine cooling system .......................................... 8-6
Engine oil ......................................................................... 8-8
Engine serial number ......................................... 9-10
Engine specifications.............................................. 9-6
Engine start operation indicator (for
Automatic Transmission (AT) models) ... 2-23
Engine start operation indicator (for
Manual Transmission (MT) models) ......... 2-23
Fuel filter....................................................................... 8-11
If your vehicle overheats .................................. 6-10
Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide)............................ 5-5
F
Flat tyre..................................................................................... 6-2
Floor mat cleaning ........................................................... 7-4
Fluid
Brake fluid ................................................................... 8-14
Clutch fluid ................................................................. 8-14
Engine coolant ............................................................ 8-6
Engine oil ......................................................................... 8-8
Power steering fluid ............................................ 8-15
Window washer fluid................................ 8-4, 8-17
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD)
player............................................4-31, 4-36, 4-43, 4-49
Fog light switch .............................................................. 2-36
Front seat, Front seat adjustment ....................... 1-2
Fuel
Bleeding the fuel system ................................. 8-11
Fuel economy ........................................................... 5-59
Fuel filter....................................................................... 8-11
Fuel information ......................................................... 9-4
Fuel octane (cetane) rating............................... 9-4
Gauge ............................................................................. 2-10
Fuel Efficiency and Carbon Dioxide
Reduction driving tips ............................................... 5-59
Fuel-filler lid and cap................................................... 3-17
Fuses....................................................................................... 8-21
Fusible links ....................................................................... 8-22
G
Gauge......................................................................................... 2-7
Engine coolant temperature gauge............ 2-9
Fuel gauge .................................................................. 2-10
Odometer ........................................................................ 2-9
Speedometer ................................................................ 2-9
Tachometer ................................................................... 2-9
Trip computer (with color display) .......... 2-27
Trip computer (without color display) ... 2-30
General maintenance .................................................... 8-2
Glove box ............................................................................. 2-43
H
Hands-Free Phone System, Bluetooth®
....................................................................................... 4-59, 4-65
Head restraints ................................................................... 1-6
Headlights
Bulb replacement .................................................. 8-24
Headlight switch .................................................... 2-32
Heater
Heater and air conditioner operation .... 4-18
High beam assist ........................................................... 2-33
Hill start assist system .............................................. 5-25
Hood release..................................................................... 3-16
Horn......................................................................................... 2-39
I
Impact sensing door lock releasing
mechanism ............................................................................ 3-5
Indicator
Vehicle information display (models
with color display) ................................................. 2-18
Vehicle information display (models
without color display)......................................... 2-29
Indicator lights ................................................................ 2-16
Instrument brightness control ........................... 2-11
Instrument panel .............................................................. 2-5
Intelligent Around View Monitor .......................... 4-8
Intelligent Driver Alertness..................................... 5-56
Intelligent Emergency Braking ........................... 5-43
Intelligent Emergency Braking system
warning light .................................................................... 2-15
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system ................................................................................... 5-49
Intelligent Key ...................................................................... 3-2
Intelligent Key battery ............................................... 8-20
Intelligent Key battery discharge...................... 8-20
Intelligent Key system ................................................... 3-6
Key operating range................................................ 3-8
Interior light switch ..................................................... 2-45
Interior lights .................................................................... 2-45
ISOFIX child restraint system ............................... 1-18
J
Jump starting ...................................................................... 6-7
K
Key
Intelligent Key............................................................... 3-2
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*) key...... 3-2
Keys ............................................................................................. 3-2
For Intelligent Key system ................................. 3-2
Ignition switch ..................................................................... 5-8
Ignition switch (Push-button) ................................. 5-9
10-2
10-Index.indd 2
2021/01/11 01:28:12 PM
L
Labels
Air conditioner specification label ............ 9-10
Engine serial number ......................................... 9-10
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)............. 9-9
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) ......................... 5-26
Light
Bulb replacement ....................................... 8-2, 8-24
Fog light switch ...................................................... 2-36
Headlight switch .................................................... 2-32
Headlights bulb replacement ....................... 8-24
Indicator lights......................................................... 2-16
Interior lights............................................................. 2-45
Map lights .................................................................... 2-46
Replacement .................................................. 8-2, 8-24
Room light .................................................................. 2-47
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders .................................................................... 2-12
Lock
Vehicle speed sensing door lock
mechanism .................................................................... 3-5
Low fuel warning........................................................... 2-24
Low fuel warning light............................................... 2-15
M
Maintenance
Battery ................................................................ 8-4, 8-18
General maintenance............................................. 8-2
Maintenance precautions ................................... 8-4
Maintenance requirement .................................. 8-2
Seat belt maintenance ...................................... 1-12
Malfunction indicator light (MIL) ........................ 2-16
Manual air conditioner and heater .................. 4-19
Map light control switch ......................................... 2-46
Map lights ........................................................................... 2-46
Master warning light .................................................. 2-15
Maximum load limits .................................................. 5-64
Mechanical key (Intelligent Key system)
......................................................................................................... 3-3
Mechanical key (NISSAN Anti-Theft
System) ..................................................................................... 3-2
Meter
Trip computer (with color display) ............ 2-27
Trip computer (without color display) ... 2-30
Meters and gauges .......................................................... 2-7
Instrument brightness control.................... 2-11
Mirror, Vanity mirror..................................................... 3-25
Moving Object Detection (MOD) ........................ 4-14
N
New vehicle break-in ...................................................... 5-4
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*) key ............ 3-2
NissanConnect Owner’s Manual ........................... 4-3
O
Odometer ............................................................................... 2-9
Oil
Checking engine oil level ..................................... 8-8
Engine oil ......................................................................... 8-8
Oil control system ................................................. 2-30
Operating precautions.............................................. 5-63
Outside air temperature .......................................... 2-30
Overheat, If your vehicle overheats................. 6-10
P
Parking
Brake break-in.......................................................... 5-66
Parking brake operation .................................. 5-68
Parking sensor (sonar) function ........................ 4-13
Parking sensor (sonar) system ........................... 5-61
Phone
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System ............................................................. 4-59, 4-65
Power
Auto slide back window system ................ 2-40
Power outlet .............................................................. 2-41
Power steering fluid ............................................ 8-15
Power windows ...................................................... 2-39
Pre-tensioner seat belt system ............. 1,28, 1-34
Precautions
Audio operation ...................................................... 4-23
Cruise control ........................................................... 5-41
Driving safety ................................................................ 5-7
Maintenance ................................................................. 8-4
On-pavement and off-road driving ............. 5-6
Seat belt usage ........................................................... 1-8
When starting and driving................................. 5-4
Push starting .................................................................... 6-10
Push-button ignition switch .................................... 5-9
R
Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) ............................ 5-36
Rear differential locking system ........................ 5-22
Rear door lock, Child safety rear door lock
......................................................................................................... 3-5
Rear ventilators .............................................................. 4-17
Rear view monitor ............................................................ 4-3
Remote controller battery ..................................... 8-19
Remote keyless entry system ................................ 3-5
Roof, Roof rack ................................................................ 2-44
Room light .......................................................................... 2-47
S
Safety chains .................................................................... 5-64
Safety, Child seat belts .................................................. 1-9
Seat
ISOFIX child restraint system ........................ 1-18
Seat adjustment, Front seats ................................... 1-2
Seat belt
Child restraint installation using threepoint type seat belt .............................................. 1-21
10-3
10-Index.indd 3
2021/01/11 01:28:12 PM
Seat belt(s)
Child safety..................................................................... 1-9
Injured persons ....................................................... 1-10
Pre-tensioner seat belt system..... 1-28, 1-34
Precautions on seat belt usage ...................... 1-8
Pregnant women................................................... 1-10
Seat belt cleaning...................................................... 7-5
Seat belt maintenance ...................................... 1-12
Seat belt warning light ...................................... 2-15
Seat belts ......................................................................... 1-8
Shoulder belt height adjustment .............. 1-11
Seat(s)
Seats.................................................................................... 1-2
Servicing air conditioner ......................................... 4-23
Shift lever
Shift lock release.................................................... 5-15
Shift lock release
Transmission ............................................................. 5-15
Shoulder belt height adjustment...................... 1-11
Side ventilators ............................................................... 4-17
Spare tyre ............................................................................ 8-32
Spark plugs ........................................................................ 8-12
Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-9
SRS air bag deployment conditions ............... 1-31
Starting
Jump starting ............................................................... 6-7
Precautions when starting and driving.... 5-4
Push starting ............................................................ 6-10
Steering
Audio control steering switch...................... 4-56
Power steering fluid ............................................ 8-15
Steering lock ............................................................. 5-10
Steering lock release malfunction
indicator ....................................................................... 2-23
Tilting steering wheel ......................................... 3-23
Sun visors............................................................................ 2-45
Sunglasses holder ........................................................ 2-43
Supplemental air bag systems
Supplemental curtain side-impact air
bag system................................................................. 1-31
Supplemental driver’s knee air bag
system ........................................................................... 1-31
Supplemental front-impact air bag
system ........................................................................... 1-31
Supplemental side-impact air bag
system ........................................................................... 1-31
Supplemental curtain side-impact air bag
system ................................................................................... 1-25
Supplemental driver’s knee air bag
system ................................................................................... 1-25
Supplemental front-impact air bag
system ................................................................................... 1-25
Supplemental side-impact air bag
system ................................................................................... 1-25
Switch
Fog light switch ...................................................... 2-36
Headlight switch .................................................... 2-32
Ignition switch ......................................................... 5-10
Power door lock switch ....................................... 3-4
Steering switch ....................................................... 4-56
Turn signal switch ................................................. 2-35
T
Tachometer ........................................................................... 2-9
Tailgate ................................................................................. 3-19
Temperature gauge, Engine coolant
temperature gauge ......................................................... 2-9
Tie down hooks .............................................................. 3-20
Tilting steering wheel ................................................ 3-23
Tyre recommendation for 4WD .......................... 5-21
Tyres
Flat tyre ............................................................................. 6-2
Tyre chains ................................................................. 8-30
Tyre pressure ............................................................ 5-64
Tyre rotation................................................... 8-3, 8-31
Types of tyres ........................................................... 8-30
Towing, Tow truck towing ...................................... 6-11
Trailer towing ................................................................... 5-63
Transmission, Transmission shift lever
lock release ........................................................................ 5-15
Trip computer (with color display) ................... 2-27
Trip computer (without color display) ........... 2-30
Truck box ............................................................................. 3-19
Turbocharger system .................................................... 5-5
Turn signal switch ........................................................ 2-35
U
Underbody cleaning ....................................................... 7-3
Universal child restraints for rear
seats........................................................................................ 1-14
USB (Universal Serial Bus) charging
connector ........................................................................... 2-42
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port .......................................................................................... 4-55
Using remote keyless entry system................... 3-6
V
Vanity mirror ..................................................................... 3-25
Vanity mirror light ......................................................... 2-47
Variable voltage control system ........................ 8-21
Vehicle
Dimensions .................................................................... 9-8
Identification Number (VIN) ............................... 9-9
Speed sensing door lock mechanism ...... 3-5
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)
system ........................................................................... 5-23
Vehicle information display
Vehicle information display warnings
and indicators .......................................................... 2-22
Vehicle information display (models with
color display) .................................................................... 2-18
How to use the vehicle information
display ............................................................................ 2-18
Settings ......................................................................... 2-19
Startup display ........................................................ 2-19
Vehicle information display (models
without color display) ................................................ 2-29
10-4
10-Index.indd 4
2021/01/11 01:28:12 PM
Vehicle speed ................................................................... 2-28
Ventilators .......................................................................... 4-17
W
Wiper
Windshield wiper and washer switch ... 2-36
Wiper blades .............................................................. 8-16
Warning
4WD warning ............................................................ 5-20
Intelligent Forward Collision Warning
system ........................................................................... 5-49
Lights .............................................................................. 2-13
Vehicle information display (models
with color display) ................................................. 2-18
Vehicle information display (models
without color display)......................................... 2-29
Warning lights, indicator lights and
audible reminders ................................................. 2-12
Warning light
Anti-lock braking system (ABS) warning
light .................................................................................. 2-13
Brake warning light.............................................. 2-13
Door open warning light .................................. 2-14
Low fuel warning light ....................................... 2-15
Seat belt warning light ...................................... 2-15
Washer switch, Windshield wiper and
washer switch ................................................................. 2-36
Washing .................................................................................... 7-2
Waxing ....................................................................................... 7-2
Welcome light and farewell light
function .................................................................................... 3-9
Wheels and tyres
Care of wheels ............................................................. 7-3
Cleaning aluminum alloy wheels................... 7-3
Tyres and wheels ........................................ 8-30, 9-7
Window washer fluid ....................................... 8-4, 8-17
Window(s)
Auto slide back window system ................ 2-40
Cleaning................................................................. 7-3, 7-4
Manual windows .................................................... 2-39
Power windows ...................................................... 2-39
Windshield wiper and washer switch ............ 2-36
10-5
10-Index.indd 5
2021/01/11 01:28:12 PM
MEMO
10-6
10-Index.indd 6
2021/01/11 01:28:12 PM
GAS STATION INFORMATION
GAS STATION INFORMATION
FUEL INFORMATION
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OIL
Gasoline engine
See "Recommended
capacities" (P.9-2)
QR25DE engine:
UNLEADED gasoline with an octane rating of at
least 91 (RON).
CAUTION:
Do not use leaded gasoline. Using leaded
gasoline will damage the three-way catalyst.
fluids/lubricants
y
TYRE COLD PRESSURE
See the tyre placard affixed to the driver's side
center pillar.
In case of emergency - 6-1
(Flat tyre, engine will not start, overheating,
towing)
and
y
How to start the engine - 5-1
y
How to read the meters and gauges - 2-1
y
Maintenance and do-it-yourself - 8-1
y
Technical information - 9-1
Diesel engine*
YD25DDTi engine:
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane and with a
maximum of 50 ppm of sulfur (EN590) must be
used.
*if two types of diesel fuel are available, use
summer or winter fuel properly according to
the following temperature conditions.
y
Above -7˚C (20˚F) - Summer type diesel fuel.
y
Below -7˚C (20˚F) - Winter type diesel fuel.
y
Do not use home heating oil, gasoline or
other alternate fuels in your diesel engine.
The use of those or adding those to diesel
fuel can cause engine damage.
y
Do not use summer fuel at temperatures
below −7˚C (20˚F). The cold temperatures
will cause wax to form in the fuel. As a
result, it may prevent the engine from
running smoothly.
CAUTION:
11-Gas station information.indd 1
2020/11/23 12:50:57 PM